703613
559
Verklein
Vergroot
Pagina terug
1/562
Pagina verder
Digital–inthe vehicleVehicle document walletDigital –onthe InternetDigital –asanApp
Familiarize yourself withthe con‐
tents of theOperator's Manual
directly via thevehicle's multi‐
media system (menu item "Vehi‐
cle"). Startwiththe quickguide,
discoveryour vehicle's highlights
or broaden your knowledgewith
useful tips.
Hereyou can find comprehen‐
sive informationabout operating
your vehicle and about services
and warranties in printed form.
Youcan find theOperator's Man‐
ual on theMercedes-Benz home‐
page.
The Mercedes-Benz Guides App
is available free-of-charge in
familiar App stores.
É2225849009ÅËÍ
2225849009
Apple
®
iOS Android
TM
Order no. P222 0157 13
EditionC2018
Part no. 222 5849009
S-Class
Operator's Manual
Mercedes-Benz
Mercedes-Benz S-Class
Publication details
Internet
Further information about Mercedes-Benzvehi‐
cles and about Daimler AG can be found on the
following websites:
http://www.mbusa.com (USAonly)
http://www.mercedes-benz.ca (Canada only)
Editorial office
©
Daimler AG:Not to be reprinted, translated or
otherwise reproduced, in whole or in part, with‐
out written permission from Daimler AG.
Vehiclemanufacturer
Daimler AG
Mercedesstrasse 137
70327Stuttgart
Germany
Symbols
In this Operator's Manual, youwill find thefol‐
lowing symbols:
&
DANGER Dangerdue to notobserving
thewarning notices
Warning notices draw your attentiontohaz‐
ards that mayendanger your healthorlife, or
thehealthorlifeofothers.
#
Please observe thewarning notices in
this manual.
+
ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
damage due to failuretoobserve envi‐
ronmental notes
Environmental notesinclude information on
environmentally responsible behavior or envi‐
ronmentally responsible disposal.
#
Observe environmentalnotes.
*
NOTE Damage to property due to failure
to observe notesonmaterial damage
Notesonmaterial damageinformyou of
riskswhichmay lead to your vehicle being
damaged.
#
Observe notesonmaterial damage.
%
Useful instructions or further information
that couldbehelpful to you.
X
Instruction
(Q page)
Further information on atopic
Display
Information in themultifunction dis‐
play/multimedia display
+
Highestmenu level, whichistobe
selected in themultimedia system
*
Corresponding submenus, whichare
to be selected in themultimedia sys‐
tem
*Indicates acause
As at 12.01.17
Welcome to the world of Mercedes-Benz
Before you first drive off, read this Operator's
Manual carefully and familiarize yourself with
your vehicle. For your own safety and a longer
vehicle life, follow the instructions and warning
notices in this Operator's Manual. Disregarding
them may lead to damage to the vehicle or per‐
sonal injury.
Vehicle damage resulting from the disregard of
the instructions is not covered by the Mercedes-
Benz Limited Warranty.
The equipment or model designation of your
vehicle may vary according to:
R
Model
R
Order
R
National version
R
Availability
Mercedes-Benz reserves the right to introduce
changes in the following areas:
R
Design
R
Equipment
R
Technical features
The equipment in your vehicle may therefore dif‐
fer from that shown in the descriptions and illus‐
trations.
The following are integral parts of the vehicle:
R
Digital Operator's Manual
R
Printed Operator's Manual
R
Maintenance Booklet
R
Equipment-dependent supplements
Keep these documents in the vehicle at all
times. If you sell the vehicle, always pass all of
the documents on to the new owner.
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.
A Daimler Company
2225849009
2225849009
At a glance .................................................... 6
Cockpit ........................................................... 6
Warning and indicator lamps .......................... 8
Overhead control panel ................................ 10
Door control panel and seat adjustment ....... 12
Control settings in the rear passenger
compartment ................................................ 14
Emergencies and breakdowns ...................... 16
Digital Operator's Manual ......................... 18
Calling up the Digital Operator's Manual ...... 18
General notes ............................................. 19
Protecting the environment .......................... 19
Mercedes-Benz GenuineParts ....................... 19
Operator's Manual ........................................20
Service and vehicle operation ....................... 21
Operating safety ...........................................22
Declaration of conformity for wireless
vehicle components .....................................23
Diagnostics connection ................................ 24
Qualified specialist workshop ....................... 25
Correct use of the vehicle ............................25
Problems with your vehicle ........................... 25
Reporting safety defects ...............................25
Limited Warranty .......................................... 26
QR codes for the rescue card ....................... 26
Vehicle data storage .....................................26
Copyright ...................................................... 30
Occupant safety ......................................... 31
Restraint system ...........................................31
Seat belts ..................................................... 33
Airbags ......................................................... 38
PRE-SAFE
®
system ....................................... 45
Children in the vehicle ..................................47
Notes on pets in the vehicle .........................56
Opening and closing .................................. 58
SmartKey ...................................................... 58
Doors ............................................................ 62
Trunk ............................................................ 66
Roller sun blinds ...........................................72
Side windows ................................................ 73
Sliding sunroof ............................................. 77
Anti-theft protection .....................................86
Seats and stowing ..................................... 88
Notes on the correct driver's seat position ... 88
Seats ............................................................ 89
Steering wheel ............................................ 110
Using the memory function .........................113
Memory function in the rear passenger
compartment .............................................. 114
Stowage areas .............................................118
Cup holder .................................................. 129
Ashtray and cigarette lighter .......................132
Sockets ....................................................... 134
Refrigerator box .......................................... 137
Wireless charging of the mobile phone
and connection with the exterior antenna .. 139
Installing or removing the floor mats ........... 141
Installing/removing the pennant holder ...... 141
Light and visibility ................................... 143
Exterior lighting .......................................... 143
Interior lighting ........................................... 148
Windshield wiper and windshield washer
system ........................................................ 149
Mirrors ........................................................ 152
Operating the sun visors ............................. 155
2
Contents
Function of the infrared reflective wind‐
shield ..........................................................155
Climate control ......................................... 157
Overview of climate control systems ..........157
Operating the climate control system ......... 158
Driving and parking ................................. 165
Driving ........................................................ 165
DYNAMIC SELECT switch ............................172
Automatic transmission .............................. 173
Refueling ..................................................... 177
Parking .......................................................179
Driving and driving safety systems .............188
Instrument Display and on-board
computer .................................................. 244
Instrument Display overview .......................244
Overview of the buttons on the steering
wheel ..........................................................245
Operating the on-board computer .............. 245
Overview of displays in the multifunction
display ........................................................ 247
Adjusting the instrument lighting ................247
Menus and submenus ................................. 248
Head-up Display ......................................... 254
Voice Control System .............................. 256
Operating safety .........................................256
Operation ................................................... 256
Using the Voice Control System effec‐
tively ........................................................... 258
Essential voice commands .........................259
Multimedia system .................................. 269
Overview and operation .............................. 269
System settings .......................................... 277
ENERGIZING comfort .................................. 289
Navigation ................................................... 291
Telephone ...................................................315
Online and Internet functions ..................... 330
Media ......................................................... 337
Radio .......................................................... 350
Sound .........................................................357
Rear Seat Entertainment System ................360
Maintenance and care ............................. 377
ASSYST PLUS service interval display .........377
Engine compartment .................................. 378
Cleaning and care .......................................385
Breakdown assistance ............................ 393
Emergency ..................................................393
Flat tire ....................................................... 393
Battery (vehicle) ......................................... 399
Tow starting or towing away ....................... 404
Electrical fuses ............................................ 410
Wheels and tires ....................................... 413
Noise or unusual handling characteristics ...413
Checking wheels and tires regularly ............ 413
Notes on snow chains .................................414
Tire pressure ...............................................414
Loading the vehicle .................................... 420
Tire labeling ................................................ 425
Definition of terms for tires and loading ..... 431
Changing a wheel ....................................... 433
Contents
3
Technical data .......................................... 443
Notes on technical data .............................. 443
Vehicle electronics .....................................443
Vehicle identification plate, VIN and
engine number overview ............................ 445
Operating fluids .......................................... 447
Vehicle data ................................................ 454
Display messages and warning/indi‐
cator lamps .............................................. 457
Display messages .......................................457
Warning and indicator lamps ...................... 501
Index .......................................................... 519
4
Contents
6
At a glance Cockpit
1
Steering wheel gearshift paddle
176
2
Combination switch
144
3
DIRECT SELECT lever
173
4
PASSENGER AIRBAG indicator lamps
,, 43
5
Display (multimedia system)
269
6
Start/Stop button
166
7
Climate control systems
158
8
Glove box
120
9
Stowage compartment
120
A
Cup holder
129
B
Hazard warning lights
145
C
Extends the head restraints of the rear seats
102
D
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
220
E
Control elements for the multimedia system
269
F
Active Parking Assist
228
G
Sets the vehicle level
213
H
DYNAMIC SELECT switch
173
I
ECO start/stop function
171
J
Control panel for the multimedia system
245
K
Adjusts the steering wheel
110
L
Control panel for:
On-board computer
245
Operating cruise control
197
Operating Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
200
M
Unlocks the hood
378
N
Electric parking brake
185
O
Light switch
143
P
Control panel for:
Active Steering Assist
206
Active Lane Keeping Assist
242
Night View Assist
236
Head-up Display
255
Rear window roller sunblind
72
At a glance Cockpit
7
Instrument Display in the Widescreen Cockpit
8
At a glance Warning and indicator lamps
1
Speedometer
244
2
AIR BODY CONTROL malfunctioning
511
3
#! Turn signal light
144
4
Multifunction display
247
5
Tachometer
244
6
å ESP
®
OFF
503
÷ ESP
®
503
7
K High beam
144
L Low beam
143
T Parking lights
143
8
? Coolant too hot/cold
513
9
Coolant temperature gauge
244
A
· Distance warning
511
B
Ð Steering assistance malfunction
512
C
# Electrical malfunction
513
D
Brakes (red)
503
$ USA only
J Canada only
E
ü Seat belt is not fastened
510
F
Fuel level indicator
G
8 Fuel reserve with fuel filler flap location
indicator
513
H
R Rear fog light
144
I
6 Restraint system
J
% Indicator lamp has no function
K
; Check Engine
513
L
J Brakes (yellow)
503
M
Electric parking brake applied (red)
503
F USA only
! Canada only
N
h Tire pressure monitoring system
517
O
! ABS malfunction
503
P
! Electric parking brake (yellow)
503
At a glance Warning and indicator lamps
9
10
At a glance Overhead control panel
1
Sun visors
155
2
F Breakdown assistance call button
(mbrace
®
)
330
3
p Switches the left-hand reading lamp
on/off
148
4
| Switches the automatic lighting control
on/off
148
5
G SOS button (mbrace
®
)
329
6
c Switches the front interior lighting on/off
148
7
u Switches the rear interior lighting on/off
148
8
p Switches the right-hand reading lamp
on/off
148
9
ï MB Info call button (mbrace
®
)
329
A
Eyeglasses compartment
121
B
3 Opens/closes the panoramic sliding sun‐
roof
77
Opens/closes the roller sunblinds
77
C
Operates MAGIC SKY CONTROL
82
D
Rear-view mirror
At a glance Overhead control panel
11
12
At a glance Door control panel and seat adjustment
1
Adjusts the seats electrically
89
2
Switches the seat heater on/off
107
3
Switches the seat ventilation on/off
109
4
Adjusts the front passenger seat from the driv‐
er's seat
91
5
Sets the memory function
113
6
W Opens/closes the rear left side window
73
7
W Opens/closes the left side window
73
8
Adjusts and folds the outside mirrors out/in
electrically
152
9
Opens/closes the trunk lid
66
A
W Opens/closes the right side window
73
B
W Opens/closes the rear right side window
73
C
Child safety lock for the rear side windows
56
D
Opens the door
62
E
& Locks the vehicle
63
F
% Unlocks the vehicle
63
G
Seat adjustment using the multimedia system
105
H
Adjusts the head restraints
100
At a glance Door control panel and seat adjustment
13
Vehicles with a reclining rear seat
14
At a glance Control settings in the rear passenger compartment
1
Blu-ray/DVD drive
2
Cigarette lighter
133
Socket
134
3
Cup holder
130
4
Stowage compartment in the rear armrest
121
5
Stowage box in the seat backrest
122
Refrigerator box
137
6
Selects the front passenger seat
91
7
Switches the rear seat heater on/off
107
8
Switches the rear seat ventilation on/off
109
9
Sets the fore-and-aft position of the head
restraint
93
A
Adjusts the height of the head restraint
93
B
Seat backrest inclination
93
C
Sets the combined seat cushion inclination and
length
93
D
Sets the combined seat cushion inclination and
length
93
E
Angle of the leg rest
93
F
Fore-and-aft position of the leg rest
93
G
Memory function in the rear passenger com‐
partment
114
H
Sets the fully reclined position
94
At a glance Control settings in the rear passenger compartment
15
16
At a glance Emergencies and breakdowns
What to do in the event of an accident
1
QR code for accessing the rescue card
26
2
Safety vests
393
3
Button for the SOS emergency call system and
Roadside Assistance
328
4
Checking and topping up operating fluids
447
5
Tow-starting and towing away
405
6
Flat tire
393
7
Starting assistance
401
8
Hazard warning lights
145
9
Fuel filler flap with instruction labels for tire
pressure, fuel type and QR codes for accessing
the rescue card
177
A
Tow-starting and towing away
405
B
TIREFIT kit
395
At a glance Emergencies and breakdowns
17
Calling up the Digital Operator's Manual
Multimedia system:
,

.
Õ  
#
Select a menu item.
In addition, you can also call up the Operator's
Manual within a main function (e.g. via 
 ).
The Digital Operator's Manual describes the
function and operation of:
R
the vehicle
R
the multimedia system
For safety reasons, the Digital Operator's Man‐
ual is deactivated while driving.
The Digital Operator's Manual contains the fol‐
lowing menu items:
R
: allows you to search precisely for
keywords.
R
 : provides you with important
information so that you can start using your
vehicle immediately.
R
: provides tips on how to use your vehicle
in certain situations.
R
: provides you with further informa‐
tion about the messages in the instrument
cluster.
R
: provides you with a list of all the
bookmarks you have stored yourself.
1
Picture
2
Menu
3
Navigation window
Some sections of the Digital Operator's Manual,
such as warning notes, can be made visible by
highlighting and pressing them.
%
The Operator's Manual can also be found in
the Mercedes-Benz Guides App in all com‐
mon App Stores.
18
Digital Operator's Manual
Protecting the environment
Plug-in hybrid: observe the notes in the Supple‐
ment. Otherwise, you may not recognize dan‐
gers.
+
ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
damage due to operating conditions and
personal driving style
The pollutant emission of your vehicle is
directly related to the way you operate your
vehicle.
You can help to protect the environment by
operating your vehicle in an environmentally-
responsible manner. Please observe the fol‐
lowing recommendations on operating condi‐
tions and personal driving style.
Operating conditions:
#
Make sure that the tire pressure is cor‐
rect.
#
Do not carry any unnecessary weight
(e.g. roof luggage racks once you no
longer need them).
#
Adhere to the service intervals.
A regularly serviced vehicle will contrib‐
ute to environmental protection.
#
Always have service work carried out at
a qualified specialist workshop.
Personal driving style:
#
Do not depress the accelerator pedal
when starting the engine.
#
Do not warm up the engine while the
vehicle is stationary.
#
Drive carefully and maintain a suitable
distance from the vehicle in front.
#
Avoid frequent, sudden acceleration
and braking.
#
Change gear in good time and use each
gear only up to Ô of its maximum
engine speed.
#
Switch off the engine in stationary traf‐
fic, e.g. by using the ECO start/stop
function.
#
Drive in a fuel-efficient manner.
Environmental issues and recommendations:
It is recommended that you re-use or recycle
materials first instead of just disposing of them.
The relevant environmental regulations and
guidelines serve to protect the environment and
must be strictly observed.
Mercedes-Benz GenuineParts
+
ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
damage caused by not using recycled
reconditioned components
Daimler AG offers recycled reconditioned
components and parts with the same quality
as new parts. The same entitlement from the
Limited Warranty is valid as for new parts.
#
Use recycled reconditioned compo‐
nents and parts from Daimler AG.
General notes
19
*
NOTE Impairment of the operating effi
ciency of the restraint systems from
installing accessories or from repairs or
welding
Airbags, Emergency Tensioning Devices, as
well as control units and sensors for the
restraint systems, may be installed in the fol‐
lowing areas of your vehicle:
R
Doors
R
Door pillars
R
Door sills
R
Seats
R
Cockpit
R
Instrument cluster
R
Center console
#
Do not install accessories such as audio
systems in these areas.
#
Do not carry out repairs or welding.
#
Have accessories retrofitted at a quali‐
fied specialist workshop.
You could jeopardize the operating safety of your
vehicle if you use parts, tires and wheels as well
as accessories relevant to safety which have not
been approved by Mercedes-Benz. Safety-rele‐
vant systems, e.g. the brake system, may mal‐
function. Only use Mercedes-Benz GenuineParts
or parts of equal quality. Only use tires, wheels
and accessory parts that have been specifically
approved for your vehicle model.
Mercedes-Benz GenuineParts are subject to
strict quality control. Each part has been spe‐
cially developed, manufactured or selected for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles and fine-tuned for them.
Therefore, only Mercedes-Benz GenuineParts
should be used.
More than 300,000 different Mercedes-Benz
GenuineParts are available for Mercedes-Benz
models.
All authorized Mercedes-Benz Centers maintain
a supply of Mercedes-Benz GenuineParts for
necessary service and repair work. In addition,
strategically located parts-delivery centers pro‐
vide for quick and reliable parts service.
Always specify the vehicle identification number
(VIN) (
page 445) when ordering Mercedes-
Benz GenuineParts.
Operator's Manual
This Operator's Manual describes all models and
all standard and optional equipment available for
your vehicle at the time of this Operator's Man‐
ual going to press. Country-specific differences
are possible. Note that your vehicle may not be
equipped with all features described. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and functions.
Therefore, the equipment on your vehicle may
differ from that in the descriptions and illustra‐
tions.
The original purchase contract documentation
for your vehicle contains a list of all of the sys‐
tems in your vehicle.
Should you have any questions concerning
equipment and operation, please consult an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
The Operator's Manual and Maintenance Booklet
are important documents and should be kept in
the vehicle.
20
General notes
Service and vehicle operation
Vehicle operation outside the USA or Canada
When you are abroad with your vehicle, observe
the following points:
R
Service points or replacement parts may not
be available immediately.
R
Unleaded fuel may not be available for vehi‐
cles with a catalytic converter. Leaded fuel
may cause damage to the catalytic converter.
R
The fuel may have an extremely low octane
number. Unsuitable fuel can cause engine
damage.
Some Mercedes-Benz models are available in
Europe through our European Delivery Program.
For more information, please consult an author‐
ized Mercedes‑Benz service center, or write to
one of the following address:
In the USA:
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC
European Delivery Department
One Mercedes Drive
Montvale, NJ 07645-0350
In Canada:
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.
European Delivery Department
98 Vanderhoof Avenue
Toronto, Ontario M4G 4C9
Maintenance
Your customer advisor confirms the service in
the service report.
Roadside Assistance
The Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Pro‐
gram offers technical help in the case of a
breakdown. Your calls to the toll-free Roadside
Assistance Hotline are answered by our agents
24 hours a day, 365 days a year.
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372) (USA)
1-800-387-0100 (Canada)
You can find further information in the
Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Program
brochure (USA) or the "Roadside Assistance"
section in the maintenance and warranty infor‐
mation booklet (Canada). You will find both in
the vehicle document wallet.
Change of address or change of ownership
In the event of a change of address, please send
us the "Notification of address change" in the
Service and Guarantee booklet or simply call the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center
(USA) on the hotline number
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372) or Cus‐
tomer Service (Canada) on 1-800-387-0100. We
can then reach you in a timely fashion, if neces‐
sary.
If you sell your Mercedes, please leave all litera‐
ture in the vehicle so that it is available to the
next owner. If you have purchased a used vehi‐
cle, please send us the "Notice of Purchase of
Used Car" in the Service and Guarantee booklet
or simply call the Mercedes-Benz Customer
Assistance Center (USA) at the hotline number
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372) or Cus‐
tomer Service (Canada) at 1-800-387-0100.
General notes
21
Important notice for California retail buyers
and lessees of Mercedes-Benz automobiles
Under California law you may be entitled to a
replacement of your vehicle or a refund of the
purchase price or lease price, if after a reasona‐
ble number of repair attempts Mercedes-Benz
USA, LLC and/or its authorized repair or service
facilities fail to fix one or more substantial
defects or malfunctions in the vehicle that are
covered by its express warranty.
During a period of 18 months from original deliv‐
ery of the vehicle or a kilometer/mileage read‐
ing of 18,000 miles (29,000 km), whichever
occurs first, vehicle repair is presumed for a
retail buyer or lessee if one or more of the fol‐
lowing occurs:
(1) the serious defect or damage can result in
deadly or serious injury to the vehicle occu‐
pants while driving AND this defect has
already been repaired at least twice AND
Mercedes‑Benz, LLC has been informed in
writing of the necessity of a repair.
(2) the defect or damage, though less serious
than (1) above, has already been repaired at
least four times AND Mercedes‑Benz has
been informed in writing of the necessity of
a repair.
(3) the vehicle cannot be used for longer than
30 calendar days because of repair work
resulting from this or other serious defects
or damage.
Please send your written notice to:
Mercedes‑Benz USA, LLC
Customer Assista
nce C
enter
3 Mercedes Drive
Montvale, NJ 07645-0350
Operating safety
Plug-in hybrid: observe the notes in the Supple‐
ment. Otherwise, you may not recognize dan‐
gers.
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to mal‐
functions or system failures
If you do not have the prescribed service/
maintenance work or any required repairs
carried out, this could result in malfunctions
or system failures.
#
Always have the prescribed service/
maintenance work as well any required
repairs carried out at a qualified spe‐
cialist workshop.
&
WARNING Risk of accident or injury due
to incorrect modification of electronic
components and parts
Modification to electronic components, their
software or wiring could impair their function
and/or the function of other networked com‐
ponent parts. In particular, systems relevant
to safety could also be affected.
As a result, these may no longer function
properly and/or jeopardize the operating
safety of the vehicle.
22
General notes
#
Never tamper with the vehicle's wiring,
electronic components or software.
#
You should have all work on electrical
and electronic components carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
&
WARNING Risk of fire due to flammable
materials on hot parts of the exhaust
system
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact
with hot parts of the exhaust system.
#
When driving on unpaved roads or off-
road, regularly check the vehicle under‐
side.
#
Remove trapped plants or other flam‐
mable material.
#
If there is damage, consult a qualified
specialist workshop immediately.
*
NOTE Damage to the vehicle
Damage to the vehicle may occur in the fol‐
lowing cases:
R
The vehicle becomes grounded, e.g. on a
high curb or an unpaved road.
R
The vehicle is driven too fast over an
obstacle, e.g. a curb, speed bump or pot‐
hole.
R
A heavy object strikes the underbody or
parts of the chassis.
In situations such as this, the body, the
underbody, chassis parts, wheels or tires
could be damaged without the damage being
visible. Components damaged in this way
can unexpectedly fail or, in the case of an
accident, no longer withstand the strain they
are designed to.
If the underbody paneling is damaged, flam‐
mable materials such as leaves, grass or
twigs can gather between the underbody and
the underbody paneling. If these materials
come into contact with hot parts on the
exhaust system, they may catch fire.
#
Have the vehicle checked and repaired
immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop.
or
#
If driving safety is impaired while con‐
tinuing your journey, pull over and stop
the vehicle immediately, paying atten‐
tion to road and traffic conditions, and
contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Declaration of conformity for wireless vehi‐
cle components
USA: "The wireless devices of this vehicle com‐
ply with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is
subject to the following two conditions: 1) These
devices may not cause harmful interference, and
2) These devices must accept any interference
received, including interference that may cause
undesired operation. Changes or modifications
not expressly approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user's authority to
operate the equipment."
General notes
23
Canada: "The wireless devices of this vehicle
comply with Industry Canada license-exempt
RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the fol‐
lowing two conditions: (1) These devices may
not cause interference, and (2) These devices
must accept any interference, including interfer‐
ence that may cause undesired operation of the
device."
USA: "Wireless charging system for mobile devi‐
ces (Model: D-WMI2015A): this device complies
with Part 18 of the FCC Rules."
The name and address of the responsible party
is:
Continental Automotive Systems US Inc.
2400 Executive Hills Drive
Auburn Hills, MI 48326-2980
United States of America
Diagnostics connection
The diagnostics connection is only intended for
the connection of diagnostic devices at a quali‐
fied specialist workshop.
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to con‐
necting devices to the diagnostics con‐
nection
If you connect equipment to a diagnostics
connection in the vehicle, it may affect the
operation of vehicle systems.
As a result, the operating safety of the vehi‐
cle could be affected.
#
Only connect equipment to a diagnos‐
tics connection in the vehicle which is
approved for your vehicle by Mercedes-
Benz.
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to
objects in the driver's footwell
Objects in the driver's footwell may impede
pedal travel or block a depressed pedal.
This jeopardizes the operating and road
safety of the vehicle.
#
Stow all objects in the vehicle securely
so that they cannot get into the driver's
footwell.
#
Always install the floor mats securely
and as prescribed in order to ensure
that there is always sufficient room for
the pedals.
#
Do not use loose floor mats and do not
place floor mats on top of one another.
*
NOTE Battery discharging from using
devices connected to the diagnostics
connection
Using devices at the diagnostics connection
drains the battery.
#
Check the charge level of the battery.
#
If the charge level is low, charge the
battery, e.g. by driving a considerable
distance.
Connecting equipment to the diagnostics con‐
nection can lead to emissions monitoring infor‐
mation being reset, for example. This may lead
to the vehicle failing to meet the requirements of
the next emissions inspection during the main
inspection.
24
General notes
Qualified specialist workshop
Plug-in hybrid: be sure to observe the notes in
the Supplement. Otherwise, you may not recog‐
nize dangers.
An authorized Mercedes-Benz Center is a quali‐
fied specialist workshop. It has the necessary
specialist knowledge, tools and qualifications to
correctly carry out the work required on your
vehicle. This particularly applies to work relevant
to safety.
Always have the following work carried out on
your vehicle at a qualified specialist workshop:
R
Work relevant to safety
R
Service and maintenance work
R
Repair work
R
Modifications as well as installations and
conversions
R
Work on electronic component parts
Mercedes‑Benz recommends an authorized
Mercedes‑Benz Center.
Correct use of the vehicle
If you remove any warning stickers, you or others
could fail to recognize certain dangers. Leave
warning stickers in position.
When using the vehicle, observe the following
information:
R
The safety notes in this manual
R
The vehicle technical data
R
Traffic rules and regulations
R
Laws and safety standards pertaining to
motor vehicles
Problems with your vehicle
If you should experience a problem with your
vehicle, particularly one that you believe may
affect its safe operation, we urge you to contact
an authorized Mercedes-Benz service center
immediately to have the problem diagnosed and
rectified. If the problem is not resolved to your
satisfaction, please discuss the problem again
with the authorized Mercedes-Benz service cen
ter or, if necessary, contact us at one of the fol‐
lowing addresses.
In the USA:
Customer Assistance Center
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC
3 Mercedes Drive
Montvale, NJ 07645-0350
In Canada:
Customer Relations Department
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.
98 Vanderhoof Avenue
Toronto, Ontario M4G 4C9
Reporting safety defects
USA only:
The following text is published as required of
manufacturers under Title 49, Code of U.S. Fed‐
eral Regulations, Part 575 pursuant to the
"National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act of
1966".
General notes
25
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect
which could cause a crash or could cause injury
or death, you should immediately inform the
National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
(NHTSA) in addition to notifying Mercedes-Benz
USA, LLC.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may
open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety
defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order
a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA
cannot become involved in individual problems
between you, your dealer, or Mercedes-Benz
USA, LLC.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle
Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236
(TTY: 1-800-424-9153) (inside the USA); go to
http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Adminis‐
trator, NHTSA, 400 Seventh Street, SW., Wash‐
ington, DC 20590, USA.
Further information on vehicle safety can be
found at: http://www.safercar.gov
Limited Warranty
*
NOTE Damage to the vehicle arising
from culpable violation of these operat‐
ing instructions.
Damage to the vehicle can arise from culpa‐
ble violation of these operating instructions.
This damage is not covered either by the
Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty or by the
New Vehicle or Used Vehicle Warranty.
#
Follow the instructions in this manual
on proper operation of your vehicle as
well as on possible vehicle damage.
QR codes for the rescue card
The QR code is secured in the fuel filler flap and
on the opposite side on the B-pillar. In the event
of an accident, rescue services can use the QR
code to quickly find the appropriate rescue card
for your vehicle. The current rescue card con‐
tains the most important information about your
vehicle in a compact form, e.g. the routing of the
electric lines.
Further information can be obtained at http://
www.mercedes-benz.de/qr-code.
Vehicle data storage
Information from electronic control units
Your vehicle is equipped with electronic control
units. Some of these are necessary for the safe
operation of your vehicle, while some assist you
when driving (driver assistance systems). In
addition, your vehicle provides convenience and
entertainment functions, which are also made
possible by electronic control units.
Electronic control units contain data memories
which can temporarily or permanently store
technical information about the vehicle's operat‐
ing status, component loads, maintenance
requirements and technical events or malfunc‐
tions.
In general, this information documents the state
of a component part, a module, a system or the
surroundings, for example:
R
operating statuses of system components
(e.g. fluid levels, battery status, tire pressure)
26
General notes
R
status messages concerning the vehicle and
its individual components (e.g. number of
wheel revolutions/speed, deceleration, lat‐
eral acceleration, display of the fastened seat
belts)
R
malfunctions or defects in important system
components (e.g. lights, brakes)
R
information on vehicle damage events
R
system reactions in special driving situations
(e.g. air bag deployment, intervention of sta‐
bility control systems)
R
ambient conditions (e.g. temperature, rain
sensor)
In addition to providing the actual control unit
function, this data assists the manufacturer in
detecting and rectifying malfunctions and opti‐
mizing vehicle functions. The majority of this
data is temporary and is only processed in the
vehicle itself. Only a small portion of the data is
stored in the event or malfunction memory.
When your vehicle is serviced, technical data
from the vehicle can be read out by service net‐
work employees or third parties. Services
include repair services, maintenance processes,
warranty events and quality assurance meas‐
ures, for example. The read out is performed via
the legally prescribed port for OBD ("on-board
diagnostics") in the vehicle. The respective
service network locations or third parties col‐
lect, process and use the data. They document
technical statuses of the vehicle,
assist in find
ing malfunctions and improving quality and are
transmitted to the manufacturer, if necessary.
Furthermore, the manufacturer is subject to
product liability. For this, the manufacturer
requires technical data from vehicles.
Malfunction memories in the vehicle can be
reset by a service outlet as part of repair or
maintenance work.
They can enter data into the vehicle's conveni‐
ence and infotainment functions themselves as
part of the selected equipment.
This includes, for example:
R
multimedia data such as music, films or pho‐
tos for playback in an integrated multimedia
system
R
address book data for use in connection with
an integrated hands-free system or an inte‐
grated navigation system
R
entered navigation destinations
R
data about the use of Internet services
This data can be stored locally in the vehicle or
is located on a device which you have connected
to the vehicle. If this data is stored in the vehi‐
cle, you can delete it at any time. This data can
only be transmitted to third parties upon your
request with particular regard to the scope of
use of online services according to your selected
settings.
You can store or change convenience settings/
individualization in the vehicle at any time.
Depending on the eq
uipment, this in
cludes, for
example:
R
seat and steering wheel position settings
R
suspension and climate control settings
R
individualization such as interior lighting
If your vehicle is accordingly equipped, you can
connect your smartphone or another mobile end
General notes
27
device to the vehicle. You can control them via
the control elements integrated in your vehicle.
Images and audio from the smartphone can be
output via the multimedia system. Certain infor‐
mation is simultaneously transmitted to your
smartphone.
Depending on the respective integration type,
this includes, for example:
R
general vehicle information
R
position data
This enables the use of selected smartphone
Apps, e.g. navigation or music playback. There is
no further interaction between the smartphone
and the vehicle; in particular, vehicle data is not
directly accessible. The type of further data pro‐
cessing is determined by the provider of the App
used. The respective App and your smartphone's
operating system determine whether changes
can be made to the settings and which settings
can be changed.
Service providers
Wireless network connection
If your vehicle has a wireless network connec‐
tion, it enables data to be exchanged between
your vehicle and additional systems. The wire‐
less network connection is enabled via the vehi‐
cle's transmission and reception unit or via con‐
nected mobile end devices (e.g. smartphones).
Online functions can be used via the wireless
network connection. This includes online serv‐
ices and applications/Apps provided by the
manufacturer or other providers.
Manufacturer's services
The manufacturer describes the respective func‐
tions and corresponding legal data protection
information when suitable for the manufacturer's
online services. Personal data may be used for
the provision of online services. Data is
exchanged via a secure connection, e.g. to the
manufacturer's designated IT systems. Personal
data is collected, processed and used via the
provision of services exclusively on the basis of
legal permissions or with prior consent.
The services and functions (sometimes subject
to a fee) can usually be activated or deactivated.
In some cases, this also applies to the entire
vehicle's data connection. This excludes, in par‐
ticular, legally prescribed functions and services.
Third party services
If it is possible to use online services from other
providers, these services are subject to the data
protection and terms of use of the responsible
provider.
The man
ufacturer has no influence on
the content exchanged.
Please enquire, therefore, about the type, scope
and purpose of the collection and use of per‐
sonal data as part of third party services from
their respective provider.
COMAND/mbrace
If the vehicle is equipped with COMAND or
mbrace, additional data about the vehicle's oper‐
ation, the use of the vehicle in certain situations,
and the location of the vehicle may be compiled
through COMAND or the mbrace system.
28
General notes
For additional information please refer to the
chapter Multimedia system and/or the mbrace
Terms and Conditions.
Event Data Recorders
This vehicle is equipped with an event data
recorder (EDR). The main purpose of an EDR is
to record, in certain crash or near crash-like sit‐
uations, such as an air bag deployment or hitting
a road obstacle, data that will assist in under‐
standing how a vehicle's systems performed.
The EDR is designed to record data related to
vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short
period of time, typically 30 seconds or less.
The EDR in this vehicle is designed to record
such data as:
R
How various systems in your vehicle were
operating
R
Whether or not the driver and front
passenger seat belts were buckled/fastened
R
How far (if at all) the driver was depressing
the accelerator and/or brake pedal and
R
How fast the vehicle was traveling.
This data can help provide a better understand‐
ing of the circumstances in which accidents and
injuries occur. NOTE: EDR data is recorded by
your vehicle only if a non-trivial crash situation
occurs; no data is recorded by the EDR under
normal driving conditions and no personal data
(e.g. name, gender, age and crash location) is
recorded. However, other parties, such as law
enforcement, could combine the EDR data with
the type of personally identifying data routinely
acquired during a crash investigation.
Access to th
e vehicle and/or the E
DR is needed
to read data that is recorded by an EDR, and
special equipment is required. In addition to the
vehicle manufacturer, other parties that have the
special equipment, such as law enforcement,
can read the information by accessing the vehi‐
cle or the EDR.
EDR data may be used in civil and criminal mat‐
ters as a tool in accident reconstruction, acci‐
dent claims and vehicle safety. Since the Crash
Data Retrieval (CDR) tool that is used to extract
data from the EDR is commercially available,
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC ("MBUSA") expressly
disclaims any and all liability arising from the
extraction of this information by unauthorized
Mercedes-Benz personnel.
MBUSA will not share EDR data with others with‐
out the consent of the vehicle owner or, if the
vehicle is leased, without the consent of the les‐
see. Exceptions to this representation include
responses to subpoenas by law enforcement; by
federal, state or local government; in connection
with or arising out of litigation involving MBUSA
or its subsidiaries and affiliates; or, as required
by law.
Warning: the EDR is a component of the
Restraint System Module. Tampering with, alter‐
ing, modifying or removing the EDR component
may result in a malfunction of the
Restrain
t Sys‐
tem Module and other systems.
State laws or regulations regarding EDRs that
conflict with federal regulation are pre-empted.
This means that in the event of such conflict, the
federal regulation governs. As of February 2013,
13 states have enacted laws relating to EDRs.
General notes
29
Copyright
Free and open source software
Information on free and open source software
licenses for your vehicle's software can be found
on the data storage medium in your vehicle
document wallet and on the Internet together
with updates:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com/opensource
Registered trademarks
R
Bluetooth
®
is a registered trademark of Blue‐
tooth SIG Inc.
R
DTS™ is a registered trademark of DTS, Inc.
R
Dolby
®
and MLP™ are registered trademarks
of DOLBY Laboratories.
R
BabySmart™, ESP
®
and PRE-SAFE
®
are reg‐
istered trademarks of Daimler AG.
R
HomeLink
®
is a registered trademark of
Johnson Controls.
R
iPod
®
and iTunes
®
are registered trademarks
of Apple Inc.
R
Burmester
®
is a registered trademark of
Burmester Audiosysteme GmbH.
R
Microsoft
®
and Windows Media
®
are regis‐
tered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation.
R
SIRIUS
®
is a registered trademark of Sirius
XM Radio Inc.
R
HD Radio™ is a registered trademark of iBiq‐
uity Digital Corporation.
R
Gracenote
®
is a registered trademark of
Gracenote, Inc.
R
ZAGATSurvey
®
and related brands are regis‐
tered trademarks of ZagatSurvey, LLC.
30
General notes
Restraint system
Protection by the restraint system
The restraint system includes the following:
R
Seat belt system
R
Air bags
R
Child restraint system
R
Child seat securing system
The restraint system can reduce the risk of vehi‐
cle occupants coming into contact with parts of
the vehicle interior in the event of an accident. In
the event of an accident, the restraint system
can also reduce the forces to which the vehicle
occupants are subjected.
A seat belt can only provide the best level of pro‐
tection if it is worn correctly. Depending on the
detected accident situation, Emergency Tension‐
ing Devices and/or air bags supplement the pro‐
tection offered by a correctly worn seat belt.
Emergency Tensioning Devices and/or air bags
are not deployed in every accident.
In order for the restraint system to provide the
intended level of protection, each vehicle occu‐
pant must observe the following information:
R
Fasten seat belts correctly.
R
Sit in an almost upright seat position with
their back against the seat backrest.
R
Sit with their feet resting on the floor, if pos‐
sible.
R
Always secure persons under 5 ft (1.50 m)
tall in an additional restraint system suitable
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
However, no system available today can com‐
pletely
eliminate in
juries and fatalities in every
accident situation. In particular, the seat belt
and air bag generally do not protect against
objects penetrating the vehicle from the outside.
It is also not possible to completely rule out the
risk of injury caused by the air bag deploying.
Reduced restraint system protection
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death from
modifications to the restraint system
The restraint system can no longer function
correctly after alterations have been made.
The restraint system may then not protect
the vehicle occupants as intended by failing
in an accident or triggering unexpectedly, for
example
#
Never alter the parts of the restraint
system.
#
Never tamper with the wiring or any
electronic component parts or their
software.
R
If it is necessary to modify the vehicle to
accommodate a person with disabilities, con‐
tact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for
details.
R
USA only: for details, contact our Customer
Assistance Center on 1-800-FOR-MERCedes
(1‑800‑367‑6372).
Occupant safety
31
Restraint system functionality
When the ignition is switched on, a system self-
test is performed, during which the 6
restraint system warning lamp lights up. It goes
out no later than a few seconds after the vehicle
is started. The components of the restraint sys‐
tem are then functional.
Malfunctioning restraint system
A malfunction has occurred in the restraint sys‐
tem if:
R
The 6 restraint system warning lamp
does not light up when the ignition is
switched on.
R
The 6 restraint system warning lamp
lights up continuously or repeatedly during a
journey.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or fatal injury
due to a malfunction in the restraint sys‐
tem
If the restraint system is malfunctioning,
restraint system components may be trig‐
gered unintentionally or might not be trig‐
gered at all in the event of an accident. This
may affect the Emergency Tensioning Device
or airbag, for example.
#
Have the restraint system checked and
repaired immediately at a qualified spe‐
cialist workshop.
Function of the restraint system in an acci‐
dent
How the restraint system works is determined by
the severity of the impact detected and the type
of accident anticipated:
R
Frontal impact
R
Rear impact
R
Side impact
R
Rollover
The activation thresholds for the components of
the restraint system are determined based on
the evaluation of the sensor values measured at
various points in the vehicle. This process is pre-
emptive in nature. The triggering/deployment of
the components of the restraint system should
take place in good time at the start of the colli‐
sion.
Factors which can only be seen and measured
after a collision has occurred cannot play a deci‐
sive role in air bag deployment, nor do they pro‐
vide an indication of air bag deployment.
The vehicle may be deformed significantly with‐
out an air bag being deployed. This is the case if
only parts which are relatively easily deformed
are affected and the rate of vehicle deceleration
is not high. Conversely, an air bag may be
deployed even though the vehicle suffers only
minor deformation. If very rigid vehicle parts
such as longitudinal members are hit, for exam‐
ple, the vehicle deceleration may be high enough
for this to happen.
32
Occupant safety
The components of the restraint system can
be activated or deployed independently of
each other:
Component Detected deploy‐
ment situation
Emergency Tension‐
ing Devices
Frontal impact, rear
impact, side impact,
rollover
Driver's air bag, front
passenger air bag
Frontal impact
Knee air bag Frontal impact
Side air bag Side impact
Window air bagSide impact, rollover,
frontal impact
Belt air bag Frontal impact
Cushionbag Frontal impact
The front-passenger air bag can be deployed in
an accident only if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF
indicator lamp is off. If the front passenger seat
is occupied, make sure, both before and during
the journey, that the status of the front
passenger air bag is correct (
page 43).
&
WARNING Risk of burns from hot air bag
components
The air bag parts are hot after an air bag has
been deployed.
#
Do not touch the air bag parts.
#
Have a deployed air bag replaced at a
qualified specialist workshop as soon
as possible.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have the
vehicle towed to a qualified specialist workshop
after an accident. Take this into account, partic‐
ularly if an Emergency Tensioning Device is trig‐
gered or an air bag is deployed.
If the Emergency Tensioning Devices are trig‐
gered or an air bag is deployed, you will hear a
bang, and powder may also be released:
R
The bang will not generally affect your hear‐
ing.
R
In general, the powder released is not haz‐
ardous to health but may cause short-term
breathing difficulties to persons suffering
from asthma or other pulmonary conditions.
Provided it is safe to do so, leave the vehicle
immediately or open the window in order to
prevent breathing difficulties.
Air bags and pyrotechnic Emergency Tensioning
Devices contain perchlorate material, which may
require special handling or environmental pro‐
tection measures. National guidelines must be
observed during disposal. In California, see
http://www.dtsc.ca.gov/HazardousWaste/
Perchlorate/index.cfm.
Seat belts
Protection provided by the seat belt
Always fasten your seat belt correctly before
starting a journey. A seat belt can only provide
the best level of protection if it is worn correctly.
Occupant safety
33
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
incorrectly fastened seat belt
If the seat belt is not worn correctly, it can‐
not perform its intended protective function.
In addition, an incorrectly fastened seat belt
can also cause injuries, for example, in the
event of an accident or when braking or
changing direction suddenly.
#
Always ensure that all vehicle occu‐
pants have their seat belts fastened
correctly and are sitting properly.
In order for the correctly worn seat belt to pro‐
vide the intended level of protection, each vehi‐
cle occupant must observe the following infor‐
mation:
R
The seat belt must not be twisted and must
fit tightly and snugly across the body.
R
The seat belt must be routed across the cen‐
ter of the shoulder and as low down across
the hips as possible.
R
The shoulder section of the seat belt should
not touch your neck nor be routed under
your arm or behind your back.
R
Avoid wearing bulky clothing, e.g. a winter
coat.
R
Push the lap belt down as far as possible
across your hips and pull tight with the shoul‐
der section of the belt. Never route the lap
belt across your abdomen.
R
Never route the seat belt across sharp, poin‐
ted, abrasive or fragile objects.
R
Only one person should use each seat belt at
any one time. Never allow babies and chil‐
dren to travel sitting on the lap of another
vehicle occupant.
R
Never secure objects with a seat belt if the
seat belt is also being used by one of the
vehicle's occupants. Always observe the
instructions for loading the vehicle when
securing objects, luggage or loads
(
page 118).
Also ensure that no objects are placed
between a person and the seat. e.g. a cush‐
ion.
The seat belts on the following seats are equip‐
ped with
a special seat
belt retractor:
R
Front passenger seat
R
Rear seats
Activate or deactivate the special seatbelt
retractor of the seat belt (
page 50).
If children are traveling in the vehicle, be sure to
observe the instructions and safety notes on
"Children in the vehicle" (
page 47).
Reduced seat belt protection
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
incorrect seat position
The seat belt does not offer the intended
level of protection if you have not moved the
seat backrest to an almost vertical position.
When braking or in the event of an accident,
you could slide underneath the seat belt and
sustain abdominal or neck injuries, for exam‐
ple.
34
Occupant safety
#
Adjust the seat properly before begin‐
ning your journey.
#
Always ensure that the seat backrest is
in an almost vertical position and that
the shoulder section of your seat belt is
routed across the center of your shoul‐
der.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death when
additional restraint systems are not used
for persons with a smaller build
Persons under 5 ft (1.50 m ) tall cannot wear
the seat belt correctly without a suitable
additional restraint system.
If the seat belt is not worn correctly, it can‐
not perform its intended protective function.
In addition, an incorrectly fastened seat belt
can also cause injuries, for example, in the
event of an accident or when braking or
changing direction suddenly.
#
Always secure persons under 5 ft
(1.50 m) tall in a suitable restraint sys‐
tem.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
blocked seat belt buckle or seat belt
anchorage
Objects next to the front seat that block the
seat belt buckle or the moving seat belt
anchorage on the front seat impair the func‐
tion of the Emergency Tensioning Devices.
The Emergency Tensioning Devices can,
then, not function as intended and the seat
belt can no longer provide the intended pro‐
tection.
#
Before starting the journey, make sure
that there are no objects around the
seat belt buckle or between the front
seat and door.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
damaged or modified seat belts
Seat belts cannot provide protection in the
following situations:
R
If the seat belts are damaged, modified,
extremely dirty, bleached or dyed
R
If the seat belt buckle is damaged or
extremely dirty
R
If the Emergency Tensioning Devices,
seat belt anchorages or seat belt retrac‐
tors have been modified
Seat belts may be damaged in an accident,
although the damage may not be visible, e.g.
due to splinters of glass.
Modified or damaged seat belts may tear or
fail, e.g. in an accident.
Modified Emergency Tensioning Devices can
accidentally trigger or fail to function as
intended.
#
Never modify the seat belts, Emergency
Tensioning Devices, seat belt ancho‐
rages or seat belt retractors.
#
Make sure that the seat belts are
undamaged, not worn and clean.
#
Always have the seat belts checked
immediately after an accident at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Occupant safety
35
Only use seat belts that have been approved for
your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death from
deployed pyrotechnic Emergency Ten‐
sioning Devices
Pyrotechnic Emergency Tensioning Devices
that have been deployed are no longer opera‐
tional and are unable to perform their inten‐
ded protective function.
#
Therefore, have deployed pyrotechnic
Emergency Tensioning Devices immedi‐
ately replaced at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have the
vehicle towed to a qualified specialist workshop
after an accident.
*
NOTE Damage caused by trapping the
seat belt
If an unused seat belt is not fully retracted, it
may become trapped in the door or in the
seat mechanism.
#
Always ensure that an unused seat belt
is fully retracted.
Information on the belt air bag in the rear
seat belt
The BELTBAG identification indicates that a rear
seat belt is equipped with a belt air bag.
When activated, the belt air bag increases the
protected area of the vehicle occupant's ribcage.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death
through the use of a non-approved child
restraint system
In an accident, the belt air bag may damage
a non-approved or non-authorized child
restraint system.
As a result, the child restraint system may
not be able to provide the intended level of
protection.
#
Therefore, always use LATCH or LATCH-
type (ISOFIX) to fasten a child seat
equipped with an integrated restraint
system.
#
For vehicles equipped with the optional
rear seat-belt air bags ("beltbag"), only
use a Mercedes-Benz approved booster
seat with integrated backrest.
#
Never use an air bag equipped seat belt
to fasten a front or rear-facing child
seat or a non-approved booster seat.
#
Please contact an authorized Mercedes-
Benz Center for information on
approved child restraint systems.
Fastening and adjusting seat belts
If the seat belt is pulled quickly or sharply, the
seat belt retractor locks. The belt strap cannot
be pulled out any further.
36
Occupant safety
#
Always engage seat belt tongue 2 of the
seat belt into seat belt buckle 1 of the cor‐
responding seat.
#
Press and hold the seat belt outlet release
and slide the seat belt outlet into the desired
position.
#
Let go of the belt outlet release and ensure
that the seat belt outlet locks in position.
Vehicles with PRE-SAFE
®
: If the front seat belt
is not pulled tight across your body, the seat belt
adjustment may automatically apply a certain
tightening force. Do not hold the seat belt tightly
while it is adjusting. You can activate and deacti‐
vate the seat belt adjustment function using the
multimedia system.
Vehicles with automatic front passenger air
bag shutoff:
*
NOTE Deployment of the Emergency
Tensioning Device and side air bag when
the front passenger seat is unoccupied
If the seat belt tongue is engaged in the seat
belt buckle of the unoccupied front
passenger seat, the Emergency Tensioning
Device and the side air bag may also deploy
in the event of an accident along with other
systems.
#
Only one person should use each seat
belt at any one time.
Vehicles without automatic front passenger
air bag shutoff:
*
NOTE Deployment of the Emergency
Tensioning Device when the front
passenger seat is unoccupied
If the seat belt tongue is engaged in the seat
belt buckle of the unoccupied front
passenger seat, the Emergency Tensioning
Device may also deploy in the event of an
accident along with other systems.
#
Only one person should use each seat
belt at any one time.
Information on the rear seat belt buckle
extender
The seat belt buckle extender for the outer rear
seats makes it easier to fasten the seat belt.
Always ensure that the seat belt buckle can be
extended and retracted freely.
After the seat belt is fastened, the seat belt
buckle returns to its normal position. The seat
belt then lies tightly across the lap and thorax
areas.
Occupant safety
37
Releasing seat belts
#
Press the release button in the seat belt
buckle and guide the seat belt back with the
seat belt tongue.
Activating or deactivating seat belt adjust‐
ment via the multimedia system
Multimedia system:
,

.
î  
.


#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Seat belt warning function for the driver and
front passenger
The ü seat belt warning lamp in the Instru‐
ment Display is a reminder that all vehicle occu‐
pants must wear their seat belts correctly.
The ü seat belt warning lamp lights up for six
seconds after every engine start.
In addition, an acoustic warning tone may sound.
When the driver's and front passenger's doors
are closed and the driver and front passenger
have fastened their seat belts, the seat belt
warning goes out.
During a journey, the seat belt warning lights up
if:
R
The vehicle speed exceeds 15 mph
(25 km/h) and the driver's or front
passenger seat belt is not fastened.
R
The driver or front passenger unfastens their
seat belt while the vehicle is in motion.
Airbags
Overview of air bags
1
Knee air bag
2
Driver's air bag
3
Front-passenger front air bag
4
Window air bag
5
Side air bag
The installation location of an air bag is identi‐
fied by the AIRBAG symbol.
38
Occupant safety
When activated, an air bag can provide addi‐
tional protection for the respective vehicle
occupant.
AIR BAGPotential protection for
Knee air bag Thigh, knee and lower leg
Driver's air bag,
front passenger
air bag
Head and ribcage
Window air bagHead
Side air bag Ribcage, also pelvis for
front seat occupants
The front-passenger air bag can be deployed in
an accident only if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF
indicator lamp is off. If the front passenger seat
is occupied, make sure, both before and during
the journey, that the status of the front
passenger air bag is correct (
page 43).
*
NOTE Important points to remember if
the front passenger seat is unoccupied
In an accident, the components of the
restraint system may deploy unnecessarily
on the front passenger side if:
R
There are heavy objects on the front
passenger seat.
R
The seat belt tongue is engaged in the
seat belt buckle of the front passenger
seat and the front passenger seat is
unoccupied.
#
Stow objects in a suitable place.
#
Only one person should use each seat
belt at any one time.
Cushionbag in the reclining rear seat
If the seat backrest inclination is significant, the
cushionbag provides additional occupant protec‐
tion in the event of a frontal impact. When acti‐
vated, the cushionbag deploys under the seat
cushion. This helps prevent the vehicle occupant
from slipping off the seat cushion.
If you install a child restraint system on the
reclining rear seat, always observe the additional
notes (
page 47).
Protection potential of air bags
Depending on the accident situation, an air bag
may supplement the protection offered by a cor‐
rectly fastened seat belt.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
incorrect seat position
If you deviate from the correct seat position,
the air bag cannot perform its intended pro‐
tective function and deployment may even
cause further injuries.
To avoid hazardous situations, always make
sure that all vehicle occupants:
R
Have their seat belt fastened correctly,
including pregnant women.
R
Are seated properly and that distance to
the air bags is as large as possible.
R
Observe the following information.
Occupant safety
39
#
Always make sure that there are no
objects between the air bag and the
vehicle occupant.
To avoid the risks resulting from the deployment
of an air bag, each vehicle occupant must
observe the following information:
R
Before starting your journey, adjust your seat
correctly; the driver's seat and front
passenger seat should be moved as far back
as possible.
When doing so, always observe the informa‐
tion on the correct driver's seat position
(
page 88).
R
Only hold the steering wheel by the steering
wheel rim. This allows the air bag to be fully
deployed.
R
Always lean against the seat backrest when
the vehicle is in motion. Do not lean forwards
or against the door or side window. You may
otherwise be in the deployment area of the
air bags.
R
Always keep your feet on the floor. Do not
put your feet on the dashboard, for example.
Your feet may otherwise be in the deploy‐
ment area of the air bag.
R
If children are traveling in the vehicle,
observe the additional notes (
page 47).
R
Always stow and secure objects correctly.
Objects in the vehicle interior may prevent an air
bag from functioning correctly. Each vehicle
occupant must always make sure of the follow‐
ing:
R
There are no people, animals or objects
between the vehicle occupants and an air
bag.
R
There are no objects between the seat, door
and door pillar (B-pillar).
R
There are no hard objects, e.g. coat hangers,
hanging on the grab handles or coat hooks.
R
There are no accessory parts, such as cup
holders, attached to the vehicle within the
deployment area of an air bag, e.g. on doors,
side windows or side paneling.
R
There are no heavy, sharp-edged or fragile
objects in the pockets of your clothing. Store
such objects in a suitable place.
Reduced air bag protection
&
WARNING Risk of injury from modifica‐
tions to the airbag cover
If you modify an airbag cover or affix objects
such as stickers to it, the airbag can no lon‐
ger function correctly.
#
Never modify an airbag cover and do
not affix objects to it.
The installation location of an air bag is identi‐
fied by the AIRBAG symbol (
page 38).
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
the use of unsuitable seat covers
Unsuitable seat covers can obstruct or pre‐
vent the deployment of air bags integrated
into the seats.
Consequently, the air bags cannot protect
vehicle occupants as they are designed to
do. In addition, operation of the automatic
front passenger air bag shutoff may be
restricted.
40
Occupant safety
#
You should only use seat covers that
have been approved for the correspond‐
ing seats by Mercedes-Benz.
&
WARNING Risk of injury due to malfunc‐
tions of the sensors in the door paneling
Sensors to control the airbags are located in
the doors. Modifications or work not per‐
formed correctly to the doors or door panel‐
ing, as well as damaged doors, can lead to
the function of the sensors being impaired.
The airbags might therefore not function
properly any more.
Consequently, the airbags cannot protect
vehicle occupants as they are designed to
do.
#
Never modify the doors or parts of the
doors.
#
Always have work on the doors or door
paneling carried out at a qualified spe‐
cialist workshop.
&
WARNING Risk of injury due to deployed
airbag
A deployed airbag no longer has a protective
function and cannot protect as intended in
the event of an accident.
#
Have the vehicle towed to a qualified
specialist workshop in order to have the
deployed airbag replaced.
Have deployed air bags replaced immediately.
Status of the front passenger airbag
Function of the automatic front passenger
air bag shutoff
The automatic front passenger air bag shutoff is
able to detect whether the front passenger seat
is occupied by a person or a child restraint sys‐
tem. The front passenger air bag is enabled or
deactivated accordingly.
When installing a child restraint system on the
front passenger seat, always make sure of the
following:
R
Ensure that the child restraint system is posi‐
tioned correctly (
page 47).
R
Always observe the child restraint system
manufacturer's installation instructions.
R
Never place objects under or behind the
child restraint system, e.g. cushions.
R
Fully retract the seat cushion length adjust‐
ment.
R
The entire base of the child restraint system
must always rest on the seat cushion of the
front-passenger seat.
R
The backrest of the forward-facing child
restraint system must, as far as possible, be
resting on the seat backrest of the front
passenger seat.
R
The child restraint system must not touch the
roof or be put under strain by the head
restraints. Adjust the seat backrest inclina‐
tion and the head restraint setting accord‐
ingly.
Occupant safety
41
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
objects between the sitting surface and
the child restraint system
Objects between the sitting surface and the
child restraint system could affect the func‐
tion of the automatic front passenger airbag
shutoff.
This could result in the front passenger air‐
bag not functioning as intended during an
accident.
#
Do not place any objects between the
sitting surface and the child restraint
system.
#
The entire base of the child restraint
system must always rest on the sitting
surface of the front passenger seat.
#
The backrest of the forward-facing child
restraint system must lie as flat as pos‐
sible against the backrest of the front
passenger seat.
#
Always comply with the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation
instructions.
A person on the front passenger seat must
observe the following information:
R
Fasten seat belts correctly.
R
Sit in an almost upright seat position with
their back against the seat backrest.
R
Sit with their feet resting on the floor, if pos‐
sible.
Otherwise, the front passenger air bag may be
deactivated by mistake, for example in the fol‐
lowing situations:
R
The front passenger transfers their weight by
supporting themselves on a vehicle armrest.
R
The front passenger sits in such a way that
their weight is raised from the sitting sur‐
face.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
deactivated front passenger airbag
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is lit, the front passenger airbag is disa‐
bled. It will not be deployed in the event of
an accident and cannot perform its intended
protective function.
A person in the front passenger seat could
then, for example, come into contact with
the vehicle interior, especially if the person is
sitting too close to the cockpit.
If the front passenger seat is occupied,
always ensure that:
R
The classification of the person in the
front passenger seat is correct and the
front passenger airbag is enabled or disa‐
bled in accordance with the person in the
front passenger seat.
R
The front passenger seat has been moved
as far back as possible.
R
The person is seated correctly.
#
Ensure, both before and during the jour‐
ney, that the status of the front
passenger airbag is correct.
42
Occupant safety
PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamp
System self-test
When the ignition is switched on, a system self-
test is performed during which the two
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON and OFF indicator
lamps light up simultaneously.
The status of the front passenger air bag is dis‐
played after the system self-test:
R
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON lights up for
60 seconds, subsequently both PASSENGER
AIR BAG ON and OFF indicator lamps are off:
the front passenger air bag is able to deploy
in the event of an accident.
R
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF lights up continu‐
ously: the front passenger air bag is deactiva‐
ted. It will then not be deployed in the event
of an accident.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp is
off, only the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp shows the status of the front passenger air
bag. The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp may be lit continuously or be off.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
and the 6 restraint system warning lamp
light up simultaneously, the front passenger seat
may not be used. Also in this case, do not install
a child restraint system on the front passenger
seat. Have the automatic front passenger air bag
shutoff checked and repaired immediately at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Status display
If the front passenger seat is occupied, ensure,
both before
and durin
g the journey, that the sta‐
tus of the front passenger air bag is correct for
the prevailing situation.
After installing a rearward-facing child
restraint system on the front passenger
seat: PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF must be lit con‐
tinuously.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death from
using a rearward-facing child restraint
system when the front passenger air bag
is enabled
If you secure a child in a rearward-facing
child restraint system on the front passenger
seat and the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indi‐
cator lamp is off, the front passenger air bag
can deploy in the event of an accident.
The child could be struck by the air bag.
Always ensure that the front passenger air
bag is disabled. The PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF indicator lamp must be lit.
Occupant safety
43
NEVER use a rearward facing child restraint
on a seat protected by an ACTIVE FRONT AIR
BAG in front of it; DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY
to the child can occur.
When installing a child restraint system on the
front passenger seat, observe the vehicle-spe‐
cific information in this Operator's Manual.
Depending on the child restraint system and the
stature of the child, the PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF indicator lamp may be off. In this case, do
not install the rearward-facing child restraint
system on the front passenger seat.
Instead, install the rearward-facing child
restraint system on a suitable rear seat.
After installing a forward-facing child
restraint system on the front passenger
seat: depending on the child restraint system
and the stature of the child, PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF may be lit continuously or be off.
Always observe the following information.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
incorrect positioning of the forward-
facing child restraint system
If you secure a child in a forward-facing child
restraint system on the front passenger seat
and you position the front passenger seat too
close to the cockpit, in the event of an acci‐
dent, the child could:
R
Come into contact with the vehicle inte‐
rior if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indi‐
cator lamp is lit, for example.
R
Be struck by the air bag if the
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
is off.
#
Always move the front passenger seat
as far back as possible and fully retract
the seat cushion length adjustment.
Always make sure that the shoulder belt
strap is correctly routed from the seat
belt outlet on the vehicle to the shoul‐
der belt guide on the child restraint sys‐
tem. The shoulder belt strap must be
routed forwards and downwards from
the vehicle belt outlet. If necessary,
adjust the seat belt outlet and the front
passenger seat accordingly.
#
Always observe the child restraint sys‐
tem manufacturer's installation instruc‐
tions.
When installing a child restraint system on the
front passenger seat, observe the vehicle-spe‐
cific information in this Operator's Manual.
If a person is sitting in the front passenger
seat: PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF may be lit con‐
tinuously or be off, depending on the person's
stature.
A person on the front passenger seat must
always observe the following information:
R
If the front passenger seat is occupied with
an adult or a person with a stature corre
sponding to that of an adult, the PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp must be off. This
indicates that the front passenger air bag is
enabled.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is lit continuously, an adult or person
with a build corresponding to that of an adult
44
Occupant safety
should not use the front passenger seat.
Instead, they should use a rear seat.
R
If the front passenger seat is occupied with a
person of smaller stature (e.g. a teenager or
small adult), the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF
indicator lamp either lights up continuously
or remains out, depending on the result of
the classification:
-
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF is off: move the
front passenger seat as far back as possi‐
ble or a person of smaller stature should
use a rear seat.
-
If the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator
lamp is lit continuously: a person of
smaller stature should not use the front
passenger seat.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death when
the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is lit
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp remains lit after the system self-test,
the front passenger air bag is deactivated. It
will not be deployed in the event of an acci‐
dent. In this case, the front passenger air bag
cannot perform its intended protective func‐
tion, e.g. when a person is seated in the front
passenger seat.
That person could, for example, come into
contact with the vehicle interior, especially if
the person is sitting too close to the cockpit.
If the front passenger seat is occupied,
always ensure that:
R
The classification of the person in the
front passenger seat is correct and the
front passenger air bag is enabled or
deactivated in accordance with the per‐
son in the front passenger seat.
R
The person is seated properly with a cor‐
rectly fastened seat belt.
R
The front passenger seat has been moved
as far back as possible.
Further related subjects:
R
Child restraint system on the front passenger
seat (
page 53).
PRE-SAFE
®
system
Information on PRE-SAFE
®
(anticipatory
occupant protection)
PRE-SAFE
®
is able to detect certain critical driv‐
ing situations and implement pre-emptive meas‐
ures to protect the vehicle occupants.
PRE-SAFE
®
can implement the following meas‐
ures independently of each other:
R
Tightening the seat belts on the driver's seat
and front passenger seat.
R
Closing the side windows.
R
Vehicles with sliding sunroof: Closing the
sliding sunroof.
R
Vehicles with memory function: Moving
the front passenger seat to a more favorable
seat position.
R
Vehicles with memory function in the
rear passenger compartment: moving the
outer rear seats to a more favorable seat
position.
Occupant safety
45
R
Vehicles with multicontour seat: Increas‐
ing the air pressure in the seat side bolsters
of the seat backrest.
R
Vehicles with rear seat belt buckle
extenders: tightening seat belts on the outer
rear seats.
R
PRE-SAFE
®
Sound: Provided that the multi‐
media system is switched on, generates a
brief noise signal to stimulate the innate pro‐
tective mechanism of a person's hearing.
*
NOTE Damage caused by objects in the
footwell or behind the seat
The automatic adjustment of the seat posi‐
tion may result in damage to the seat and/or
the object.
#
Stow objects in a suitable place.
Reversing the PRE-SAFE
®
system measures
If an accident did not occur, the pre-emptive
measures that were taken are reversed.
You will need to perform certain settings your‐
self.
#
If the seat belt pre-tensioning is not reduced,
move the seat backrest back slightly.
The locking mechanism releases.
Information on PRE-SAFE
®
PLUS (anticipa‐
tory occupant protection plus)
PRE-SAFE
®
PLUS can detect certain impacts,
particularly an imminent rear impact, and take
pre-emptive measures to protect the vehicle
occupants. These measures cannot necessarily
prevent an imminent impact.
PRE-SAFE
®
PLUS can implement the following
measures independently of each other:
R
Tightening the seat belts on the driver's seat
and front passenger seat.
R
Vehicles with electric rear seats: tighten‐
ing seat belts on the outer rear seats.
R
Increasing brake pressure when the vehicle
is stationary. This brake application is can‐
celed automatically when the vehicle pulls
away.
If an accident did not occur, the pre-emptive
measures that were taken are reversed.
System limitations
The system will not initiate any action in the fol‐
lowing situations:
R
when backing up
The system will not initiate any braking applica‐
tion in the following situations:
R
whilst driving
or
R
when entering or exiting a parking space
while using Active Parking Assist
46
Occupant safety
Children in the vehicle
Notes on the safe transportation of children
&
WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to children left unattended in the
vehicle
If you leave children unaccompanied in the
vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion, for example by:
R
Releasing the parking brake.
R
Shifting the transmission out of park
position j.
R
Starting the engine.
In addition, they may operate vehicle equip‐
ment.
#
Never leave children and animals unat‐
tended in the vehicle.
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
&
WARNING Risk of fatal injury due to
exposure to extreme heat or cold in the
vehicle
If people particularly children are
exposed to extreme heat or cold over an
extended period of time, there is a risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
#
Never leave anyone particularly chil‐
dren unattended in the vehicle.
&
WARNING Risk of burns when the child
seat is exposed to direct sunlight
If the child restraint system is exposed to
direct sunlight or heat, parts could heat up.
Children could suffer burns from these parts,
particularly on metallic parts of the child
restraint system.
#
Always make sure that the child
restraint system is not exposed to
direct sunlight.
#
Protect it with a blanket, for example.
#
If the child restraint system has been
exposed to direct sunlight, allow it to
cool before securing a child into it.
#
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
The use of seat belts and child restraint systems
is required by law in:
R
All 50 states
R
The U.S. territories
R
The District of Columbia
R
All Canadian provinces
All child restraint systems must meet the follow‐
ing standards:
R
U.S. Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards
213 and 225
R
Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards
213 and 210.2
You can obtain further information about the
correct child restraint system from any author‐
ized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Occupant safety
47
To improve protection for children younger than
12 years old or under 5 ft (1.50 m) in height,
Mercedes-Benz recommends you observe the
following information:
R
Only secure children using a child restraint
system which is suitable and recommended
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles, as well as appro‐
priate to the height, age and weight of the
child. Be sure to observe the instructions for
correct use of the child restraint system.
R
Always install a child restraint system on a
rear seat if possible.
R
Only use the following securing systems for
child restraint systems:
-
the seat belt system
-
the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) mounting brack‐
ets
-
the Top Tether anchorages
R
The manufacturer's installation instructions
for the child restraint system.
R
The warning labels in the vehicle interior and
on the child restraint system.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death caused
by incorrect installation of the child
restraint system
If the child restraint system is incorrectly
installed on a suitable seating position, it
cannot perform its intended protective func‐
tion.
The child cannot be restrained in the event of
an accident, heavy braking or a sudden
change of direction.
#
Always comply with the manufacturer's
installation instructions for the child
restraint system and its correct use.
#
Make sure that the entire base of the
child restraint system always rests on
the sitting surface of the seat.
#
Never place objects under or behind
the child restraint system, e.g. cush‐
ions.
#
Always use child restraint systems with
the original cover designed for them.
#
Always replace damaged covers with
genuine covers.
&
WARNING Risk of accident caused by
incorrectly installed child restraint sys‐
tems
If the child restraint system is not correctly
installed or secured, it could release in the
event of an accident, sudden braking or a
sudden change in direction.
The child restraint system could be flung
around and hit vehicle occupants. This poses
an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
#
Always install child restraint systems
correctly, even when not in use.
#
Always comply with the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation
instructions.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death caused
by the use of damaged child restraint
systems
Child restraint systems or their retaining sys‐
tems that have been subjected to a load in
48
Occupant safety
an accident may then not be able to perform
their intended protective function.
The child cannot be restrained in the event of
an accident, heavy braking or a sudden
change of direction.
#
Always replace child restraint systems
immediately that have been damaged or
involved in an accident.
#
Have the securing systems for the child
restraint systems checked at a qualified
specialist workshop before installing a
child restraint system again.
A booster seat may be necessary to achieve
proper seat belt positioning for children over
40 lbs (18 kg) in weight or until they reach a
height where a three-point seat belt can be
installed properly without a booster seat.
Vehicles with seat belt buckle extenders:
When securing a child in a child restraint system
on a rear seat, observe the following notes:
R
Make sure that the seat belt is fastened on
the child restraint system according to the
manufacturer's installation instructions for
the child restraint system.
R
For child restraint systems with a belt clamp:
engage the seat belt tongue into the seat belt
buckle before you tighten the seat belt using
the belt clamp.
&
WARNING Risk of injury due to the seat
backrest being reclined too far back‐
wards
If a child restraint system is installed and the
seat backrest is reclined too far backwards,
the cushionbag may deploy by mistake in the
event of an accident.
#
When using a child restraint system,
always ensure that the seat is correctly
adjusted and that the seat backrest is
almost vertical.
Vehicles with a reclining rear seat: When
installing a child restraint system, move the
reclining rear seat backrest to an almost upright
position. The reclining rear seat backrest must
rest against the child restraint system. Observe
the notes on the cushionbag (
page 38).
Vehicles with a reclining rear seat: If you
install a child restraint system on the reclining
rear seat, be sure to observe the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation instructions.
The following notes must be observed:
R
When installing a child restraint system on
the front passenger seat, the information on
installing a child restraint system on the front
passenger seat (
page 53).
R
Instructions and safety notes on the auto‐
matic front passenger air bag shutoff
(
page 41 ).
R
Safety notes on the seat belt ( page 33).
R
Information on the correct use of the seat
belt (
page 38).
Occupant safety
49
Activating/deactivating the child seat safety
feature of the seat belt
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death if a
seat belt is unfastened while the vehicle
is in motion
If the seat belt is released while the vehicle is
in motion, the child restraint system is no
longer correctly secured. The child seat
safety feature is deactivated and the seat
belt is drawn in a bit by the inertia reel.
It is therefore not possible to engage the seat
belt again.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as
soon as possible, paying attention to
road and traffic conditions.
#
Activate the child seat safety feature
again and correctly secure the child
restraint system.
When enabled, the child seat safety feature
ensures that the seat belts of the front
passenger seat and rear seats do not slacken
once the child restraint system is secured.
Installing a child restraint system:
#
Always comply with the manufacturer's
installation instructions when installing and
removing the child restraint system.
#
Pull the seat belt smoothly from the seat belt
outlet.
#
Engage the seat belt tongue in the seat belt
buckle.
Activating the child seat safety feature:
#
Pull the seat belt out fully and let the inertia
reel retract it again.
When the child seat safety feature is activa‐
ted,you should hear a ratcheting sound.
#
Push the child restraint system down until
the seat belt sits tightly.
Deactivating the child seat safety feature:
#
Press the release button of the seat belt
buckle.
#
Hold the seat belt tongue and guide it back
to the seat belt outlet.
LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat attachment
Notes on LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat
securing systems
&
WARNING Risk of injury or fatal injury if
the child secured weighs more than the
permissible weight for the LATCH-type
(ISOFIX) child restraint system
LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint systems
do not offer sufficient protection for children
weighing more than 65 lbs (29 kg) together
with the child restraint system, who are
secured using the seat belt integrated in the
child restraint system. For example, the child
may not be restrained correctly in the event
of an accident.
#
If the child and the child restraint sys‐
tem together weigh more than 65 lbs
(29 kg), only use LATCH-type (ISOFIX)
child restraint systems with which the
child is secured with the vehicle seat
belt.
#
Also secure the child restraint system
with the Top Tether belt, if available.
50
Occupant safety
When installing a child restraint system, be sure
to observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions and the instructions for correct use
of the child restraint system.
ISOFIX is a standardized securing system for
specially designed restraint systems. LATCH-
type (ISOFIX) child restraint systems are
approved in accordance with ECE R44.
Only child restraint systems that have been
approved in accordance with ECE R44 may be
attached to LATCH-type (ISOFIX) mounting
brackets.
Symbol for installing a LATCH-type (ISOFIX)
child restraint system
Installing LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat
securing systems
&
WARNING Risk of injury or fatal injury if
the child secured weighs more than the
permissible weight for the LATCH-type
(ISOFIX) child restraint system
LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint systems
do not offer sufficient protection for children
weighing more than 65 lbs (29 kg) together
with the child restraint system, who are
secured using the seat belt integrated in the
child restraint system. For example, the child
may not be restrained correctly in the event
of an accident.
#
If the child and the child restraint sys‐
tem together weigh more than 65 lbs
(29 kg), only use LATCH-type (ISOFIX)
child restraint systems with which the
child is secured with the vehicle seat
belt.
#
Also secure the child restraint system
with the Top Tether belt, if available.
Occupant safety
51
When installing a child restraint system, be sure
to observe the manufacturer's installation
instructions and the instructions for correct use
of the child restraint system.
Before every trip, make sure that the LATCH-type
(ISOFIX) child restraint system is engaged cor‐
rectly in both LATCH-type (ISOFIX) mounting
brackets.
*
NOTE Damage to the seat belt for the
center seat
When installing a child restraint system, the
seat belt for the center seat could be dam‐
aged.
#
Make sure that the seat belt is not trap‐
ped.
#
Vehicles with a reclining rear seat: Move
the reclining rear seat backrest down slightly
before the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child
restraint system is installed.
#
Remove upholstered lining 1.
#
Vehicles without a reclining rear seat:
Fold upholstered lining 1 upwards.
#
Turn the support on the rear side of uphol‐
stered lining 1 by 90°.
Upholstered lining 1 remains folded
upwards.
#
Attach the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child
restraint system to both LATCH-type (ISOFIX)
mounting brackets 2.
#
Vehicles with a reclining rear seat: Return
the reclining rear seat backrest to an upright
position.
The reclining rear seat backrest must rest
against the child restraint system.
Securing Top Tether
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death when
adjusting the seat after installing a child
restraint system
Vehicles with electrically adjustable rear
seats:
If you adjust the seat after installing a child
restraint system, the following may occur:
R
the seat belt may either sit too loose or
too tight
R
the child restraint system can become
loose, incorrectly positioned or damaged
As a result, the child restraint system may
not be able to provide the intended level of
protection.
52
Occupant safety
#
Never adjust the seat after installing
the child restraint system.
The risk of injury can be reduced by Top Tether
as Top Tether provides an additional connection
between the child restraint system secured with
LATCH-type (ISOFIX) and the vehicle.
The child restraint system must be equipped
with a Top Tether belt.
#
If necessary, move head restraint 1
upwards (
page 103).
#
Fold up cover 2 of Top Tether anchorage
3.
#
Install the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint
system with Top Tether. Always comply with
the child restraint system manufacturer's
installation instructions when doing so.
#
Route Top Tether belt 4 under head
restraint 1 between the two head restraint
bars.
#
Hook Top Tether hook 5 of Top Tether belt
4 without twisting into Top Tether anchor‐
age 3.
#
Tension Top Tether belt 4. Always comply
with the child restraint system manufactur‐
er's installation instructions when doing so.
#
Fold down cover 2 of Top Tether anchorage
3.
#
If necessary, slide head restraint 1 down‐
wards (
page 103). Make sure that you do
not interfere with the correct routing of Top
Tether belt 4.
Child restraint systems on the front
passenger seat
Notes on child restraint systems on the front
passenger seat
Accident statistics show that children secured in
the rear seats are safer than children secured in
the front seats. For this reason, Mercedes-Benz
strongly advises that you install a child restraint
system on a rear seat.
Occupant safety
53
If it is absolutely necessary to install a child
restraint system on the front passenger seat,
always observe the information on the automatic
front passenger air bag shutoff (
page 41 ).
By doing this, you can avoid risks caused by:
R
A child restraint system that is not detected
by the automatic front passenger air bag
shutoff.
R
An unintentionally deactivated front
passenger air bag.
R
Incorrect positioning of the child restraint
system.
Forward-facing and rearward-facing child
restraint systems on the front passenger
seat
When using a rearward-facing child restraint sys‐
tem on the front passenger seat, the front
passenger air bag must always be deactivated.
This is only the case if the PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF indicator lamp is lit continuously
(
page 43).
When using the child restraint system on the
front passenger seat, it is essential to observe
the following:
R
Move the front passenger seat as far back as
possible.
R
Set the seat backrest to an almost vertical
position.
R
Retract the seat cushion length as far as pos‐
sible.
R
The entire base of the child restraint system
must always rest on the seat cushion of the
front-passenger seat.
R
The backrest of the forward-facing child
restraint system must
, as far as possible, be
resting on the seat backrest of the front
passenger seat. The child restraint system
must not touch the roof or be put under
strain by the head restraints.
R
If necessary, adjust the angle of the seat
backrest and the head restraint position
accordingly.
R
Adjust the seat cushion inclination so that
the front edge of the seat cushion is in the
highest position and the rear edge of the
seat cushion is in the lowest position.
R
Always make sure that the shoulder belt
strap is correctly routed from the seat belt
outlet of the vehicle to the shoulder belt
guide on the child restraint system. The
shoulder belt strap must be routed forwards
and downwards from the seat belt outlet.
R
If necessary, adjust the seat belt outlet and
the front passenger seat accordingly.
R
Never place objects under or behind the
child restraint system, e.g. cushions.
Always comply with the manufacturer's installa‐
tion and operating instructions for the child
restraint system used.
54
Occupant safety
Child safety locks
Activating/deactivating the child safety lock
for the rear doors
&
WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to children left unattended in the
vehicle
If you leave children unaccompanied in the
vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion, for example by:
R
Releasing the parking brake.
R
Shifting the transmission out of park
position j.
R
Starting the engine.
In addition, they may operate vehicle equip‐
ment.
#
Never leave children and animals unat‐
tended in the vehicle.
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
&
WARNING Risk of fatal injury due to
exposure to extreme heat or cold in the
vehicle
If people particularly children are
exposed to extreme heat or cold over an
extended period of time, there is a risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
#
Never leave anyone particularly chil‐
dren unattended in the vehicle.
&
WARNING There is a risk of accident
and injury if you leave children unatten‐
ded in the vehicle
If children are traveling in the vehicle, they
could:
R
Open doors, thereby endangering other
persons or road users.
R
Get out of the vehicle and be hit by
oncoming traffic.
R
Operate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example.
#
Always activate the child safety locks
available if children are traveling in the
vehicle.
#
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
Child safety locks are available for the rear doors
and for the rear side windows.
The child safety lock on the rear doors secures
each door separately. The doors can no longer
be opened from the inside.
Occupant safety
55
#
Press the lever in direction 1 (activate) or
2 (deactivate).
#
Make sure that the child safety locks are
working properly.
Activating/deactivating the child safety lock
for the rear side windows
#
To activate/deactivate: press button 2.
Opening/closing the side window in the rear
passenger compartment is possible:
R
With indicator lamp 1 lit: via the switch
on the driver's door.
R
With indicator lamp 1 off: via the switch
on the corresponding rear door or driv‐
er's door.
When the child safety lock is activated, the con‐
trols in the rear passenger compartment are
deactivated for:
R
The rear side windows
R
The adjustment of the front passenger seat
from the rear passenger compartment
R
The roller sunblinds:
-
Of the rear side windows
-
Of the rear window
-
In the roof
Notes on pets in the vehicle
&
WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to animals left unsecured or unat‐
tended in the vehicle
If you leave animals in the vehicle unatten‐
ded or unsecured, they could possibly press
down buttons or switches.
56
Occupant safety
Thereby an animal may:
R
activate vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
R
switch systems on or off and endanger
other road users
Unsecured animals may be thrown around in
the vehicle in the event of an accident or
sudden steering and braking maneuver and
injure vehicle occupants in the process.
#
Never leave animals in the vehicle unat‐
tended.
#
Always correctly secure animals while
driving, for example using a suitable
animal carrier.
Occupant safety
57
SmartKey
Overview of SmartKey functions
&
WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to children left unattended in the
vehicle
If children are left unattended in the vehicle,
they could:
R
Open doors, thereby endangering other
persons or road users
R
Get out of the vehicle and be hit by
oncoming traffic
R
Operate vehicle equipment
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example, by:
R
Releasing the parking brake
R
Shifting the transmission out of park
position j
R
Starting the engine.
#
Never leave children and animals unat‐
tended in the vehicle.
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
#
Keep the SmartKey out of the reach of
children.
*
NOTE Damage to the key caused by
magnetic fields
#
Keep the key away from strong mag‐
netic fields.
1
Locks
2
Battery check lamp
3
Unlocks
4
Opens/closes the trunk lid
5
Panic alarm
The SmartKey locks and unlocks the following
components:
R
Doors
R
Trunk lid
R
Fuel filler flap
If you do not open the vehicle within approx
imately 40 seconds after unlocking:
R
The vehicle is locked again.
R
Anti-theft protection is reactivated.
Do not keep the SmartKey together with elec‐
tronic devices or metal objects. This can affect
the SmartKey's functionality.
Do not keep the SmartKey in the temperature-
controlled cup holder. Otherwise, the SmartKey
will not be reliably detected.
%
If battery check lamp 2 does not light up
after pressing the % or & button, the
battery is discharged.
58
Opening and closing
Activating/deactivating the acoustic locking
verification signal
Multimedia system:
,

.
î  

.
 
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Arming/deactivating the panic alarm
Requirements:
R
The ignition is switched off.
#
To arm: press button 1 for approximately
one second.
A visual and audible alarm is triggered.
#
To deactivate: briefly press button 1 again.
or
#
Press the start/stop button on the cockpit
(the SmartKey is inside the vehicle).
Changing the unlocking settings
Possible unlocking functions of the SmartKey:
R
Central unlocking
R
Unlocking the driver's door and fuel filler flap
#
To switch between settings: press the
% and & buttons simultaneously for
approximately six seconds until the battery
check lamp flashes twice.
If the unlocking function for the driver's door
and fuel filler flap has been selected:
R
Pressing the % button a second time cen‐
trally unlocks the vehicle.
R
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: If you touch
the inner surface of the door handle on the
driver's door, only the driver's door and fuel
filler flap are unlocked.
Reducing the energy consumption of the
SmartKey
All vehicles: if you do not use the vehicle or a
SmartKey for an extended period of time, you
can reduce the energy consumption of the
respective SmartKey. To do so, deactivate the
SmartKey functions.
#
To deactivate: press the & button on the
SmartKey twice in rapid succession.
The battery check lamp of the SmartKey
flashes twice briefly and lights up once.
#
To activate: press any button on the Smart‐
Key.
%
When the vehicle is started with the Smart‐
Key in the stowage compartment of the cen‐
ter console, the SmartKey functions are
automatically activated (
page 167).
Vehicles with KEYLESS-GO: Automatic deacti‐
vation of the SmartKey functions occurs after a
few minutes if the SmartKey is not moved thus
Opening and closing
59
reducing the power consumption of the Smart‐
Key. When deactivated, the SmartKey cannot be
accessed without authorization.
To activate the SmartKey functions:
R
Press any button on the SmartKey.
R
Move the SmartKey.
R
Start the vehicle with the SmartKey in the
stowage compartment of the center console
(
page 167).
Inserting/removing the mechanical key
#
To remove: press release knob 1.
Mechanical key 2 is pushed out slightly.
#
Pull out mechanical key 2 until it engages in
the intermediate position.
%
You can use the intermediate position of
mechanical key 2 to attach the SmartKey
to a key ring.
#
Press release knob 1 again and fully
remove mechanical key 2.
#
To insert: press release knob 1.
#
Insert mechanical key 2 to the intermediate
position or fully until it engages.
Replacing the SmartKey battery
&
DANGER Serious damage to health
caused by swallowing batteries
Batteries contain toxic and corrosive sub‐
stances. Swallowing batteries may cause
serious damage to health.
There is a risk of fatal injury.
#
Keep batteries out of the reach of chil‐
dren.
#
If batteries are swallowed, seek medical
attention immediately.
+
ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
damage caused by improper disposal of
batteries
Batteries contain pollutants. It is
illegal to dispose of them with the household
rubbish.
#
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible manner.
Take discharged batteries to a qualified
specialist workshop or to a collection
point for used batteries.
Requirements:
R
You require a CR 2032 3 V cell battery.
60
Opening and closing
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have the
battery replaced at a qualified specialist work
shop.
#
Remove the mechanical key ( page 60).
#
Press release button 2 down fully and
remove cover 1.
#
Remove battery compartment 3 and take
out the discharged battery.
#
Insert the new battery into battery compart‐
ment 3. Observe the positive pole marking
in the battery compartment and on the bat‐
tery.
#
Push in battery compartment 3.
#
Replace cover 1 so that it engages.
Problems with the SmartKey
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
You can no longer lock or unlock the
vehicle.
Possible causes:
R
The SmartKey battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
R
There is interference from a powerful radio signal source.
R
The SmartKey is defective.
Opening and closing
61
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
#
Check the battery using the battery check lamp and replace if necessary .
#
Use the mechanical key to lock or unlock the vehicle .
#
Have the SmartKey checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
You have lost a SmartKey.
#
Have the SmartKey deactivated at a qualified specialist workshop.
#
If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
Doors
Unlocking and opening doors from the inside
#
To unlock and open a front door: pull door
handle 2.
Locking pin 1 pops up when the door is
unlocked.
#
To unlock a rear door: pull the rear door
handle.
The locking pin pops up when the rear door
is unlocked.
#
To open a rear door: pull the rear door han‐
dle again.
62
Opening and closing
Locking/unlocking the vehicle centrally from
the inside
#
To unlock: press button 1.
#
To lock: press button 2.
This does not lock or unlock the fuel filler flap.
The vehicle is not unlocked:
R
If you have locked the vehicle using the
SmartKey.
R
If you have locked the vehicle using KEY‐
LESS-GO.
Locking and unlocking the vehicle with KEY‐
LESS-GO
Requirements:
R
The SmartKey is outside the vehicle.
R
The distance between the SmartKey and the
vehicle does not exceed 3 ft (1 m).
R
The driver's door and the door at which the
door handle is used are closed.
#
To unlock the vehicle: touch the inner sur‐
face of the door handle.
#
To lock the vehicle: touch sensor surface
1 or 2.
#
Convenience closing: touch recessed sen‐
sor surface 2 for an extended period.
%
For further information on convenience clos‐
ing (
page 75).
Opening and closing
63
If you open the trunk lid from outside, the trunk
lid is automatically unlocked.
Problems with KEYLESS-GO
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
You can no longer lock or unlock the
vehicle using KEYLESS-GO.
Possible causes:
R
The SmartKey battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
R
There is interference from a powerful radio signal source.
R
The SmartKey is defective.
#
Check the battery using the battery check lamp and replace if necessary .
#
Use the mechanical key to lock or unlock the vehicle .
#
Have the vehicle and SmartKey checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Switching the automatic locking feature
on/off
The vehicle is locked automatically when the
ignition is switched on and the wheels are turn‐
ing faster than walking pace.
64
Opening and closing
#
To deactivate: press and hold button 1 for
approximately five seconds until an acoustic
signal sounds.
#
To activate: press and hold button 2 for
approximately five seconds until an acoustic
signal sounds.
In the following situations, there is a danger of
being locked out when the function is activated:
R
The vehicle is being towed/pushed.
R
The vehicle is being tested on a dynamome‐
ter.
Information on the power closing function
for the doors
If you push the door into the lock up to the first
detent position, the power closing function will
automatically pull the door into the lock.
Unlocking/locking the driver's door using
the mechanical key
%
If you wish to lock the vehicle entirely using
the mechanical key, first press the button for
locking from the inside while the driver's
door is open. Then proceed to lock the driv‐
er's door using the mechanical key.
#
Insert the mechanical key as far as it will go
into opening 1 in the cover.
#
Pull and hold the door handle.
#
Pull the cover on the mechanical key as
straight as possible away from the vehicle
until it releases.
#
Release the door handle.
Opening and closing
65
#
To unlock: turn the mechanical key counter-
clockwise to position 1.
#
To lock: turn the mechanical key clockwise
to position 1.
#
Carefully press the cover onto the lock cylin‐
der until it engages and is seated firmly.
Trunk
Opening the trunk lid
&
WARNING Risk of exhaust gas poisoning
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Exhaust
gases can enter the vehicle interior if the
trunk lid is open when the engine is running,
especially if the vehicle is in motion.
#
Always switch off the engine before
opening the trunk lid.
#
Never drive with the trunk lid open.
*
NOTE Damage to the trunk lid by obsta
cles above the vehicle
The trunk lid swings upwards when it is
opened.
#
Therefore, make sure that there is suffi
cient clearance above the trunk lid.
You have the following options to open the trunk
lid:
#
Pull the trunk lid handle.
#
Vehicles with trunk lid convenience clos‐
ing: With the trunk lid stopped in an inter‐
mediate position, pull the trunk lid upwards
and release as soon as it begins to open.
#
Press and hold the p button on the
SmartKey.
#
Pull trunk lid remote operating switch 1.
66
Opening and closing
#
Vehicles with HANDS-FREE ACCESS: move
your foot below the bumper (
page 69).
Vehicles with trunk lid convenience closing:
If an object restricts the trunk lid during the
automatic opening process, the obstacle detec‐
tion system stops the trunk lid. The obstacle
detection function is only an aid and is not a
substitute for your attentiveness.
Plug-in hybrid: observe the notes in the Supple‐
ment. Otherwise, you may not recognize dan‐
gers.
Closing the trunk lid
&
WARNING Risk of injury from unsecured
items in the vehicle
If objects, luggage or loads are not secured
or not secured sufficiently, they could slip,
tip over or be thrown around and thereby hit
vehicle occupants.
There is a risk of injury, particularly in the
event of sudden braking or a sudden change
in direction.
#
Always stow objects in such a way that
they cannot be thrown around.
#
Before the journey, secure objects, lug‐
gage or loads against slipping or tipping
over.
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
during automatic closing of the trunk lid
Parts of the body could become trapped dur‐
ing automatic closing of the trunk lid. More‐
over, people, e.g. children, may be standing
in the closing area or may enter the closing
area during the closing process.
#
Make sure that nobody is in the vicinity
of the closing area during the closing
process.
#
Use one of the following options to stop
the closing process:
R
Press the p button on the
SmartKey.
R
Press or pull the remote operating
switch on the driver's door.
R
Press the closing or locking button
on the trunk lid.
R
Pull the trunk lid handle.
Vehicles with HANDS-FREE ACCESS: It is also
possible to stop the closing process by moving
your foot in a kicking motion under the rear
bumper.
You have the following options to close the trunk
lid:
#
Pull the trunk lid down using the handle
recess and push it closed.
%
If you lightly push the trunk lid closed, the
power closing function automatically pulls
the trunk lid into the lock.
#
Vehicles with trunk lid convenience clos‐
ing: Pull down the trunk lid slightly and
release it as soon as it begins to close.
#
Vehicles with trunk lid convenience clos‐
ing: Press and hold the p button on the
SmartKey (with the SmartKey in the vicinity
of the vehicle).
Opening and closing
67
#
Vehicles with trunk lid convenience clos‐
ing: Press closing button 1 in the trunk lid.
#
Vehicles with trunk lid convenience clos‐
ing and KEYLESS-GO: Press locking button
2 in the trunk lid.
If a SmartKey is detected outside the vehicle,
the trunk lid closes and the vehicle is locked.
#
Vehicles with trunk lid convenience clos‐
ing: Press trunk lid remote operating switch
1.
#
Vehicles with HANDS-FREE ACCESS: move
your foot in a kicking motion under the
bumper (
page 69).
Automatic reversing function of the trunk lid
If an object restricts the trunk lid during the
automatic closing process, the trunk lid opens
again automatically. The automatic reversing
function is only an aid and is not a substitute for
your attentiveness.
#
When closing, make sure that no body parts
are in the closing area.
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
despite the reversing function
The reversing function does not react:
R
to soft, light and thin objects, e.g. fingers.
R
over the last Ó in (8 mm) of the closing
path.
In these situations in particular, the reversing
function cannot prevent someone being trap‐
ped.
#
When closing, make sure that no body
parts are in the closing area.
#
If someone is trapped, use one of the
following options:
R
Press the p button on the
SmartKey.
R
Press the remote operating switch
on the driver's door.
68
Opening and closing
R
Press the closing or locking button
on the trunk lid.
R
Pull the trunk lid handle.
HANDS-FREE ACCESS function
With HANDS-FREE ACCESS you can open, close
or interrupt trunk lid movement by performing a
kicking movement under the rear bumper.
The kicking movement triggers the opening or
closing process alternately.
Observe the notes when opening (
page 66)
and closing (
page 67) the trunk lid.
%
A warning tone sounds while the trunk lid is
opening or closing.
&
WARNING Risk of burns caused by a hot
exhaust system
The vehicle exhaust system can become very
hot. If you use HANDS-FREE ACCESS, you
could burn yourself by touching the exhaust
system.
#
Always ensure that you only make a
kicking movement within the detection
range of the sensors.
*
NOTE Damage to the vehicle caused by
unintentionally opening the trunk lid
R
When using an automatic car wash
R
When using a high pressure cleaner
#
Deactivate KEYLESS-GO or make sure
that the SmartKey located is at least
10 ft (3 m) away from the vehicle in
such situations.
When making the kicking movement, make sure
that your feet are firmly on the ground, other‐
wise you could lose your balance, e.g. on ice.
Requirements:
R
The SmartKey is behind the vehicle.
R
Stand at least 12 in (30 cm) away from the
vehicle while performing the kicking move
ment.
R
Do not come into contact with the bumper
while making the kicking movement.
R
Do not carry out the kicking movement too
slowly.
Opening and closing
69
R
The kicking movement must be towards the
vehicle and back.
1
Sensor detection range
If several consecutive kicking movements are
not successful, wait ten seconds.
System limitations
The system may be impaired or may not function
if:
R
Snow or dirt, e.g. from road salt, covers the
sensor area.
R
The kicking movement is made using a pros‐
thetic leg.
The trunk lid could be opened or closed uninten‐
tionally, in the following situations:
R
If a person's arms or legs are moving in the
sensor detection range, e.g. when polishing
the vehicle, sitting on the edge of the trunk,
or picking up objects.
R
If objects are moved or placed behind the
vehicle, e.g. charging cables, tensioning
straps or luggage.
R
When working on the trailer coupling, trailers
or rear bicycle racks.
Deactivate KEYLESS-GO (
page 59) or do not
carry the SmartKey about your person in such
situations.
Switching separate trunk locking on/off
If you centrally unlock the vehicle while separate
locking is activated, the trunk remains locked.
#
To switch on: slide the switch to position
2.
#
To switch off: slide the switch to position
1.
%
If an accident has been detected, the trunk
unlocks even if separate locking is switched
on.
70
Opening and closing
Unlocking the trunk with the emergency
release from inside
Requirements:
R
the 12 V vehicle battery is connected and
charged.
#
Press emergency release button 1 briefly.
The trunk lid unlocks and opens.
Unlocking the trunk lid using the mechanical
key
#
Take the mechanical key out of the SmartKey
(
page 60).
#
Insert the mechanical key into the trunk lock
as far as it will go.
#
Turn the mechanical key counter-clockwise
from position 1 to position 2.
#
Turn the mechanical key back to position 1
and remove it.
%
If you use the mechanical key to unlock and
open the trunk lid, the anti-theft alarm sys‐
tem will be triggered.
Activating/deactivating the trunk lid opening
height restriction
Multimedia system:
,

.
î  

.
  
Activating the function allows you to avoid
bumping the trunk lid on a low garage ceiling, for
example.
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Opening and closing
71
Roller sun blinds
Extending or retracting the roller sunblinds
on the rear side windows
The roller sunblinds for the rear side windows
can be operated with the buttons for the side
windows.
1
Rear left side window
2
Rear right side window
#
To close fully: pull the corresponding button
when the side window is closed.
#
To open fully: press the corresponding but‐
ton.
Extending/retracting the rear window roller
sunblind
&
WARNING Risk of entrapment when
extending or retracting the roller sun
blind
Body parts could become entrapped in the
sweep of the roller sun blind when it is being
extended or retracted.
#
Make sure that no body parts are in the
sweep of the roller sun blind when it is
being extended or retracted.
#
If someone becomes trapped, briefly
press the button again.
The opening or closing process is
briefly stopped. The roller sun blind
then returns to its starting position.
Extending/retracting from the driver's seat
*
NOTE Damage caused by objects
#
Make sure that the roller sun blind can
move freely.
72
Opening and closing
#
Press button 1.
%
Depending on the model, button 1 is loca‐
ted in the door control panel on the driver's
side.
Extending/retracting from the rear
passenger compartment
*
NOTE Damage caused by objects
#
Make sure that the roller sun blind can
move freely.
#
To extend: pull switch 1.
#
To retract: push switch 1.
When the override feature for the rear side win‐
dows is activated, switch 1 cannot be oper‐
ated.
Side windows
Opening/closing the side windows
&
WARNING Risk of entrapment when
opening a side window
When opening a side window, parts of the
body could be drawn in or become trapped
between the side window and window frame.
#
When opening, make sure that nobody
is touching the side window.
#
If someone is trapped, release the but‐
ton immediately or pull it in order to
close the side window again.
Opening and closing
73
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
when closing a side window
When closing a side window, body parts
could be trapped in the closing area in the
process.
#
When closing, make sure that no body
parts are in the closing area.
#
If someone is trapped, release the but‐
ton immediately or press the button in
order to reopen the side window.
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
when children operate the side windows
Children could become trapped if they oper‐
ate the side windows, particularly when unat‐
tended.
#
Activate the child safety lock for the
rear side windows.
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
#
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
1
Closes
2
Opens
The buttons in the driver's door take prece‐
dence.
#
To start automatic operation: press/pull
the W button beyond the pressure point.
#
To interrupt automatic operation: press/
pull the W button again.
%
Vehicles with electric roller sunblinds in
the left and right rear doors: The buttons
for the rear side windows also open and
close the roller sunblinds (
page 72).
Automatic reversing function for the side
windows
If an object blocks a side window during the
closing process, the side window opens again
automatically. The automatic reversing function
is only an aid and is not a substitute for your
attentiveness.
#
When closing, make sure that no body parts
are in the closing area.
74
Opening and closing
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
despite reversing protection on the side
window
The reversing function does not react:
R
to soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small
fingers.
R
over the last ã in (4 mm) of the closing
path.
R
during resetting.
R
when closing the side window again man‐
ually immediately after automatic revers
ing.
This means that the reversing function can‐
not prevent someone from becoming trapped
in these situations.
#
When closing, make sure that no body
parts are in the closing area.
#
If someone becomes trapped, press the
W button to open the side window
again.
Ventilating the vehicle before starting a jour‐
ney (convenience opening)
&
WARNING Risk of entrapment when
opening a side window
When opening a side window, parts of the
body could be drawn in or become trapped
between the side window and window frame.
#
When opening, make sure that nobody
is touching the side window.
#
Release the button immediately if
somebody becomes trapped.
#
Press and hold the % button on the
SmartKey.
The following functions are performed:
R
The vehicle is unlocked.
R
The side windows are opened.
R
The panoramic sliding sunroof is opened.
R
The seat ventilation of the driver's seat is
switched on.
If the roller sunblinds of the panoramic sliding
sunroof are closed, the roller sunblinds are
opened first.
If the roller sunblinds of the rear doors are
closed, the roller sunblinds are opened first.
#
To continue the opening procedure: press
the % button again.
#
To interrupt convenience opening: release
the % button.
Closing side windows from the outside (con‐
venience closing)
&
WARNING Risk of entrapment caused by
inadvertent convenience closing
When the convenience closing feature is
operating, parts of the body could become
trapped in the closing area of the side win‐
dow and the sliding sunroof.
#
Observe the complete closing proce‐
dure when using convenience closing.
#
When closing, make sure that no body
parts are in the closing area.
Opening and closing
75
#
Press and hold the & button on the
SmartKey.
The following functions are performed:
R
The vehicle is locked.
R
The side windows are closed.
R
The panoramic sliding sunroof is closed.
#
To close the roller sunblinds: press the
& button again.
#
To interrupt convenience closing: release
the & button.
%
Convenience closing can also be operated
with KEYLESS-GO (
page 63).
Problems with the side windows
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
A side window cannot be closed and
you cannot see the cause.
#
Check to see if any objects are in the window guide.
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped or fatally injured if reversing protection is not activated
If you close a side window again immediately after it has been blocked or reset, the side window closes
with increased or maximum force. The reversing feature is then not active.
Parts of the body could become trapped in the closing area in the process.
#
Make sure that no parts of the body are in the closing area.
#
To stop the closing process, release the button or press the button again to reopen the side win‐
dow.
If a side window is obstructed during closing and reopens again slightly:
#
Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding button again until the side window has
closed, and hold the button for an additional second.
The side window is closed with increased force.
76
Opening and closing
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
If a side window is obstructed again during closing and reopens again slightly:
#
Repeat the previous step.
The side window is closed without the automatic reversing function.
The side windows cannot be opened or
closed using the convenience opening
feature.
The SmartKey battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
#
Check the battery using the battery check lamp and replace if necessary .
Sliding sunroof
Opening/closing the sliding sunroof
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
while opening and closing the sliding
sunroof
During opening and closing, parts of the
body could get caught in the sweep of the
sliding sunroof.
#
When opening or closing, make sure
that no body parts are in the sweep.
#
Release the button immediately if
somebody becomes trapped.
or
#
Press the button in any direction during
the automatic opening/closing process.
The opening/closing process is stop‐
ped.
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped if
the sliding sunroof is operated by chil‐
dren
Children operating the sliding sunroof could
get caught in the moving parts, particularly if
unattended.
#
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the key with you and lock the vehicle.
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
while opening and closing the roller sun
blind
When opening or closing, make sure that no
body parts become trapped between the
roller sun blind and frame or the sliding sun‐
roof.
Opening and closing
77
#
When opening or closing, make sure
that no body parts are in the sweep of
the roller sun blind.
#
Release the button immediately if
somebody becomes trapped.
or
#
Press the button in any direction during
the automatic opening/closing process.
The opening/closing process is stop‐
ped.
*
NOTE Malfunction caused by snow and
ice
Snow and ice may lead to a malfunction of
the sliding sunroof.
#
Only open the sliding sunroof if it is free
of snow and ice.
*
NOTE Damage caused by protruding
objects
Objects that protrude from the sliding sun‐
roof may damage the sealing strips.
#
Do not allow anything to protrude from
the sliding sunroof.
Requirements:
R
The sliding sunroof can only be operated
when the roller sunblind is open.
R
The roller sunblind can only be operated
when the sliding sunroof is closed.
%
The term "sliding sunroof" refers to the pan‐
oramic sliding sunroof.
1
To raise
2
To open
3
To close/lower
Use the 3 button to operate the sliding sun‐
roof and the front roller sunblind.
#
To start automatic operation: press/pull
the 3 button beyond the pressure point.
78
Opening and closing
#
To interrupt automatic operation: press/
pull the 3 button again.
Restrictions:
R
Automatic operation for raising is only availa‐
ble when the sliding sunroof is closed or
raised.
R
Do not open the sliding sunroof if a roof rack
is installed. The sliding sunroof closes again
automatically when it encounters resistance.
Operating the rear roller sunblind from the
front
#
To open or close: press button 1.
#
To stop: press button 1 again.
You must first open or close the rear roller sun‐
blind fully before you can move it in the other
direction.
Operating the rear roller sunblind from the
rear passenger compartment
#
To open/close manually: press or pull but‐
ton 1 to the point of resistance and hold it
until the roller sunblind has reached the
desired position.
#
To open/close fully: press or pull button 1
beyond the point of resistance and release it.
Opening and closing
79
Automatic reversing function of the sliding
sunroof
If there is an object obstructing the sliding sun‐
roof during the closing process, the sliding sun‐
roof opens again automatically. The automatic
reversing function is only an aid and is not a sub‐
stitute for your attentiveness.
#
When closing, make sure that no body parts
are in the closing area.
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
despite the reversing function being
active
The reversing function does not react:
R
to soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small
fingers
R
during the last 1/6 in (4 mm) of the clos‐
ing path
R
during resetting
R
when closing the sliding sunroof again
manually immediately after automatic
reversing
This means that the reversing function can‐
not prevent someone being trapped in these
situations.
#
When closing, make sure that no body
parts are in the closing area.
#
Release the button immediately if
somebody becomes trapped.
or
#
Press the button in any direction during
the automatic closing process.
The closing process is stopped.
Automatic reversing function of the roller
sunblind
If there is an object obstructing the roller sun‐
blind during the closing process, the roller sun‐
blind opens again automatically. The automatic
reversing function is only an aid and is not a sub‐
stitute for your attentiveness.
#
When opening or closing the roller sunblind,
make sure that no body parts are in the
sweep.
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
despite the reversing function being
active
In particular, the reversing function does not
react to soft, light and thin objects, for exam‐
ple small fingers.
This means that the reversing function can‐
not prevent entrapment in these situations.
#
When opening or closing the roller sun
blind, make sure that no body parts are
in the sweep.
#
Release the button immediately if
somebody becomes trapped.
or
#
Press the button in any direction during
the automatic closing process.
The closing process is stopped.
Automatic features of the sliding sunroof
%
The term "sliding sunroof" refers to the pan‐
oramic sliding sunroof.
80
Opening and closing
By pushing or pulling the 3 button, you can
interrupt the automatic functions: "Rain closing
function when driving" and "Automatic lowering
feature".
Rain closing function when driving
The raised sliding sunroof automatically lowers
when driving if it starts to rain.
Automatic lowering feature
If the sliding sunroof is raised at the rear, it auto‐
matically lowers slightly at higher speeds. At low
speeds, it is raised again automatically.
&
WARNING Risk of entrapment by auto‐
matic lowering of the sliding sunroof
At high speeds the raised sliding sunroof
automatically lowers slightly at the rear.
This could trap you or other persons.
#
Make sure that nobody reaches into the
sweep of the sliding sunroof whilst the
vehicle is in motion.
#
If somebody becomes trapped, immedi‐
ately pull back the sliding sunroof but‐
ton.
The sliding sunroof lifts during opening.
MAGIC SKY CONTROL
MAGIC SKY CONTROL function
MAGIC SKY CONTROL is a function with which
you can change the transparency of the panor‐
amic sliding sunroof. You can choose between
darkened or transparent states of the front and
rear elements of the panoramic sliding sunroof.
&
DANGER Risk of fatal injury caused by
touching electrical component parts of
MAGIC SKY CONTROL
MAGIC SKY CONTROL operates using high
voltage. If the roof lining is damaged or
removed, electric component parts will be
exposed.
If you touch these component parts, you
could get an electric shock.
#
Never remove the roof lining.
#
If the roof lining is damaged, never
touch the electrical component parts
behind it.
#
Always have work on MAGIC SKY CON‐
TROL carried out at a qualified special‐
ist workshop.
Opening and closing
81
Operating MAGIC SKY CONTROL
Operating the front and rear elements from
the front
#
Press button 1.
If the rear element is in a different state to
the front element: the transparency of the
front element changes.
If both elements are in the same state: the
transparency of both elements changes.
%
When you switch off the power supply, both
elements darken automatically.
When you switch on the power supply or the
ignition, both elements return to the state
they were in before the power supply was
switched off.
Operating the rear element from the rear
passenger compartment
#
If the roller sunblind is fully closed: pull but‐
ton 1.
The roller sunblind is opened. The transpar‐
ency of the rear element then changes.
82
Opening and closing
#
If the roller sunblind is fully opened: press
button 1.
The transparency of the rear element
changes.
%
The rear element darkens automatically if
you close the rear roller sunblind.
Problems with the sliding sunroof
%
The term "sliding sunroof" refers to the pan‐
oramic sliding sunroof.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
The sliding sunroof cannot be closed
and you cannot see the cause.
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped or fatal injury by closing the sliding sunroof again
If you close the sliding sunroof again immediately after it has been blocked or reset, the sliding sunroof
closes with increased or maximum force.
The reversing feature is then not active. Parts of the body could become trapped in the closing area in
the process.
#
Make sure that no parts of the body are in the closing area.
#
Release the button immediately if somebody becomes trapped.
or
#
Press the button in any direction during the automatic closing process.
The closing process is stopped.
If the sliding sunroof is obstructed during closing and reopens again slightly:
Opening and closing
83
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
#
Immediately after automatic reversing, pull and hold the 3 button down again to the point of resist‐
ance until the sliding sunroof is closed.
The sliding sunroof is closed with increased force.
If the sliding sunroof is obstructed again and reopens again slightly:
#
Repeat the previous step.
The sliding sunroof is closed again with increased force.
The sliding sunroof or the front roller
sunblind does not move smoothly.
#
Pull the 3 button down repeatedly to the point of resistance until the sliding sunroof is fully closed.
#
Pull the 3 button for another second.
#
Pull and hold the 3 button down until the front roller sunblind is fully closed.
#
Pull the 3 button for another second.
#
Use automatic operation to fully open and then close the sliding sunroof.
84
Opening and closing
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
The rear roller sunblind does not move
smoothly.
#
Pull and hold button 1 down repeatedly until the rear roller sunblind is fully closed.
#
Pull the 1 button for another second.
#
Use automatic operation to fully open and then close the rear roller sunblind.
Opening and closing
85
Anti-theft protection
Function of the immobilizer
The immobilizer prevents your vehicle from being
started without the correct SmartKey.
The immobilizer is automatically activated when
the ignition is switched off and deactivated when
the ignition is switched on.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the Smart‐
Key with you and lock the vehicle. Anyone can
start the engine if a valid SmartKey has been left
inside the vehicle.
%
If the event that the engine cannot be star‐
ted (yet the vehicle's battery is charged), the
system is not operational. Contact an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or call
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (in the USA) or
1-800-387-0100 (in Canada).
ATA (anti-theft alarm system)
Function of the ATA system (anti-theft alarm
system)
If the ATA system is armed, a visual and audible
alarm is triggered in the following situations:
R
A door is opened.
R
The trunk lid is opened.
R
The hood is opened.
The ATA system is armed automatically after
approximately 10 seconds:
R
After locking the vehicle with the SmartKey.
R
After locking the vehicle using KEYLESS-GO.
When the ATA system is armed, indicator lamp
1 flashes.
The ATA system is automatically deactivated:
R
After unlocking the vehicle with the Smart‐
Key.
R
After pressing the start/stop button with the
SmartKey inside the vehicle.
86
Opening and closing
R
After unlocking the vehicle using KEYLESS-
GO.
%
When the mbrace service (
page 329) is
active and the alarm stays on for more than
30 seconds, a message is automatically sent
to the Customer Assistance Center.
Deactivating the ATA (anti-theft alarm sys‐
tem) alarm
#
Press the %, & or p button on the
SmartKey.
or
#
Press the start/stop button (the SmartKey is
inside the vehicle).
Stopping the alarm using KEYLESS-GO
#
Grasp the outside door handle (with the
SmartKey outside the vehicle).
Opening and closing
87
Notes on the correct driver's seat position
&
WARNING Risk of injury from adjusting
the vehicle settings while the vehicle is in
motion
You could lose control of the vehicle in the
following situations:
R
if you adjust the driver's seat, the head
restraint, the steering wheel or the mirror
while the vehicle is in motion
R
if you fasten your seat belt while the vehi‐
cle is in motion
#
Before starting the engine: adjust the
driver's seat, the head restraint, the
steering wheel or the mirror and fasten
your seat belt.
Observe the following when adjusting steering
wheel 1, seat belt 2 and driver's seat 3:
R
you are as far away from the driver's airbag
as possible
R
you are sitting in a normal upright position
R
your thighs are slightly supported by the seat
cushion
R
your legs are not entirely stretched and you
can depress the pedals properly
R
the back of your head is supported at eye
level by the center of the head restraint
R
you can hold the steering wheel with your
arms slightly bent
R
you can move your legs freely
R
you can see all the displays in the instrument
cluster clearly
R
you should have a good overview of traffic
conditions
R
the seat belt is pulled snugly against the
body and must be routed across the center
of your shoulder and across your hips in the
pelvic area
88
Seats and stowing
Seats
Adjusting the front seat electrically
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped if
the seats are adjusted by children
Children could become trapped if they adjust
the seats, particularly when unattended.
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
#
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
The seats can be adjusted when the ignition is
switched off.
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
when adjusting the seats
When you adjust a seat, you or other vehicle
occupants could become trapped, e.g. on the
seat guide rail.
#
Make sure when adjusting a seat that
no one has any body parts in the sweep
of the seat.
Observe the safety notes on "Air bags" and "Chil‐
dren in the vehicle".
&
WARNING Risk of injury from adjusting
the vehicle settings while the vehicle is in
motion
You could lose control of the vehicle in the
following situations:
R
if you adjust the driver's seat, the head
restraint, the steering wheel or the mirror
while the vehicle is in motion
R
if you fasten your seat belt while the vehi‐
cle is in motion
#
Before starting the engine: adjust the
driver's seat, the head restraint, the
steering wheel or the mirror and fasten
your seat belt.
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped if
the seat height is adjusted carelessly
If you adjust the seat height carelessly, you
or other vehicle occupants could be trapped
and thereby injured.
Children in particular could accidentally
press the electrical seat adjustment buttons
and become trapped.
#
While moving the seats, make sure that
hands or other body parts do not get
under the lever assembly of the seat
adjustment system.
&
WARNING Risk of injury due to head
restraints which are not installed or are
adjusted incorrectly
If head restraints are not installed or are
adjusted incorrectly, the head restraints can‐
not provide protection as intended.
There is an increased risk of injury in the
head and neck area, e.g. in the event of an
accident or when braking.
Seats and stowing
89
#
Always drive with the head restraints
installed.
#
Before driving off, make sure for every
vehicle occupant that the center of the
head restraint supports the back of the
head at about eye level.
Do not swap the head restraints of the front and
rear seats. Otherwise, you cannot adjust the
height and angle of the head restraints correctly.
Adjust the head restraint fore-and-aft position so
that it is as close as possible to the back of your
head.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death due to
incorrect seat position
The seat belt does not offer the intended
level of protection if you have not moved the
seat backrest to an almost vertical position.
When braking or in the event of an accident,
you could slide underneath the seat belt and
sustain abdominal or neck injuries, for exam‐
ple.
#
Adjust the seat properly before begin‐
ning your journey.
#
Always ensure that the seat backrest is
in an almost vertical position and that
the shoulder section of your seat belt is
routed across the center of your shoul‐
der.
*
NOTE Damage to the seats when moving
the seats back
The seats may be damaged by objects when
moving the seats back.
#
When moving the seats back, make
sure that there are no objects in the
footwell or under or behind the seats.
1
Height/fore-and-aft position of the head
restraint (vehicles with an EASY ADJUST
luxury head restraint)
2
Head restraint height
3
Seat height
4
Seat cushion inclination
5
Seat cushion length
90
Seats and stowing
6
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
7
Backrest angle
#
Save the settings with the memory function
(
page 113).
%
The head restraint height is adjusted auto‐
matically when you adjust the seat height or
the seat fore-and-aft position.
%
Vehicles with EASY ADJUST luxury head
restraints: the fore-and-aft position of the
head restraint is pre-adjusted automatically
when you adjust the backrest angle.
Adjusting the front passenger seat from the
driver's seat electrically
Requirements:
R
To select the front passenger seat: the power
supply is switched on
You can call up the following functions for the
front passenger seat:
R
Seat adjustment
R
Seat heater
R
Seat ventilation
R
Memory function
#
To select the front passenger seat: press
button 1.
When the indicator lamp lights up, the front
passenger seat is selected.
#
Adjust the front passenger seat using the
buttons in the door control panel on the driv‐
er's side.
Adjusting the front passenger seat electri‐
cally from the rear passenger compartment
Requirements:
R
To select the front passenger seat: the power
supply is switched on
Seats and stowing
91
Vehicles with electrically adjustable outer seats
1
Selects the front passenger seat
2
Head restraint height
3
Seat backrest inclination
4
Seat height
5
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
Vehicles with an EASY ADJUST luxury head restraint
1
Selects the front passenger seat
2
Head restraint fore-and-aft position
3
Head restraint height
4
Seat backrest inclination
5
Seat height
6
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
Vehicles with seat for chauffeur mode and long
wheelbase
1
Selects the front passenger seat
2
Head restraint fore-and-aft position
3
Head restraint height
4
Seat backrest inclination
5
Seat height
6
Footrest
7
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
92
Seats and stowing
The footrest can only be adjusted when one of
the following conditions has been fulfilled:
R
The front passenger seat is moved fully
forward
R
The front passenger seat is in the position for
chauffeur mode
#
Adjust the rear seat ( page 93).
#
Adjust the reclining rear seat ( page 93).
#
To select the front passenger seat: press
button 1.
When the indicator lamp lights up, the front
passenger seat is selected.
#
Adjust the front passenger seat using the
buttons in the door control panel in the rear
passenger compartment.
%
Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: it is suffi
cient to adjust the footrest if the front
passenger seat is moved into the center set‐
ting area.
%
You can use the override feature in the rear
passenger compartment to disable this func‐
tion (
page 56).
Adjusting the rear seats electrically
You can electrically adjust only the outer seats in
the rear passenger compartment.
1
Height/fore-and-aft position of the head
restraint (vehicles with active multicontour
seat)
2
Head restraint height
3
Seat backrest inclination
4
Combined seat cushion inclination and
length
#
Saving the settings with the memory function
(
page 114).
Adjusting a reclining rear seat electrically
The reclining rear seat is available in long wheel‐
base vehicles equipped with "executive seats".
On vehicles without a reclining rear seat, the
button for setting the angle and fore-and-aft
position of the leg rest has no function.
Vehicles with a long wheelbase: the reclining
rear seat is on the front passenger side.
Mercedes-Maybach vehicles: the reclining rear
seats are on the driver's and the front passenger
sides.
Seats and stowing
93
1
Height/fore-and-aft position of the head
restraint (vehicles with active multicontour
seat)
2
Head restraint height
3
Seat backrest inclination
4
Combined seat cushion inclination and
length
5
Combined seat cushion inclination and
length
6
Angle of the leg rest
7
Fore-and-aft position of the leg rest
#
Save the settings using the memory function
(
page 114).
%
The leg rest folds down if overloaded. If this
is the case, fold up the leg rest and engage
it.
%
Vehicles with a long wheelbase and a Chauf‐
feur/Rear Seat Memory Package also have a
footrest. This is located on the lower part of
the front passenger seat backrest
(
page 91).
Setting the fully reclined position
Requirements:
R
The power supply is switched on.
This function is available in vehicles with a long
wheelbase.
#
To set the reclined position: press and hold
button 1 until the reclined position is
reached.
R
The rear seat moves into the reclined
position.
R
The front passenger seat moves into the
position for chauffeur mode.
R
The footrest moves out from under the
front passenger seat.
94
Seats and stowing
R
if available, the leg rest rises.
#
To set the seat position: manually adjust
the seat to the desired position.
or
#
Call up the settings with the memory func‐
tion (
page 114).
%
You can use the override feature in the rear
passenger compartment to disable this func‐
tion (
page 56).
%
The leg rest folds down if overloaded. If this
is the case, fold up the leg rest and engage
it.
Chauffeur mode
Information on chauffeur mode
&
WARNING Risk of injury due to head
restraints which are not installed or are
adjusted incorrectly
If head restraints are not installed or are
adjusted incorrectly, the head restraints can‐
not provide protection as intended.
There is an increased risk of injury in the
head and neck area, e.g. in the event of an
accident or when braking.
#
Always drive with the head restraints
installed.
#
Before driving off, make sure for every
vehicle occupant that the center of the
head restraint supports the back of the
head at about eye level.
Do not swap the head restraints of the front and
rear seats. Otherwise, you cannot adjust the
height and angle of the head restraints correctly.
Adjust the head restraint fore-and-aft position so
that it is as close as possible to the back of your
head.
&
WARNING Risk of accident with the
front passenger head restraint folded
down
If the front passenger seat is in the chauffeur
mode position and the front passenger head
restraint is folded down, the view of the pas‐
senger's outside mirror can be impaired.
#
To have a free view of the outside mir‐
ror, remove the front passenger head
restraint before beginning a journey.
*
NOTE Damage to objects in the luggage
net of the front passenger footwell when
adjusting the front passenger seat to the
chauffeur position
Objects in the luggage net in the front
passenger footwell can become damaged
when the front passenger seat is adjusted to
the chauffeur position.
#
Remove the objects from the luggage
net.
*
NOTE Damage to the seats when moving
the seats back
The seats may be damaged by objects when
moving the seats back.
#
When moving the seats back, make
sure that there are no objects in the
footwell or under or behind the seats.
Seats and stowing
95
Observe the following:
R
adjust the front passenger seat for chauffeur
mode before the journey
R
do not remove the front passenger seat head
restraint during the journey
For chauffeur mode, the following settings are
made for the front passenger seat:
R
the seat is moved forwards
R
the backrest is tilted forwards
R
the head restraint is folded forwards
The front passenger seat automatically moves
from the chauffeur position back into the normal
position in the following situations:
R
the front passenger seat is adjusted using
the buttons in the door control panel on the
front passenger side
R
the front passenger seat belt is fastened
R
an occupant is detected on the front
passenger seat
R
the front passenger head restraint is inserted
and the power supply is switched on
R
the front passenger backrest is adjusted
rearwards
R
the front passenger seat is moved in the fore-
and-aft direction out of the chauffeur area
Positioning the front passenger seat for
chauffeur mode
Requirements:
R
The power supply is switched on.
R
The front passenger seat is not occupied.
R
The front passenger seat belt is not inserted
into the seat belt buckle.
96
Seats and stowing
#
To select the front passenger seat: press
button 1.
When the indicator lamp lights up, the front
passenger seat is selected.
Setting the chauffeur position
#
Press button 2 forwards and hold it in this
position.
The front passenger seat moves forward and
stops at the threshold of the area for chauf‐
feur mode.
#
Release button 2.
#
Press forward and hold button 2 again until
the front passenger seat is in position for
chauffeur mode.
The front passenger head restraint folds for‐
wards. The front passenger seat moves
forward.
The       
      
display message appears in the multifunction
display.
%
If the front passenger seat is already at the
threshold to the area for chauffeur mode,
the position for chauffeur mode is set imme‐
diately.
#
Saving the settings with the memory function
(
page 114).
%
You can use the override feature in the rear
passenger compartment to disable this func‐
tion (
page 56).
Removing or installing the front passenger
head restraints (chauffeur mode)
Requirements:
R
The front passenger head restraint is folded
completely forward
Seats and stowing
97
Removing the head restraint
#
Fold head restraint bar covers 2 towards
the rear.
#
Hold front passenger head restraint 1
tightly.
#
Pull adjuster lever 3 towards the rear and
hold it in this position.
#
Remove front passenger head restraint 1.
#
Release adjuster lever 3.
Red pin 4 protrudes from the adjuster lever.
#
Press down red pin 4.
#
Fold covers 2 forwards and close them.
Inserting the head restraint
#
Fold head restraint bar covers 2 towards
the rear.
#
Pull adjuster lever 3 towards the rear.
Red pin 4 protrudes from the adjuster lever.
#
Insert front passenger head restraint 1 into
the brackets.
The front passenger head restraint must
engage on both sides.
#
Press down red pin 4.
If pin 4 can be pressed down and is then no
longer visible, the front passenger head
restraint has engaged correctly.
#
Fold covers 2 forwards and close them.
The front passenger head restraint folds into
position automatically.
Moving the front passenger seat into the
normal position (chauffeur mode)
Requirements:
R
To select the front passenger seat: the power
supply is switched on
R
The front passenger head restraint is instal‐
led.
98
Seats and stowing
#
To select the front passenger seat: press
button 1.
When the indicator lamp lights up, the front
passenger seat is selected.
Setting the normal position
#
Press button 3 towards the rear and hold it
in this position.
The front passenger seat moves to the
threshold of the area for chauffeur mode.
The front passenger head restraint folds into
position.
The front passenger seat then moves further
towards the rear passenger compartment.
or
#
Briefly press button 2 back.
The front passenger seat moves automati‐
cally to the threshold of the area for chauf‐
feur mode. The front passenger head
restraint folds into position.
%
You can also set the normal position from
the front passenger seat. To do so, press any
button in the door control panel on the front
passenger side.
#
Call up the settings with the memory func‐
tion (
page 114).
%
You can use the override feature in the rear
passenger compartment to disable this func‐
tion (
page 56).
Seats and stowing
99
Setting the fully reclined position of the front
passenger seat (chauffeur mode)
Setting the reclined position
This function is available in vehicles with the fol‐
lowing equipment:
R
Electrically adjustable rear seats.
R
Individual rear seats without a leg rest.
You can move the front passenger seat into a
fully reclined position. The rear seat and front
passenger seat then provide a continuous sur‐
face.
#
Put the seat cushion of the rear seat all the
way back in the fore-and-aft position
(
page 93).
#
Move the front passenger seat into position
for chauffeur mode (
page 96).
#
Remove the front passenger head restraint
(
page 97).
#
Move the front passenger seat so that the
backrest is in a fully reclined position
(
page 89).
Leaving the reclined position
#
Fold the front passenger seat backrest
upright to a suitable position.
#
Install the front passenger head restraint
(
page 97).
Head restraints
Adjusting the front seat head restraints man‐
ually
&
WARNING Risk of injury from adjusting
the vehicle settings while the vehicle is in
motion
You could lose control of the vehicle in the
following situations:
R
if you adjust the driver's seat, the head
restraint, the steering wheel or the mirror
while the vehicle is in motion
R
if you fasten your seat belt while the vehi‐
cle is in motion
#
Before starting the engine: adjust the
driver's seat, the head restraint, the
steering wheel or the mirror and fasten
your seat belt.
&
WARNING Risk of injury due to head
restraints which are not installed or are
adjusted incorrectly
If head restraints are not installed or are
adjusted incorrectly, the head restraints can‐
not provide protection as intended.
There is an increased risk of injury in the
head and neck area, e.g. in the event of an
accident or when braking.
#
Always drive with the head restraints
installed.
#
Before driving off, make sure for every
vehicle occupant that the center of the
head restraint supports the back of the
head at about eye level.
Do not rotate the head restraints of the front and
rear seats. Otherwise, you cannot adjust the
height and angle of the head restraints correctly.
100
Seats and stowing
Adjust the head restraint fore-and-aft position so
that the head restraint is as close as possible to
the back of your head.
#
To move forwards: pull the head restraint
forwards.
#
To move backwards: press release knob 1
and push the head restraint towards the rear.
Adjusting the front seat luxury head
restraints manually
#
To adjust the side bolsters of the head
restraint: pull or push right or left-hand side
bolster 2.
#
To move forwards: pull the head restraint
forwards.
#
To move backwards: press release knob 1
and push the head restraint towards the rear.
Adjusting the EASY ADJUST luxury head
restraints on the front seats manually
#
To adjust the side bolsters of the head
restraint: pull or push right or left-hand side
bolster 1.
%
The fore-and-aft position of the head
restraint is adjusted automatically when you
adjust the backrest using the buttons in the
door control panel.
Seats and stowing
101
Lowering the rear seat head restraints elec‐
trically from the front
Requirements:
R
The power supply is switched on.
#
Press button 1.
%
Depending on the model, button 1 is loca‐
ted in the door control panel on the driver's
side.
%
If all of the rear seat head restraints are low‐
ered and button 1 is pressed again, the
outer rear head restraints move into the last
stored position (
page 103).
Extending the outer rear seat head restraints
electrically from the front
Requirements:
R
The power supply is switched on.
This function is available on vehicles with electri‐
cally adjustable rear seats.
#
Press and hold button 1 until the head
restraints have extended upwards.
%
Depending on the model, button 1 is loca‐
ted in the door control panel on the driver's
side.
102
Seats and stowing
Extending the outer rear seat head restraints
to the last stored position
Requirements:
R
The power supply is switched on.
This function is available on vehicles with electri‐
cally adjustable rear seats.
#
Briefly press switch 1.
The head restraints lower.
#
Briefly press switch 1 again.
The head restraints move to the last stored
position.
%
Depending on the model, button 1 is loca‐
ted in the door control panel on the driver's
side.
Adjusting the rear seat outer head restraints
manually
#
To move forwards: pull the head restraint
forwards.
#
To move backwards: press release knob 1
and push the head restraint towards the rear.
Seats and stowing
103
Adjusting the outer luxury head restraints of
the rear seats mechanically
#
To adjust the side bolsters: push or pull
right and/or left-hand side bolster 1 into
the desired position.
#
To adjust the angle of the head restraint:
pull or push the head restraint in the direc‐
tion of arrow 2.
Attaching and removing the supplementary
cushion of the rear luxury head restraint
The supplementary cushion is available on vehi‐
cles with electrically adjustable rear seats.
Only use the supplementary cushion when the
vehicle is stationary. The supplementary cushion
is in the vehicle.
#
Position the head restraint as far forwards as
possible.
#
To attach the supplementary cushion:
hold supplementary cushion 1 against the
head restraint and push press studs 2 into
the counterpieces.
#
To remove the supplementary cushion:
release press studs 2 and remove supple‐
mentary cushion 1.
Extending or retracting the rear seat center
head restraint electrically
104
Seats and stowing
#
Press and hold button 1 until the head
restraint has extended or retracted.
Folding the center head restraint into posi‐
tion mechanically
#
Pull the head restraint up until it engages.
Configuring seat adjustment
Requirements:
R
The ignition is switched on.
Multimedia system:
,

.
a 
#
Select   or  .
Adjusting the backrest side bolsters
#
Select  .
#
Select the setting.
Adjusting the seat contour in the lumbar
region of the seat backrest
#
Select .
#
Adjust the air cushion.
Setting the shoulder section
#
Select .
#
Select the settings.
Setting seat heating balance
#
Select   .
#
Select the settings.
Memory function
#
Save the seat adjustments with the memory
function (
page 113).
Setting automatic adjustment of the lateral
support (active multicontour seat)
Multimedia system:
,

.
a 
With this function, the lateral support of the
active multicontour seat is automatically adjus‐
ted to the driving and cornering dynamics of the
vehicle.
#
Select   or  .
#
Select  .
#
Select setting: ,  or  .
Seats and stowing
105
Overview of massage and workout programs
The following massage program can be selected:
Massage program for the front seats Function
Hot Relaxing Massage for backRelaxing massage program starting in the pelvic area. Warm pressure points can be felt, full back massage,
stretching the pelvic area. Ending with gentle stroking motions.
Hot Relaxing Massage for shouldersRelaxing massage program starting in the shoulder area. Warm pressure points can be felt, full twin-wave
back massage, stretching the shoulder area. Ending with gentle stroking motions.
Activating Massage Activating back massage with increasing twin-waves and then soothing movements.
Classic Massage Massage with increasing twin-waves and soothing movements.
Mobilizing Massage Mobilization of the spinal column and the complete upper body by means of a pressure point mobilizing
massage at chest height.
Active Workout programs
The Active Workout programs require your active
co-operation and are a convenient way of exer‐
cising your abdomen and back muscles during a
traffic jam, for example, by tensing and releasing
the specific muscle groups. Tensing and releas‐
ing also helps to improve blood flow to your
muscles. Press against a pressure point as soon
as you feel it.
106
Seats and stowing
The following Active Workout programs can be selected:
Workout programFunction
Active Workout To stimulate the muscles in your abdomen and back: press against the pressure points in the backrest.
Keep the pressure under your feet even. Continue to breathe normally; do not hold your breath.
When the pressure in the seat backrest recedes, stop pressing against it and relax briefly.
Selecting the massage program for the front
seats
Multimedia system:
,

.
a 
#
Select   or  .
#
Select .
#
Select a massage program.
The massage program runs for approximately
8 to 18 minutes, depending on the setting.
#
To set the massage intensity: switch 
 on O or off ª.
Resetting seat and massage settings
Multimedia system:
,

.
a 
.

#
Select  or .
Depending on whether the settings for the driver
or front passenger seat are selected, only the
selected seat can be reset.
Switching the seat heater on/off
&
WARNING Risk of burns due to repeat‐
edly switching on the seat heater
Repeatedly switching on the seat heater can
cause the seat cushion and seat backrest
padding to become very hot.
The health of persons with limited tempera‐
ture sensitivity or a limited ability to react to
excessively high temperatures may be affec‐
ted or they may even suffer burn-like injuries.
#
Do not repeatedly switch on the seat
heater.
Seats and stowing
107
*
NOTE Damage to the seats caused by
objects or documents when the seat
heater is switched on
When the seat heater is switched on, over‐
heating can occur due to objects or docu‐
ments placed on the seats e.g. seat cushions
or child seats. This could cause damage to
the seat surface.
#
Make sure that no objects or docu‐
ments are on the seats when the seat
heater is switched on.
Requirements:
R
The power supply is switched on.
#
To switch on/increase the level: press but‐
ton 1 repeatedly until the desired heating
level is set.
Depending on the heating level, up to three
indicator lamps light up.
108
Seats and stowing
#
To switch off/reduce the level: press but‐
ton 1 repeatedly until the desired heating
level is set.
If all indicator lamps are off, the seat heater
is switched off.
%
The seat heater automatically switches down
from the three heating levels after 8, 10 and
20 minutes until the seat heater is switched
off.
%
If you switch the power supply off and on
again within 20 minutes, the previous setting
of the seat heater for the driver's seat
remains active.
%
You can set the distribution of the heated
sections of the seat cushions and seat
backrests on the front and rear seats in the
multimedia system (
page 109).
%
Vehicles with the Warmth Comfort Pack
age: You can adjust the heating of the armr‐
ests in the door and center console in the
multimedia system.
Setting the panel heating
Multimedia system:
,

.
î  

.
 
When the seat heater is switched on, the armr‐
ests in the vehicle and the center console can be
heated.
#
Select   ,  ,  
or .
Switching the seat ventilation on/off
Requirements:
R
The power supply is switched on.
Seats and stowing
109
#
To switch on/increase the level: press but‐
ton 1 repeatedly until the desired ventila‐
tion level is set.
Depending on the ventilation level, up to
three indicator lamps light up.
#
To switch off/reduce the level: press but‐
ton 1 repeatedly until the desired ventila‐
tion level is set.
If all indicator lamps are off, the seat ventila‐
tion is switched off.
%
If you switch the power supply off and on
again within 20 minutes, the previous setting
of the seat ventilation for the driver's seat
remains active.
Steering wheel
Adjusting the steering wheel electrically
&
WARNING Risk of injury from adjusting
the vehicle settings while the vehicle is in
motion
You could lose control of the vehicle in the
following situations:
R
if you adjust the driver's seat, the head
restraint, the steering wheel or the mirror
while the vehicle is in motion
R
if you fasten your seat belt while the vehi‐
cle is in motion
#
Before starting the engine: adjust the
driver's seat, the head restraint, the
steering wheel or the mirror and fasten
your seat belt.
&
WARNING Risk of entrapment for chil‐
dren when adjusting the steering wheel
Children could injure themselves if they
adjust the steering wheel.
#
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
The steering wheel can be adjusted when the
power supply is switched off.
110
Seats and stowing
1
Adjusts the distance to the steering wheel
2
Adjusts the height
#
Save the settings with the memory function
(
page 113).
Overview of the steering wheel heater
The steering wheel heater can be operated when
the power supply or ignition is switched on.
1
To activate
2
To deactivate
3
Indicator lamp
Easy entry and exit feature
Function of the easy entry and exit feature
&
WARNING Risk of accident when driving
off while adjusting the easy exit feature
If you drive off while the easy entry and exit
feature is making adjustments, you could
lose control of the vehicle.
#
Always wait until the adjustment proc‐
ess is complete before driving off.
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
while adjusting the easy entry and exit
feature
When the easy entry and exit feature adjusts
the steering wheel and the driver's seat, you
and other vehicle occupants particularly
children could become trapped.
#
During the adjustment process of the
easy entry and exit feature, make sure
that no one has any body parts in the
sweep of the seat or the steering wheel.
Seats and stowing
111
If there is a risk of becoming trapped by the
steering wheel:
#
Move the adjustment lever of the steer‐
ing wheel.
The adjustment process is stopped.
If there is a risk of becoming trapped by the
driver's seat:
#
Press the seat adjustment switch.
The adjustment process is stopped.
Vehicles with memory function: you can stop the
adjustment process by pressing one of the mem‐
ory position switches of the memory function.
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
during activation of the easy entry and
exit feature by children
If children activate the easy entry and exit
feature, they can become trapped, particu‐
larly when unattended.
#
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
If the easy entry and exit feature is active, the
steering wheel will move upwards and the driv‐
er's seat will move back in the following situa‐
tions:
R
You switch the ignition off when the driver's
door is open
R
You open the driver's door when the ignition
is switched off
%
The steering wheel only moves upwards if it
has not already reached the upper stop. The
driver's seat moves backwards unless it is
already in the rearmost position.
The steering wheel and the driver's seat move
back to the last drive position in the following
cases:
R
You switch the power supply or the ignition
on when the driver's door is closed
R
You close the driver's door when the ignition
is switched on
The last drive position of the steering wheel is
stored in the following situations:
R
You switch the ignition off
R
You call up the seat settings via the memory
function
R
You save the seat setting using the memory
function
If you press one of the memory function position
buttons, the adjustment process is stopped.
Setting the easy entry and exit feature
Multimedia system:
,

.
î  

.
 
#
Select   , 
  or .
112
Seats and stowing
Using the memory function
&
WARNING Risk of an accident if memory
function is used while driving
If you use the memory function on the driv‐
er's side while driving, you could lose control
of the vehicle as a result of the adjustments
being made.
#
Only use the memory function on the
driver's side when the vehicle is station‐
ary.
&
WARNING Risk of entrapment when set‐
ting the seat with the memory function
When the memory function adjusts the seat
or steering wheel, you and other vehicle
occupants particularly children could
become trapped.
#
During the setting procedure of the
memory function, ensure that no body
parts are in the sweep of the seat or
the steering wheel.
#
If somebody becomes trapped, immedi‐
ately release the memory function posi‐
tion button.
The adjustment process is stopped.
&
WARNING Risk of entrapment if the
memory function is activated by children
Children could become trapped if they acti‐
vate the memory function, particularly when
unattended.
#
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the key with you and lock the vehicle.
The memory function can be used when the igni‐
tion is switched off.
Storing
The memory function is only available in vehicles
with the memory package.
Seat adjustments for up to three people can be
stored and called up using the memory function.
The following settings can be stored for the front
seats:
R
Seat, backrest, head restraint position and
contour of the seat backrest in the lumbar
region
R
Active multicontour seat: side bolsters of the
seat backrest, shoulder of the seat backrest,
contour of the seat backrest, dynamic func‐
tion level
R
Seat heater: distribution of the heated sec‐
tions of the seat cushion and seat backrest
R
Driver's side: steering wheel position and
position of the outside mirrors on the driver's
and front passenger sides
R
Head-up Display
Seats and stowing
113
#
Set the seat, the steering wheel, the Head-up
Display and the outside mirror to the desired
position.
#
Briefly press memory button M and then
press preset position button 1, 2 or 3 within
three seconds.
An acoustic signal sounds. The settings are
stored.
#
To call up: press and hold the relevant pre‐
set position button 1, 2 or 3 until the front
seat, the steering wheel, Head-up Display
and outside mirror is in the stored position.
%
If you release the preset position button, the
seat, steering wheel and mirror setting func‐
tions stop immediately.
Vehicles with an Active Multicontour
Package: The setting of the active multicon‐
tour seat or the 4-way lumbar support is still
carried out.
Vehicles without the Active Multicontour
Package: Adjustment of the 4-way lumbar
support is still carried out.
Memory function in the rear passenger
compartment
Operating rear seats via the memory func‐
tion in the rear passenger compartment
Storing
Rear seat settings for up to three people can be
stored and called up using the memory function
in the rear passenger compartment.
The following settings can be stored for the rear
seats:
R
Position of the seat, backrest and head
restraint
R
Active multicontour seats: the seat side bol‐
sters of the seat backrest as well as the con‐
tour of the seat backrest in the lumbar and
shoulder regions
R
Seat heater: distribution of the heated sec‐
tions of the seat cushion and seat backrest
114
Seats and stowing
#
Press button 1.
The rear seat is selected if the indicator lamp
in the button does not light up.
#
Adjust the rear seat using the buttons in the
door control panel (
page 93).
Example: vehicles without reclining rear seat
#
Briefly press memory button M and then
press preset position button 1, 2 or 3 within
three seconds.
The settings for the rear seat are stored in
the selected storage position.
%
Vehicles with reclining rear seat: You can‐
not store any settings on the button for set‐
ting the reclined position.
Calling up
#
Press button 1.
The rear seat is selected if the indicator lamp
in the button does not light up.
Seats and stowing
115
Example: vehicles without reclining rear seat
#
Press and hold the relevant preset position
button 1, 2 or 3 until the rear seat is in the
stored position.
%
Seat adjustment is interrupted as soon as
you release the preset position button.
The adjustment of the active multicontour
seat is still carried out.
Operating the front passenger seat and rear
seats via the memory function in the rear
passenger compartment
Requirements:
R
To select the front passenger seat: the power
supply is switched on
Storing
Front passenger seat adjustments and rear seat
adjustments for up to three people can be
stored and called up using the memory function
in the rear passenger compartment.
The following settings can be stored for the front
passenger seat:
R
Position of the seat, backrest and head
restraint
The following settings can be stored for the rear
seats:
R
Position of the seat, backrest and head
restraint
R
Active multicontour seats: the seat side bol‐
sters of the seat backrest as well as the con‐
tour of the seat backrest in the lumbar and
shoulder regions
R
Seat heater: distribution of the heated sec‐
tions of the seat cushion and seat backrest
The following settings are also stored to a mem‐
ory position, if the indicator lamp in the v
button lights up:
R
Position of the footrest of the front
passenger seat, if available
R
Position of the screen, if available
Using the preset position buttons, you always
store the current setting of each seat.
116
Seats and stowing
#
Press button 1.
The rear seat is selected if the indicator lamp
in the button does not light up.
#
Adjust the rear seat using the buttons in the
door control panel (
page 93).
#
Press button 1.
When the indicator lamp lights up, the front
passenger seat is selected.
#
Adjust the front passenger seat using the
buttons in the door control panel in the rear
passenger compartment (
page 89).
#
Ensure that the indicator lamp in button 1
lights up.
Example: vehicles without reclining rear seat
#
Briefly press memory button M and then
press preset position button 1, 2 or 3 within
three seconds.
The settings for the front passenger seat and
the rear seat are stored in the selected pre‐
set position.
%
Vehicles with reclining rear seat: You can‐
not store any settings on the button for set‐
ting the reclined position.
Seats and stowing
117
Calling up
#
Press button 1.
When the indicator lamp lights up, the front
passenger seat is selected.
Example: vehicles without reclining rear seat
#
Press and hold the relevant preset position
button 1, 2 or 3 until both seats are in the
stored position.
%
The preset positions in the area for the
chauffeur mode can only be set when the
conditions for the chauffeur mode are fulfil‐
led (
page 95).
%
Seat adjustment is interrupted as soon as
you release the preset position button.
The adjustment of the active multicontour
seat is still carried out.
%
You can use the rear passenger compart‐
ment child safety lock to deactivate this
function (
page 56).
Stowage areas
Notes on loading the vehicle
&
WARNING Risk of exhaust gas poisoning
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Exhaust
gases can enter the vehicle interior if the
trunk lid is open when the engine is running,
especially if the vehicle is in motion.
#
Always switch off the engine before
opening the trunk lid.
#
Never drive with the trunk lid open.
118
Seats and stowing
&
WARNING Risk of injury from unsecured
items in the vehicle
If objects, luggage or loads are not secured
or not secured sufficiently, they could slip,
tip over or be thrown around and thereby hit
vehicle occupants.
There is a risk of injury, particularly in the
event of sudden braking or a sudden change
in direction.
#
Always stow objects in such a way that
they cannot be thrown around.
#
Before the journey, secure objects, lug‐
gage or loads against slipping or tipping
over.
&
WARNING Risk of injury from incorrectly
stowed objects
If objects in the vehicle interior are stowed
incorrectly, they can slide or be thrown
around and hit vehicle occupants. In addi‐
tion, cup holders, open stowage spaces and
mobile phone brackets cannot always retain
all objects they contain.
There is a risk of injury, particularly in the
event of sudden braking or a sudden change
in direction.
#
Always stow objects so that they can‐
not be thrown around in such situa‐
tions.
#
Always make sure that objects do not
protrude from stowage spaces, luggage
nets or stowage nets.
#
Close the lockable stowage spaces
before starting a journey.
#
Always stow and secure heavy, hard,
pointed, sharp-edged, fragile or bulky
objects in the trunk.
&
WARNING Risk of burns from tailpipes
and tailpipe trim
The tailpipe and tailpipe trim can become
very hot. If you come into contact with these
parts of the vehicle, you could burn yourself.
#
Always be particularly careful around
the tailpipe and the tailpipe trim.
#
Allow the vehicle parts to cool down
before you touch them.
The handling characteristics of your vehicle are
dependent on the distribution of the load within
the vehicle. You should bear the following in
mind when loading the vehicle:
R
Never exceed the maximum permissible
gross mass or the permissible axle loads for
the vehicle (including occupants). The values
are specified on the vehicle identification
plate on the vehicle's B-pillar.
R
The load must not protrude above the upper
edge of the seat backrests.
R
Always place the load behind unoccupied
seats if possible.
R
Secure the load using the parcel net hooks.
Distribute the load on the parcel net hooks
evenly.
Seats and stowing
119
Stowage spaces in the vehicle interior
Overview of the front stowage compart
ments
&
WARNING Risk of injury from incorrectly
stowed objects
If objects in the vehicle interior are stowed
incorrectly, they can slide or be thrown
around and hit vehicle occupants. In addi‐
tion, cup holders, open stowage spaces and
mobile phone brackets cannot always retain
all objects they contain.
There is a risk of injury, particularly in the
event of sudden braking or a sudden change
in direction.
#
Always stow objects so that they can‐
not be thrown around in such situa‐
tions.
#
Always make sure that objects do not
protrude from stowage spaces, luggage
nets or stowage nets.
#
Close the lockable stowage spaces
before starting a journey.
#
Always stow and secure heavy, hard,
pointed, sharp-edged, fragile or bulky
objects in the trunk.
Observe the notes on loading the vehicle.
1
Stowage compartment in the doors
2
Stowage/telephone compartment in the
armrest with multimedia and USB ports as
well as stowage space, e.g. for an MP3
player
3
Stowage compartment in the front center
console
4
Glove box
Locking or unlocking the glove box
#
Turn the mechanical key a quarter turn clock‐
wise 2 (to lock) or counter-clockwise 1 (to
unlock).
120
Seats and stowing
Opening the glasses compartment
#
Press button 1.
Folding the folding table out or in
&
WARNING Risk of injury from the open
folding table
If you are driving with the folding table open,
vehicle occupants could strike against it, in
particular in the event of an accident, sudden
braking or an abrupt change of direction.
#
Close the folding table before each jour‐
ney.
*
NOTE Damage to the folding tables when
moving the seats back
Open folding tables may be damaged when
moving the seats back.
#
Make sure that the folding tables are
folded in when moving the seats back.
Folding out
#
Open rear armrest 1 ( page 121).
#
Pull the folding table forwards and upwards
by handle recess 2 or 3 and swing out‐
wards.
#
Fold the table panels apart.
#
To fold in: fold the table panels together and
swing in the folding table.
Opening the stowage compartment in the
rear armrest
Vehicles with a rear bench seat
#
Fold down the rear armrest.
Seats and stowing
121
#
To open: press release catch 1 and swing
the cover of the armrest upwards.
Vehicles with electrically adjustable outer seats
#
Fold down the rear armrest.
#
To open: pull handle 1 and fold the cover of
the armrest upwards.
Opening the stowage compartment in the
rear-compartment center console
Vehicles with individual rear seats
#
Pull handle 1 and fold the cover of the arm‐
rest upwards.
Opening the stowage box in the rear seat
backrest
*
NOTE Damage to the rear armrest
When folded out, the rear armrest can be
damaged by the weight of your body.
#
Do not sit or support yourself on the
rear armrest.
Vehicles with a rear bench seat
122
Seats and stowing
Vehicles with electrically adjustable outer seats Vehicles with individual rear seats
#
Vehicles with a rear bench seat or electri‐
cally adjustable outer seats: Fold down the
rear armrest.
#
Pull handle 1 and fold down cover 2.
Parcel net hooks
Observe the following notes:
R
Secure the load using the parcel net hooks.
R
Do not use elastic straps or nets to secure a
load. These are intended only as anti-slip pro‐
tection for light loads.
R
Do not route tie downs across sharp edges
or corners.
R
Pad sharp edges for protection.
There are up to four parcel net hooks in the
trunk depending on the equipment installed.
Seats and stowing
123
1
Parcel net hooks
Using the bag hooks
&
WARNING Risk of injury when using bag
hooks with heavy objects
The bag hooks cannot restrain heavy objects
or items of luggage.
Objects or items of luggage could be thrown
around and thereby hit vehicle occupants
when braking or abruptly changing direc‐
tions.
#
Only hang light objects on the bag
hooks.
#
Never hang hard, sharp-edged or fragile
objects on the bag hooks.
#
Pull bag hook 2 down by tab 1.
%
Observe the notes on loading the vehicle
(
page 118).
EASY-PACK trunk box
Adjusting the height of the EASY-PACK trunk
box to any position
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
and injured when moving the floor up
When the floor moves up, your hands may
become trapped on the frame of the EASY-
PACK trunk box and objects may be thrown
up.
#
When the floor moves up, make sure
that your hands are not within the
sweep of the floor.
#
If someone becomes trapped, carefully
push the center of the floor downward.
#
Remove all objects from the floor
before moving it up.
124
Seats and stowing
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped
when pressing the EASY-PACK trunk box
in
When the EASY-PACK trunk box is pressed
into the retracted position, your hands may
become trapped. Children, in particular, may
injure themselves when doing so.
#
When pressing the EASY-PACK trunk
box in, make sure that your hands are
not within the sweep of the EASY-PACK
trunk box.
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
#
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
*
NOTE Damage to the extended EASY-
PACK trunk box
The EASY-PACK trunk box may be damaged
when it is extended.
#
Do not place any objects on or press
down on the EASY-PACK trunk box
frame.
#
Do not close the trunk lid when the
EASY-PACK trunk box is extended.
*
NOTE Damage to the EASY-PACK trunk
box by objects
Objects which are sharp-edged, pointed,
fragile, rounded or heavy and objects that
roll can damage the EASY-PACK trunk box
and be thrown out.
#
Do not transport objects which are
sharp-edged, pointed, rounded or frag‐
ile and objects that roll in the EASY-
PACK trunk box.
#
Always stow and secure such objects
outside of the box in the trunk.
#
Always observe the maximum permitted
load of the EASY-PACK trunk box.
#
Do not use the EASY-PACK trunk box
when the rear seats are folded for‐
wards.
The maximum permissible load of the EASY-
PACK trunk box is 22 lbs (10 kg). To prevent the
box from being overloaded, the box floor lowers
onto the trunk floor when the load reaches
approximately 11 lbs (5 kg).
#
To remove: pull handle 2 of the box.
Seats and stowing
125
#
To increase the load capacity: press the
center of floor 1 downwards to the desired
position and box size.
#
To reduce the load capacity: press button
3.
#
To stow: press the box in completely using
handle 2 until it locks in place.
%
Observe the notes on cleaning the EASY-
PACK trunk box (
page 390).
Installing or removing the EASY-PACK trunk
box
Installing
#
Turn rotating catches 6 outward.
#
Insert retainers 2 of box 1 into outer
holes 3.
#
Raise box 1 and press hooks 5 into rear
shelf 4.
#
Turn rotating catches 6 inward.
126
Seats and stowing
Removing
#
Turn rotating catches 6 outward.
#
Lower box 1 and pull it out of anchorages
4.
#
Pull box 1 back out of openings 3.
Opening the stowage space under the trunk
floor
#
Pull trunk floor 2 upwards using handle 1
until it rests against the trunk separator.
#
Fold out hook 3 on the underside of the
trunk floor.
#
Clip hook 3 into groove 4.
Seats and stowing
127
Attaching the roof rack
&
WARNING Risk of injury by exceeding
the maximum roof load
When you load the roof, the vehicle center of
gravity rises and the driving characteristics
change.
If you exceed the maximum roof load, the
driving characteristics, as well as the steer‐
ing and braking, will be greatly impaired.
#
Never exceed the maximum roof load
and adjust your driving style.
The maximum roof load can be found under
"Technical data".
*
NOTE Vehicle damage from non-
approved roof racks
The vehicle could be damaged by roof racks
which have not been tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
#
Only use roof racks tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
#
Depending on the vehicle equipment,
ensure that when the roof rack is instal‐
led:
R
The sliding sunroof can be fully
raised.
R
The trunk lid can be fully opened.
#
Position the load on the roof rack in
such a way that the vehicle will not sus‐
tain damage even when it is in motion.
*
NOTE Damage to the sliding sunroof
when a roof rack is installed
The sliding sunroof may be damaged by the
roof rack if you attempt to open it when the
roof rack is installed.
#
Do not open the sliding sunroof when
the roof rack is installed.
In order to allow ventilation of the vehicle
interior, you can raise the sliding sunroof.
*
NOTE Damage to the covers
The covers may be damaged and scratched
when being opened.
#
Do not use metallic or hard objects.
#
Fold covers 1 carefully upwards in the
direction of the arrow.
128
Seats and stowing
#
Secure the roof rack to the anchorage points
under covers 1.
#
Comply with the roof rack manufacturer's
installation instructions.
#
Secure the load on the roof rack.
Cup holder
Removing or installing the cup holder in the
center console
&
WARNING Risk of accident or injury
when using the cup holder while the
vehicle is moving
The cup holder cannot secure containers
while the vehicle is moving.
If you use a cup holder while the vehicle is
moving, the container may be flung around
and liquids may be spilled. The vehicle occu‐
pants may come into contact with the liquid
and if it is hot, they could be scalded. You
could be distracted from traffic conditions
and you may lose control of the vehicle.
#
Only use the cup holder when the vehi‐
cle is stationary.
#
Only use the cup holder for containers
of the right size.
#
Close the container, particularly if the
liquid is hot.
Observe the following for Mercedes-Maybach
vehicles equipped with champagne glasses:
R
Do not use the champagne glasses while the
vehicle is in motion
R
Do not use champagne glasses made of
breakable glass, and store them in the trunk
if possible.
#
To remove: slide catch 2 forwards and pull
out cup holder 1.
#
To install: insert cup holder 1 and slide
back catch 2.
%
The cup holder rubber mat can be removed
for cleaning, e.g. using clean, lukewarm
water.
%
Observe the notes on loading the vehicle
(
page 118).
Seats and stowing
129
Opening the cup holder in the rear armrest
(vehicles with rear bench seat)
*
NOTE Damage to the cup holder
When the rear armrest is folded back the cup
holder could become damaged.
#
Only fold the rear armrest back when
the cup holder is closed.
#
To open: press cup holder 1 or 2.
#
Place or remove a container in cup holder 1
or 2.
Opening or closing the cup holder in the rear
armrest (vehicles with electrically adjustable
rear seats)
#
To open: press down cup holder base 2 in
the middle until it engages.
#
To close: press closing button 1.
%
The cup holder insert can be removed for
cleaning, e.g. using clean, lukewarm water.
Removing and fitting the cup holder insert in
the rear armrest (vehicles with electrically
adjustable rear seats)
Removing the insert
*
NOTE Damage to the wooden trim
The wooden trim can be damaged by pulling
out the cup holder insert.
#
Do not pull the cup holder insert out
from the rear armrest any farther than
0.6 in (15 mm).
130
Seats and stowing
#
Press down cup holder base 3 in the middle
until it engages.
#
Press both retaining clips 2 and pull the
cup holder insert upwards approximately
0.6 in (15 mm).
#
Press button 1.
Cup holder base 3 raises.
#
Remove the cup holder insert from the rear
armrest completely.
Installing the insert
*
NOTE Damage to the wooden trim
The wooden trim can be damaged by insert
ing the cup holder insert.
#
Make sure that the cup holder insert
has been inserted into the recess cor‐
rectly.
#
Make sure that cup holder base 2 is in the
upper position.
#
Place the cup holder insert into the recess in
the rear armrest such that button 1 is
facing forwards.
#
Press the cup holder insert down.
#
Press outer ring 3 of the cup holder insert
until the cup holder insert engages audibly.
Switching the cooling or heating function for
the temperature-controlled cup holder on or
off
When the heating function is used, the metal
insert of the cup holder is heated. For this rea‐
son, you must not reach into the cup holder
insert.
Seats and stowing
131
#
To switch on: press button 2 repeatedly
until the blue (keep cool) or red (keep warm)
indicator lamp on the button lights up.
#
To switch off: press button 2 repeatedly
until the indicator lamp on the button goes
out.
%
Only clean the removable rubber mat with
clear, lukewarm water, and cup holder 1
with a damp cloth.
Ashtray and cigarette lighter
Using the ashtray in the front center console
#
To open: briefly press marking 4.
#
To remove the insert: grip the sides of
insert 1, push it forward and pull it upwards
2.
#
To re-install the insert: press insert 1 into
the drawer until it engages.
#
To close: press stowage compartment 3
closed until it locks.
Using the ashtray in the rear door
To use the ashtray, you can place it in a cup
holder or hold it in your hand.
#
Fold lid 2 upwards.
If you are not using the ashtray, close it and
place it in retainer 1 in the rear door.
132
Seats and stowing
Using the cigarette lighter in the front center
console
&
WARNING Risk of fire and injury from
hot cigarette lighter
You can burn yourself if you touch the hot
heating element or the socket of the ciga‐
rette lighter.
In addition, flammable materials may ignite
if:
R
you drop the hot cigarette lighter
R
a child holds the hot cigarette lighter to
objects, for example
#
Always hold the cigarette lighter by the
knob.
#
Always make sure that the cigarette
lighter is out of reach of children.
#
Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
Requirements:
R
The ignition is switched on.
#
Press in cigarette lighter 1.
The cigarette lighter will pop out automati‐
cally when the heating element is red-hot.
Using the cigarette lighter in the rear
passenger compartment
Requirements:
R
The ignition is switched on.
Vehicles with a rear bench seat or electrically
adjustable outer seats
Vehicles with individual rear seats
Seats and stowing
133
#
Lightly press cover 1.
#
Press in cigarette lighter 2.
The cigarette lighter will pop out automati‐
cally when the heating element is red-hot.
Sockets
Using the 12 V socket in the front center
console
Requirements:
R
Only connect devices up to a maximum of
180 watts (15 A).
#
Lift up socket cap 1.
#
Insert the plug of the device.
If you have connected a device to the 12 V
socket, leave the cover of the stowage compart‐
ment open.
Using the 12 V socket in the rear passenger
compartment
Requirements:
R
Only connect devices up to a maximum of
180 watts (15 A).
Vehicles with a rear bench seat or electrically
adjustable outer seats
Vehicles with individual rear seats
#
Lightly press cover 1.
#
Lift up socket cap 2.
#
Insert the plug of the device.
If you have connected a device to the 12 V
socket, leave the cover of the stowage compart‐
ment open.
134
Seats and stowing
Using the 115 V socket in the rear passenger
compartment
&
DANGER Risk of fatal injury due to dam‐
aged connecting cables or sockets
If a suitable device is connected, the 115 V
socket will be carrying a high voltage. If the
connecting cable or the 115 V socket is
pulled out of the trim or is damaged or wet,
you could receive an electric shock.
#
Only use dry and damage-free connect‐
ing cables.
#
When the ignition is switched off,
ensure that the 115 V socket is dry.
#
If the 115 V socket is damaged or gets
pulled out of the paneling, immediately
have the socket checked or replaced at
a qualified specialized workshop.
#
Never plug the connecting cable into a
115 V socket that is damaged or has
been pulled out of the trim.
&
DANGER Risk of fatal injury due to incor‐
rect handling of the socket
You could receive an electric shock:
R
if you reach into the socket.
R
if you insert unsuitable devices or objects
into the socket.
#
Only connect suitable devices to the
socket.
Requirements
R
Only connect devices with a suitable plug
which conforms to the standards specific to
the country you are in.
R
Only connect devices up to a maximum of
150 watts.
R
Do not use multiple socket outlets.
Vehicles with a rear bench seat or electrically
adjustable outer seats
Seats and stowing
135
Vehicles with individual rear seats
#
Open flap 3.
#
Insert the plug of the device into 115 V
socket 2.
When the on-board electrical system voltage
is sufficient, indicator lamp 1 lights up.
Using the 12 V socket in the trunk
Requirements:
R
Only connect devices up to a maximum of
180 watts (15 A).
#
Lift up cap 1 of the socket and insert the
plug of the device.
USB port in the rear passenger compartment
Vehicles with a rear bench seat or electrically
adjustable outer seats
136
Seats and stowing
Vehicles with individual rear seats
You can charge a USB device, e.g. a mobile
phone, at USB ports 1 using a suitable charg‐
ing cable. The devices can be charged with 5 V
(2.1 A) and when the ignition is switched on.
Refrigerator box
Using the refrigerator box
&
WARNING Risk of fire due to a covered
vent grille on the refrigerator box
If you cover the vent grille for the refrigerator
box, it may overheat.
#
Always make sure that the vent grille is
not covered.
The vent grille for the refrigerator box is in the
trunk.
The refrigerator box can bear a maximum load of
7. 7 lb (3.5 kg).
Store only plastic bottles in the upper compart‐
ment of the refrigerator box. The contents of the
bottle must be no more than 17 fl. oz. (0.5 l).
If you do not need to use the refrigerator box for
an extended period you should switch it off,
defrost it and clean it. After doing so, leave the
lid open for a time.
The refrigerator box reduces its cooling capacity
or switches off in the following cases:
R
too many electrical consumers are turned on
R
the starter battery is not sufficiently charged
If this is the case, the indicator lamps flash in
the button to switch the refrigerator box on and
off. The cooling function will automatically
switch back on as soon as there is sufficient
voltage.
Seats and stowing
137
#
Vehicles with a rear bench seat or electrically
adjustable outer seats: fold down the rear
armrest.
#
Pull handle 1 and fold down cover 2.
#
To open: pull handle 1 and fold down the
cover.
#
To switch on: press button 2 repeatedly
until an indicator lamp (low cooling) flashes
or two indicator lamps (high cooling) flash.
#
To switch off: press button 2 repeatedly
until both indicator lamps go out.
Removing or installing the refrigerator box
Removing
#
Switch off the refrigerator box.
#
Pull plug 2 down and out.
#
Unscrew both screws 3.
#
Pull out the refrigerator box.
#
Close flap 1.
138
Seats and stowing
Installing
#
Swing flap 1 to the side until it is locked in
place by the magnet.
#
Insert the refrigerator box.
#
Tighten both screws 3.
#
Connect plug 2.
Wireless charging of the mobile phone and
connection with the exterior antenna
Notes on wireless charging of the mobile
phone
&
WARNING Risk of injury from incorrectly
stowed objects
If objects in the vehicle interior are stowed
incorrectly, they can slide or be thrown
around and hit vehicle occupants. In addi‐
tion, cup holders, open stowage spaces and
mobile phone brackets cannot always retain
all objects they contain.
There is a risk of injury, particularly in the
event of sudden braking or a sudden change
in direction.
#
Always stow objects so that they can‐
not be thrown around in such situa‐
tions.
#
Always make sure that objects do not
protrude from stowage spaces, luggage
nets or stowage nets.
#
Close the lockable stowage spaces
before starting a journey.
#
Always stow and secure heavy, hard,
pointed, sharp-edged, fragile or bulky
objects in the trunk.
Observe the notes on loading the vehicle.
&
WARNING Risk of fire from placing
objects in the mobile phone stowage
compartment
If you place objects in the mobile phone
stowage compartment, they may heat up
excessively and even catch fire.
#
Do not place additional objects, espe‐
cially those mode of metal, in the
mobile phone stowage compartment.
*
NOTE Damage to objects caused by
placing them in the mobile phone stow
age compartment
If you place objects in the mobile phone
stowage compartment, these may be dam‐
aged by electromagnetic fields.
#
Do not place credit cards, storage
media or other objects sensitive to
electromagnetic fields in the mobile
phone stowage compartment.
*
NOTE Damage to the mobile phone
stowage compartment caused by liquids
If liquids enter the mobile phone stowage
compartment, the compartment may be
damaged.
#
Ensure that no liquids enter the mobile
phone stowage compartment.
Seats and stowing
139
R
Depending on the vehicle equipment, the
mobile phone is connected to the vehicle's
exterior antenna via the charging module.
R
The charging function and wireless connec‐
tion of the mobile phone to the vehicle's
exterior antenna are only available if the igni‐
tion is switched on.
R
Small mobile phones may not be able to be
charged in every position of the mobile
phone stowage compartment.
R
Large mobile phones which do not rest flat in
the mobile phone stowage compartment may
not be able to be charged or connected with
the vehicle's exterior antenna.
R
The mobile phone may heat up during the
charging process.
R
To ensure more efficient charging and con‐
nection with the vehicle's exterior antenna,
remove the protective cover from the mobile
phone.
R
When charging, the mat should be used if
possible.
Wireless charging of the mobile phone in the
front
Requirements:
R
The mobile phone must be suitable for wire‐
less charging (Qi-compatible mobile phone).
You can find a list of Qi-compatible mobile
phones at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
Example: vehicles without a rear air conditioning
system
#
Place the mobile phone as close to the cen‐
ter of mat 1 as possible with the display
facing upwards.
When the charging symbol is shown in the
multimedia system, the mobile phone is
being charged.
Malfunctions during the charging process are
shown in the multimedia system display.
%
The mat can be removed for cleaning, e.g.
using clean, lukewarm water.
Wireless charging of a mobile phone in the
rear passenger compartment
Requirements:
R
The mobile phone must be suitable for wire‐
less charging (Qi-compatible mobile phone).
You can find a list of Qi-compatible mobile
phones at:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
140
Seats and stowing
Example: vehicles with individual rear seats
#
Place the mobile phone as close to the cen‐
ter of mat 1 as possible with the display
facing upwards.
When the indicator lamp at the front of the
mobile phone system lights up, the mobile
phone is being charged.
%
The mat can be removed for cleaning, e.g.
using clean, lukewarm water.
Installing or removing the floor mats
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to
objects in the driver's footwell
Objects in the driver's footwell may impede
pedal travel or block a depressed pedal.
This jeopardizes the operating and road
safety of the vehicle.
#
Stow all objects in the vehicle securely
so that they cannot get into the driver's
footwell.
#
Always install the floor mats securely
and as prescribed in order to ensure
that there is always sufficient room for
the pedals.
#
Do not use loose floor mats and do not
place floor mats on top of one another.
#
To install: press studs 1 onto holders 2.
#
To remove: pull the floor mat off holders 2.
Installing/removing the pennant holder
Installing
The pennant holder is installed or removed in
identical fashion on both the driver's and front
passenger sides.
Seats and stowing
141
#
Press cover 1 and turn it forwards in the
direction of travel.
#
Remove the cover.
#
Position pennant holder 2 horizontally on
the opening and press it in.
#
Turn pennant holder 2 in the opposite
direction to the direction of travel until it is in
a vertical position and engages in place.
Removing
#
Press pennant holder 2 into the opening
and turn it forwards in the direction of travel
until it is in a horizontal position.
#
Remove pennant holder 2.
#
Install cover 1 and turn it backwards in the
opposite direction to the direction of travel.
The pennant holder can be stowed in the parcel
net in the trunk, for example.
142
Seats and stowing
Exterior lighting
Lighting systems and your responsibility
The various lighting systems of the vehicle are
only aids. The driver of the vehicle is responsible
for correct vehicle illumination in accordance
with the prevailing light and visibility conditions,
legal requirements and traffic situation.
Light switch
Operating the light switch
#
1 W Left-hand standing lamps
#
2 X Right-hand standing lamps
#
3 T Parking lights and license plate
lighting
#
4 Ã Automatic driving lights (preferred
light switch position)
#
5 L Low beam/high beam
#
6 R Switches the rear fog light on or off
When low beam is activated, the indicator lamp
for the parking lights is deactivated and replaced
by the low beam indicator lamp.
Always park your vehicle safely and in a well-lit
area, in accordance with the relevant legal stipu‐
lations.
*
NOTE Battery discharging by operating
the standing lights
Operating the standing lights over a period of
hours puts a strain on the battery.
#
Where possible, switch on the
right X or left W parking light.
In the case of severe battery discharging, the
standing lamps or standing lamps are automati‐
cally switched off to facilitate a future engine
start.
Light and visibility
143
The exterior lighting (except parking and stand‐
ing lamps) switches off automatically when the
driver's door is opened.
R
Observe the notes on surround lighting
(
page 147).
Automatic driving lights
The parking lights, low beam and daytime run‐
ning lamps are switched on automatically
depending on the ignition status, whether the
engine is running and on the ambient light.
&
WARNING Risk of accident when the low
beam is switched off in poor visibility
When the light switch is set to Ã, the low
beam may not be switched on automatically
if there is fog, snow or other causes of poor
visibility such as spray.
#
In such cases, turn the light switch to
L.
The automatic driving lights are only an aid. You
are responsible for vehicle lighting.
Activating/deactivating the rear fog light
Requirements:
R
The light switch is in the L or à posi‐
tion.
#
Press the R button.
Please observe the country-specific laws on the
use of rear fog lamps.
Operating the light combination switch
1
High-beam headlamps
2
Turn signal light, right
3
High-beam flasher
4
Turn signal light, left
144
Light and visibility
#
To indicate briefly: press the combination
switch briefly up to the pressure point in the
direction of arrow 2 or 4.
The corresponding turn signal light flashes
three times.
#
To indicate permanently: press the combi‐
nation switch beyond the pressure point in
the direction of arrow 2 or 4.
Vehicles with Active Lane Keeping Assist:
Active Lane Keeping Assist can:
R
Lengthen turn signal operation for the dura‐
tion of the lane change if the driver has acti‐
vated the turn signal indicator.
R
Automatically activate the turn signal indica‐
tor, if the driver indicated to turn in that
direction immediately previously but a lane
change was not immediately possible.
#
To switch on the high beam: turn the light
switch to the L position.
#
Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow 1.
When the high beam is activated, the indica‐
tor lamp for low beam is deactivated and
replaced by the indicator lamp for the high
beam.
#
To switch off the high beam: move the
combination switch back to its starting posi‐
tion.
#
High-beam flasher: pull the combination
switch in the direction of arrow 3.
Activating/deactivating the hazard warning
light
#
Press button 1.
Light and visibility
145
Cornering light
Cornering light function
Cornering light improves the illumination of the
road over a wide angle in the turning direction,
enabling better visibility in tight bends, for exam‐
ple. It can only be activated when low beam is
switched on.
The function is active:
R
At speeds below 25 mph (40 km/h) when
the turn signal light is switched on or the
steering wheel is turned.
R
At speeds between 25 mph (40 km/h) and
45 mph (70 km/h) when the steering wheel
is turned.
Traffic circle and intersection function: the
cornering light is activated on both sides through
an evaluation of the current GPS position of the
vehicle. It remains active until after the vehicle
has left the traffic circle or the intersection.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Function of Adaptive Highbeam Assist
&
WARNING Risk of accident despite
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Adaptive Highbeam Assist does not recog‐
nize the following road users:
R
Road users without lights, e.g. pedes‐
trians
R
Road users with poor lighting, e.g.
cyclists
R
Road users whose lighting is obstructed,
e.g. by a barrier
On very rare occasions, Adaptive Highbeam
Assist may fail to recognize other road users
with their own lighting, or may recognize
them too late.
In these or similar situations, the automatic
high beam is not deactivated or is activated
despite the presence of other road users.
#
Always observe the traffic carefully and
switch off the high beam in good time.
System limitations
Adaptive Highbeam Assist cannot take into
account road, weather or traffic conditions.
Detection may be restricted if:
R
Visibility is impaired, for example in fog,
heavy rain or snow.
R
There is dirt on the sensors or the sensors
are obscured.
Adaptive Highbeam Assist is only an aid. You are
responsible for adjusting the vehicle's lighting to
the prevailing light, visibility and traffic condi‐
tions.
146
Light and visibility
Adaptive Highbeam Assist switches automati‐
cally between:
R
Low beam
R
High beam
At speeds above 19 mph (30 km/h):
R
If no other road users are detected, high
beam is automatically switched on.
High beam switches off automatically:
R
At speeds below 16 mph (25 km/h).
R
If other road users are detected.
R
If street lighting is sufficient.
At speeds above approx. 31 mph (50 km/h):
R
The headlamp range of low beam is regulated
automatically based on the distance to other
road users.
The system's optical sensor is located behind
the windshield near the overhead control panel.
Switching Adaptive Highbeam Assist on/off
#
To switch on: turn the light switch to
the à position.
#
Switch on the high beam using the combina‐
tion switch.
When the high beam is switched on automat‐
ically in the dark, the _ indicator lamp in
the multifunction display comes on.
#
To switch off: switch off the high beam
using the combination switch.
Switching the daytime running lamps on/off
Multimedia system:
,

.
÷  
.

  
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Setting the surround lighting
Requirement:
R
The ignition is switched on.
Multimedia system:
,

.
÷  
.

 
Exterior switch-off delay time: the exterior
lighting can be activated for a short time after
the vehicle is parked.
#
Set the switch-off delay time.
Locator lighting: if a switch-off delay time is
set, the exterior lighting remains lit up for
40 seconds after the vehicle is unlocked. When
you start the vehicle, the locator lighting is
Light and visibility
147
switched off and automatic driving lights are
activated.
Interior lighting
Adjusting the interior lighting
Front overhead control panel
#
1 p Switches the front left-hand reading
lamp on/off
#
2 | Switches the automatic interior
lighting control on/off
#
3 c Switches the front interior lighting
on/off
#
4 u Switches the rear interior lighting
on/off
#
5 p Switches the front right-hand read‐
ing lamp on/off
Control panel in the grab handle (rear
passenger compartment)
You can switch the reading and make-up lamps
on or off for one side or for both sides of the
vehicle.
#
Press button 1 repeatedly until the reading
lamp and the make-up lamp switch on or off
on the respective side of the vehicle.
#
Press button 2 repeatedly until the reading
lamp and the make-up lamp switch on or off
on both sides of the vehicle.
Adjusting the ambient lighting
Multimedia system:
,

.
÷  
.

 
Setting the color
#
Select .
#
Set the color.
Setting the brightness
#
Select .
#
Set the brightness value.
Activating the brightness for zones
#
Select  .
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
The ,  and  zones can be set
separately.
148
Light and visibility
%
Setting brightness zones is not available for
the Rear Seat Entertainment System.
Activating multi-color lighting
#
Select .
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
There are ten preset color combinations
available.
Activating multi-color animation
#
Select  .
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
The chosen color combination varies in a pre‐
defined rhythm.
Activating climate-dependent lighting
#
Select .
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
The color of the ambient lighting adapts to
suit the climate control setting.
Activating welcome lighting
#
Select .
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
When the vehicle is unlocked, a special inte‐
rior lighting sequence runs.
Setting the interior lighting switch-off delay
time
Multimedia system:
,

.
÷  
.

  
#
Set the switch-off delay time.
Windshield wiper and windshield washer
system
Switching the windshield wipers on/off
#
1 í Single wipe/î wipes with
washer fluid
#
1gWindshield wipers off
#
2 Ä Intermittent wiping, normal
Light and visibility
149
#
3 Å Intermittent wiping, frequent
#
4 ° Continuous wiping, slow
#
5 ¯ Continuous wiping, fast
Moving the wiper arms to a vertical position
(service position)
&
WARNING Risk of becoming trapped if
the windshield wipers are switched on
while wiper blades are being replaced
If the windshield wipers begin to move while
you are changing the wiper blades, you can
be trapped by the wiper arm.
#
Always switch off the windshield wipers
and the ignition before changing the
wiper blades.
Activating the service position
#
Switch the power supply on and off again
(
page 165).
#
Press and hold button 1 for longer than a
second.
The wiper arms move to a position vertical to
the hood.
#
Fold the wiper arm away from the windshield.
Deactivating the service position
#
Switch the power supply on and off again
(
page 165).
#
Press button 1.
The wiper arms return to their normal posi‐
tion.
150
Light and visibility
Changing the windshield wiper blades
Removing the wiper blades
#
Press both retaining clips 1.
#
Fold the wiper blade in the direction of arrow
2 away from the wiper arm.
#
Remove the wiper blade in the direction of
arrow 3.
Installing the wiper blades
#
Place recess 1 of the new wiper blade on
locking clip 5.
#
Fold the wiper blade in the direction of arrow
3 onto the wiper arm until retaining clips
2 engage in bracket 4.
#
Make sure that the wiper blade sits correctly.
#
Fold the wiper arm back onto the windshield.
Replacing the windshield wiper blades
(MAGIC VISION CONTROL)
Removing the wiper blades
#
To bring the wiper blade into position to
be removed: hold the wiper arm firmly in
one hand. With the other hand, turn the
Light and visibility
151
wiper blade in the direction of arrow 1
beyond the point of resistance.
The wiper blade engages in the removal posi‐
tion with a click.
#
To remove the wiper blade: press release
knob 2, pull the wiper blade in the direction
of arrow 3 and remove.
Installing the wiper blades
#
Push the new wiper blade onto the wiper arm
in the direction of arrow 1 until release
knob 2 engages.
#
Press the wiper blade beyond the point of
resistance in the direction of arrow 3 on
the wiper arm.
The wiper blade engages with a noticeable
click and moves freely again.
#
Fold the wiper arm back onto the windshield.
Mirrors
Operating the outside mirrors
&
WARNING Risk of injury from adjusting
the vehicle settings while the vehicle is in
motion
You could lose control of the vehicle in the
following situations:
R
if you adjust the driver's seat, the head
restraint, the steering wheel or the mirror
while the vehicle is in motion
R
if you fasten your seat belt while the vehi‐
cle is in motion
#
Before starting the engine: adjust the
driver's seat, the head restraint, the
steering wheel or the mirror and fasten
your seat belt.
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to mis‐
judgment of distances when using the
passenger mirror
The outside mirror on the front passenger
side reflects objects on a smaller scale. The
objects in view are in fact closer than they
appear.
As a result, you may misjudge the distance
between you and the road user driving
behind you, for example, when changing
lanes.
#
Therefore, always look over your shoul‐
der in order to ensure that you are
aware of the actual distance between
you and the road users driving behind
you.
152
Light and visibility
Folding the outside mirrors in/out
#
Briefly press switch 1.
%
If the battery has been disconnected or com‐
pletely discharged, the outside mirrors must
be reset. Only then will the automatic mirror
folding function work properly.
Adjusting the outside mirrors
#
Select the required mirror using button 3 or
4.
#
Use button 2 to set the position of the mir‐
ror you have selected.
Engaging the outside mirrors
#
Press and hold button 1.
You will hear a click and the mirror audibly
engage in position. The mirror is set in the
correct position.
Information on automatic anti-glare mirrors
&
WARNING Risk of burns and poisoning
due to the anti-glare mirror electrolyte
Electrolyte may escape if the glass in an
automatic anti-glare mirror breaks.
The electrolyte is harmful and causes irrita
tion. It must not come into contact with your
skin, eyes, respiratory organs or clothing or
be swallowed.
#
If you come into contact with electro‐
lyte, observe the following:
R
Rinse the electrolyte from your skin
and seek medical attention immedi‐
ately.
R
If electrolyte comes into contact
with your eyes, rinse them thor‐
oughly with clean water and seek
medical attention immediately.
R
If the electrolyte is swallowed,
immediately rinse your mouth out
thoroughly. Do not induce vomiting.
Seek medical attention immediately.
R
Immediately change out of clothing
which has come into contact with
electrolyte.
R
If an allergic reaction occurs, seek
medical attention immediately.
The outside mirrors and inside rearview mirrors
on the driver's side automatically go into anti-
glare mode if light from a headlamp hits the
inside rearview mirror.
Light and visibility
153
System limitations
The system does not go into anti-glare mode in
the following situations:
R
the engine is switched off
R
reverse gear is engaged
R
interior lighting is switched on
Function of the passenger outside mirror
parking position
The parking position makes parking easier.
The passenger outside mirror tilts downwards
and shows the rear wheel on the front passenger
side in the following situations:
R
the parking position is stored
R
the passenger mirror is selected
R
reverse gear is engaged
The passenger outside mirror moves back to its
original position in the following situations:
R
if you shift the transmission to another trans‐
mission position
R
when driving faster than 9 mph (15 km/h)
R
if you press the button for the outside mirror
on the driver's side
Storing the parking position of the
passenger outside mirror using reverse gear
Storing
#
Select the passenger outside mirror using
button 2.
#
Engage reverse gear.
#
Move the passenger outside mirror into the
desired parking position using button 1.
Calling up
#
Select the passenger outside mirror using
button 2.
#
Engage reverse gear.
The passenger outside mirror moves to the
stored parking position.
Activating/deactivating the automatic mirror
folding function
Multimedia system:
,

.
î  

.
  
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
154
Light and visibility
Operating the sun visors
Using the single sun visor
#
Glare from the front: fold sun visor 1
down.
#
Glare from the side: swing sun visor 1 to
the side.
#
Vehicles with an extendable sun visor: slide
sun visor 1 horizontally as required.
Using the additional sun visor
#
Vehicles with an additional sun visor: fold
additional sun visor 2 down.
Function of the infrared reflective wind‐
shield
The infrared reflective windshield is coated and
prevents an excessive build-up of heat in the
vehicle interior.
The coating shields the vehicle interior against
radio waves up into the gigahertz range.
Radio-controlled equipment, such as toll sys‐
tems, can only be mounted on areas of the wind‐
shield which are permeable to radio waves 1.
Light and visibility
155
Areas permeable to radio waves 1 are best visi‐
ble from outside the vehicle when the windshield
is illuminated using an external light source.
156
Light and visibility
Overview of climate control systems
Overview of the control panel for automatic
climate control
Plug-in hybrid: observe the notes in the Supple‐
ment. Otherwise, you may not recognize dan‐
gers.
The indicator lamps in the buttons indicate that
the current function is activated.
1
à To set climate control to automatic,
left (
page 158)
2
w To set the temperature, left
3
K To set the airflow, left
4
g To switch air-recirculation mode on/off
(
page 160)
5
¬ To defrost the windshield
6
t To call up the air conditioning menu
7
¤ To switch the rear window heater
on/off
8
Á To switch the A/C function on/off
(
page 158)
To switch the residual heat on or off
(
page 160)
9
K To set the airflow, right
A
w To set the temperature, right
B
à To set climate control to automatic,
right
Overview of the rear operating unit
Example: USA
1
Sets the temperature, left
2
Sets the air distribution, left
3
Sets climate control to automatic mode
(
page 158)
4
Sets the airflow
5
Switches climate control on/off
(
page 158)
Switches the residual heat on/off
(
page 160)
6
Sets the air distribution, right
7
Sets the temperature, right
Climate control
157
Operating the climate control system
Switching front climate control on/off
#
To switch on: set the airflow to level 1 or
higher using the K button.
#
To switch off: set the airflow to level 0 using
the K button.
%
If climate control is switched off, the win‐
dows may fog up more quickly. Switch off
climate control only briefly.
Switching rear climate control on/off
#
Press button 5.
%
When rear climate control is switched off,
the indicator lamp is activated and OFF is
shown in the rear display.
Activating/deactivating the A/C function via
the control panel
The A/C function heats, cools and dehumidifies
the vehicle's interior air.
#
Press the Á button.
Deactivate the A/C function only briefly other‐
wise the windows can fog up more quickly.
Condensation may drip from the underside of
the vehicle when cooling mode is active. This is
not a sign that there is a malfunction.
Activating/deactivating the A/C function
using the multimedia system
Multimedia system:
,

.
b  
.

The A/C function heats, cools and dehumidifies
the vehicle's interior air.
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Setting front climate control to automatic
mode
In automatic mode, the set temperature is regu‐
lated by the temperature of the dispensed air
and the airflow.
#
Press the à button.
#
To switch to manual mode: press the K
button.
Setting climate control in the rear to auto‐
matic mode
In automatic mode, the set temperature is regu‐
lated by the temperature of the dispensed air
and the airflow.
#
Press button 3.
Climate style
Climate style function
In automatic mode you can select the following
climate style settings for the driver's and front
passenger areas:
R
FOCUS: high airflow, slightly cooler setting
R
MEDIUM: medium airflow, standard setting
R
DIFFUSE: low airflow, slightly warmer and
draft-free setting
Setting the climate style
Multimedia system:
,

.
b  
.

 
#
Select ,  or .
158
Climate control
%
In order to feel the effect of the climate
style, the à function must be active
(
page 158).
Air distribution settings
The symbols in the display indicate which vents
the airflow is being directed through:
R
¯ Defroster vents
R
P Center and side air vents
R
O footwell vents
R
S Center, side and footwell vents
R
a Defroster and footwell vents
R
_ All vents
R
b Defroster, middle and side air vents
R
W Automatic air distribution
Setting the air distribution
Multimedia system:
,

.
b  
.


#
Select  and/or .
#
Set the air distribution.
Setting the footwell temperature
Multimedia system:
,

.
b  

.
 
#
Select  and/or .
#
Set the footwell temperature.
Setting the rear climate control using the
multimedia system
Multimedia system:
,

.
b  

.

Activating rear climate control
If this function is activated, the settings from the
front control panel are automatically adopted for
rear climate control.
#
Select  .
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Controlling the rear climate control automat‐
ically
#
Select .
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Setting the airflow
#
Select .
#
Set the airflow.
Setting the temperature
#
Select .
Climate control
159
#
Select   and/or  .
#
Set the temperature.
Setting the air distribution
#
Select  .
#
Select   and/or  .
#
Set the air distribution.
Activating/deactivating the climate control
synchronization function using the multime‐
dia system
Multimedia system:
,

.
b  

.

Climate control can be set centrally using the
synchronization function. The temperature set‐
ting is automatically adopted for all climate
zones.
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Defrosting the windows
Windows fogged up on the inside
#
Press the à button.
#
If the windows continue to fog up: press the
¬ button.
Windows fogged up on the outside
#
Switch on the windshield wiper.
#
Press the à button.
Switching air-recirculation mode on/off
#
Press the g button.
The interior air will be recirculated.
Air-recirculation mode is switched off automati‐
cally.
%
If air-recirculation mode is switched on, the
windows may fog up more quickly. Switch on
air-recirculation mode only briefly.
Switching the front residual heat on/off
Requirements:
R
The vehicle is parked.
It is possible to make use of the residual heat
from the engine to continue heating or ventilat‐
ing the front compartment of the vehicle for
approximately 30 minutes.
#
To switch on: press the ! or Á but‐
ton.
Residual heat is switched off automatically.
Switching the rear residual heat on/off
Requirements:
R
The vehicle is parked.
When the residual heat of the engine is activated
in the rear passenger compartment, you can
heat or ventilate the front and rear passenger
compartments for approximately 15 minutes.
#
Press button 5.
160
Climate control
Activating and deactivating ionization
Multimedia system:
,

.
b  
.


Ionization cleans and refreshes the interior air of
the vehicle. The ionization of the interior air is
odorless.
#
Switch the function on O or off ª.
Perfume atomizer
Setting the fragrance system
Requirements:
R
Automatic climate control is activated.
R
The glove box is closed.
Multimedia system:
,

.
b  
.


The fragrance system distributes a pleasant fra‐
grance throughout the vehicle interior from a fla‐
con located in the glove box.
#
To set the intensity: select , ,
 or .
Inserting or removing the flacon of the fra‐
grance system
&
WARNING Risk of injury from liquid per‐
fume
If children open the flacon, they could drink
the liquid perfume or it could come into con‐
tact with their eyes.
#
Consult a doctor immediately if liquid
perfume has been drunk.
#
If liquid perfume comes into contact
with your eyes or skin, rinse your eyes
with clean water.
#
If symptoms continue, consult a doctor.
+
ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
damage due to improper disposal of full
flacons
Full flacons must not be disposed
of with household waste.
#
Full flacons must be taken to
a harmful substance collection point.
Climate control
161
1
Cap
2
Flacon
#
To insert: slide the flacon into the holder as
far as it will go.
#
To remove: pull out the flacon.
If you do not use genuine Mercedes-Benz interior
perfumes, observe the manufacturers' safety
notices on the perfume packaging.
Dispose of the genuine Mercedes-Benz interior
perfume flacon when it is empty and do not refill
it.
Refillable flacon
#
Unscrew the cap of the empty flacon.
#
Fill the flacon with a maximum of 0.5 fl. oz.
(15 ml).
#
Screw the cap back on to the flacon.
Always refill the empty refillable flacon with the
same perfume. Observe the separate informa‐
tion sheet attached to the flacon.
Information on the windshield heater
The windshield heater is switched on automati‐
cally if the ¬ button is activated.
After the vehicle is started the windshield heater
is switched on automatically as needed.
Air vents
Adjusting the front air vents
&
WARNING Danger of burns or frostbite
due to being too close to the air vents
Very hot or very cold air can flow from the air
vents.
This could result in burns or frostbite in the
immediate vicinity of the air vents.
#
Make sure that all vehicle occupants
always maintain a sufficient distance to
the air vents.
#
If necessary, direct the airflow to
another area of the vehicle interior.
162
Climate control
#
To open or close: turn controller 1 to the
left or right as far as it will go.
#
To adjust the air direction: hold air vent 2
in the center and move it up or down or to
the left or right.
Adjusting the rear air vents
Adjusting the rear center air vent
#
To open or close: turn controller 2 to the
left or right as far as it will go.
#
To adjust the air direction: hold air vent 1
in the center and move it up or down or to
the left or right.
Adjusting the rear side air vents
#
To open or close: turn controller 2 to the
left or right.
#
To adjust the air direction: hold air vent 1
in the center and move it up or down or to
the left or right.
Climate control
163
Opening/closing the air vent in the glove box
*
NOTE Damage to temperature-sensitive
objects in the glove box
Temperature-sensitive objects stored in the
glove box may be damaged by the air vent
located inside it.
#
Close the air vent when you heat the
vehicle.
#
At high outside temperatures, open the
air vent and switch on the A/C func‐
tion.
Requirements:
R
Automatic climate control is activated.
1
Air vent controller
2
Air vent
#
To open or close: turn controller 1 to the
left or right.
164
Climate control
Driving
Notes on Mercedes-AMG vehicles
Observe the notes on the following topics in the
Supplement. Otherwise, you may not recognize
dangers.
R
AMG Performance exhaust system
R
AMG high-performance brake system and
AMG ceramic high-performance composite
brake system
R
AMG adaptive sport suspension system
Switching on the power supply or ignition
using the start/stop button
&
WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to children left unattended in the
vehicle
If children are left unattended in the vehicle,
they could:
R
Open doors, thereby endangering other
persons or road users
R
Get out of the vehicle and be hit by
oncoming traffic
R
Operate vehicle equipment
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example, by:
R
Releasing the parking brake
R
Shifting the transmission out of park
position j
R
Starting the engine.
#
Never leave children and animals unat‐
tended in the vehicle.
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
#
Keep the SmartKey out of the reach of
children.
&
WARNING Risk of exhaust gas poisoning
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases causes poisoning.
#
Never leave the engine running in an
enclosed space without sufficient venti‐
lation.
&
WARNING Risk of fire caused by flam‐
mable material on the exhaust system
Flammable materials brought in by either ani‐
mals or environmental influences may ignite
if they come into contact with hot parts of
the engine or exhaust system.
#
Therefore, check regularly that there
are no flammable materials in the
engine compartment or on the exhaust
system.
Requirements:
R
The SmartKey is located in the vehicle and
the SmartKey battery is not discharged.
Driving and parking
165
#
To switch on the power supply: press but‐
ton 1 (USA) or 2 (Canada) once.
You can activate the windshield wiper, for
example.
The power supply is switched off again if the fol‐
lowing conditions are met:
R
You open the driver's door.
R
You press button 1 (USA) or 2 (Canada)
twice.
#
To switch on the ignition: press button 1
(USA) or 2 (Canada) twice.
The indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
light up.
The ignition is switched off again if one of the
following conditions is met:
R
You do not start the vehicle within
15 minutes.
R
You press button 1 (USA) or 2 (Canada)
once.
Starting the vehicle
Starting the vehicle with the start/stop but‐
ton
Requirements:
R
The SmartKey is located in the vehicle and
the SmartKey battery is not discharged.
#
Shift the transmission to position j or i.
#
Depress the brake pedal and push button 1
(USA) or 2 (Canada) once.
#
If the vehicle does not start: switch off non-
essential consumers and press button 1
(USA) or 2 (Canada) once.
#
If the vehicle still does not start and the
       
  display message also
appears in the multifunction display: start
the vehicle in emergency operation mode.
You can switch off the engine while driving by
pressing button 1 (USA) or 2 (Canada) for
about three seconds. Be sure to observe the
safety notes under "Driving instructions".
Starting the vehicle via Remote Online serv‐
ices
Cooling or heating the vehicle interior before
starting the journey
If you start the vehicle via your smartphone, the
previously selected air conditioning adjustment
is active.
166
Driving and parking
Before starting, make sure:
R
The legal stipulations in the area where your
vehicle is parked permit engine starting via
smartphone.
R
It is safe to start and run the engine where
your vehicle is parked.
R
The fuel tank is sufficiently filled.
R
The starter battery has sufficient charge.
Starting the vehicle using a smartphone
&
WARNING Risk of crushing or entrap‐
ment due to unintentional starting of the
engine
Limbs could be crushed or trapped if the
engine is started unintentionally during
service or maintenance work.
#
Always secure the engine against unin‐
tentional starting before carrying out
maintenance or repair work.
Requirements:
R
Park position j is selected.
R
The anti-theft alarm system is not armed.
R
The panic alarm is not armed.
R
The hazard warning lights are switched off.
R
The engine hood is closed.
R
The doors are closed and locked.
R
The windows and sliding sunroof are closed.
#
Start the vehicle using the smartphone:
R
After every vehicle start, the engine runs for
ten minutes.
R
You can carry out a maximum of two consec‐
utive starting attempts.
R
You can stop the vehicle again at any time.
R
Further information can be found in the
smartphone app.
Securing the engine against starting before
carrying out maintenance or repair work:
#
Switch on the hazard warning lights.
or
#
Unlock the doors.
or
#
Open a side window or the sliding sunroof.
Starting the vehicle in emergency operation
mode
If the vehicle does not start and the  
       
display message appears in the multifunction
display, you can start the vehicle in emergency
operation mode.
#
Make sure that marked space 2 is empty.
#
Remove SmartKey 1 from the key ring.
#
Place SmartKey 1 in marked space 2.
The vehicle will start after a short while.
If you remove SmartKey 1 from marked
space 2 the engine continues running. For
further vehicle starts however, SmartKey 1
Driving and parking
167
must be located in marked space 2 during
the entire journey.
#
Have SmartKey 1 checked at a qualified
specialist workshop.
If the vehicle does not start:
#
Leave SmartKey 1 in marked space 2.
#
Depress the brake pedal and start the vehicle
using the start/stop button.
%
You can also switch on the power supply or
the ignition with the start/stop button.
Breaking-in notes
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. Otherwise, you may not recog‐
nize dangers.
To preserve the engine during the first
1,000 miles (1,500 km):
R
Drive at varying road speeds and engine
speeds.
R
Drive in drive program C or E.
R
Change gear before the tachometer needle is
Ô of the way to the red area of the tachome‐
ter.
R
Do not shift down a gear manually in order to
brake.
R
Avoid overstraining the vehicle, e.g. driving at
full throttle.
R
Do not depress the accelerator pedal beyond
the pressure point (kickdown).
R
Only increase the engine speed gradually and
accelerate the vehicle to full speed after
1,000 miles (1,500 km).
This also applies when the engine or parts of the
drivetrain have been replaced.
Please also observe the following breaking-in
notes:
R
In certain driving and driving safety systems,
the sensors adjust automatically while a cer‐
tain distance is driven after the vehicle has
been delivered or after repairs. Full system
effectiveness is not achieved until the end of
this teach-in process.
R
Brake linings, brake discs and tires that are
either new or have been replaced only ach‐
ieve optimum braking effect and
gri
p after
several hundred kilometers of driving. Com‐
pensate for the reduced braking effect by
applying greater force to the brake pedal.
Notes on driving
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to
objects in the driver's footwell
Objects in the driver's footwell may impede
pedal travel or block a depressed pedal.
This jeopardizes the operating and road
safety of the vehicle.
#
Stow all objects in the vehicle securely
so that they cannot get into the driver's
footwell.
#
Ensure floor mats and carpets cannot
slip and provide sufficient room for the
pedals.
#
Do not lay multiple floor mats or car‐
pets on top of one another.
168
Driving and parking
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to
unsuitable footwear
Operation of the pedals may be restricted
due to unsuitable footwear such as:
R
Shoes with platform soles
R
Shoes with high heels
R
Slippers
#
When driving always wear suitable
shoes in order to be able to operate the
pedals safely.
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to the
ignition being switched off whilst the
vehicle is in motion
If you switch off the ignition whilst the vehi‐
cle is in motion safety-relevant functions will
be restricted or no longer available. This may
effect the power steering system and brake
force boosting, for example.
You will need to use considerably more force
to steer and brake.
#
Do not switch off the ignition whilst the
vehicle is in motion.
&
WARNING Risk of exhaust gas poisoning
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases causes poisoning.
#
Never leave the engine running in an
enclosed space without sufficient venti‐
lation.
&
WARNING Risk of skidding and of an
accident due to shifting down on slippery
road surfaces
If you shift down on slippery road surfaces to
increase the engine braking effect, the drive
wheels may lose traction.
#
Do not shift down on slippery road sur‐
faces to increase the engine braking
effect.
&
DANGER Risk of fatal injury due to poi‐
sonous exhaust gases
If the tailpipe is blocked or sufficient ventila‐
tion is not possible, poisonous exhaust gases
such as carbon monoxide may enter the vehi‐
cle. This is the case if the vehicle gets stuck
in snow, for example.
#
Keep the tailpipe and the area around
the vehicle free from snow when the
engine or the stationary heater are run‐
ning.
#
Open a window on the windward side of
the vehicle to ensure an adequate sup‐
ply of fresh air.
&
WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to being under the influence of alco‐
hol and drugs while driving
Driving when under the influence of alcohol
and/or drugs is an extremely dangerous
combination. Even small quantities of alcohol
or drugs may affect your reflexes, perception
and judgment.
Driving and parking
169
The probability of a serious or even fatal acci‐
dent greatly increases if you drive when
under the influence of alcohol or drugs.
#
Do not drink alcohol or take drugs while
driving, and do not allow anyone to
drive who has been drinking alcohol or
taking drugs.
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to the
brake system overheating
If you leave your foot on the brake pedal
when driving, the brake system may over‐
heat.
This increases the braking distance and the
brake system may even fail.
#
Never use the brake pedal as a footrest.
#
Do not depress the brake pedal and the
accelerator pedal at the same time
while driving.
*
NOTE Wearing out the brake linings by
continuously depressing the brake pedal
#
Do not depress the brake pedal contin‐
uously whilst driving.
#
To use the braking effect of the engine,
shift to a lower gear in good time.
*
NOTE Damage to the drivetrain and the
engine when pulling away
#
Do not warm up the engine when the
vehicle is stationary. Pull away immedi‐
ately.
#
Avoid high engine speeds and driving at
full throttle until the engine has reached
operating temperature.
#
Do not allow the wheels to spin.
*
NOTE Damage to the catalytic converter
due to non-combusted fuel
The engine is not running smoothly and is
misfiring.
Non-combusted fuel may get into the cata‐
lytic converter.
#
Only depress the accelerator pedal
slightly.
#
Have the cause rectified immediately at
a qualified specialist workshop.
Limited braking effect on salt-treated roads:
R
Due to salt build-up on the brake discs and
brake lining, the braking distance can
increase considerably or result in braking
only on one side.
R
Maintain a much greater distance to the vehi‐
cle in front.
To prevent salt build-up:
R
Brake occasionally while paying attention to
the traffic conditions.
R
Carefully depress the brake pedal at the end
of the journey and when starting the next
journey.
170
Driving and parking
Plug-in hybrid: observe the notes in the Supple‐
ment. Otherwise, you may not recognize dan‐
gers.
ECO start/stop function
Operation of the ECO start/stop function
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: be sure to observe
the notes in the Supplement. Otherwise, you
may not recognize dangers.
The engine is automatically switched off if the
following conditions are met:
R
If you brake the vehicle to a standstill in
transmission position h or i.
R
If all vehicle conditions for an automatic
engine stop are met.
The è symbol appears in the multifunction
display when the vehicle is stationary.
The engine is restarted automatically if:
R
You release the brake pedal with the trans‐
mission in position h when the HOLD func‐
tion is not active.
R
You shift from transmission position j.
R
You engage transmission position h or k.
R
You depress the accelerator pedal.
R
You change the vehicle level.
R
An automatic engine start is necessary.
If the engine was switched off by the ECO start/
stop function and you leave the vehicle, a warn
ing tone sounds. The   
     display message
also appears in the multifunction display. If you
do not switch off the ignition, the ignition is
automatically switched off after one minute.
Deactivating or activating the ECO start/
stop function
#
Press button 1.
If indicator lamp 2 lights up, the ECO start/
stop function is switched on.
Driving and parking
171
Function of the ECO display
The ECO display summarizes the driving style
from the start of the journey to its completion
and assists you in achieving the most economi‐
cal driving style.
You can influence consumption if you:
R
drive with particular care
R
drive the vehicle in drive program E
R
observe the gearshift recommendations
The inner segment lights up green and the outer
segment fills up:
R
1 Moderate acceleration
R
2 Gentle deceleration and rolling
R
3 Consistent speed
The inner segment is gray and the outer seg‐
ment empties:
R
1 Sporty acceleration
R
2 Heavy braking
R
3 Fluctuations in speed
You have driven economically when:
R
the three outer segments are completely fil‐
led simultaneously.
R
the ECO display border lights up.
The additional range achieved as a result of your
driving style in comparison to a driver with a
very sporty driving style is shown under 
 . The range displayed does not indicate a
fixed reduction in consumption.
DYNAMIC SELECT switch
Function of the DYNAMIC SELECT switch
Plug-in hybrid: be sure to observe the notes in
the Supplement. Otherwise, you may not recog‐
nize dangers.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: be sure to observe
the notes in the Supplement. Otherwise, you
may not recognize dangers.
Use the DYNAMIC SELECT switch to change
between the following drive programs:
R
I (Individual): individual settings
R
S (Sport): sporty driving style
R
C (Comfort): comfortable and economical
driving style
R
Vehicles with MAGIC BODY CONTROL: CV
(CURVE): comfortable driving with curve
inclination function
R
E (Eco): particularly economical driving style
Depending on the drive program selected, the
following vehicle characteristics will change:
R
Drive system
172
Driving and parking
-
Engine and transmission management
-
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
R
ESP
®
R
Suspension
R
Steering
Selecting the drive program
#
Press DYNAMIC SELECT switch 1 forwards
or backwards.
The drive program selected appears in the
multifunction display.
Configuring drive program I
Multimedia system:
,

.
e 

.

#
Select the individual setting.
Displaying vehicle data
Multimedia system:
,

.
e  
#
Select  .
Displaying engine data
Multimedia system:
,

.
e  
#
Select  .
%
The values for engine output and engine tor‐
que may deviate from the nominal values.
Items that can influence this are, for exam‐
ple:
R
engine speed
R
sea level
R
fuel grade
R
outside temperature
Automatic transmission
DIRECT SELECT lever
Function of the DIRECT SELECT lever
&
WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to children left unattended in the
vehicle
If children are left unattended in the vehicle,
they could:
R
Open doors, thereby endangering other
persons or road users
Driving and parking
173
R
Get out of the vehicle and be hit by
oncoming traffic
R
Operate vehicle equipment
In addition, the children could also set the
vehicle in motion, for example, by:
R
Releasing the parking brake
R
Shifting the transmission out of park
position j
R
Starting the engine.
#
Never leave children and animals unat‐
tended in the vehicle.
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
#
Keep the SmartKey out of the reach of
children.
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to incor‐
rect gearshifting
If the engine speed is higher than the idle
speed and you engage the transmission posi‐
tion h or k, the vehicle may accelerate
sharply.
#
If you engage the transmission position
h or k always depress the brake
pedal firmly and do not accelerate at
the same time.
Use the DIRECT SELECT lever to shift the trans‐
mission position. The current transmission posi‐
tion is displayed in the multifunction display.
j
Park position
k
Reverse gear
i
Neutral
h
Drive position
174
Driving and parking
Engaging reverse gear R
#
Depress the brake pedal and push the
DIRECT SELECT lever up past the first point
of resistance.
The transmission position display shows k
in the multifunction display.
Shifting to neutral N
#
Depress the brake pedal and push the
DIRECT SELECT lever up or down to the first
point of resistance.
The transmission position display shows i
in the multifunction display.
Subsequently releasing the brake pedal will
allow you to move the vehicle freely, e.g. to push
it or tow it away.
If you want the automatic transmission to
remain in neutral N even if the ignition is
switched off:
#
Start the vehicle.
#
Depress the brake pedal and shift to neutral
i.
#
Release the brake pedal.
#
Switch the ignition off.
%
If you then exit the vehicle leaving the
SmartKey in the vehicle, the automatic trans‐
mission remains in neutral i
Engaging park position P
#
Press button 1.
The transmission position display shows j
in the multifunction display.
Park position j is engaged automatically if one
of the following conditions is met:
R
If you switch the engine off with the trans‐
mission in position h or k.
R
If you open the driver's door when the vehi‐
cle is stationary or when driving at a very low
speed and the transmission is in position h
or k.
Engaging drive position D
#
Depress the brake pedal and push the
DIRECT SELECT lever down past the first
point of resistance.
The transmission position display shows h
in the multifunction display.
When the automatic transmission is in transmis‐
sion position h, it shifts the gears automati‐
cally. This depends on the following factors:
R
The selected drive program
R
The position of the accelerator pedal
R
The road speed
Driving and parking
175
Manual gear shifting
&
WARNING Risk of skidding and of an
accident due to shifting down on slippery
road surfaces
If you shift down on slippery road surfaces to
increase the engine braking effect, the drive
wheels may lose traction.
#
Do not shift down on slippery road sur‐
faces to increase the engine braking
effect.
#
To activate: pull steering wheel paddle
shifter 1 or 2.
Manual gearshifting is activated for a short
time. The current gear is displayed in the
multifunction display.
#
To shift up: pull steering wheel paddle
shifter 2.
#
To shift down: pull steering wheel paddle
shifter 1.
#
To deactivate: pull steering wheel paddle
shifter 2 and hold it in place.
The transmission position
h appears in the multifunction display.
%
If you select the Manual drive setting in
drive program I, manual gearshifting is per‐
manently activated.
Plug-in hybrid: be sure to observe the notes in
the Supplement. Otherwise, you may not recog‐
nize dangers.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: be sure to observe
the notes in the Supplement. Otherwise, you
may not recognize dangers.
Gearshift recommendation
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. Otherwise, you may not recog‐
nize dangers.
The gearshift recommendations assist you in
adopting an economical driving style.
#
If gearshift recommendation message 1 is
shown in the multifunction display, shift to
the recommended gear.
176
Driving and parking
Using kickdown
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: be sure to observe
the notes in the Supplement. Otherwise, you
may not recognize dangers.
#
Maximum acceleration: depress the accel‐
erator pedal beyond the pressure point.
During kickdown, you cannot shift gears using
the steering wheel paddle shifters. The auto
matic transmission shifts up to the next gear
when the maximum engine speed is reached to
protect the engine from overrevving.
#
Ease off the accelerator pedal once the
desired speed is reached.
Glide mode function
Plug-in hybrid: be sure to observe the notes in
the Supplement. Otherwise, you may not recog‐
nize dangers.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: be sure to observe
the notes in the Supplement. Otherwise, you
may not recognize dangers.
With an anticipatory driving style, glide mode
helps you to reduce fuel consumption.
Glide mode is characterized by the following:
R
The combustion engine is disconnected from
the drivetrain and the vehicle continues to
roll in neutral.
R
The transmission position h is displayed in
green in the multifunction display.
Glide mode is activated if the following condi‐
tions are met:
R
Drive program E is selected.
R
The speed is within a suitable range.
R
The course of the road is suitable, e.g. no
steep uphill or downhill gradients or tight
bends.
R
You do not depress the accelerator or brake
pedal.
%
Glide mode can also be activated if you have
selected the "Eco" setting for the drive
(engine management) when in drive program
I.
Glide mode is deactivated again if one of the
conditions is no longer met.
Vehicles with Active Distance Assistant
DISTRONIC: When Active Distance Assistant
DISTRONIC is active, the glide mode function is
restricted.
Refueling
Refueling the vehicle
&
WARNING Risk of fire and explosion
caused by fuel
Fuels are highly inflammable.
#
You must avoid fire, open flames, creat‐
ing sparks and smoking.
#
Before refueling, switch off the engine
and, if installed in your vehicle, the sta‐
tionary heater.
&
WARNING Risk of injury from fuel
Fuels are poisonous and harmful to your
health
Driving and parking
177
#
Do not swallow fuel or let it come into
contact with skin, eyes or clothing.
#
Do not inhale fuel vapors.
#
Keep children away from fuel.
If you or other people come into contact with
fuel, observe the following:
#
Immediately rinse fuel off your skin with
soap and water.
#
If fuel comes into contact with your
eyes, immediately rinse them thor‐
oughly with clean water. Seek medical
attention immediately.
#
If you swallow fuel, seek medical atten‐
tion immediately. Do not induce vomit‐
ing.
#
Change immediately out of clothing that
has come into contact with fuel.
&
WARNING Risk of explosion or fire due
to electrostatic charge
Electrostatic charge can cause sparks and
thereby ignite fuel vapors.
#
Always touch the metal vehicle body
before opening the fuel filler cap or
touching the pump nozzle.
This discharges any electrostatic charge that
may have built up.
*
NOTE Damage caused by the wrong fuel
Vehicles with a gasoline engine:
Even small amounts of the wrong fuel could
result in damage to the fuel system, the
engine and the emission control system.
#
Only refuel with low-sulfur premium
grade fuel.
This fuel may contain up to 10 % ethanol.
Your vehicle is suitable for use with E10 fuel.
Do not refuel using:
R
Diesel
R
E15, E85, E100
R
Gasoline containing methanol (M15, M30,
M85, M100)
R
Gasoline with additives containing metal
If you accidentally refuel with the wrong fuel:
#
Do not switch the ignition on.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
*
NOTE Do not use diesel to refuel vehi‐
cles with a gasoline engine.
If you accidentally refuel with the wrong fuel:
R
Do not switch on the ignition. Otherwise
fuel can enter the engine.
Even small amounts of the wrong fuel
could result in damage to the fuel system
and the engine. The repair costs are high.
#
Contact a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Have the fuel tank and fuel lines
drained completely.
178
Driving and parking
*
NOTE Damage to the fuel system caused
by overfilled fuel tanks.
#
Only fill the fuel tank until the pump
nozzle switches off.
*
NOTE Fuel may spray out when you
remove the fuel pump nozzle.
#
Only fill the fuel tank until the pump
nozzle switches off.
Requirements:
R
Unlock the vehicle.
%
Do not get into the vehicle again during the
refueling process. Otherwise, electrostatic
charge could build up again.
Observe the notes on operating fluids
(
page 447).
Plug-in hybrid: observe the notes in the Supple‐
ment. Otherwise, you may not recognize dan‐
gers.
Refueling
1
Fuel filler flap
2
Bracket for the fuel filler cap
3
Tire pressure table
4
QR code for rescue card
5
Fuel type
#
Press fuel filler flap 1.
#
Turn the fuel filler cap counter-clockwise and
remove it.
#
Insert the fuel filler cap into bracket 2.
#
Completely insert the fuel pump nozzle into
the tank filler neck, hook in place and refuel.
#
Only fill the tank until the pump nozzle
switches off.
Parking
Switching off the vehicle
&
WARNING Risk of fire caused by hot
exhaust system parts
Flammable material such as leaves, grass or
twigs may ignite if they come into contact
with hot parts of the exhaust system or
exhaust gas flow.
#
Park the vehicle so that no flammable
material can come into contact with hot
vehicle components.
#
In particular, do not park on dry grass‐
land or harvested grain fields.
Driving and parking
179
&
WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to children left unattended in the
vehicle
If you leave children unaccompanied in the
vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion, for example by:
R
Releasing the parking brake.
R
Shifting the transmission out of park
position j.
R
Starting the engine.
In addition, they may operate vehicle equip‐
ment.
#
Never leave children and animals unat‐
tended in the vehicle.
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
*
NOTE Damage to the vehicle or the driv‐
etrain caused by the vehicle rolling away
#
Always properly secure the vehicle
against rolling away.
#
On uphill or downhill inclines, turn the front
wheels towards the curb.
#
Select transmission position j.
#
Apply the electric parking brake.
#
Press button 1 (USA) or 2 (Canada) once.
%
When you switch off the vehicle, you can still
operate the side windows and the panoramic
sliding sunroof for five minutes.
Garage door opener
Programming buttons for the garage door
opener
&
WARNING Risk of exhaust gas poisoning
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust
gases such as carbon monoxide. Inhaling
these exhaust gases causes poisoning.
#
Never leave the engine running in an
enclosed space without sufficient venti‐
lation.
180
Driving and parking
&
WARNING Risk of injury and entrapment
when opening the garage door using the
garage door opener
When you operate or program the garage
door with the integrated garage door opener,
persons in the range of movement of the
garage door can become trapped or struck
by the garage door.
#
When using the integrated garage door
opener, always make sure that nobody
is within the sweep of the garage door.
Only operate the garage door opener on the fol‐
lowing garage doors:
R
Garage doors with a safety stop and revers
ing feature.
R
Garage doors which conform to the current
U.S. safety standards.
Requirements:
R
The vehicle is parked outside of the garage.
R
The engine is switched off.
#
Check if the transmitter frequency of the
remote control has the frequency range of
280 to 868 MHz.
Radio equipment approval number:
R
NZLMUAHL5 (USA)
R
4112A-MUAHL5 (Canada)
#
Press and hold button 1, 2 or 3 that you
wish to program.
Indicator lamp 4 flashes yellow.
%
It can take up to 20 seconds before the indi‐
cator lamp flashes yellow.
#
Release the previously pressed button.
Indicator lamp 4 continues to flash yellow.
#
Point remote control 5 at a distance of 1 in
(1 cm) to 3 in (8 cm) towards buttons 1, 2
or 3.
#
Press and hold button 6 of remote control
5 until:
R
Indicator lamp 4 lights up green contin‐
uously. Programming is complete.
R
Indicator lamp 4 flashes green. Pro‐
gramming was successful. Additionally,
synchronization of the rolling code with
the garage door system must also take
place.
#
If indicator lamp 4 does not light up or flash
green: repeat the procedure.
#
Release all of the buttons.
Driving and parking
181
%
The remote control for the garage door drive
is not included in the scope of delivery of the
garage door opener.
Synchronizing the rolling code
Requirements:
R
The garage door system uses a rolling code.
R
The vehicle must be within range of the
garage door or exterior gate drive.
R
The vehicle as well as persons and objects,
are located outside the sweep of the garage
door.
#
Press the programming button on the door
drive unit.
Initiate the next step within approximately
30 seconds.
#
Press previously programmed button 1, 2
or 3 repeatedly, until the door closes.
When the door closes, programming is com‐
pleted.
%
Please also read the operating instructions
for the garage door drive.
Troubleshooting when programming the
remote control
#
Check if the transmitter frequency of remote
control 5 is supported.
#
Replace the batteries in remote control 5.
#
Hold remote control 5 at various angles at
a distance between 1 in (1 cm) to 3 in (8 cm)
front of the inside rearview mirror. You
should test every position for at least 25 sec‐
onds before trying another position.
182
Driving and parking
#
Hold remote control 5 at the same angles
at various distances in front of the inside rear
view mirror. You should test every position
for at least 25 seconds before trying another
position.
#
Note that some remote controls transmit
only for a limited period, press button 6 on
remote control 5 again before transmission
ends.
#
Align the antenna line of the garage door
opener unit with the remote control.
%
Support and additional information on pro‐
gramming:
R
On the toll free HomeLink
®
Hotline on
1-800-355-3515.
R
On the Internet at http://
www.homelink.com/mercedes.
Opening/closing the garage door
Requirements:
R
The corresponding button is programmed to
operate the garage door.
#
Press and hold buttons 1, 2 or 3 until
the garage door opens or closes.
#
If indicator lamp 4 flashes yellow after
approximately 20 seconds: press and hold
the previously pressed button again until the
garage door opens or closes.
Clearing the garage door opener memory
#
Press and hold buttons 1 and 3.
Indicator lamp 4 lights up yellow.
#
If indicator lamp 4 flashes green: release
buttons 1 and 3.
Driving and parking
183
Radio equipment approval numbers for the
garage door opener
Radio equipment approval numbers
CountryRadio type approval number
EgyptTAC.2511151293.WIR
Andorra CE
Australia R-NZ
Barbados MED1578
Chile 2488/DFRS20576/F-74
European
Union
CE
GibraltarCE
Iceland CE
Jordan TRC/LPD/2015/299
CanadaIC: 4112A-MUAHL5
Kuwait CE
Country Radio type approval number
Liechten‐
stein
CE
Mexico RCPGEMU15-0448
Monaco CE
New Zea‐
land
R-NZ
NorwayCE
Russian
Federa‐
tion
not required
Saudi Ara‐
bia
TA 10525
Switzer‐
land
CE
CountryRadio type approval number
South
Africa
TA-2015/1386
Turkey not required
United
Arab Emi‐
rates
ER41849/15
Dealer No: DA35176/14
United
States
FCC ID: NZLMUAHL5
184
Driving and parking
Brazil
Este equipamento opera em caráter secundário,
isto é, não tem direito à proteção contra interfer‐
ência prejudicial, mesmo de estações do mesmo
tipo, e não pode causar interfencia a sistemas
operando em caráter primário.
Para maiores informações acessar
www.anatel.gov.br
Further information on the declaration of con‐
formity for wireless vehicle components
(
page 23).
Electric parking brake
Function of the electric parking brake (apply
ing automatically)
&
WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to children left unattended in the
vehicle
If you leave children unaccompanied in the
vehicle, they may be able to set the vehicle in
motion, for example by:
R
Releasing the parking brake.
R
Shifting the transmission out of park
position j.
R
Starting the engine.
In addition, they may operate vehicle equip‐
ment.
#
Never leave children and animals unat‐
tended in the vehicle.
#
When leaving the vehicle, always take
the SmartKey with you and lock the
vehicle.
The electric parking brake is applied if the trans‐
mission is in position j and one of the follow‐
ing conditions is fulfilled:
R
The engine is switched off.
R
The seat belt tongue is not inserted in the
seat belt buckle of the driver's seat and the
driver's door is opened.
%
To prevent application: pull the handle of the
electric parking brake.
In the following situations, the electric parking
brake is also engaged:
R
The Active Distance Assistant DISTRONIC is
bringing the vehicle to a standstill.
R
The HOLD function is keeping the vehicle sta‐
tionary.
R
Active Parking Assist is keeping the vehicle
stationary.
This is only the case if one of the following con‐
ditions is also fulfilled:
R
The engine is switched off.
Driving and parking
185
R
The seat belt tongue is not inserted in the
seat belt buckle of the driver's seat and the
driver's door is opened.
R
There is a system malfunction.
R
The power supply is insufficient.
R
The vehicle is stationary for a lengthy period.
When the electric parking brake is applied, the
F (USA) or ! (Canada) indicator lamp
lights up in the instrument cluster.
The electric parking brake is not automatically
applied if the engine is switched off by the ECO
start/stop function.
Function of the electric parking brake
(releasing automatically)
The electric parking brake is released when the
following conditions are fulfilled:
R
The engine is running.
R
The seat belt tongue is inserted into the seat
belt buckle of the driver's seat.
R
The transmission is in position h or k and
you depress the accelerator pedal or you
shift from transmission position j to h or
k.
R
If the transmission is in position k, the
trunk lid must be closed.
If the seat belt tongue is not inserted into the
seat belt buckle of the driver's seat, the follow‐
ing conditions must be fulfilled:
R
The driver's door is closed.
R
You move the transmission out of transmis‐
sion position j or you have previously
driven faster than 2 mph (3 km/h).
R
If the transmission is in position k, the
trunk lid must be closed.
If the elect
ric parking brake is released, the
F (USA) or ! (CANADA) indicator lamp in
the instrument cluster goes out.
Applying or releasing the electric parking
brake manually
Applying
#
Push handle 1.
The F (USA) or ! (Canada) indicator
lamp appears in the instrument cluster.
186
Driving and parking
Releasing
#
Switch on the ignition.
#
Pull handle 1.
The F (USA) or ! (Canada) indicator
lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
Emergency braking
#
Press and hold handle 1.
When the vehicle has been braked to a
standstill, the electric parking brake is
applied. The F (USA) or ! (Canada)
indicator lamp appears in the instrument
cluster.
Notes on parking the vehicle for a longer
period
If you leave the vehicle parked for longer than
four weeks, the battery may become damaged.
If you leave the vehicle parked for longer than six
weeks, it may suffer damage as a result of lack
of use.
%
Further information can be obtained at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Plug-in hybrid: observe the notes in the Supple‐
ment. Otherwise, you may not recognize dan‐
gers.
Standby mode (extension of the starter bat‐
tery's period out of use)
Standby mode function
If standby mode is activated, the vehicle can be
parked for an extended period of time without
losing power.
Standby mode is characterized by the following:
R
The starter battery is preserved.
R
The maximum period out of use is displayed
in the multimedia system display.
R
Functions such as interior protection or the
tow-away alarm are not available.
R
The connection to online services is interrup‐
ted.
If the following conditions are fulfilled, standby
mode can be activated or deactivated using the
multimedia system:
R
The engine is switched off.
R
The ignition is switched on.
Exceeding the vehicle's displayed period out of
use may cause inconvenience, i.e. it cannot be
guaranteed that the starter battery will reliably
start the engine.
The starter battery must be charged first in the
following situations:
R
The vehicle's period out of use must be
extended.
R
The     
 message appears in the multimedia
system display.
%
Standby mode is automatically deactivated
when the ignition is switched on.
Activating or deactivating standby mode
Multimedia system:
,

.
î  

.
 
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
When you activate the function, a prompt
appears.
Driving and parking
187
#
Select .
Standby mode is activated.
Driving and driving safety systems
Driving systems and your responsibility
Your vehicle is equipped with driving systems
which assist you in driving, parking and maneu‐
vering the vehicle. The driving systems are aids
and do not relieve you of your responsibility. Pay
attention to the traffic conditions at all times
and intervene when necessary. Be aware of the
limitations regarding the safe use of these sys‐
tems.
Function of the radar sensors
Some driving and driving safety systems use
radar sensors to monitor the area in front of,
behind or next to the vehicle (depending on the
vehicle's equipment).
Depending on the vehicle's equipment, the radar
sensors are integrated behind the bumpers
and/or behind the radiator grill. Keep these
parts free of dirt, ice and slush (
page 389).
The sensors must not be covered, for example
by bicycle racks, overhanging loads or radar-
reflecting stickers. Following an impact and in
the event of associated damage, which may not
be visible, to the bumpers or radiator grille, have
the function of the radar sensors checked at a
qualified specialist workshop. The driver assis‐
tance system may no longer work properly.
Overview of driving systems and driving
safety systems
In this section, you will find information about
the following driving systems and driving safety
systems:
R
360° Camera ( page 224)
R
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
(
page 189)
R
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
(
page 199)
R
AIR BODY CONTROL( page 211)
R
Active Brake Assist ( page 192)
R
Active Lane Keeping Assist ( page 240)
R
ATTENTION ASSIST ( page 232)
R
BAS (Brake Assist System) ( page 189)
R
EBD (Electronic Brake force Distribution)
(
page 192)
R
ESP
®
(Electronic Stability Program)
(
page 189)
R
HOLD function ( page 210)
R
STEER CONTROL ( page 192)
R
Active Steering Assist ( page 204)
R
MAGIC BODY CONTROL ( page 214)
R
Active Parking Assist ( page 226)
R
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC ( page 218)
R
Rear view camera ( page 222)
R
Cruise control ( page 196)
R
Blind Spot Assist and Active Blind Spot Assist
(
page 238)
R
Traffic Sign Assist ( page 233)
188
Driving and parking
Functions of ABS (anti-lock braking system)
ABS regulates the brake pressure in critical driv‐
ing situations:
R
During braking, e.g. at maximum full-stop
braking or insufficient traction of the tires,
the wheels are prevented from blocking.
R
Vehicle steerability while braking is ensured.
If ABS intervenes when braking, you will feel a
pulsing in the brake pedal. The pulsating brake
pedal can be an indication of hazardous road
conditions and can serve as a reminder to take
extra care while driving.
System limitations
R
ABS is active from speeds of approx. 5 mph
(8 km/h).
R
ABS may be impaired or may not function if a
malfunction has occurred and the yel‐
low ! ABS warning lamp lights up contin‐
uously in the instrument cluster after the
engine is started.
Function of BAS (Brake Assist System)
&
WARNING Risk of an accident caused by
a malfunction in BAS (Brake Assist Sys‐
tem)
If BAS is malfunctioning, the braking distance
in an emergency braking situation is
increased.
#
Depress the brake pedal with full force
in emergency braking situations. ABS
prevents the wheels from locking.
BAS supports your emergency braking situation
with additional brake force.
If you depress the brake pedal quickly, BAS is
activated:
R
BAS automatically boosts the brake pres‐
sure.
R
BAS can shorten the braking distance.
R
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will function as usual once you
release the brake pedal. BAS is deactivated.
Functions of ESP
®
(Electronic Stability Pro‐
gram)
&
WARNING Risk of skidding if ESP
®
is
malfunctioning
If ESP
®
is malfunctioning, ESP
®
cannot carry
out vehicle stabilization. In addition, other
driving safety systems are switched off.
#
Drive on carefully.
#
Have ESP
®
checked at a qualified spe‐
cialist workshop.
&
WARNING Risk of skidding if ESP
®
is
deactivated
If you deactivate ESP
®
, ESP
®
cannot carry
out vehicle stabilization.
#
ESP
®
should only be deactivated in the
following situations.
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. Otherwise, you may not recog‐
nize dangers.
Driving and parking
189
ESP
®
can monitor and improve driving stability
and traction in the following situations, within
physical limits:
R
When pulling away on a wet or slippery road.
R
When braking.
R
In strong sidewinds when you are driving
faster than 50 mph (80 km/h).
If the vehicle deviates from the direction desired
by the driver, ESP
®
can stabilize the vehicle by
intervening in the following ways:
R
One or more wheels are braked.
R
The engine output is adapted according to
the situation.
ESP
®
is deactivated if the ESP
®
OFF å warn
ing lamp lights up continuously in the instrument
cluster:
R
Driving stability will no longer be improved.
R
Crosswind Assist is no longer active.
R
The drive wheels could spin.
R
ETS/4ETS traction control is still active.
%
When ESP
®
is deactivated, you are still assis‐
ted by ESP
®
when braking.
ESP
®
is intervening if the ESP
®
÷ warning
lamp flashes in the instrument cluster:
R
Do not deactivate ESP
®
.
R
Only depress the accelerator pedal as far as
is necessary.
R
Adapt your driving style to suit the current
road and weather conditions.
Deactivate ESP
®
in the following situations to
improve traction:
R
When using snow chains
R
In deep snow
R
On sand or gravel.
%
Spinning the wheels results in a cutting
action which provides better grip.
If the ESP
®
÷ warning lamp lights up continu‐
ously, ESP
®
is not available due to a malfunction.
Observe the following information:
R
Warning and indicator lamps ( page 501)
R
Display messages ( page 457)
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
ETS/4ETS traction control is part of ESP
®
and
makes it possible to pull away or accelerate on a
slippery surface.
ETS/4ETS can improve the vehicle's traction by
intervening in the following ways:
R
The drive wheels are braked individually if
they spin.
R
More drive torque is transferred to the wheel
or wheels with traction.
Influence of drive programs on ESP
®
The drive programs enable ESP
®
to adapt to dif‐
ferent weather and road conditions as well as
the driver's preferred driving style. You can
select the drive programs using the DYNAMIC
SELECT switch (
page 173).
190
Driving and parking
ESP
®
characteristics per drive program
Drive program
ESP
®
mode
Characteristics
S (Sport)
ESP
®
Sport
This drive program continues to offer stability
but with a sporty setup which allows the enthu‐
siastic driver a more active driving style.
Only select drive program S in good road condi‐
tions, for example on dry roads and clear
stretches of road.
C (Comfort)
Vehicles with MAGIC BODY CONTROL: CV
(CURVE)
E (Economy)
ESP
®
Comfort
These drive programs provide the ideal balance
between traction and stability.
Select drive program C, CV or E, in difficult road
conditions, such as in snow or ice, or when the
road is wet from rain.
Activating/deactivating ESP
®
(Electronic Sta‐
bility Program)
Multimedia system:
,

.
k 
.

Mercedes‑AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. Otherwise, you may not recog‐
nize dangers.
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
ESP
®
is deactivated if the å ESP
®
OFF warn
ing lamp lights up continuously in the instrument
cluster.
Observe the information on warning lamps and
display messages which may be shown in the
instrument cluster.
Functions of ESP
®
Crosswind Assist
ESP
®
Crosswind Assist detects sudden gusts of
side wind and helps the driver to keep the vehi‐
cle in the lane:
R
ESP
®
Crosswind Assist is active at vehicle
speeds between 50 mph (80 km/h) and
Driving and parking
191
125 mph (200 km/h) when driving straight
ahead or cornering slightly.
R
The vehicle is stabilized by means of individ‐
ual brake application on one side.
Function of EBD (electronic brake force dis‐
tribution)
EBD is characterized by the following:
R
Monitoring and regulating the brake pressure
on the rear wheels.
R
Improved driving stability when braking,
especially on bends.
Function of STEER CONTROL
STEER CONTROL helps you by transmitting a
noticeable steering force to the steering wheel in
the direction required for vehicle stabilization.
This steering recommendation is given particu‐
larly in the following situations:
R
Both right wheels or both left wheels are on
a wet or slippery road surface when you
brake.
R
The vehicle starts to skid.
System limitations
STEER CONTROL may be impaired or may not
function in the following situations:
R
ESP
®
is deactivated.
R
ESP
®
is malfunctioning.
R
The steering is malfunctioning.
If ESP
®
is malfunctioning, you will be assisted
further by the electric power steering.
Function of Active Brake Assist
Active Brake Assist consists of:
R
Distance warning function
R
Autonomous braking function
R
Situation-dependent braking assistance
R
Vehicles with Driving Assistance Pack
age: Evasive Steering Assist
Active Brake Assist can help you to minimize the
risk of a collision with vehicles or pedestrians or
to reduce the effects of such a collision.
If Active Brake Assist has detected a risk of colli‐
sion, you will be warned visually and acousti‐
cally.
If you do not react to the visual or acoustic warn
ing, autonomous braking can be initiated in criti‐
cal situations.
In especially critical situations, Active Brake
Assist can initiate autonomous braking directly.
In this case, the visual and acoustic warning
occurs simultaneously with the braking applica‐
tion.
If you apply the brake yourself in a critical situa‐
tion or apply the brake during autonomous brak‐
ing, situation-dependent braking assistance
occurs. This increases the brake pressure up to
maximum full-stop braking if necessary.
If the autonomous braking function or the situa‐
tion-dependent braking assistance is triggered,
additional preventive measures for occupant
protection (PRE-SAFE
®
) may also be initiated, if
the vehicle is equipped with these.
192
Driving and parking
&
WARNING Risk of an accident caused by
limited detection performance of Active
Brake Assist
Active Brake Assist cannot always clearly
identify objects and complex traffic situa‐
tions.
In such cases, Active Brake Assist might:
R
Give a warning or brake without reason
R
Not give a warning or not brake
#
Always pay careful attention to the traf‐
fic situation; do not rely on Active Brake
Assist alone. Active Brake Assist is only
an aid. The driver is responsible for
maintaining a suitable distance to the
vehicle in front, vehicle speed and for
braking in good time.
#
Be prepared to brake or swerve if nec‐
essary.
Also observe the system limitations of Active
Brake Assist.
The individual subfunctions are available in
the following speed ranges:
Distance warning function
The distance warning function issues a warning
at speeds:
R
From approximately 4 mph (7 km/h), if your
vehicle is critically close to a vehicle or
pedestrian. An intermittent warning tone
sounds and the · distance warning lamp
lights up in the instrument cluster.
Brake immediately or take evasive action, provi‐
ded it is safe to do so and the traffic situation
allows this.
The distance warning function can aid you in the following situations with an intermittent warning tone and a warning lamp:
Vehicles traveling in
front
Stationary vehicles Crossing vehicles Crossing pedestrians Stationary pedes‐
trians
Vehicles without Driv‐
ing Assistance pack
age
up to approx. 155 mph
(250 km/h)
up to approx. 50 mph
(80 km/h)
no reaction up to approx. 37 mph
(60 km/h)
no reaction
Vehicles with Driving
Assistance package
up to approx. 155 mph
(250 km/h)
up to approx. 62 mph
(100 km/h)
up to approx. 43 mph
(70 km/h)
up to approx. 43 mph
(70 km/h)
up to approx. 43 mph
(70 km/h)
Driving and parking
193
Autonomous braking function
The autonomous braking function may intervene at speeds starting from approximately 4 mph (7 km/h) in the following situations:
Vehicles traveling in
front
Stationary vehicles Crossing vehicles Crossing pedestrians Stationary pedes‐
trians
Vehicles without Driv‐
ing Assistance pack
age
up to approx. 124 mph
(200 km/h)
up to approx. 31 mph
(50 km/h)
no reaction up to approx. 37 mph
(60 km/h)
no reaction
Vehicles with Driving
Assistance package
up to approx. 155 mph
(250 km/h)
up to approx. 62 mph
(100 km/h)
up to approx. 43 mph
(70 km/h)
up to approx. 43 mph
(70 km/h)
up to approx. 43 mph
(70 km/h)
Situation-dependent braking assistance
Situation-dependent braking assistance may intervene at speeds starting from approximately 4 mph (7 km/h) in the following situations:
Vehicles traveling in
front
Stationary vehicles Crossing vehicles Crossing pedestrians Stationary pedes‐
trians
Vehicles without Driv‐
ing Assistance pack
age
up to approx. 155 mph
(250 km/h)
up to approx. 50 mph
(80 km/h)
no reaction up to approx. 37 mph
(60 km/h)
no reaction
Vehicles with Driving
Assistance package
up to approx. 155 mph
(250 km/h)
up to approx. 62 mph
(100 km/h)
up to approx. 43 mph
(70 km/h)
up to approx. 43 mph
(70 km/h)
up to approx. 43 mph
(70 km/h)
194
Driving and parking
Canceling a brake application of Active Brake
Assist
You can cancel a brake application of Active
Brake Assist at any time by:
R
Depressing the accelerator pedal fully.
R
Releasing the brake pedal.
Active Brake Assist cancels the intervention
when at least one of the following conditions is
fulfilled:
R
You maneuver to avoid the obstacle.
R
There is no longer a risk of collision.
R
An obstacle is no longer detected in front of
your vehicle.
Evasive Steering Assist (only vehicles with
Driving Assistance package)
Evasive Steering Assist has the following charac‐
teristics:
R
Can detect stationary or crossing pedes‐
trians.
R
Can assist the driver with additional steering
assistance if it detects a swerving maneuver.
R
Can be activated by an abrupt steering move
ment during a swerving maneuver.
R
Can assist during swerving and straightening
of the vehicle.
R
Can react from a speed of approximately
12 mph (20 km/h) up to a speed of approx
imately 43 mph (70 km/h).
R
You can prevent the assistance at any time
by active steering.
&
WARNING Risk of an accident despite
Evasive Steering Assist
Evasive Steering Assist cannot always clearly
identify objects and complex traffic situa‐
tions.
In addition, the steering support of Evasive
Steering Assist is generally not sufficient to
avoid a collision.
In such cases Evasive Steering Assist can:
R
give an unnecessary warning or provide
assistance
R
not give a warning or not provide assis‐
tance
#
Always pay careful attention to the traf‐
fic situation; do not rely on Evasive
Steering Assist alone.
#
Be ready to brake and take evasive
action if necessary.
#
Prevent the assistance by actively steer‐
ing in non-critical driving situations.
#
Drive at an appropriate speed if pedes‐
trians are close to the path of your vehi‐
cle.
Also observe the system limitations of Evasive
Steering Assist.
System limitations
The system may be impaired or may not function
in the following situations:
R
In snow, rain, fog, heavy spray, if there is
glare, in direct sunlight or in greatly varying
ambient light.
R
If the sensors are dirty, fogged up, damaged
or covered.
Driving and parking
195
R
If the sensors malfunction due to other radar
source interference, for example strong radar
reflections in parking garages.
R
If a loss of tire pressure or a defective tire
has been detected and displayed.
The system may not react correctly:
R
In complex traffic stations where objects
cannot always be clearly identified.
R
To pedestrians or vehicles if they move
quickly into the sensor detection range.
R
To pedestrians who are hidden by other
objects.
R
If the typical outline of a pedestrian cannot
be distinguished from the background.
R
If a pedestrian is not recognized as such, e.g.
due to special clothing or other objects.
R
On bends with a tight radius.
Setting Active Brake Assist
Multimedia system:
,

.
k 
.

 
Vehicles without Driving Assistance pack‐
age: The settings can be made after starting the
vehicle.
Vehicles with Driving Assistance package:
The settings can be made when the ignition is
switched on.
%
It is recommended that you always leave
Active Brake Assist switched on.
Select one of the following settings:
#
: your selection is retained when the
vehicle is next started.
#
: your selection is retained when the
vehicle is next started.
#
: your selection is retained when the
vehicle is next started.
#
:
Vehicles without Driving Assistance pack‐
age: The distance warning function and the
autonomous braking function are deactiva‐
ted. When the vehicle is next started, the
middle setting is automatically selected.
Vehicles with Driving Assistance pack‐
age: The distance warning function and the
autonomous braking function are deactiva‐
ted. Evasive Steering Assist is unavailable.
When the ignition is next started, the middle
setting is selected automatically and Evasive
Steering Assist is available.
%
When Active Brake Assist is deactivated, the
æ symbol appears in the assistance
graphic in the multifunction display.
Speed control cruise control
Function of cruise control
Cruise control accelerates and brakes the vehi‐
cle automatically in order to maintain a previ‐
ously stored speed.
If you accelerate to overtake, for example, the
stored speed is not deleted. If you remove your
foot from the accelerator pedal after overtaking,
cruise control will resume speed regulation back
to the stored speed.
196
Driving and parking
Cruise control is operated using the correspond‐
ing steering wheel buttons. You can store any
road speed above 15 mph (20 km/h).
If you fail to adapt your driving style, cruise con‐
trol can neither reduce the risk of an accident
nor override the laws of physics. It cannot take
into account road, weather or traffic conditions.
Cruise control is only an aid. You are responsible
for the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehi‐
cle speed, for braking in good time and for stay
ing in lane.
Displays in the multifunction display
The status of cruise control and the stored
speed are shown in the multifunction display.
1
Cruise control is selected
2
Speed is saved, cruise control is deactivated
3
Speed is saved, cruise control is activated
%
The segments between the stored speed and
the end of the segment display light up in
the speedometer.
System limitations
Cruise control may be unable to maintain the
stored speed on uphill gradients. The stored
speed is resumed when the gradient evens out.
Change into a lower gear in good time on long
and steep downhill gradients. Take particular
note of this when driving a laden vehicle. By
doing so, you will make use of the braking effect
of the engine. This relieves the load on the brake
system and prevents the brakes from overheat‐
ing and wearing too quickly.
Do not use cruise control in the following situa‐
tions:
R
In traffic situations which require frequent
changes of speed, e.g. in heavy traffic, on
winding roads
R
On slippery roads. Accelerating can cause
the drive wheels to lose traction and the
vehicle could then skid
R
When visibility is poor
Operating cruise control
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to stored
speed
If you call up the stored speed and this is
lower than your current speed, the vehicle
decelerates.
#
Take into account the traffic situation
before calling up the stored speed.
Driving and parking
197
Requirements:
R
ESP
®
must be activated, but not intervening.
R
The driving speed is at least 15 mph
(20 km/h).
#
To switch on cruise control: push rocker
switch 1 up.
#
To activate cruise control: push rocker
switch 2 up (SET+) or down (SET-).
#
Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.
The current speed is stored and maintained
by the vehicle.
#
To increase/reduce speed: press rocker
switch 2 up/down.
The stored speed is increased or reduced by
1 mph (1 km/h).
or
#
Press rocker switch 2 beyond the pressure
point.
The stored speed is increased or reduced by
5 mph (10 km/h).
or
#
Accelerate the vehicle to the desired speed.
#
Push rocker switch 2 up.
If cruise control is activated and Traffic Sign
Assist has detected speed restriction signs, and
these maximum permissible speeds are dis‐
played in the instrument cluster:
#
To adopt the detected speed: push rocker
switch 3 up.
The maximum permissible speed shown by
the traffic sign is stored and the vehicle
maintains this speed.
#
To deactivate cruise control:
push rocker switch 3 (CNCL) down.
When cruise control is deactivated:
R
Rocker switch 2 (SET+) or (SET-) saves the
currently driven speed and the vehicle main‐
tains this speed.
R
Rocker switch 3 (RES) calls up the speed
last stored and the vehicle maintains this
speed.
#
To switch off cruise control: push rocker
switch 1 down.
%
If you brake, deactivate ESP
®
or if ESP
®
intervenes, cruise control is deactivated.
When you switch off the vehicle, the last
speed stored is cleared.
Setting the speed limit for winter tires
Multimedia system:
,

.
î  
.

  
#
Select a speed or deactivate the function.
198
Driving and parking
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
Function of Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC maintains the
set speed on free-flowing roads. If vehicles
ahead are detected, the set distance is main‐
tained, if necessary until the vehicle comes to a
halt. The vehicle accelerates or brakes depend‐
ing on the distance to the vehicle in front and
the set speed. Speed (in the range between
15 mph (20 km/h) and 130 mph (210 km/h))
and the distance to the vehicle ahead are set
and saved on the steering wheel.
Other features of Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC:
R
Adjusts the driving style depending on the
selected drive program (fuel-saving, comfort‐
able or dynamic) (
page 172)
R
Responds in urban speed ranges to station‐
ary vehicles (except bicycles, motorcycles
and pedestrians) if conditions are sufficient
to enable detection.
R
Initiates rapid acceleration to the stored
speed, if the turn signal indicator is switched
on to change to the overtaking lane.
R
Takes one-sided overtaking restrictions into
account on freeways or on multi-lane roads
with separate carriageways.
Vehicles with Active Parking Assist: if the vehicle
has been braked to a standstill on multi-lane,
separate carriageways by Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC, it can automatically follow the vehi‐
cle in front driving
off again, within 30 seconds.
If a crit
ical situation is detected when driving off,
a visual and acoustic warning is given indicating
that the driver must now take control of the vehi‐
cle. The vehicle is not accelerated any further.
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is only an aid.
The driver is responsible for the distance to the
vehicle in front, for vehicle speed and for braking
in good time.
System limitations
The system may be impaired or may not function
in the following instances, for example:
R
In snow, rain, fog, heavy spray, if there is
glare, in direct sunlight or in greatly varying
ambient light.
R
The windshield in the area of the camera is
dirty, fogged up, damaged or covered.
R
If the radar sensors are dirty or covered.
R
On slippery roads, braking or accelerating
can cause the drive wheels to lose traction
and the vehicle could then skid.
R
In parking garages or on roads with steep
uphill or downhill gradients.
Do not use Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC in
these situations.
Driving and parking
199
&
WARNING Risk of accident from acceler‐
ation or braking by Active Distance
Assist DISTRONIC
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC may accel‐
erate or brake in the following cases, for
example:
R
If the vehicle pulls away using Active Dis‐
tance Assist DISTRONIC.
R
If the stored speed is called up and is
considerably faster or slower than the
currently driven speed.
R
If Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC no
longer detects a vehicle in front or does
not react to relevant objects.
#
Always carefully observe the traffic con‐
ditions and be ready to brake at all
times.
#
Take into account the traffic situation
before calling up the stored speed.
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to insuf‐
ficient deceleration by Active Distance
Assist DISTRONIC
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC brakes
your vehicle with up to 50 % of the maximum
possible deceleration. If this deceleration is
not sufficient, Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC alerts you with a visual and
acoustic warning.
#
In these cases, adjust your speed and
keep a sufficient distance.
#
Brake the vehicle yourself and/or take
evasive action.
&
WARNING Risk of accident if detection
function of Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC is impaired
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC does not
react or only partially reacts:
R
When driving on a different line to the
vehicle ahead or changing lane.
R
To pedestrians, animals, bicycles or
motor bikes, stationary vehicles or unex‐
pected obstacles.
R
To complex traffic situations.
R
To oncoming vehicles and crossing traf‐
fic.
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC can nei‐
ther give warnings nor intervene in such sit‐
uations.
#
Always observe the traffic conditions
carefully and react accordingly.
Operating Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
Requirements:
R
The vehicle has been started.
R
The electric parking brake is released.
R
ESP
®
is activated and is not intervening.
R
The transmission is in position h.
R
All the doors are closed.
R
Check of the radar sensor system success‐
fully completed (vehicle traveling faster than
12 mph (20 km/h)).
200
Driving and parking
#
To activate/deactivate Active Distance
Assist DISTRONIC: press button 1.
#
To activate Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC: press rocker switch 3 up (SET
+) or down (SET-). Remove your foot from the
accelerator pedal.
The current speed is stored and maintained
by the vehicle.
or
#
To activate Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC with a stored speed: press
rocker switch 4 up. Remove your foot from
the accelerator pedal.
%
If rocker switch 4 is pressed up twice,
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is activa
ted with the speed restriction displayed in
the instrument cluster.
#
To accept the displayed speed restriction
when Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
is active: press rocker switch 4 (RES) up.
The speed limit displayed in the instrument
cluster is adopted as the stored speed. The
vehicle adapts its speed to that of the vehicle
in front, but only up to the stored speed.
#
To pull away with Distance Assist
DISTRONIC activated: remove your foot
from the brake pedal.
#
Push rocker switch 4 (RES) up.
or
#
Depress the accelerator pedal briefly and dis‐
tinctly.
The functions of Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC continue to be carried out.
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to Active
Distance Assist DISTRONIC still being
activated when you leave the driver's
seat
If you leave the driver's seat while the vehicle
is being braked by Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC only, the vehicle can roll away.
#
Always deactivate Active Distance
Assist DISTRONIC and secure the vehi‐
cle to prevent it from rolling away
before you leave the driver's seat.
#
To deactivate Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC: press rocker switch 4 (CNCL)
down.
#
To increase/reduce speed: press rocker
switch 3 up/down.
The stored speed is increased or reduced by
1 mph (1 km/h).
or
#
Press rocker switch 3 beyond the pressure
point.
The stored speed is increased or reduced by
5 mph (10 km/h).
Driving and parking
201
#
To increase or reduce the specified dis‐
tance from the vehicle in front: press
rocker switch 2 up or down.
Function of Active Speed Limit Assist
%
The availability of the following function is
country-dependent.
If a change in the speed limit is detected and
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is activated,
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC assumes this
new speed as the stored speed.
The driven speed is adjusted when the vehicle is
level with the traffic sign at the latest. In the
case of signs indicating entry into an urban area,
the speed is adapted beforehand. The speed
limit display in the Instrument Display is always
updated when the vehicle is level with the traffic
sign.
If there is no speed restriction on an unlimited
stretch of road (e.g. on a freeway), the recom‐
mended speed is adopted as the stored speed.
The system uses the speed stored on an unlimi‐
ted stretch of road as the recommended speed.
If you do not alter the stored speed on an unlimi‐
ted stretch of road, the recommended speed is
80 mph (130 km/h).
If Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC has been
put into passive mode by pressing the accelera‐
tor pedal, only speed limits which are higher
than the set speed are adopted.
Active Speed Limit Assist can be configured in
the multimedia system (
page 235).
Active Speed Limit Assist is only an aid. The
driver is responsible for the dista
nce to the vehi‐
cle in front, for vehicle speed and for bra
king in
good time. The maximum permissible speed also
depends on factors such as the road surface and
traffic conditions.
System limitations
Temporary speed restrictions (e.g. for a certain
time or due to weather conditions) cannot be
properly detected by the system. The maximum
permissible speed applying for a vehicle with a
trailer is not detected by the system. In these sit‐
uations you must adjust your speed yourself.
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to Active
Speed Limit Assist adapting the vehicle's
speed
The speed adopted by Active Speed Limit
Assist may be too high or incorrect in some
individual cases, such as:
R
In the wet or in fog
202
Driving and parking
R
When towing a trailer
#
Ensure that the driven speed complies
with traffic regulations.
#
Adjust the driving speed to suit current
traffic and weather conditions.
Function of route-based speed adjustment
%
The availability of the following function is
country-dependent.
When Distance Assist DISTRONIC is active, the
function adjusts the speed depending on the
route events ahead. Depending on the drive pro‐
gram selected, the vehicle negotiates the route
event ahead in a fuel-saving, comfortable or
dynamic manner. When the route event has been
passed, the vehicle accelerates again to the
stored speed. The set distance to the vehicle
ahead, vehicles detected ahead and speed
restrictions ahead are taken into account.
Route-based speed adjustment can by config‐
ured in the multimedia system (
page 204).
Route events ahead are:
R
Bends
R
T-intersections, traffic circles and toll sta‐
tions
R
Turnings and exits
%
When the toll station is reached, Active Dis‐
tance Assist DISTRONIC adopts the speed as
the stored speed.
Also, the speed is reduced if the turn signal to
change lanes is switched on and one of the fol‐
lowing situations is detected:
R
Turning off at intersections
R
On slowing-down lanes
R
On lanes adjacent to slowing-down lanes
The driver is responsible for choosing the right
speed and observing other road users. This
applies in particular to intersections, traffic cir‐
cles and sets of traffic lights, as ro
ute-
based
speed adjustment does not brake the vehicle to
a standstill.
With active route guidance, the first speed
adjustment is carried out automatically. If the
turn signal indicator is switched on, the selected
route is confirmed and further speed adjustment
is activated.
Speed adjustment is canceled in the following
cases:
R
If the turn signal indicator is switched off
before the route event.
R
If the driver depresses the accelerator or
brake pedal during the process.
System limitations
Route-based speed adjustment does not take
right of way regulations into account. The driver
is responsible for complying with road traffic
regulations and driving at a suitable speed.
In difficult ambient conditions (e.g. unclear
roads, narrow lanes, wet road surfaces, snow or
ice) or when driving with a trailer, the speed
adjustment made by the system may not always
be suitable. In these situations the driver must
intervene accordingly.
Driving and parking
203
&
WARNING Risk of accident in spite of
route-based speed adjustment
Route-based speed adjustment might mal‐
function or be temporarily unavailable in the
following situations:
R
If map data is not up to date or available
R
If you do not follow the selected route
guidance
R
If the set route is re-planned
R
In road construction areas
R
When towing a trailer
R
In bad weather or road conditions
R
If the accelerator pedal is depressed
#
Adjust the speed to the traffic situation.
Setting route-based speed adjustment
Requirement:
R
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is activa
ted.
Multimedia system:
,

.
k 
.


#
Select    or  .
Active Steering Assist
Function of Active Steering Assist
Active Steering Assist assists the driver at
speeds up to 130 mph (210 km/h) and helps the
driver to stay in the center of the lane by means
of moderate steering interventions. The system
orients itself using detected lane markings.
Depending on the speed driven, Active Steering
Assist uses the vehicles ahead as a reference. If
the detection of lane markings and vehicles
ahead is impaired, Active Steering Assist
switches to passive mode. The system does not
provide support in the form of steering interven‐
tions.
R
The driver is required to keep their hands on
the steering wheel at all times and be able to
intervene at any time to correct the course of
the vehicle and keep it in lane.
R
The status of Active Steering Assist is dis‐
played in the status bar of the multifunction
display.
Steering and contact detection
The driver is required to keep their hands on the
steering wheel at all times and to be able to
intervene at any time. The driver must expect a
change from active to passive mode or vice
versa at any time.
204
Driving and parking
If the system reaches a system limitation or the
driver has not steered the vehicle for a consider‐
able period of time or has removed their hands
from the steering wheel, the system will,
depending on the situation, first alert the driver
with a visual warning. Display 1 appears in the
multifunction display. If the driver still does not
steer the vehicle himself or herself, or still has
not taken hold of the steering wheel, a repeated
warning tone sounds in addition to the visual
warning message to remind the driver to take
control of the vehicle.
The warning message does not appear or disap‐
pears if one of the following conditions are met:
R
The driver steers the vehicle.
R
The driver presses a steering wheel button or
operates Touch Control.
Active Steering Assist is only an aid. The driver is
responsible for the distance to the vehicle in
front, for vehicle speed, for braking in good time
and for staying in lane. Before changing lanes,
the driver must make sure that the neighboring
lane is free (glance over the shoulder).
System limitations
Active Steering Assist has a limited steering tor‐
que for lateral guidance. In some cases, the
steering intervention is not sufficient to keep the
vehicle
in the lan
e or to drive past exits. Active
Steering Assist cannot provide the driver with
steering assistance at traffic circles, T-intersec‐
tions, intersections, toll stations or turnings, for
example.
The system may be impaired or may not function
in the following instances:
R
In snow, rain, fog, heavy spray, if there is
glare or direct sunlight or if there are greatly
varying ambient light or reflections, or strong
shadows on the road.
R
Insufficient road illumination.
R
The windshield in the area of the camera is
dirty, fogged up, damaged or covered.
R
Absence of lane markings, or several unclear
lane markings, or if the markings change rap‐
idly.
R
The distance to the vehicle in front is too
small and the lane markings thus cannot be
detected.
R
The road is narrow and winding.
R
Obstacles on the lane or projecting out into
the lane.
The system does not provide assistance in the
following conditions:
R
On tight bends, traffic circles and when turn‐
ing.
R
If you actively change lane without switching
on the turn signal indicator.
Driving and parking
205
&
WARNING Risk of accident if Active
Steering Assist unexpectedly stops func‐
tioning
If the system limitations of Active Steering
Assist are reached there is no guarantee that
the system will remain active or will keep the
vehicle in lane.
#
Always keep your hands on the steering
wheel and observe the traffic carefully.
#
Always steer the vehicle paying atten‐
tion to traffic conditions.
&
WARNING Risk of accident if Active
Steering Assist unexpectedly intervenes
A malfunction in the detection of lane mark‐
ings and objects can occur.
This could cause unexpected steering inter‐
vention.
#
Steer according to traffic conditions.
Activating Active Steering Assist
Requirements:
R
ESP
®
must be activated, but not intervening.
R
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is activa
ted.
#
If indicator lamp 1 is off: press button 2.
Function of Active Lane Change Assist
%
The availability of the following function is
country-dependent.
Active Lane Change Assist supports the driver
when changing lanes, by applying steering tor‐
ques.
Assistance when changing lanes is provided if all
the following conditions are met:
R
You are driving on a freeway or road with
multiple lanes in the direction of travel.
R
The neighboring lane is separated by a bro‐
ken lane marking.
R
No vehicle is detected in the adjacent lane.
R
The driven speed is between 50 mph
(80 km/h) and 110 mph (180 km/h).
R
Active Lane Change Assist is activated by the
driver with the turn signal indicator.
R
Active Lane Change Assist is switched on in
the multimedia system.
R
Active Steering Assist is switched on and
active.
206
Driving and parking
If no vehicle is detected in the adjacent lane and
a lane change is permitted, the steering wheel
symbol and the arrow are shown in green 2 .
The      message appears,
for example. If Active Lane Change Assist is acti‐
vated with the turn signal indicator but a lane
change is not immediately possible, the steering
wheel symbol remains green and the arrow
appears gray 1. When the lane change support
starts, the turn signal indicator is automatically
activated. If a lane change is not possible within
the defined length of time, the arrow fades out
and a new lane change must be initiated. An
immediate lane change is only possible on free‐
way sections without speed limits.
If the system is impaired, Active Lane Change
Assist may be canceled. If it is canceled the
   message appears in the
multifunction display and a warning tone sounds.
&
WARNING Risk of accident from chang‐
ing lane to an occupied adjacent lane
Lane Change Assist cannot always detect
clearly if the adjacent lane is free.
The lane change might be initiated although
the adjacent lane is not free.
#
Before changing lanes, make sure that
the neighboring lane is free and there is
no danger to other road users.
#
Monitor the lane change.
&
WARNING Risk of accident if Lane
Change Assist unexpectedly stops func‐
tioning
If the system limitations for Lane Change
Assist have been reached, there is no guar‐
antee that the system will remain active.
Lane Change Assist cannot then assist you
by applying steering torques.
#
Always monitor the lane change and
keep your hands on the steering wheel.
Observe the traffic conditions and steer
and/or brake if necessary.
System limitations
The system limitations of Active Steering Assist
apply to Lane Change Assist (
page 204).
Activating/deactivating Active Lane Change
Assist
Multimedia system:
,

.
k 
#
Select   .
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Function of Active Emergency Stop Assist
If the driver continues to ignore the acoustic
warning to put their hands on the steering
wheel, Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
reduces the speed. If the driver still does not
respond, the    mes‐
sage is shown in the multifunction display. The
Driving and parking
207
vehicle is decelerated in stages to a standstill. At
speeds below 40 mph (60 km/h) the hazard
warning lights switch on automatically.
When stationary:
R
The vehicle is secured with the electric park‐
ing brake.
R
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is ended.
R
The vehicle is unlocked.
R
If possible, an emergency call is placed to
the Mercedes-Benz emergency call center.
The driver can cancel the deceleration at any
time by performing one of the following actions:
R
Steering
R
Depressing the brake or accelerator pedal
R
Pressing a steering wheel button or operat‐
ing Touch Control
R
Activating or deactivating Active Distance
Assist DISTRONIC
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC displays in
the instrument cluster
The assistance graphic and the status display
show the status of the following functions in the
instrument cluster.
R
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
R
Route-based speed adjustment
R
Active Steering Assist
Assistance graphic
1
Route-based speed adjustment (type of
route event)
2
Vehicle ahead
3
Distance indicator
4
Set specified distance
5
Own vehicle
208
Driving and parking
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC status dis‐
play and route-based speed adjustment
1
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC selected,
set specified distance
2
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC deactiva
ted, speed stored
3
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC active,
speed stored, no vehicle detected (gray vehi‐
cle symbol)
4
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC active,
speed stored, vehicle detected (green vehi‐
cle symbol)
5
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC and route-
based speed adjustment active, speed
stored
%
On freeways or high-speed major roads, the
green ç vehicle symbol is displayed cycli‐
cally when the vehicle is ready to pull away.
Speedometer
The stored speed is highlighted on the speedom‐
eter. If the speed of the vehicle ahead or the
speed adjustment is less than the stored speed
due to the route event ahead, the segments in
the speedometer light up. Activation or deactiva
tion of Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC as well
as alterations in the saved speed and the dis‐
tance to be maintained, are displayed in the indi‐
vidual control feedback of the multifunction dis‐
play.
Active Steering Assist status display
1
Gray steering wheel: Active Steering Assist
switched on and passive
2
Green steering wheel: Active Steering Assist
switched on and active
3
Yellow steering wheel flashing: transition
from active to passive status (system limita‐
tion detected or prompt to the driver to
actively confirm)
During the transition from the active to passive
status, the è symbol is shown as enlarged
and flashes yellow. Once the system is passive
the è symbol is shown as gray in the multi‐
function display.
Driving and parking
209
Information on Hill Start Assist
Hill Start Assist holds the vehicle for a short
time when pulling away on a hill under the fol‐
lowing conditions:
R
The transmission is in position h or k.
R
The electric parking brake is released.
This gives you enough time to move your foot
from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal
and depress it before the vehicle begins to roll.
&
WARNING Risk of accident and injury
caused by the vehicle rolling away
After a short time, Hill Start Assist no longer
holds the vehicle and it can roll away.
#
Therefore, swiftly move your foot from
the brake pedal to the accelerator
pedal. Never attempt to leave the vehi‐
cle if it is being held by Hill Start Assist.
HOLD function
HOLD function
The HOLD function holds the vehicle at a stand‐
still without requiring you to depress the brake
pedal, e.g. when pulling away on steep slopes.
System limitations
R
The incline must not be greater than 30%.
Activating/deactivating the HOLD function
&
WARNING Risk of an accident due to the
HOLD function being activated when you
leave the vehicle
If you leave the vehicle while only the HOLD
function is braking the vehicle, the vehicle
can roll away in the following situations:
R
If there is a malfunction in the system or
in the power supply.
R
If the HOLD function is deactivated by
depressing the accelerator pedal or the
brake pedal, e.g. by a vehicle occupant.
R
If the electrics in the engine compart
ment, the battery or the fuses are tam‐
pered with or if the battery is disconnec‐
ted.
#
Always deactivate the HOLD function
and secure the vehicle against rolling
away before leaving the vehicle.
*
NOTE Damage from automatic braking
When Active Brake Assist, Active Distance
Assist DISTRONIC or the HOLD function are
activated, the vehicle brakes autonomously
in certain situations.
To avoid damage to the vehicle, deactivate
these systems in the following or similar sit‐
uations:
#
During towing
#
In a car wash
Requirements:
R
The vehicle is stationary.
R
The driver's door is closed or the seat belt on
the driver's side is fastened.
210
Driving and parking
R
The engine is running or has been automati‐
cally switched off by the ECO start/stop
function.
R
The electric parking brake is released.
R
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is deacti‐
vated.
R
The transmission is in position h, k or i.
Activating the HOLD function
#
Depress the brake pedal and after a short
time quickly depress further until the ë
display appears in the multifunction display.
#
Release the brake pedal.
Deactivating the HOLD function
#
Depress the accelerator pedal to pull away.
or
#
Depress the brake pedal until the ë dis‐
play disappears from the multifunction dis‐
play.
The HOLD function is deactivated in the follow‐
ing situations:
R
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is activa
ted.
R
The transmission is switched to position j.
R
The vehicle is secured with the electric park‐
ing brake.
In the following situations, the vehicle is held by
the transmission position j or by the electric
parking brake:
R
The seat belt is unfastened and the driver's
door is opened.
R
The engine is switched off.
R
There is a malfunction in the system or the
power supply is insufficient.
AIR BODY CONTROL
AIR BODY CONTROL function
AIR BODY CONTROL is an air suspension system
with variable damping for improved driving com‐
fort. The all-round level control system ensures
the best possible suspension and constant
ground clearance, even with a laden vehicle.
When driving at speed, the vehicle is lowered
automatically to improve driving safety and to
reduce fuel consumption. The option of manually
adjusting the vehicle level is also available.
AIR BODY CONTROL comprises:
R
Air suspension with automatic all-round level
control
R
Speed-dependent lowering to reduce fuel
consumption
R
Manual level adjustment
R
ADS PLUS (Adaptive Damping System with
constant damping force adjustment)
R
DYNAMIC SELECT switch and level button
Driving and parking
211
Available suspension settings
Drive programCharacteristics
S
(Sport)
R
The suspension tuning is firmer.
R
The vehicle is lowered by 0.4 in (10 mm) compared to the normal level.
R
When driving at speeds above 75 mph (120 km/h), the vehicle is lowered by a further 0.4 in (10 mm).
R
The vehicle is not lowered any further if you are traveling at higher speeds.
R
When driving at speeds below 50 mph (80 km/h), the vehicle is raised again.
C
(Comfort)
E
(Economy)
R
The suspension tuning is comfortable.
R
The vehicle is set to the normal level.
R
When driving at speeds above 77 mph (125 km/h), the vehicle is lowered by 0.4 in (10 mm) compared to the
normal level.
R
When driving at speeds below 50 mph (80 km/h), the vehicle is raised again.
R
When driving at speeds above 100 mph (160 km/h), the vehicle is lowered by a further 0.4 in (10 mm).
R
When driving at speeds between 75 mph (120 km/h) and 100 mph (160 km/h), the vehicle is raised again by
0.4 in (10 mm).
212
Driving and parking
Setting the vehicle level
&
WARNING Risk of accident because
vehicle level is too high
If you drive at a higher vehicle level, the driv‐
ing characteristics may be impaired due to
the higher vehicle center of gravity.
The vehicle may tip over more quickly on a
bend, for example.
#
Always select as low a vehicle level as
possible and adapt your driving style
accordingly.
&
WARNING Risk of entrapment from vehi‐
cle lowering
When lowering the vehicle, people could
become trapped if their limbs are between
the vehicle body and the tires or underneath
the vehicle.
#
Make sure no one is underneath the
vehicle or in the immediate vicinity of
the wheel arches when you lower the
vehicle.
&
WARNING Risk of entrapment from vehi‐
cle lowering
Vehicles with AIR BODY CONTROL or
level control system: When you unload lug‐
gage or leave the vehicle, the vehicle first
rises slightly and then returns to the set level
shortly afterwards.
You or anyone else in the vicinity of the
wheel arches or the underbody could thus
become trapped.
The vehicle can also be lowered after being
locked.
#
When leaving the vehicle, make sure
that nobody is in the vicinity of the
wheel arches or the underbody.
Requirements:
R
The vehicle has been started.
R
The vehicle must not be moving faster than
50 mph (80 km/h).
Raising the vehicle
#
Press button 1.
Indicator lamp 2 lights up.
The vehicle is raised by 1 in (25 mm) com‐
pared to the normal level.
Your selection is saved.
Driving and parking
213
The vehicle is lowered again in the following sit‐
uations:
R
When driving faster than 75 mph
(120 km/h).
R
When driving between 50 mph (80 km/h)
and 75 mph (120 km/h) for approximately
three minutes.
R
After selecting a drive program using the
DYNAMIC SELECT switch.
The vehicle is adjusted to the height of the last
active drive program.
Lowering the vehicle
#
Press button 1.
Indicator lamp 2 goes out. The vehicle is
adjusted to the height of the last active drive
program.
MAGIC BODY CONTROL
MAGIC BODY CONTROL function
MAGIC BODY CONTROL is an electrohydraulic
suspension with variable damping for improved
driving comfort. The all-round level control sys‐
tem ensures the best possible suspension and
constant ground clearance, even with a laden
vehicle. When driving at speed, the vehicle is
lowered automatically to improve driving safety
and to reduce fuel consumption. The suspension
tuning is adjusted depending on the road sur‐
face, vehicle load and the drive program selec‐
ted. The ROAD SURFACE SCAN function detects
areas of unevenness in the road before you drive
over them by means of a multifunction camera.
This reduces chassis movements. The option of
manually adjusting the vehicle level is also avail‐
able.
The damping is adjusted individually to each
wheel and depends on:
R
The driving style, e.g. sporty
R
The road surface condition, e.g. bumps
R
The individual selection of "Sport", "Com‐
fort", "CURVE" or "Economy"
MAGIC BODY CONTROL comprises:
R
Active Body Control ABC
R
ROAD SURFACE SCAN
R
Curve inclination function CURVE
R
Automatic level control system
R
Automatic vehicle stabilization in the event of
sidewinds
R
Speed-dependent lowering to reduce fuel
consumption
R
Manual level adjustment
R
DYNAMIC SELECT switch and level button
214
Driving and parking
Available suspension settings
Drive programCharacteristics
S
(Sport)
R
The suspension tuning is firmer.
R
When driving at speeds between 40 mph (65 km/h) and 87 mph (140 km/h), the vehicle is lowered steadily by
a further 0.6 in (15 mm) and remains at this level up to the maximum vehicle speed.
R
When returning to speeds between 87 mph (140 km/h) and 40 mph (65 km/h), the vehicle is raised again by
0.6 in (15 mm).
R
ROAD SURFACE SCAN is deactivated.
C
(Comfort)
R
The suspension tuning is comfortable.
R
The vehicle is set to the normal level.
R
ROAD SURFACE SCAN is active.
CV
(Curve)
R
The suspension tuning is comfortable.
R
The vehicle is set to the normal level.
R
The curve inclination function is active.
R
ROAD SURFACE SCAN is active.
E
(Economy)
R
The suspension tuning is comfortable.
R
The vehicle is set to the normal level.
R
ROAD SURFACE SCAN is deactivated.
Driving and parking
215
Crosswind Assist
The crosswind stabilization:
R
Operates by changing wheel loads through
adjusting the ABC spring struts.
R
Reduces disruptions when driving straight
ahead.
R
Supports countersteering.
R
Is active in the speed range between 50 mph
(80 km/h) and 130 mph (210 km/h) when
driving straight ahead or cornering gently.
ROAD SURFACE SCAN
%
This function is not available in all countries.
ROAD SURFACE SCAN:
R
Monitors the road in front of the vehicle
using multifunction camera 1.
R
Is active when drive program Comfort or
CURVE is selected.
R
Detects unevenness in the road surface, e.g.
bumps, before the vehicle drives over them.
R
Reduces chassis movements.
System limitations
ROAD SURFACE SCAN can be impaired in the
following situations or can stop functioning:
R
If the road is insufficiently lit, e.g. at night.
R
In snow, rain, fog, heavy spray, if there is
glare, in direct sunlight or in greatly varying
ambient light.
R
If the windshield in the area of multifunction
camera 1 is dirty, fogged up, damaged or
covered.
R
If the road surface has no optic structure or
reflects light.
R
If the distance to the vehicle in front is too
short.
R
If sections of the route have a very small
radius of curvature.
R
In dynamic driving maneuver, e.g. if you
accelerate or brake the vehicle sharply.
R
At speeds below 5 mph (7 km/h) or above
112 mph (180 km/h).
R
If the vehicle is at a raised level or in drive
program Sport.
216
Driving and parking
Observe the notes on cleaning the multifunction
camera (
page 389).
Setting the vehicle level
&
WARNING Risk of entrapment from vehi‐
cle lowering
When lowering the vehicle, people could
become trapped if their limbs are between
the vehicle body and the tires or underneath
the vehicle.
#
Make sure no one is underneath the
vehicle or in the immediate vicinity of
the wheel arches when you lower the
vehicle.
&
WARNING Risk of entrapment from vehi‐
cle lowering
Vehicles with AIR BODY CONTROL or
level control system: When you unload lug‐
gage or leave the vehicle, the vehicle first
rises slightly and then returns to the set level
shortly afterwards.
You or anyone else in the vicinity of the
wheel arches or the underbody could thus
become trapped.
The vehicle can also be lowered after being
locked.
#
When leaving the vehicle, make sure
that nobody is in the vicinity of the
wheel arches or the underbody.
Requirements:
R
The vehicle has been started.
R
The vehicle must not be moving faster than
75 mph (120 km/h).
R
Only when lowering the vehicle: when the
vehicle is stationary, all the doors have to be
closed.
Raising the vehicle
#
Press button 1.
Indicator lamp 2 lights up.
The vehicle is raised by 1.2 in (30 mm) com‐
pared to the normal level.
Your selection is saved.
Driving and parking
217
The vehicle is lowered again in the following sit‐
uations:
R
When driving faster than 75 mph
(120 km/h).
R
When driving between 50 mph (80 km/h)
and 75 mph (120 km/h) for approximately
three minutes.
R
After selecting a drive program using the
DYNAMIC SELECT switch.
The vehicle is adjusted to the height of the last
active drive program.
Lowering the vehicle
#
Press button 1.
Indicator lamp 2 goes out. The vehicle is
adjusted to the height of the last active drive
program.
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
Function of Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is an electronic
parking assistance system with ultrasound. It
monitors the area around your vehicle using six
sensors 1 in the front bumper and six sensors
in the rear bumper. Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
indicates visually and audibly the distance
between your vehicle and an object.
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is only an aid. It is
not a substitute for your attention to the sur‐
roundings. The responsibility for safe maneuver‐
ing and parking remains with you. Make sure
that there are no persons, animals or objects in
the maneuvering area while maneuvering and
parking in/exiting parking spaces.
In the standard setting, an intermittent warning
tone sounds from a distance of approximately
1.0 ft (0.3 m) to an obstacle. A continuous tone
sounds from a distance of approximately 0.7 ft
(0.2 m). You can set the warning tone in the mul‐
timedia system so that it will sound earlier at a
greater distance of approximately 3.3 ft (1.0 m)
(
page 221).
If Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is deactivated,
Active Parking Assist is unavailable.
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC display in the
multimedia system
If Active Parking Assist is
not ac
tivated and an
obstacle is detected in the path of the vehicle, a
pop-up window for Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
1 appears in the multimedia system at speeds
up to approximately 6 mph (10 km/h).
218
Driving and parking
Vehicles with Active Parking Assist without a 360°
Camera
Vehicles with Active Parking Assist and a 360°
Camera
System limitations
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC does not necessa‐
rily take into account the following obstacles:
R
Obstacles below the detection range, e.g.
persons, animals or objects.
R
Obstacles above the detection range, e.g.
overhanging loads, overhangs or loading
ramps of trucks.
The sensors must be free of dirt, ice and slush.
Otherwise, they may not function correctly.
Clean the sensors regularly, taking care not to
scratch or damage them.
Function of the passive side impact protec‐
tion
Passive side impact protection is an additional
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC function which
warns the driver about obstacles at the side of
the vehicle. A warning is issued when obstacles
are detected between the front and rear detec‐
tion range. In order for an object to be detected,
the sensors in the front or rear bumper must
detect the object while you are driving past it.
During the parking procedure or maneuvering,
objects are detected as the vehicle drives past.
If you steer in the direction of a detected obsta
cle and there is a risk of a lateral collision, a
warning is issued. The lateral segments light
up
oran
ge or red, depending on the distance to the
obstacle.
Segment color depending on distance
Color Lateral distance in cm
RedApprox. < 30
OrangeApprox. 30 - 60
In order for lateral front or rear segments to be
displayed, the vehicle must first travel a distance
of at least half of the vehicle length. Once the
vehicle has traveled the length of the vehicle, all
of the lateral front and rear segments can be dis‐
played.
Driving and parking
219
Vehicles without 360° Camera
1
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is only opera‐
tional in the front and rear
2
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is operational
and can also warn the driver about obstacles
at the side of the vehicle
3
Obstacles detected at the front right
(orange) and rear (red)
Vehicles with 360° Camera
1
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is only opera‐
tional in the front and rear
2
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is operational
and can also warn the driver about obstacles
at the side of the vehicle
3
Obstacles detected at the front right
(orange) and rear (red)
Saved obstacles are deleted in the following sit‐
uations, for example:
R
You switch off the vehicle
R
You open the doors
After the engine is restarted, obstacles must be
detected again, before a new warning can be
issued.
System limitations
The system limitations for Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC apply for passive side impact pro‐
tection.
The following objects are not detected, for exam‐
ple:
R
Pedestrians who approach the vehicle from
the side
R
Objects placed next to the vehicle
Deactivating/activating Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC
*
NOTE Risk of an accident from objects
at close range
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC may not detect
certain objects at close range.
#
When parking or maneuvering the vehi‐
cle, pay particular attention to any
objects which are above or below the
sensors, e.g. flower pots or drawbars.
220
Driving and parking
The vehicle or other objects could oth‐
erwise be damaged.
If indicator lamp 2 is not lit, Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC is active. If the indicator lamp is lit
and the é symbol appears in the multifunc‐
tion display, Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is not
active.
#
Press button 1 .
%
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is automatically
activated when the vehicle is started.
Adjusting the warning tones of Parking
Assist PARKTRONIC
Multimedia system:
,

.
k 
.


.
  
Adjusting the volume of the warning tones
#
Select   .
#
Set a value.
Adjusting the pitch of the warning tones
#
Select   .
Set a value.
Specifying the starting point for the warning
tones
You can specify whether the Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC warning tones should commence
when the vehicle is further away from an obsta
cle.
#
Select  .
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Activating/deactivating audio fadeout
You can specify whether the volume of a media
source in the multimedia system is to be
reduced when Parking Assist PARKTRONIC gives
an audible warning.
#
Select     .
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Driving and parking
221
Reversing camera
Function of the rear view camera
When you engage reverse gear, the image from
rear view camera 1 is shown in the multimedia
system. Dynamic guide lines show the path the
vehicle will take with the steering wheel in its
current position. This helps you to orientate
yourself and to avoid obstacles when backing
up.
The rear view camera is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the surroundings.
You are always responsible for safe maneuvering
and parking. Make sure that there are no per‐
sons, animals or objects in the maneuvering
area while maneuvering and parking in parking
spaces.
You can select from the following views:
R
Normal view
R
Wide-angle view
The area behind the vehicle is displayed as a
mirror image, as in the inside rearview mirror.
Camera views in the multimedia system
Normal view
1
Yellow lane marking the course the tires will
take at the current steering wheel angle
(dynamic)
2
Yellow guide line, vehicle width (driven sur‐
face) depending on the current steering
wheel angle (dynamic)
3
Red guide line at a distance of approximately
12 in (0.3 m) from the rear area
4
Orange warning display of Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC: obstacles are a medium dis‐
tance away (between approximately 1.0 ft
(0.3 m) and 2.0 ft (0.6 m))
222
Driving and parking
5
Red warning display of Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC: obstacles are very close
(approximately 1.0 ft (0.3 m) or less)
6
Yellow warning display of Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC: obstacles are at a distance of
between approximately 2.0 ft (0.6 m) and
3.3 ft (1.0 m)
%
If the entire system fails, the inner segments
of the warning display are shown in red. The
indicator lamp on the Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC button lights up and the é
symbol appears in the multifunction display.
If the system fails at the rear of the vehicle:
R
The rear segments are shown in red
when backing up.
R
The rear segments are hidden when driv‐
ing forwards.
When Active Parking Assist is active, the
lanes are displayed in green.
If Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is deactivated,
the warning display fades out.
Wide-angle view
System failure
If there is no operational readiness, the following
message appears in the multimedia system:
System limitations
The rear view camera will not function or will
only partially function in the following situations:
R
The trunk lid is open.
R
There is heavy rain, snow or fog.
R
The ambient light is poor, e.g. at night.
R
The camera lens is obstructed, dirty or fog‐
ged up. Observe the notes on cleaning the
rear view camera (
page 389).
R
The camera or rear of your vehicle is dam‐
aged. In this case, have the camera and its
position and setting checked at a qualified
specialist workshop.
The field of vision and other functions of the rear
view camera may be restricted due to additional
accessories on the rear of the vehicle (e.g.
license plate bracket or bicycle rack).
%
The contrast of the display may be impaired
by direct sunlight or by other light sources,
e.g. when driving out of a garage. In this
case, pay particular attention.
Driving and parking
223
%
Have the display repaired or replaced if, for
example, pixel errors considerably restrict its
use.
Observe the notes on cleaning the rear view
camera (
page 389).
360° camera
Function of the 360° Camera
The 360° Camera is a system that consists of
four cameras. The cameras cover the immediate
vehicle surroundings. The system assists you,
e.g. when parking or at exits with reduced visibil‐
ity.
The 360° Camera is only an aid. It is not a sub‐
stitute for your attention to the surroundings.
You are always responsible for safe maneuvering
and parking. Make sure that there are no per‐
sons, animals or objects in the maneuvering
area while maneuvering and parking in parking
spaces.
The system evaluates images from the following
cameras:
R
Rear view camera
R
Front camera
R
Two side cameras in the outside mirrors
Views of the 360° Camera
You can select from different views:
1
Wide-angle view, front
2
Top view with image from the front camera
3
Top view with images from the side cameras
in the outside mirrors
4
Wide-angle view, to the rear
5
Top view with image from the rear view cam‐
era
6
Top view with trailer view (if trailer hitch is
installed)
Top view
1
Lane indicating the route the vehicle will
take with the steering wheel in its current
position
2
Yellow warning display of Parking Assist
PARKTRONIC: obstacles at a distance of
approximately 3.3 ft (1.0 m) or less
3
Your vehicle from above
If the distance to the object lessens, the color of
the warning display changes 2. From a dis‐
tance of approximately 2.0 ft (0.6 m) the warn
ing display is shown in orange. From a distance
of approximately 1.0 ft (0.3 m) the warning dis‐
play is shown in red.
224
Driving and parking
When Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is operational
and no object is detected, the segments of the
warning display are shown in gray.
%
If the entire system fails, the segments of
the warning display are shown in red. The
indicator lamp on the PARKTRONIC button
lights up and the é symbol appears in
the multifunction display.
If the system fails at the rear of the vehicle:
R
The rear segments are shown in red
when backing up.
R
The rear segments are hidden when driv‐
ing forwards.
If Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is deactivated,
the warning display fades out.
Guide lines
1
Yellow lane marking the course the tires will
take at the current steering wheel angle
(dynamic)
2
Yellow guide line, vehicle width (driven sur‐
face) depending on the current steering
wheel angle (dynamic)
3
Red guide line at a distance of approximately
12 in (0.3 m) from the rear area
4
Mark at a distance of approx. 3.3 ft (1.0 m)
%
When Active Parking Assist is active, the
lanes are displayed in green.
The guide lines in the multimedia system dis‐
play show the distances to your vehicle. The
distances only apply to road level.
Side view of the mirror cameras
The sides of the vehicle can be seen in this view.
1
Guide line of external vehicle dimensions
with outside mirrors folded out
2
Marker of the wheel contact points
System limitations
The 360° Camera will not function or will only
partially function in the following situations:
R
If the doors are open.
Driving and parking
225
R
The side mirrors are folded in.
R
If the trunk lid or tailgate is open.
R
There is heavy rain, snow or fog.
R
The ambient light is poor, e.g. at night.
R
The camera lens is obstructed, dirty or fog‐
ged up.
R
Cameras, or vehicle components in which
the cameras are installed, are damaged. In
this event, have the cameras, their positions
and their setting checked at a qualified spe‐
cialist workshop.
Do not use the 360° Camera under such circum‐
stances. You could otherwise injure others or
collide with objects when parking the vehicle.
On vehicles with height-adjustable suspension or
if the vehicle is carrying a heavy load, leaving the
standard height can result in inaccuracies in the
guide lines and in the display of the generated
images, depending on technical conditions.
The field of vision and other functions of the
camera system may be restricted due to addi‐
tional accessories (e.g. license plate bracket,
bicycle rack).
See the notes on cleaning the 360° Camera
(
page 389).
Selecting a view for the 360° Camera
Requirements:
R
The     function is selec‐
ted in the multimedia system.
#
Engage reverse gear.
#
In the multimedia system, select the desired
view.
Opening the camera cover of the rear view
camera
Multimedia system:
,

.
k 
.


#
Select   .
%
The camera cover closes automatically after
some time or after an ignition cycle.
Assigning the camera as a favorite
You can call up the camera view directly in the
multimedia system by assigning it as a favorite.
#
Press the ò button on the touchpad or
controller.
The main functions are displayed.
#
Navigate downwards twice.
The Favorites menu appears.
#
Select  .
#
Select .
#
Select .
Active Parking Assist
Function of Active Parking Assist
Active Parking Assist is an electronic parking
assistance system which uses ultrasound and is
automatically activated during forward travel.
The system is operational at speeds of up to
approximately 22 mph (35 km/h). When all the
conditions are fulfilled, the c symbol appears
in the multifunction display and the system auto‐
matically searches for and measures parking
spaces on both sides of the vehicle parallel and
perpendicular to the direction of travel. If Active
Parking Assist is activated, suitable parking
spaces are displayed in the multimedia system.
226
Driving and parking
The ë symbol appears in the multifunction
display. The arrows show on which side of the
road free parking spaces are located.
The parking space and, if necessary, the parking
direction can be selected as desired. Active
Parking Assist calculates a suitable vehicle path
and assists you in parking and exiting the park‐
ing space.
Active Parking Assist changes gear, accelerates,
brakes and steers the vehicle.
Active Parking Assist is only an aid. It is not a
substitute for your attention to the surroundings.
The responsibility for safe maneuvering and
parking remains with you. Make sure that no
persons, animals or objects etc. are in the
maneuvering range.
Active Parking Assist is canceled if, among other
things, one of the following actions is carried
out:
R
You deactivate Parking Assist PARKTRONIC.
R
You deactivate Active Parking Assist.
R
You begin steering.
R
You apply the parking brake.
R
You engage transmission position j.
R
ESP
®
intervenes.
R
You open the trunk lid.
System limitations
Objects located above or below the detection
range of Active Parking Assist are not detected
when the parking space is being measured.
These are also no
t taken i
nto account when the
parking maneuver is calculated, e.g. overhanging
loads, overhangs or loading ramps of trucks or
the boundaries of parking spaces. In some cir‐
cumstances, Active Parking Assist may therefore
guide you into the parking space prematurely.
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to
objects located above or below the
detection range of Active Parking Assist
If there are objects above or below the
detection range, the following situations may
arise:
R
Active Parking Assist may steer too early.
R
Vehicles with automatic transmis‐
sion: The vehicle may not stop in front of
these objects.
This could cause a collision.
#
In these situations, do not use Active
Parking Assist.
Snowfall or heavy rain may lead to a parking
space being measured inaccurately. Parking
spaces that are partially occupied by trailer
drawbars might not be identified as such or be
measured incorrectly. Only use Active Parking
Assist on level, high-grip ground.
Do not use Active Parking Assist in the following
situations:
R
In extreme weather conditions such as ice,
packed snow or in heavy rain.
R
If you are transporting a load that protrudes
beyond the vehicle.
R
If the parking space is on a steep downhill or
uphill gradient.
R
If you have installed snow chains.
Driving and parking
227
Active Parking Assist may also display parking
spaces that are not suitable for parking, e.g.:
R
Parking spaces where parking is prohibited.
R
Parking spaces on unsuitable surfaces.
Active Parking Assist will not assist you with
parking spaces at right angles to the direction of
travel in the following situations:
R
If two parking spaces are located immedi‐
ately next to each other.
R
If the parking space is directly next to a low
obstacle such as a curb.
Active Parking Assist will not assist you with
parking spaces at right angles to the direction of
travel in the following situations:
R
If the parking space is on a curb.
R
If the parking space is bordered by an obsta
cle, e.g. a tree, a post or a trailer.
Parking with Active Parking Assist
#
Press button 1.
The Active Parking Assist view appears on
the multimedia system display. Area 2 dis‐
plays detected parking spaces 4 and vehi‐
cle path 3.
%
Vehicle path 3 shown on the multimedia
system display may differ from the actual
vehicle path.
#
If you have driven past a suitable parking
space: bring the vehicle to a standstill.
#
Select desired parking space 4.
#
Where necessary, select the parking direc‐
tion: forwards or reverse.
Vehicle path 3 is shown, depending on the
selected parking space and parking direc‐
tion.
#
Confirm the selected parking space.
228
Driving and parking
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to vehi‐
cle swinging out while parking or pulling
out of a parking space
While parking or exiting a parking space, the
vehicle swings out and can drive onto areas
of the oncoming lane.
This could cause you to collide with objects
or other road users.
#
Pay attention to objects and other road
users.
#
Where necessary, stop the vehicle or
cancel the parking procedure with
Active Parking Assist.
#
If, for example, the   
message appears in the multimedia system
display: select the corresponding transmis‐
sion position.
The vehicle drives into the selected parking
space.
On completion of the parking procedure, the
      
display message appears. Further maneuvering
may still be necessary.
#
After completion of the parking procedure,
safeguard the vehicle against rolling away.
When required by legal requirements or local
conditions: turn the wheels towards the curb.
%
You can stop the vehicle and change the
transmission position during the parking pro‐
cedure. The system then calculates a new
vehicle path. The parking procedure can
then be continued. If no new vehicle path is
available, the transmission position will be
changed again. If the vehicle has not yet
reached the parking space, the parking pro‐
cedure will be canceled, should a gear be
changed.
Exiting a parking space with Active Parking
Assist
Requirement:
You can only exit a parking space with Active
Parking Assist if you have previously parked the
vehicle with Active Parking Assist.
Please note that you are responsible for the vehi‐
cle and surroundings during the entire parking
procedure.
#
Start the vehicle.
#
Press button 1.
The Active Parking Assist view appears on
the multimedia system display.
Driving and parking
229
#
If the vehicle has been parked at right angles
to the direction of travel: in area 2, select
direction of travel 3.
%
The vehicle path shown on the multimedia
system display may differ from the actual
vehicle path.
#
Confirm direction of exit 3 to drive out of
the parking space.
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to vehi‐
cle swinging out while parking or pulling
out of a parking space
While parking or exiting a parking space, the
vehicle swings out and can drive onto areas
of the oncoming lane.
This could cause you to collide with objects
or other road users.
#
Pay attention to objects and other road
users.
#
Where necessary, stop the vehicle or
cancel the parking procedure with
Active Parking Assist.
#
If, for example, the   
message appears in the multimedia system
display: select the corresponding transmis‐
sion position.
The vehicle moves out of the parking space.
Example: vehicles with 360° Camera
After the exiting procedure has been completed,
the      
 message appears in the display of the
multimedia system. A warning tone and the dis‐
play 4 in the multimedia system prompt you to
take over. You have to accelerate, brake, steer
and change gear yourself again.
Function of Drive Away Assist
Drive Away Assist can reduce the severity of an
impact when pulling away. If an obstacle is
detected in the direction of travel, the vehicle's
speed is briefly reduced to approx. 1 mph
(2 km/h). If a critical situation is detected, a
230
Driving and parking
symbol appears on the camera image of the mul‐
timedia system.
&
WARNING Risk of accident caused by
limited detection performance of Drive
Away Assist
Drive Away Assist cannot always clearly iden‐
tify objects and traffic situations.
In such cases, Drive Away Assist might:
R
Warn you without reason and limit the
vehicle speed.
R
Not warn you or not limit the vehicle
speed.
#
Always pay careful attention to the traf‐
fic situation; do not rely on Drive Away
Assist alone.
#
Be prepared to brake or swerve as nec‐
essary, provided the traffic situation
permits and that it is safe to take eva‐
sive action.
Drive Away Assist is only an aid. It is not a sub‐
stitute for your attention to the surroundings.
You are always responsible for safe maneuver‐
ing, parking and exiting a parking space. Make
sure that no persons, animals or objects etc. are
in the maneuvering range.
A risk of a collision may arise in the following sit‐
uations, for example:
R
If the driver mixes up the accelerator and
brake pedals.
R
If the wrong gear is selected.
The Drive Away Assist function is active under
the following conditions:
R
If Parking Assist PARKTRONIC is activated.
R
Every time the gear is changed to k or h
when the vehicle is at a standstill.
R
If the detected obstacle is less than approx.
3.3 ft (1.0 m) away.
R
If the maneuvering assistance function is
activated in the multimedia system.
System limitations
Drive Away Assist is not available on inclines.
Function of Cross Traffic Alert
%
Also read the instructions on Blind Spot
Assist (
page 238).
Vehicles with Blind Spot Assist: Drivers can
also be warned of any crossing traffic when
backing up out of a parking space. If a critical
situation is detected, a warning symbol appears
on the camera image of the multimedia syst
em.
If the driver does n
ot respond to the warning,
the vehicle's brakes can be applied automati‐
cally. To do this, the function uses the radar sen‐
sors in the bumper. The area adjacent to the
vehicle is continually monitored.
If the radar sensors are obstructed by vehicles
or other objects, detection is not possible.
The Cross Traffic Alert function is active under
the following conditions:
R
If Blind Spot Assist is activated.
R
If the vehicle is backing up at walking pace.
R
If the maneuvering assistance function is
activated in the multimedia system.
The Cross Traffic Alert function is not available
on inclines.
Driving and parking
231
Deactivating/activating maneuvering assis‐
tance
Multimedia system:
,

.
k 
.


.
 
#
Switch the function on O or off ª.
ATTENTION ASSIST
Function of ATTENTION ASSIST
ATTENTION ASSIST assists you on long, monoto‐
nous journeys, e.g. on freeways and trunk roads.
If ATTENTION ASSIST detects indicators of fati‐
gue or increasing lapses in concentration on the
part of the driver, it suggests taking a break.
ATTENTION ASSIST is only an aid. It cannot
always detect fatigue or lapses in concentration
until too late. The system is not a substitute for a
well-rested and attentive driver. On long jour‐
neys, take regular breaks in good time that allow
for adequate recuperation.
You can choose between two settings.
R
Standard: normal system sensitivity.
R
Sensitive: higher system sensitivity. The
driver is warned earlier and the attention
level detected by ATTENTION ASSIST is adap‐
ted accordingly.
If drowsiness or increasing lapses in concentra‐
tion are detected, the   
 warning appears in the Instrument Dis‐
play. You can acknowledge the message and
take a break where necessary. If you do not take
a break and ATTENTION ASSIST continues to
detect increasing lapses in concentration, you
will be warned again after a minimum of
15 minutes.
You can have the following status information for
ATTENTION ASSIST displayed in the assistance
menu of the on-board computer:
R
The length of the journey since the last
break.
R
The attention level determined by ATTENTION
ASSIST.
If ATTENTION ASSIST is unable to calculate the
attention level and cannot issue a warning, the
  message appears.
If a warning is given in the Instrument Display,
the multimedia system offers to search for a rest
area. You can select a rest area and start naviga‐
tion to this rest area. This function can be activa‐
ted and deactivated in the multimedia system.
If ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated, the é
symbol appears in the assistance graphic in the
Instrument Display when the engine is running.
ATTENTION ASSIST is activated automatically
when the engine is re-started. The last selected
sensitivity level remains stored.
232
Driving and parking
System limitations
ATTENTION ASSIST is active in the 37 mph
(60 km/h) to 124 mph (200 km/h) speed range.
The functionality of ATTENTION ASSIST is
restricted, and warnings may be delayed or not
occur at all in the following situations:
R
If you have been driving for less than 30
minutes.
R
If the road condition is poor (uneven road
surface or potholes).
R
If there is a strong side wind.
R
If you adopt a sporty driving style (high cor‐
nering speeds or high rates of acceleration).
R
If the Steering Assist function of Active Dis‐
tance Assist DISTRONIC is active.
R
If the time has been set incorrectly.
R
In active driving situations, if you change
lanes and vary your speed frequently.
The ATTENTION ASSIST tiredness or alertness
assessment is deleted and restarted when con‐
tinuing the journey in the following situations:
R
If you switch off the engine.
R
If you unfasten your seat belt and open the
driver's door (e.g. change drivers or take a
break).
Setting ATTENTION ASSIST
Multimedia system:
,

.
k 
.

 
Setting options
#
Select ,  or .
Suggesting a rest area
#
Select   .
#
Activate O or deactivate the function ª.
If ATTENTION ASSIST detects fatigue or
increasing lack of attention, it suggests a
rest area in the vicinity.
#
Selecting a suggested rest area.
You are guided to the selected rest area.
Traffic Sign Assist
Function of Traffic Sign Assist
Traffic Sign Assist detects traffic signs with mul‐
tifunction camera 1 and assists you by display‐
ing detected speed limits and overtaking restric‐
tions in the instrument cluster. The camera also
detects traffic signs with a restriction indicated
by an additional sign (e.g. in wet conditions).
Driving and parking
233
Warning when the maximum permissible
speed is exceeded
The system can warn you if you unintentionally
exceed the maximum permissible speed. To do
this, you can specify in the multimedia system
by how much the maximum permissible speed
can be exceeded before a warning is issued. You
can specify whether the warning is to be just a
visual warning or an acoustic one as well. If the
automatic speed acceptance for Active Distance
Assist DISTRONIC is activated, the warnings are
suppressed.
Display in the Instrument Display
1
Permissible speed
2
Permissible speed when there is a restriction
3
Additional sign with restriction
%
Display of speed restriction signs has priority
over other recognized traffic signs, e.g. over‐
taking restriction signs.
Since Traffic Sign Assist also uses the data
stored in the navigation system, it can update
the display in the following situations without
detecting traffic signs:
R
When the vehicle changes roads, e.g. free‐
way exit or slip road.
R
When a village or city boundary is passed
which is stored in the digital map.
Traffic Sign Assist is not available in all coun‐
tries. If it is unavailable, display 1 is shown in
the speedometer.
System limitations
The system may be impaired or may not function
in the following situations:
R
There is poor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient
illumination of the road, highly variable shade
conditions, or due to rain, snow, fog or heavy
spray.
234
Driving and parking
R
If there is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic,
direct sunlight or reflections.
R
There is dirt on the windshield in the vicinity
of the multifunction camera or the camera is
fogged up, damaged or obscured.
R
If the traffic signs are hard to detect, e.g. due
to dirt or snow, or because they are covered
or due to insufficient lighting.
R
If the information in the navigation system's
digital map is incorrect or out-of-date.
R
If the signs are ambiguous, e.g. traffic signs
on construction sites or in adjacent lanes.
Setting Traffic Sign Assist
Multimedia system:
,

.
k 
.

 
Activating /deactivating automatic adoption
of speed limits
Requirements:
R
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is activa
ted.
#
Select  .
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
The speed limits detected by Traffic Sign
Assist are automatically adopted by Active
Distance Assist DISTRONIC.
Displaying detected traffic signs in the
media display
#
Select   .
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Activating/deactivating the warning when a
speed limit is exceeded
The point at which a warning is given once a
speed is exceeded (warning threshold) can be
set according to individual preferences.
#
Select   .
#
Select  ,  or .
Setting the speed
#
Select  .
#
Set the desired speed.
Night View Assist
Function of Night View Assist
With the aid of camera 2, Night View Assist
helps you to recognize the course of the road or
obstacles in the dark. The multifunction display
then shows a monochrome image of the sur‐
rounding area in front of the vehicle. Infrared
Driving and parking
235
camera 1 helps detect pedestrians and ani‐
mals.
%
As infrared light is not visible to the human
eye, Night View Assist can remain activated
when there is oncoming traffic.
The infrared headlamps switch on in the
dark from speeds of approximately 5 mph
(10 km/h). This means that, while station‐
ary, you do not have the full visual range and
cannot check whether Night View Assist is
working.
System limitations
Night View Assist cannot display objects directly
in front of or directly next to the vehicle. It may
be the case that objects are highlighted as well
as pedestrians or animals.
The system may be impaired or may not function
in the following instances:
R
Poor visibility, e.g. snow, rain, fog or spray.
R
The windshield is dirty in the vicinity of the
camera.
R
The camera is fogged up, damaged or cov‐
ered.
R
The infrared camera in the radiator grill is
damaged, dirty, fogged up or covered.
R
On bends, on hilltops or in dips.
R
At high ambient temperatures.
Pedestrian and animal detection by Night
View Assist
Night View Assist can detect pedestrians using
typical characteristics, e.g. the body contours
and posture of a person standing upright.
Large animals, such as deer, cows or horses can
also be
detecte
d. Small animals such as dogs or
cats are not detected.
Pedestrian and animal detection is automatically
switched on when the following requirements
are fulfilled:
R
Night View Assist is activated.
R
The driving speed is at least 5 mph
(10 km/h).
R
It is dark.
1
Night View Assist display
2
Standby symbol for active pedestrian detec‐
tion
3
Highlighting
4
Pedestrian detected
If pedestrian detection is active, standby symbol
2 appears. There is no separate symbol for ani‐
mals. Detected pedestrians or animals are high‐
lighted by a color frame.
Activating or deactivating Night View Assist
Requirements:
R
The vehicle has been started or the ignition
is switched on.
236
Driving and parking
R
The light switch is in the à or L posi‐
tion.
R
Reverse gear has not been engaged.
#
Press button 1.
The appropriate Night View Assist display
appears in the multifunction display.
%
The infrared headlamps are deactivated at
speeds below 3 mph (5 km/h). The Night
View image continues to be displayed until
you switch it off by pressing button 1.
Switching automatic activation on/off
Requirements:
R
Pedestrian detection is active ( page 236).
R
The carriageway is not lit.
R
The speed is at least 37 mph (60 km/h).
If all the requirements are fulfilled, the night
vision image is automatically shown in the multi‐
function display as soon as people or animals
are detected.
Multimedia system:
,

.
k 
.

  
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Spotlight function
The spotlight function is an additional function
for Night View Assist. It runs in the background
and flashes the headlamps at detected persons
with four short impulses. This attracts the driv‐
er's attention to approaching pedestrians.
Display in the assistance graphic
1
Spotlight function switched on but not oper‐
ating
2
Spotlight function switched on and operating
The pedestrian symbol in the assistance graphic
indicates the status of the spotlight function. If
the pedestrian symbol is displayed dark 1, the
function is switched on. If the symbol is dis‐
Driving and parking
237
played bright 2, the conditions for the Spotlight
function are also fulfilled.
System limitations
The spotlight function does not flash at animals.
The spotlight function is not active or is active
only to a limited extent if:
R
You are driving in city traffic.
R
The pedestrians are located in the area of an
oncoming vehicle or a vehicle in front.
Activating/deactivating the spotlight func‐
tion
Requirements:
R
Pedestrian detection is active ( page 236).
R
The carriageway is not lit.
R
The speed is at least 37 mph (60 km/h).
R
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Plus is switched
on.
If all the requirements are fulfilled, the headlamp
flashes four short pulses at a pedestrian detec‐
ted on or near to the road.
Multimedia system:
,

.
÷
.
 

.

#
Switch the function on O or off ª.
Blind Spot Assist and Active Blind Spot
Assist
Function of Blind Spot Assist and Active
Blind Spot Assist
Blind Spot Assist uses two lateral, rear-facing
radar sensors to monitor the area up to 130 ft
(40 m) behind your vehicle and 10 ft (3 m)
directly next to your vehicle.
If a vehicle is detected at speeds above approx
imately 8 mph (12 km/h) and this vehicle subse‐
quently enters the monitoring range directly next
to your vehicle, the warning lamp in the outside
mirror lights up red.
If a vehicle is detected close to your vehicle in
the lateral monitoring range and you switch on
the turn signal indicator in the corresponding
direction, a warning tone sounds once. The red
warning lamp in the outside mirror flashes. If the
turn signal indicator remains on, all other detec‐
ted vehicles are indicated only by the flashing of
the red warning lamp.
If you overtake a vehicle quickly, no warning is
given.
&
WARNING Risk of accident despite Blind
Spot Assist
Blind Spot Assist does not react to vehicles
approaching and overtaking you at a greatly
different speed.
As a result, Blind Spot Assist cannot warn
drivers in this situation.
#
Always pay careful attention to the traf‐
fic situation and maintain a safe dis‐
tance at the side of the vehicle.
Blind Spot Assist and Active Blind Spot Assist
are only aids. They may fail to detect some vehi‐
cles and are no substitute for attentive driving.
Always ensure that there is sufficient distance to
the side for other road users and obstacles.
238
Driving and parking
System limitations
The detection capability of Blind Spot Assist can
be restricted in the following situations:
R
There is dirt on the sensors or the sensors
are obscured.
R
When there is poor visibility, e.g. due to fog,
heavy rain, snow or spray.
R
If narrow vehicles are within the monitoring
range, e.g. bicycles.
Warnings may be issued in error when driving
close to crash barriers or similar solid lane bor‐
ders. Warnings may be interrupted when driving
alongside long vehicles, for example trucks, for a
prolonged time.
Blind Spot Assist is not operational when reverse
gear is engaged.
Function of braking applications (Active
Blind Spot Assist)
If Active Blind Spot Assist detects a risk of a side
impact in the monitoring range, a course-cor‐
recting brake application is carried out. This is
designed to help you avoid a collision.
The course-correcting brake application is availa‐
ble in the speed range between approximately
20 mph (30 km/h) and 125 mph (200 km/h).
&
WARNING Risk of accident despite
brake application of Active Blind Spot
Assist
A course-correcting brake application cannot
always prevent a collision.
#
Always steer, brake or accelerate your‐
self, especially if Active Blind Spot
Assist warns you or makes a course-
correcting brake application.
#
Always maintain a safe distance at the
sides.
&
WARNING Risk of accident despite
Active Blind Spot Assist
Active Blind Spot Assist does not react to the
following:
R
Overtaking vehicles closely on the side,
placing them in the blind spot area.
R
Vehicles approaching and overtaking you
at a very different speed.
As a result, Active Blind Spot Assist may nei‐
ther give warnings nor intervene in such sit‐
uations.
#
Always pay careful attention to the traf‐
fic situation and maintain a safe dis‐
tance at the side of the vehicle.
Active Blind Spot Assist is only an aid. It may fail
to detect some vehicles and is not a substitute
for attentive driving. Always ensure that there is
sufficient distance to the side for other road
users and obstacles.
Driving and parking
239
If a course-correcting brake application occurs,
the red warning lamp flashes in the outside mir‐
ror and a warning tone sounds. In addition, a dis‐
play 1 indicating the danger of a side collision
appears in the multifunction display.
In rare cases, the system may make an inappro‐
priate brake application. This brake application
may be interrupted at any time if you steer
slightly in the opposite direction or accelerate.
System limitations
Either a course-correcting brake application
appropriate to the driving situation, or none at
all, may occur in the following situations:
R
Vehicles or obstacles, e.g. crash barriers, are
located on both sides of your vehicle.
R
A vehicle approaches too closely on the side.
R
You have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds.
R
You brake or accelerate significantly.
R
A driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP
®
or Active Brake Assist.
R
ESP
®
is deactivated.
R
A loss of tire pressure or a defective tire is
detected.
Activating or deactivating Blind Spot Assist
or Active Blind Spot Assist
Multimedia system:
,

.
k 
.

 
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Active Lane Keeping Assist
Function of Active Lane Keeping Assist
Active Lane Keeping Assist monitors the area in
front of your vehicle by means of multifunction
camera 1.
240
Driving and parking
You are warned by vibration pulses in the steer‐
ing wheel in the following circumstances:
R
Active Lane Keeping Assist detects lane
markings.
R
A front wheel passes over the lane markings.
Whether a warning is issued and when this
occurs also depends on the selected sensitivity
setting (standard or adaptive).
If you fail to adapt your driving style, Active Lane
Keeping Assist can neither reduce the risk of an
accident nor override the laws of physics. It can‐
not take into account road, weather or traffic
conditions. Active Lane Keeping Assist is only an
aid. You are responsible for the distance to the
vehicle in front, for vehicle speed, for braking in
good time and for staying in lane.
Vehicles with Lane Tracking package: If the
lane markings are solid lines and you do not
react to the warning, a lane-correcting brake
application can bring the vehicle back into the
original lane.
Vehicles with Driving Assistance package or
Driving Assistance Plus package: If you do not
react to the warning, a lane-correcting brake
application can bring the vehicle back into the
original lane. In the case of a broken lane mark‐
ing being detected, a brake application will only
be made if a vehicle has been dete
cte
d in the
adjacent lane. Oncoming vehicles, overtaking
vehicles and vehicles in adjacent lanes can be
detected.
The brake application is available in the speed
range between 40 mph (60 km/h) and 120 mph
(200 km/h).
If a lane-correcting brake application occurs, dis‐
play 1 appears in the multifunction display.
System limitations
No lane-correcting brake application occurs in
the following situations:
R
You clearly and actively steer, brake or accel‐
erate.
R
You have switched on the turn signal indica‐
tor.
R
A driving safety system intervenes, such as
ESP
®
, Active Brake Assist or Active Blind
Spot Assist.
R
You have adopted a sporty driving style with
high cornering speeds or high rates of accel‐
eration.
R
ESP
®
is deactivated.
R
If a loss of tire pressure or a defective tire
has been detected and displayed.
The system may be impaired or may not function
in the following situations:
R
There is poor visibility, e.g. due to insufficient
illumination of the road, highly variable shade
conditions, or due to rain, snow, fog or heavy
spray.
Driving and parking
241
R
There is glare, e.g. from oncoming traffic, the
sun or reflections.
R
There is dirt on the windshield in the vicinity
of the multifunction camera or the camera is
fogged up, damaged or obscured.
R
No or several, unclear lane markings are
present for one lane, e.g. in a construction
area.
R
The lane markings are worn, dark or covered.
R
The distance to the vehicle in front is too
small and the lane markings thus cannot be
detected.
R
The lane markings change quickly, e.g. lanes
branch off, cross one another or merge.
R
The road is very narrow and winding.
Vehicles with Driving Assistance package or
Driving Assistance Plus package: Active Lane
Keeping Assist uses radar sensors to monitor
several areas around the vehicle. If the radar
sensors in the rear bumper are dirty or covered
with snow, the system may be impaired or may
not function. If an obstacle in the lane in which
you are driving has been detected, no lane-cor‐
recting brake application occurs.
Activating Active Lane Keeping Assist
&
WARNING Risk of accident despite
Active Lane Keeping Assist warning
A lane-correcting brake application cannot
always bring the vehicle back into the origi‐
nal lane.
#
Always steer, brake or accelerate your‐
self, especially if Active Lane Keeping
Assist warns you or makes a lane-cor‐
recting brake application.
&
WARNING Risk of accident despite inter‐
vention of Active Lane Keeping Assist
Active Lane Keeping Assist does not detect
traffic conditions or road users. In very rare
cases, the system may make an inappropri‐
ate brake application, e.g. after intentionally
driving over a solid lane marking.
The brake application can be interrupted at
any time if you steer slightly in the opposite
direction.
#
Always make sure that there is suffi
cient distance to the side for other traf‐
fic or obstacles.
&
WARNING Risk of accident despite Lane
Keeping Assist
Lane Keeping Assist cannot always clearly
detect lane markings.
In such cases, Lane Keeping Assist can:
R
give an unnecessary warning
R
not give a warning
#
Always pay particular attention to the
traffic situation and keep within the
lane, especially if Active Lane Keeping
Assist alerts you.
Requirement:
The driving speed is at least 40 mph (60 km/h).
242
Driving and parking
#
Press button 2.
If indicator lamp 1 lights up, Lane Keeping
Assist is activated. When lane markings are
detected, the lines in the assistance graphic
are shown in white.
Sensitivity of Active Lane Keeping Assist
With the standard or adaptive setting, you can
influence when the warning vibration of Lane
Keeping Assist takes place.
In both the standard and adaptive settings, no
warning vibration occurs in the following situa‐
tions:
R
You have switched on the turn signal indica‐
tor.
R
A driving safety system intervenes, such as
ABS, BAS or ESP
®
.
In the adaptive setting, there will also be no
warning vibration in the following situations:
R
The vehicle is accelerated or braked consid‐
erably.
R
You steer actively, e.g. swerve to avoid an
obstacle or change lane quickly.
R
You cut the corner on a sharp bend.
Setting the sensitivity of Active Lane Keep‐
ing Assist
Multimedia system:
,

.
k 
.

  
#
Select a setting.
Driving and parking
243
Instrument Display overview
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to an
instrument display malfunction
If the instrument display has failed or mal‐
functioned, you cannot recognize function
restrictions applying to safety relevant sys‐
tems.
The operating safety of your vehicle may be
impaired.
#
Drive on carefully.
#
Have the vehicle checked immediately
at a qualified specialist workshop.
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. Otherwise, you may not recog‐
nize dangers.
Plug-in hybrid: observe the notes in the Supple‐
ment. Otherwise, you may not recognize dan‐
gers.
If the operating safety of your vehicle is
impaired, park the vehicle safely as soon as pos‐
sible. Contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Instrument display
1
Speedometer
2
Multifunction display
3
Tachometer
4
Coolant temperature gauge
5
Fuel level and fuel filler flap location indica‐
tor
%
This display is an example. Instead of tach
ometer 3 other displays are also possible.
The segments in speedometer 1 indicate the
system status for the following:
R
Cruise control ( page 196)
R
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
(
page 199)
Vehicles with Traffic Sign Assist: detected
instructions and traffic signs appear in the
speedometer (
page 233).
*
NOTE Engine damage due to excessively
high engine speeds
The engine will be damaged if you drive with
the engine in the overrevving range.
#
Do not drive with the engine in the over‐
revving range.
In tachometer 3 the overrevving range is
shown in red. When the overrevving range is
reached, the fuel supply is interrupted to protect
the engine.
During normal operating conditions, coolant
temperature display 4 may rise to 248°F
(120°C).
244
Instrument Display and on-board computer
&
WARNING Danger of burns when open‐
ing the hood
If you open the hood when the engine has
overheated or during a fire in the engine
compartment, you could come into contact
with hot gases or other escaping operating
fluids.
#
Before opening the hood, allow the
engine to cool down.
#
In the event of a fire in the engine com‐
partment, keep the hood closed and
call the fire service.
Overview of the buttons on the steering
wheel
1
% Back button, left (on-board computer)
2
Touch Control, left (on-board computer)
3
Button group for cruise control or Active Dis‐
tance Assist DISTRONIC
4
Button group:
ó Voice Control System
ß Displays favorites (multimedia system)
VOL: Increases/decreases volume using the
8 control knob or switches off the sound
6 Makes/accepts a call
~ Rejects/ends a call
5
ò Main menu button (multimedia system)
6
Touch Control, right (multimedia system)
7
% Back button, right (multimedia system)
Operating the on-board computer
&
WARNING Risk of distraction from infor‐
mation systems and communications
equipment
If you operate information and communica‐
tion equipment integrated in the vehicle
when driving, you will be distracted from the
traffic situation. This could also cause you to
lose control of the vehicle.
#
Only operate this equipment when the
traffic situation permits.
#
If you cannot be sure of this, stop the
vehicle whilst paying attention to road
and traffic conditions and operate the
equipment with the vehicle stationary.
Instrument Display and on-board computer
245
You must observe the legal requirements for the
country in which you are currently driving when
operating the on-board computer.
%
The on-board computer displays appear in
the multifunction display (
page 247).
The on-board computer can be operated using
Touch Control 2 and back button 1 on the
left-hand side of the steering wheel.
The following menus are available:
R

R

R

R

R

R

R

R
 
R

The menus can be called up from the menu bar
in the multifunction display.
#
To call up the menu bar: press left back
button 1 repeatedly or press and hold once.
%
Vehicles without Active Distance Assist
DISTRONIC: press the ò button to call
up the menu bar of the on-board computer.
#
To scroll in the menu bar: swipe to the left
or right on Touch Control 2.
#
To call up the menu or confirm the selec‐
tion: press the left-hand side of Touch Con‐
trol 2.
#
To scroll through displays or lists in the
menu: swipe upwards or downwards on
Touch Control 2.
#
To call up the submenu or confirm the
selection: press the left-hand side of Touch
Control 2.
#
To exit the submenu: press left back button
1.
246
Instrument Display and on-board computer
Overview of displays in the multifunction
display
1
Outside temperature
2
Drive program
3
Transmission position
4
Time
5
Display section
%
The position of the displays deviates from
those displayed here.
Further displays in the multifunction display:
Z
Gearshift recommendation (
page 176)
ë
Active Parking Assist activated
é
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC deactivated
¯
Cruise control (
page 196)
ç
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
(
page 199)
a
Active Steering Assist (
page 204)
ë
HOLD function (
page 210)
_
Adaptive Highbeam Assist (
page 146)
Adjusting the instrument lighting
#
Turn brightness control 1 up or down.
The lighting of the Instrument Display and in
the control elements in the vehicle interior is
adjusted.
Instrument Display and on-board computer
247
Menus and submenus
Functions in the Service menu of the on-
board computer
On-board computer:
,

#
To select the function: swipe upwards or
downwards on the left-hand side of Touch
Control.
#
Press the left-hand side of Touch Control.
Functions in the  menu:
R
Message memory ( page 457)
R
:
-
Checking the tire pressure with the tire
pressure monitoring system (
page 419)
-
Restarting the tire pressure monitoring
system (
page 420)
R
 : calling up the service due
date (
page 377)
Calling up the Assistance graphic display
On-board computer:
,

%
When you have set the style to ,
you can view the assistance graphic menu
contents in the left-hand portion of the
instrument display.
The following displays are available from the
Assistance graphic menu:
R
Assistance graphic
R
Attention level ( page 232)
#
To switch between the displays: swipe
upwards or downwards on the left-hand side
of Touch Control.
Status displays in the Assistance graphic:
R
é: ATTENTION ASSIST deactivated
R
æ: Active Brake Assist deactivated
R
Light lane markings: Active Lane Keeping
Assist activated
R
Green lane markings: Active Lane Keeping
Assist active
248
Instrument Display and on-board computer
R
Gray radar waves next to vehicle: Blind Spot
Assist activated
R
Green radar waves next to vehicle: Blind Spot
Assist active
R
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC displays
(
page 199).
Calling up displays in the Trip menu
On-board computer:
,

%
When you have the style set to ,
you can view information on the journey in
the left-hand area of the Instrument Display.
#
To select a display: swipe upwards or down‐
wards on the left-hand side of Touch Control.
Displays in the  menu:
R
Standard display
R
Range and current fuel consumption
A recuperation display is also available for
certain engines. If there is only a small
amount of fuel left in the fuel tank, the dis‐
play shows a vehicle being refueled instead
of the range.
R
ECO display ( page 172)
R
Trip computer   and  
R
Digital speedometer
%
The digital speedometer only appears in the
 and  styles.
Example: standard display
1
Trip distance
2
Odometer
Example: trip computer
1
Odometer
2
Driving time
3
Average speed
4
Average fuel consumption
Instrument Display and on-board computer
249
Resetting values in the Trip menu of the on-
board computer
On-board computer:
,

%
The spelling may differ in the main menu dis‐
played. Therefore, observe the menu over‐
view for the Instrument Display
(
page 245).
You can reset the values of the following func‐
tions:
R
Trip distance
R
Trip computer "From start" and "From reset"
R
ECO display
#
To select the function to be reset: swipe
upwards or downwards on the left-hand side
of Touch Control.
#
Press the left-hand side of Touch Control.
#
Select .
#
Press the left-hand side of Touch Control.
If you press and hold the left-hand side of Touch
Control, the function will be reset immediately.
Calling up navigation instructions in the on-
board computer
On-board computer:
,

Example: no change of direction announced
1
Distance to the next destination
2
Estimated arrival time
3
Distance to the next change of direction
4
Current road
Example: change of direction announced
1
Road to which the change of direction leads
2
Distance to the change of direction
3
Change-of-direction symbol
4
Recommended lane and new lane during a
change of direction (white)
5
Possible lane
6
Lane not recommended (dark gray)
Further possible displays in the 
menu:
R
   or  :
a new route is calculated.
250
Instrument Display and on-board computer
R
  : the road is unknown, e.g.
newly built roads.
R
 : no route could be calculated to
the selected destination.
R
O: you have reached the destination or an
intermediate destination.
#
To exit the menu: press the back button on
the left.
In the  menu, you can also start navi‐
gation to one of the previous destinations:
#
Press the left-hand side of Touch Control.
#
To select the destination: swipe upwards or
downwards on the left-hand side of Touch
Control.
#
Press the left-hand side of Touch Control.
Route guidance is started.
If route guidance has already been activated,
a request will appear asking whether you
wish to end the current route guidance.
#
Select .
#
Press the left-hand side of Touch Control.
Route guidance is started.
Selecting radio stations using the on-board
computer
On-board computer:
,

1
Frequency range
2
Station
3
Name of track
4
Name of artist
When you select a station in the presets, the
preset appears next to the station name. When
you select a saved station in the frequency
range, an asterisk appears next to the station
name.
#
To select a radio station: swipe upwards or
downwards on the left-hand side of Touch
Control.
Selecting frequency range or station preset
list
#
Press the left-hand side of Touch Control.
#
To select the frequency range/station
preset list: swipe upwards or downwards on
the left-hand side of Touch Control.
#
Press the left-hand side of Touch Control.
Instrument Display and on-board computer
251
Playing back media using the on-board com‐
puter
On-board computer:
,

1
Media source
2
Current track and track number
3
Name of artist
4
Name of album
#
To change tracks in the active media
source: swipe upwards or downwards on the
left-hand side of Touch Control.
Changing the media source
#
Press the left-hand side of Touch Control.
#
To select a media source: swipe upwards
or downwards on the left-hand side of Touch
Control.
#
Press the left-hand side of Touch Control.
Dialing telephone numbers using the on-
board computer
Requirement:
R
The mobile phone is connected to the multi‐
media system.
On-board computer:
,

&
WARNING Risk of distraction from infor‐
mation systems and communications
equipment
If you operate information and communica‐
tion equipment integrated in the vehicle
when driving, you will be distracted from the
traffic situation. This could also cause you to
lose control of the vehicle.
#
Only operate this equipment when the
traffic situation permits.
#
If you cannot be sure of this, stop the
vehicle whilst paying attention to road
and traffic conditions and operate the
equipment with the vehicle stationary.
When telephoning, you must observe the legal
requirements for the country in which you are
currently driving.
The most recent telephone connections (dialed,
received and missed calls) are displayed in the
 menu.
#
To select the telephone number: swipe
upwards or downwards on the left-hand side
of Touch Control.
#
Press the left-hand side of Touch Control.
If there is only one telephone number
saved to an entry: the telephone number is
selected.
252
Instrument Display and on-board computer
#
If there are multiple telephone numbers
saved to an entry: swipe upwards or down‐
wards on the left-hand side of Touch Control
to select the desired telephone number.
#
Press the left-hand side of Touch Control.
The telephone number is dialed.
The following displays may appear instead of the
telephone numbers dialed:
R
 : the application is starting.
When a Bluetooth
®
connection to the mobile
phone is not established, the menu for
authorizing and connecting a mobile phone is
displayed in the multimedia system
(
page 316).
R
 : the contacts from the
mobile phone or from a storage medium are
being imported.
Accepting/rejecting a call
When you receive a call, the   mes‐
sage appears in the Head-up Display.
#
Swipe upwards or downwards on the left-
hand side of Touch Control and select 6
(Accept) or ~ (Reject).
#
Press the left-hand side of Touch Control.
The call may be accepted/rejected using the
6 or ~ buttons on the steering wheel.
Adjusting the Head-up Display settings in the
on-board computer
On-board computer:
,
 
The following characteristics of the Head-up Dis‐
play can be adjusted:
R

R

R
 
#
To select characteristics: swipe upwards or
downwards on the left-hand side of Touch
Control.
#
Press the left-hand side of Touch Control.
#
To adjust the value: swipe upwards or
downwards on the left-hand side of Touch
Control.
#
Press the left-hand side of Touch Control.
1
Currently selected setting
2
Digital speedometer
3
Traffic Sign Assist
4
Navigation displays
Instrument Display and on-board computer
253
Setting the design
On-board computer
,

%
This function is only available for vehicles
with a Widescreen Cockpit.
The following designs can be selected:
R

R

R

#
To select a design: swipe upwards or down‐
wards on the left-hand Touch Control.
#
Press the left-hand Touch Control.
The Instrument Display is shown in the selec‐
ted design.
Head-up Display
Function of the Head-up Display
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. Otherwise, you may not recog‐
nize dangers.
The Head-up Display projects information from
the navigation system, the driver assistance sys‐
tem and some warning messages above the
cockpit into the driver's field of vision.
Display elements
1
Navigation messages
2
Current speed
3
Detected instructions and traffic signs
4
Set speed in the driver assistance system
(e.g. cruise control)
When you receive a call, the 6  
message appears in the Head-up Display.
System limitations
The visibility is influenced by the following condi‐
tions:
R
Seat position
R
The positioning of the display image
R
Light conditions
R
Wet roads
R
Objects on the display cover
R
Polarization in sunglasses
%
In extreme sunlight, sections of the display
may be faded. This can be corrected by
switching the Head-up Display off and on
again.
254
Instrument Display and on-board computer
Switching the Head-up Display on/off
#
Press button 1.
Instrument Display and on-board computer
255
Operating safety
&
WARNING Risk of distraction from infor‐
mation systems and communications
equipment
If you operate information and communica‐
tion equipment integrated in the vehicle
when driving, you will be distracted from the
traffic situation. This could also cause you to
lose control of the vehicle.
#
Only operate this equipment when the
traffic situation permits.
#
If you cannot be sure of this, stop the
vehicle whilst paying attention to road
and traffic conditions and operate the
equipment with the vehicle stationary.
&
WARNING Risk of distraction from oper‐
ating mobile communication equipment
while the vehicle is in motion
If you operate communication equipment
integrated in the vehicle when driving, you
will be distracted from the traffic situation.
This could also cause you to lose control of
the vehicle.
Only operate this equipment when the vehi‐
cle is stationary.
For your own safety, always observe the follow‐
ing points when operating mobile communica‐
tions equipment and especially your voice con‐
trol system:
R
Observe the legal requirements for the coun‐
try in which you are driving.
R
While driving, only operate mobile communi‐
cations equipment and your voice control
system when the traffic conditions permit it.
You may otherwise be distracted from the
traffic conditions and cause an accident,
injuring yourself and others.
R
Do not use the voice control system in an
emergency as your voice can change and
your telephone call can be unnecessarily
delayed.
R
Familiarize yourself with the voice control
system functions before starting the journey.
Operation
Multifunction steering wheel operation over‐
view
The Voice Control System is operational approx
imately thirty seconds after the ignition is
switched on.
256
Voice Control System
1
Press the rocker switch up: ó starts
Voice Control System
2
Press the control knob: 8 switches the
sound off or on (ends Voice Control System)
Turn the rotary control up/down: increases/
decreases the volume
3
Press the rocker switch up: 6 makes/
accepts a call
Press the rocker switch down: ~ rejects/
ends a call (ends Voice Control System)
Conducting a dialog
#
To start or continue a dialog: press the
ó rocker switch on the multifunction
steering wheel up.
You can say a voice command after an
acoustic signal.
#
To correct an entry: say the 
voice command.
#
To select an entry from the selection list:
say the line number or the contents.
#
To browse the selection list: say the 
or  voice command.
#
To interrupt the dialog: say the  voice
command.
#
To cancel the dialog: say the  voice
command.
Operable functions
You can use the Voice Control System to operate
the following equipment regardless of the fea‐
tures:
R
Telephone
R
Text messages
R
Navigation
R
Address book
R
Radio
R
Audio (memory card, Media Interface, USB
and Bluetooth
®
audio)
R
Vehicle
Types of voice commands
A distinction is made between the following
voice commands:
R
Global voice commands can be said at any
time and regardless of the current applica‐
tion, e.g. the voice commands  ,
 or   .
Voice Control System
257
R
Application-specific voice commands are
only available for the active application.
1
Global voice commands
2
Application-specific voice commands
On the display next to the active application,
examples of global voice commands and the cor‐
responding application-specific voice commands
are displayed on an autocue. This makes entry
easier and supports interactive operation. The
list can be scrolled or it can be operated by
speech or the controller/touchpad.
Entering numbers
R
The numbers allowed are  to .
R
Telephone numbers can be entered as single
digits.
Information on the language setting
You can change the language of the Voice Con‐
trol System via the system language settings. If
the set system language is not supported by the
Voice Control System, English will be selected.
The Voice Control System is available in English,
French, Portuguese and Spanish.
Using the Voice Control System effectively
Audible help functions
You receive information and help for:
R
Optimal operation: say the   
  voice command.
R
Current application: push the ó rocker
switch on the multifunction steering wheel
up and say the  voice command.
R
Continued dialog: say the  voice com‐
mand during a voice dialog.
R
A specific system: say the voice commands
for the desired system, e.g.  .
Speech quality improvement
If the Voice Control System does not under‐
stand you:
R
only operate the Voice Control System from
the driver's seat.
R
say the voice commands coherently and
clearly, but do not exaggerate the words.
R
avoid loud noises, e.g. the blower, that cause
interference while making a voice command
entry.
R
say the voice tag with the same intonation
when creating voice tags.
If an address book entry voice tag is not rec‐
ognized:
R
only create sensible address book entries in
the system/mobile phone, e.g. enter sur‐
name and first name in the correct field.
258
Voice Control System
R
do not use any abbreviations, unnecessary
spaces or special characters.
If a station list entry is not recognized:
R
say the     voice command.
Essential voice commands
Switch voice commands
Switch voice commands can be used to open
certain applications. The voice command selec‐
tion can be used regardless of the application
that is currently active.
Voice command Function

To switch to navigation mode

To switch to map display
 
To switch to address book

To switch to telephone mode
 
To switch to text messages

To switch to radio mode

To switch to media mode

To switch to USB
 
To switch to memory card
  
To start a Mercedes-Benz online application. The application must be called up by touch once prior
to use.
Voice Control System
259
Voice command Function
 
To switch to Mercedes-Benz Apps

To switch to Internet mode
 
To switch to vehicle settings
  
To switch to system settings
Navigation voice commands
Using navigation voice commands, you can enter
POIs or conventional addresses as well as
directly change important navigation settings.
Voice command Function
  
Universal search for destinations of all types. A search is also performed in the address book con‐
tacts, in the navigation database and on the Internet (POIs). The order of the details, e.g. city, street
or house number, can be changed.
  
Destination entry in a desired country, e.g. address in France

Starts navigation to home address

Starts navigation to your workspace
260
Voice Control System
Voice command Function
 
Destination entry for a POI, e.g. the POI Brandenburg Gate. A search is also performed in the navi‐
gation database and on the Internet.
   
Conducts a POI search on the Internet only
   
Destination entry to a contact in the address book
 
 
 
 
 
  
  
Enters a country/city/district/street/intersection/house number/ZIP code
 
  
    
  
Searches for nearby restaurants, parking spaces, rest areas with toilets and gas stations
 
Selects a destination from the list of last entered destinations
Voice Control System
261
Voice command Function
 
Switches route guidance to another route
  
Starts route guidance after entering a valid destination
  
Cancels route guidance
  
  
Switches the route guidance voice output on/off
  
  
Switches the traffic map on/off
   
   
Switches the POI symbols display on the map on/off
Telephone voice commands
You can use the telephone voice commands to
make phone calls or search through the address
book.
262
Voice Control System
Voice command Function
 
Makes a phone call. All address book names are available.
  
Searches for and displays a contact. All address book names are available.
 
Displays the last call
 
Selects the last phone number dialed
Radio voice commands
Radio voice commands can also be used when
the radio application is running in the back‐
ground.
Voice command Function
 
To call up receivable or saved stations

To enter a frequency directly
 
 
To switch to the next available station
 
To save a station in the station list
  
To display the names of all receivable stations
Voice Control System
263
Voice command Function
   
To listen to the names of all receivable stations
  
  
To switch the traffic information service on/off
  
  
To switch the current station information on/off
Media player voice commands
Media player voice commands can also be used
when the media player is running in the back‐
ground.
264
Voice Control System
Voice command Function
 
 
 

 
 
The names of all available tracks, albums, artists, composers, genres or playlists are accepted dur‐
ing the search.
  
  
  
  
  
  
The names of all available tracks, albums, artists, composers, genres or playlists are accepted dur‐
ing the search.
Voice Control System
265
Voice command Function
  
  
  
  
  
  
Available albums, artists, composers, genres, tracks or playlists are searched for.
 
To select the next track
 
To select the previous track
   
   
To switch the random track list on/off
Message voice commands
Text messages can be created, edited and lis‐
tened to using the message voice commands.
266
Voice Control System
Voice command Function
   
To create a message. All address book names are available.

To reply to a message
  
To forward a message
Vehicle voice commands
You can use the vehicle voice commands to
directly call up the corresponding menus for the
vehicle settings.
Voice command Function
  
To display ambient light settings
  
To display the blue ambient light
   
To show display settings
 
To display assistance settings
 
To display fragrance settings
 
To display energy flow settings
 
To display ionization settings
Voice Control System
267
Voice command Function
  
To display climate control settings
    
To switch on the automatic climate control settings on the driver's side
 
To display light settings
 
To display massage settings
   
To switch on the massage function for the driver's seat
   
To switch off the massage function for the driver's seat
 
To display the outside temperature
 
To display engine data
 
To display seat adjustment settings
   
To set the seat heater for the front passenger seat to level 2
 
To display consumption
 
To display vehicle data
268
Voice Control System
Overview and operation
Overview of the multimedia system
1
Touch Control
2
Media display
3
Main function button group ( page 272)
4
Button Ü
Switches multimedia system on/off
5
Control knob
Adjusts volume and switches the sound
on/off
6
Touchpad
7
Controller
Notes on the media display
*
NOTE Scratching of the display
The display has a highly sensitive, high-gloss
surface. There is a risk of it becoming
scratched.
Avoid touching the display.
Observe the notes on cleaning.
Observe the notes on caring for the interior
(
page 390).
Automatic temperature-controlled switch-
off feature: if the temperature is too high, the
brightness is initially reduced automatically. The
media display may then switch off completely for
a while.
%
If you are wearing polarized sunglasses, it
may be difficult to read the media display.
Central control elements overview
1
Touch Control
2
Controller
3
Touchpad
Multimedia system
269
Touch Control
Operating Touch Control
#
To call up main functions: press button 1.
or
#
Press and hold button 3.
#
To call up favorites: press button 1.
#
Swipe down on Touch Control 2.
#
To open a list: press Touch Control 2.
#
To close a list: press button 3.
or
#
Swipe right on Touch Control 2.
#
To select a menu item: swipe up, down, left
or right on Touch Control 2.
#
Press Touch Control 2.
#
To move the digital map: swipe in any
direction.
Setting the sensitivity for Touch Control
Multimedia system:
,

.

.
  

#
Select ,  or .
Operating the controller
1
% button
Press briefly: returns to the previous display
Press and hold: calls up main functions
2
Controller
3
ò button
270
Multimedia system
Calling up the main functions
To call up favorites: when the main functions
are displayed, slide controller 2 down.
Controller 2 operating options:
#
Turn 3 left or right.
#
Slide 1 left or right.
#
Slide 4 up or down.
#
Slide 2 diagonally.
#
Press 7 briefly or press and hold.
Touchpad
Switching the touchpad on/off
Multimedia system:
,

.
w 
#
Switch  on O or off ª.
Operating the touchpad
Requirement:
R
The touchpad is switched on ( page 271).
1
Button %
Press briefly: returns to the previous display
Press and hold: calls up main functions
2
Touchpad
3
Button ©
Calling up the main functions
To call up favorites: when the main functions
are displayed, swipe down on touchpad 2.
4
Button D
Calls up the control menu of the last active
audio source
You can navigate in menus and lists via the
touch-sensitive surface of touchpad 2 by using
a single-finger swipe.
#
To open or close lists: swipe left or right.
#
To select the menu item: swipe up, down,
left or right.
#
Press touchpad 2.
#
To move the digital map: swipe in any
direction.
Use the following functions with a two-finger
swipe:
#
To call up main functions and favorites:
swipe down with two fingers.
#
To zoom in and out of the map: move two
fingers together or apart.
#
To call up the control menu of the last
active audio source: swipe up with two fin‐
gers.
Multimedia system
271
Setting the sensitivity for the touchpad
Multimedia system:
,

.
w 
#
Select  .
#
Select ,  or .
#
To set the pressure sensitivity: switch
  on O or off ª.
If the function is switched on O, a tap on
the touchpad is enough to select a menu
item.
Handwriting recognition: switching the read-
aloud function on/off
Multimedia system:
,

.
õ 
.
 

#
Switch     on
O or off ª.
Selecting a station and track using the
touchpad
#
Press the D button on the touchpad.
or
#
Swipe upwards using two fingers on the
touchpad.
The control menu appears for the audio
source that was last selected.
#
Use one finger to swipe up or down.
Radio: the previous or the next station is set.
Media source: the previous or the next music
track is selected.
#
To hide the control menu: swipe down on
the touchpad using two fingers.
Main functions
Calling up the main functions
1
ß button
To call up navigation
2
$ button
To call up the radio
3
Õ button
To call up media
4
% button
To call up the telephone
5
Ø button
To set vehicle functions
272
Multimedia system
#
Alternatively: press the ò button on the
controller, the touchpad or Touch Control.
The main functions are displayed.
#
Select a main function.
Favorites
Overview of favorites
Favorites offer you quick access to frequently
used applications. It is possible to create 20
favorites in total.
The following functions are available:
R
add pre-defined favorites from the follow‐
ing categories (
page 273):
-

-

-

-

-

-
 
R
add your own favorites ( page 273).
R
rename a favorite ( page 273).
R
move a favorite ( page 274).
R
delete a favorite ( page 274).
R
reset all favorites ( page 274).
Calling up favorites
#
Press the © button.
The main functions are displayed.
#
Navigate downwards once.
Navigating means:
R
swiping on Touch Control or the touchpad
R
sliding the controller
Leaving the favorites menu
#
Press the © button.
Adding a favorite
Adding a pre-defined favorite
#
Press the © button.
The main functions are displayed.
#
Navigate downwards twice.
The Favorites menu appears.
#
Select  .
The categories are displayed.
#
Select a category.
The favorites are displayed.
#
Select a favorite.
#
Store the favorite at the desired position.
If a favorite has already been added at this
position, it will be overwritten.
Example: adding your own favorite
#
Select .
#
Select   .
#
Press and hold the © button until the
favorites are displayed.
#
Store the favorite at the desired position.
Renaming a favorite
#
Press the © button.
The main functions are displayed.
#
Navigate downwards once.
#
Select a favorite.
#
Navigate downwards once.
The Favorites menu appears.
#
Select .
#
Enter the characters.
Multimedia system
273
#
To confirm the entry: select ¡.
Moving a favorite
#
Press the © button.
The main functions are displayed.
#
Navigate downwards once.
#
Select a favorite.
#
Navigate downwards once.
The Favorites menu appears.
#
Select .
#
Move the favorite to the desired position.
If a favorite has already been added at this
position, it will be overwritten.
Deleting a favorite
#
Press the © button.
The main functions are displayed.
#
Navigate downwards once.
#
Select a favorite.
#
Navigate downwards once.
The Favorites menu appears.
#
To delete: select .
#
Select .
#
To restore all favorites: select  .
A query appears.
#
Select .
The favorites are reset to the factory set‐
tings.
Switching the sound on/off
On the multifunction steering wheel
On the multimedia system
#
To mute: press volume control 1.
The 8 symbol appears in the status line
of the display.
You will also hear traffic announcements and
navigation announcements even when the
sound is muted.
274
Multimedia system
#
To switch on: change the media source or
turn volume control 1.
Adjusting the volume
On the multifunction steering wheel
On the multimedia system
#
Turn volume control 1.
The volume of the current radio or media
source is set. The volume of other audio
sources can be adjusted separately.
Adjust this in the following situations:
R
during a traffic announcement
R
during a navigation announcement
The volume of the navigation announce‐
ment changes in accordance with the vol‐
ume of the current media source.
R
during a telephone call
R
when entering or exiting a parking space
while using Active Parking Assist
or
#
Select .
#
Select .
#
Select a volume setting.
#
Set the volume.
Entering characters
Using the character input function
The following functions are available:
R
selecting a character in the character bar
R
writing a character on the touchpad
Character input can be started with a control
element and resumed with another.
Multimedia system
275
#
On Touch Control and controller: select a
character in the character bar.
Depending on the destination entered, the
following is available:
R
the full set of characters
R
characters which are useful for the cur‐
rent input string
Other characters are grayed out.
#
On the touchpad: select a character in the
character bar.
or
#
Write the characters on the touch-sensitive
surface of the touchpad.
Handwriting recognition supports you by
means of character suggestions and a read-
aloud function.
Examples of character entry:
R
Renaming a favorite
R
Entering a POI or an address using free or
step-by-step search
R
Entering a web address
Character input using the controller
Example: renaming a favorite
#
Calling up the "Renaming a favorite" function
(
page 273).
#
To enter a character: turn 3, slide 4
and press the controller.
The character is entered in the input line.
Use the following entry functions:
%
To delete a character: press the control‐
ler.
To delete an entry: press and hold the
controller until the entire entry is deleted.
Ä
To switch to special characters and sym‐
bols.
X
To switch to upper-case or lower-case let‐
ters.
B
To switch the language.
v
To switch to character entry on the touch‐
pad.
%
The available editing functions depend on
the editing task, the language set and the
character level.
#
To confirm the entry: select ¡.
Example: entering a destination (navigation)
#
Enter the POI or address ( page 292).
Entering characters on the touchpad
Requirements:
R
The touchpad is switched on ( page 271).
R
The entered or selected character should be
read out: the handwriting recognition read-
aloud function is switched on (
page 272).
276
Multimedia system
Example: renaming a favorite
#
Calling up the "Renaming a favorite" function
(
page 273).
#
To enter a character: use your finger to
write characters on the touchpad.
The character is entered in the input line. If
different interpretations are possible, charac‐
ter suggestions are displayed.
#
To select a character suggestion: turn the
controller.
#
Resume character input.
#
To enter a space: swipe right when the cur‐
sor is located in the input line.
#
To delete a character: swipe left when the
cursor is located in the input line.
#
To confirm the entry: press the touchpad.
#
To finish character entry: swipe upwards.
or
#
Press the % button.
Example: entering a destination (navigation)
#
Enter the POI or address ( page 292).
System settings
Display
Configuring display settings
Multimedia system:
,

.
G   
Designs
#
Select .
#
Select ,  or .
Adapting the ambient lighting for the style
#
Select   .
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
This function adjusts the ambient lighting for
the selected display style.
Additional display area
Depending on the vehicle, various items of addi‐
tional information can be shown. The additional
display area comprises the left-hand or right-
hand third of the display.
#
Select   .
The following display content can be selected:
R

R
 
R

R
  
Display brightness
#
Select  .
#
Select a brightness value.
Switching the display off/on
#
Off: select  .
Multimedia system
277
#
On: press a button, %, for example.
Display design
#
Select  .
#
Select ,   or 
.
Time and date
Setting the time and date automatically
Multimedia system:
,

.
&   
#
Deactivate ª   .
The time and date are set automatically for
the selected time zone and summer time
option.
%
The correct time is required for the following
functions:
R
route guidance with time-dependent traf‐
fic guidance
R
calculation of expected time of arrival
Setting the time zone
Multimedia system:
,

.
&   
.


The list of countries is displayed.
#
Select a country #.
Depending on the country, time zones are
displayed.
#
Select a time zone.
The time zone set is displayed after 
.
Setting summer time
The     and 
   options cannot be selected in
all countries.
Multimedia system:
,

.
&   
Automatically
#
Switch     on
O or off ª.
Manually
#
Deactivate ª   
.
#
Select   .
#
Select  or .
Setting the time and date format
Multimedia system:
,

.
&   
.


#
Set the date and time format #.
Setting the time manually
Prerequisite
R
The    function is
switched on.
Multimedia system:
,

.
&   
.


#
Set the hours.
#
Navigate to the right to set the minutes.
#
Set the minutes.
278
Multimedia system
#
Confirm changes when exiting the menu.
The date is set automatically via GPS.
Activating/deactivating voice amplification
to the rear
Mercedes-Maybach vehicles and vehicles
with a long wheelbase only
Requirements:
R
Your vehicle is equipped with the Burmester
®
surround sound system or the Burmester
®
high-end 3D surround sound system.
R
The ignition is switched on.
R
Doors, side windows and the panorama roof
with power tilt/sliding panel are closed.
Multimedia system:
,

.

.
 
 
The function supports communication between
the driver and front passenger with passengers
in the rear passenger compartment. When voice
amplification to rear is activated, the signals
picked up by the microphone are amplified and
played back over the speakers in the rear
passenger compartment, depending upon vehi‐
cle noise levels. An automatic adjustment occurs
based on speaker volume and ambient noise in
order to improve speech intelligibility and main‐
tain the naturalness of speech.
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Connectivity
Switching transmission of the vehicle posi‐
tion on/off
Multimedia system:
,

.
ö 
#
Select   .
#
Switch the function on O or off ª.
Bluetooth
®
Information about Bluetooth
®
Bluetooth
®
technology is a standard for short-
range wireless data transfer up to approximately
32.8 ft (10 m). You can use Bluetooth
®
to con‐
nect your mobile phone to the multimedia sys‐
tem and use the following functions, for exam‐
ple:
R
hands-free system with access to the follow‐
ing options:
-
contacts ( page 320)
-
call lists ( page 322)
-
text messages
R
Internet connection
R
listening to music via Bluetooth
®
audio
(
page 346)
R
transferring business cards (vCards) into the
vehicle
Bluetooth
®
is a registered trademark of Blue‐
tooth Special Interest Group (SIG) Inc.
%
Internet connection via Bluetooth
®
is not
available in all countries.
Activating/deactivating Bluetooth
®
Prerequisite
R
Apple CarPlay™ is not active.
Multimedia system
279
Multimedia system:
,

.
ö 
#
Activate O or deactivate ª Bluetooth
®
.
If Android Auto is active, a prompt appears ask‐
ing whether Bluetooth
®
should be deactivated.
#
Select .
Android Auto is closed and Bluetooth
®
is
deactivated.
Wi-Fi
Wi-Fi connection overview
You can use Wi-Fi to establish a connection with
a Wi-Fi network and to access the Internet or
other network devices.
The following connection options are available:
R
Wi-Fi connection
The Wi-Fi connection is established to a Wi-
Fi-capable device, e.g. to the customer's
mobile phone or tablet PC.
R
multimedia system as a Wi-Fi hotspot
Using this function, a tablet PC or notebook
can be connected, for example.
To establish a connection, you can use the fol‐
lowing methods:
R
WPS PIN
The connection to a secure Wi-Fi network is
made via a PIN.
R
WPS PBC
The connection to a secure Wi-Fi network is
made by pressing a button (push button).
R
security key
The connection to a secure Wi-Fi network is
made via a security key.
Setting up Wi-Fi
Requirement:
R
The device to be connected supports one of
the three means of connection described.
Multimedia system:
,

.
ö 
Activating/deactivating Wi-Fi
#
Activate O or deactivate ª .
If  is deactivated ª, communication via
Wi-Fi to all devices is interrupted. This also
means that a connection to the HERMES
communication module cannot be estab‐
lished. Functions such as dynamic route
guidance with Live Traffic Information are
then unavailable.
Connecting the multimedia system with a
device via Wi-Fi
This function is available if a HERMES communi‐
cation module is not installed.
The type of connection established must be
selected on the multimedia system and on the
device to be connected.
%
The connection procedure may differ
depending on the device. Follow the instruc‐
tions that are shown in the display. Further
information (see the manufacturer's operat‐
ing instructions).
280
Multimedia system
#
Select  .
#
Select    .
Using a WPS PIN:
#
Highlight a Wi-Fi network in the list.
#
Select ¥     .
The multimedia system generates an eight-
digit PIN.
#
Enter this PIN on the device to be connected.
#
Confirm the entry.
Using a button:
Requirements:
R
This function is only available in a Wi-Fi fre‐
quency of 2.4 GHz.
#
Highlight a Wi-Fi network in the list.
#
Select ¥    .
#
Select "Connect via WPS PBC" in the options
on the device to be connected.
#
Press the WPS button on the device to be
connected.
#
Select  in the multimedia system.
Using a security key:
#
Highlight a Wi-Fi network in the list.
#
Select ¥    .
#
Have the security key displayed on the device
to be connected (see the manufacturer's
operating instructions).
#
Enter this security key on the multimedia sys‐
tem.
#
Confirm the entry with ¡.
%
All devices support a security key as a
means of connection.
Device has already been connected:
#
To automatically connect: highlight a Wi-Fi
network in the list.
#
Activate O¥  .
#
To connect: highlight a Wi-Fi network in the
list.
#
Select ¥ .
The connection is established again. These
functions are possible when the device has
already been connected to the Wi-Fi network.
Setting up a Wi-Fi hotspot
Multimedia system:
,

.
ö 
Configuring the multimedia system as a Wi-
Fi hotspot
The type of connection established depends on
the device to be connected. The function must
be supported by the multimedia system and by
the device to be connected. The type of connec‐
tion established must be selected on the multi‐
media system and on the device to be connec‐
ted.
#
Select   .
#
Highlight     .
Generating a WPS PIN
#
Select ¥     
.
#
Enter the PIN shown in the multimedia sys‐
tem display on the device to be connected
and confirm.
Connecting using a WPS PIN
#
Select ¥     .
Multimedia system
281
#
Select   .
#
Enter the PIN that is shown on the external
device's display on the multimedia system.
#
Select .
Connecting using a button
Requirements:
R
This function is only available in a Wi-Fi fre‐
quency of 2.4 GHz.
#
Select ¥    .
#
Press the WPS button on the device to be
connected or select .
#
Select  in the multimedia system.
Connecting using a security key
#
Select     .
A security key is displayed.
#
Select the vehicle from the device to be con‐
nected. The vehicle is displayed with the
SSID   .
#
Enter the security key which is shown in the
multimedia system display on the device to
be connected.
#
Confirm the entry.
Connecting using NFC
#
Select   .
#
Activate NFC on the mobile device (see the
manufacturer's operating instructions).
#
Bring the mobile device into the NFC area of
the vehicle (
page 317).
#
Select .
The mobile device is now connected to the
multimedia system hotspot via NFC.
To generate a new security key:
#
Select   .
#
Select   .
A connection will be established with the
newly created security key.
#
To save a security key: select .
When a new security key is saved, all existing
Wi-Fi connections are then disconnected. If
the Wi-Fi connections are being re-estab‐
lished, the new security key must be entered.
Managing COMAND Touch devices
Requirements:
R
The COMAND Touch App is installed on the
external device (e.g. tablet or smartphone).
R
Wi-Fi is activated ( page 280) and the mul‐
timedia system is configured as a Wi-Fi Hot‐
spot (
page 281).
Multimedia system:
,

.
 
Connecting a new device
#
Select   .
#
Select   .
#
 the connection request from the new
device.
A security key is displayed.
#
Enter the security key in the external device.
The device is authorized.
Selecting a connected device
#
Select   .
The devices already connected are displayed.
282
Multimedia system
#
Select    .
The      
     message
appears.
#
Select .
Follow the instructions to authorize the
selected device.
De-authorizing the device
#
Select a connected device from the list.
The      
     message
appears.
#
Select .
A prompt will appear asking whether you
would like to de-authorize the selected
device.
#
Select .
The device is de-authorized.
Activating/deactivating parental control
Multimedia system:
,

.
 
Locking the Rear Seat Entertainment System
#
Select   or  .
#
Select .
The Rear Seat Entertainment System is
locked O or unlocked ª.
Switching off the Rear Seat Entertainment
System display
#
Select   or  .
#
Select  .
#
Switch the display on O or off ª.
Locking an external device
#
Select an external device.
#
Select .
The device connected via the COMAND
Touch App is locked O or unlocked ª.
System language
Notes on the system language
This function allows you to determine the lan‐
guage for the menu displays and the navigation
announcements. The selected language affects
the characters available for entry. The navigation
announcements are not available in all lan‐
guages. If a language is not available, the naviga‐
tion announcements will be in English.
Setting the system language
Multimedia system:
,

.

#
Set the language.
%
If you are using Arabic map data, the text
information can also be shown in Arabic on
the navigation map. To do so, select ةيبرعلا as
the language from the language list. Naviga‐
tion announcements are then also made in
Arabic.
Multimedia system
283
Setting the distance unit
Multimedia system:
,

.
% 
#
Select  or .
#
In the multifunction display of the instrument
display, switch the  
display on O.
Data import and export
Data import/export function
The following functions are possible:
R
Transferring data from one system or vehicle
to another system or vehicle.
R
Creating a backup copy of your personal data
and loading it again.
R
Protecting your personal data against unwan‐
ted export with PIN protection.
You can either use an SD card or a USB storage
device as temporary storage.
%
Please note that the NTFS file system is not
supported. The FAT32 file system is recom‐
mended.
Importing/exporting data
*
NOTE Data loss
#
Do not remove the data storage
medium when data is being exported.
Mercedes-Benz is not liable for any loss of
data.
Requirements:
R
The vehicle is stationary.
R
The ignition is switched on or the vehicle has
been started.
R
The SD card is inserted ( page 339) or the
USB device is connected (
page 341).
Multimedia system:
,

.
 
#
Select   or  .
Importing
#
Select a data storage medium.
A prompt appears asking whether you really
wish to overwrite the current data. If data
originates from another vehicle, this is recog‐
nized during data reading.
The multimedia system is restarted once the
data has been imported.
%
Current vehicle settings can be edited after
the import.
Exporting
If PIN protection is activated, your PIN is reques‐
ted.
#
Enter the four-digit PIN.
#
Select a data storage medium.
The data is exported. The data export may
take several minutes.
284
Multimedia system
Activating/deactivating PIN protection
Multimedia system:
,

.
 
Setting the PIN
#
Select  .
#
Enter a four-digit PIN.
#
Enter the four-digit PIN again.
If both PINs match, PIN protection is active.
Changing the PIN
Prerequisite
R
A current PIN must be set.
#
Select  .
#
Enter the current PIN.
#
Select  .
#
Set a new PIN.
Activating PIN protection for data export
#
Select  .
Confirm with the PIN.
#
Select   .
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Activating PIN protection for offline mode
#
Select  .
Confirm with the PIN.
#
Select     .
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Unblocking the PIN
Requirements:
R
There is an Internet connection.
R
A Mercedes me account exists at http://
www.mercedes.me.
R
The  ( page 286)service is
activated.
If the PIN has been entered incorrectly three
times, the PIN will be blocked. You can have a
single-use password sent to you via the
Mercedes me connect online portal to reset the
PIN protection.
#
Select  .
#
Enter the single-use password.
PIN protection is reset, and you can set a
new PIN.
%
Alternatively, you can have PIN protection
reset at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Cen‐
ter.
User profile
Setting a user profile
Multimedia system:
,

.
g 
Displaying a user profile when starting
If this function is active, a prompt appears when
starting the system asking which user profile to
use.
#
Select     .
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Selecting a user profile
#
Select   or individual profile #.
%
Some settings from the user profile are only
loaded when the vehicle is stationary or
when the ignition is switched on.
Multimedia system
285
Automatic synchronization
Each time the ignition is switched off or on, the
individual user profiles are synchronized on the
multimedia system and on the server. This
ensures that the latest user profiles are always
available.
#
Select  .
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
%
For more information about importing/
exporting user profiles (
page 286).
Creating a user profile
Multimedia system:
,

.
g 
.

 
#
Enter a name.
#
Select a.
Individual settings are saved in the user profile,
e.g.:
R
System settings
R
settings in the TV tuner's channel list
R
navigation and traffic information
The settings differ depending on the vehicle
equipment.
Importing/exporting user profiles
Requirements:
R
There is an Internet connection .
R
A Mercedes me account exists at http://
www.mercedes.me.
R
The  service is active.
Multimedia system:
,

.
g 
.

 
This function is not available in all countries.
Only individual profiles can be imported or
exported.
The individual profiles are always collectively
imported or exported.
#
Import: select    .
The      
       
 message appears.
#
Select .
User profiles are imported.
#
Export: select     .
User profiles are exported.
%
Certain settings, such as address book
entries or previous destinations from the
navigation system, are not exported.
Setting user profile options
Multimedia system:
,

.
g 
#
Highlight a profile.
#
Select ¥ options.
The following options are available:
R

R

R

%
The guest profile cannot be deleted or
renamed.
286
Multimedia system
Software update
Information on software updates
The multimedia system provides a message
when an update is available.
Depending on the source, you can perform vari
ous updates:
Software update
Source of the
update
Update type
InternetNavigation map, sys‐
tem updates, Digital
Operator's Manual
External storage
medium, e.g. USB
flash drive
Navigation maps
Software updates ensure your vehicle's technol‐
ogy is always up-to-date.
In order to constantly improve the quality of our
services you will receive future updates for your
multimedia system, the Mercedes-Benz mbrace
®
services and your vehicle's communication mod‐
ule. These will conveniently be sent to you via
the mobile phone connection in your vehicle
and, in many cases, installed automatically. You
can monitor the status of your updates at any
time on the Mercedes me portal and find infor‐
mation about potential innovations.
Your advantages at a glance:
R
conveniently receive software updates via
the mobile phone network
R
the long-term quality and availability of
Mercedes-Benz mbrace
®
is guaranteed
R
keep your multimedia system and communi‐
cation module up-to-date
Further information about software updates can
be found at http://me.mercedes-benz.com
Performing a software update
Requirements:
R
An Internet connection is required for
updates which are obtained online .
Multimedia system:
,

.
 
Automatically
Prerequisite
R
Your vehicle has a built-in communication
module.
#
Activate   O.
Updates are performed.
The current status of the updates is dis‐
played.
Manually
#
Deactivate   ª.
#
Select an update from the list and start the
update.
Searching for new Updates
Requirements:
R
Your vehicle does not have a built-in commu‐
nication module.
R
An Internet-enabled mobile phone is connec‐
ted to the multimedia system (
page 316).
Multimedia system
287
#
Select    .
The list of available updates is refreshed.
#
Select an update and start the update.
The selected update is downloaded via the
connected mobile phone.
Activating the software update
#
Restart the system.
Important system updates
Important system updates may be necessary for
the security of your multimedia system's data.
Please install these updates, or else the security
of your multimedia system cannot be ensured.
%
If automatic software updates are activated,
the system updates will be downloaded auto‐
matically (
page 287).
As soon as an update is available for download,
a corresponding message appears on the multi‐
media system display.
You have the following selection options:
R

The update will be downloaded in the back‐
ground.
R

Information about the pending system
update is displayed.
R

The update can be downloaded manually at a
later time (
page 287).
If the download is completed and the update is
ready for installation, you will be informed of this
after the next ignition cycle, for example.
Requirements for the installation:
R
The ignition is switched off.
R
Notes and warnings have been read and
accepted.
R
The electric parking brake is applied.
If all requirements are met, the update will be
installed. The multimedia system cannot be
operated while the update is being installed and
vehicle functions are restricted.
If errors should occur during the installation, the
multimedia system automatically att
empts to
restore the previous version
. If restoration of the
previous version is not possible, a symbol
appears on the center console display. Please
consult a qualified specialist workshop to
resolve the problem.
Reset function
Multimedia system:
,

.

Personal data is deleted, for example:
R
station presets
R
connected mobile phones
#
Select .
If PIN protection is activated, a prompt appears
asking if you also wish to restore this to the fac‐
tory settings during a reset.
#
Select 
#
Enter the current PIN.
The PIN is reset.
Or
#
Select .
The current PIN stays the same after reset‐
ting.
288
Multimedia system
%
If you have forgotten your PIN, an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center can deactivate your
PIN protection for you.
A prompt appears again asking whether you
really wish to reset.
#
Select .
The multimedia system is reset to the factory
settings.
ENERGIZING comfort
ENERGIZING comfort program overview
Program overview
Programs Function
Refresh
Can make targeted changes to the interior climate to refresh vehicle occupants. Cooling airflow and ioniza‐
tion purify the air. The vehicle interior is illuminated with cool colors, and the seat is ventilated.
Warmth
Can increase the comfort level of the occupants. The vehicle's panel, seat and steering wheel heater pro‐
duce a cozy warmth. The air is purified using ionization and a pleasant fragrance is released. The vehicle
interior is illuminated with warm lighting.
Vitality
Can counteract fatigue in monotonous driving situations. Fast-paced music and a vitalizing massage pro‐
vide invigorating stimulation for the vehicle occupants. The air is purified using ionization and a pleasant
fragrance is released. The vehicle interior is illuminated in a stimulating hue and the seat is ventilated.
Pleasure
Can promote a positive mood in the occupants. Moderately fast music is played and a massage program is
activated. The air is purified using ionization and a pleasant fragrance is released. The vehicle interior is
illuminated with amicable lighting.
Multimedia system
289
Programs Function
Well being
Can aid the physical and mental relaxation of occupants. A back massage combined with local warmth pro‐
vide relaxation. The air is purified using ionization and a pleasant fragrance is released. The music player
plays selections of calming music and the vehicle interior is illuminated with pleasant lighting.
Training
Can counteract the onset of muscle tension, limbs falling asleep or stress with targeted relaxation or stim‐
ulation trainings. The exercises are demonstrated in short videos. The air is purified using ionization and a
pleasant fragrance is released. The vehicle interior is illuminated with lighting appropriate for the training.
%
Please note that the available programs and
the associated functions are dependent on
your vehicle equipment. Depending on your
equipment, fewer functions may be availa‐
ble.
Starting the ENERGIZING comfort program
Requirements:
R
The ignition is switched on.
%
ENERGIZING comfort is available approx
imately 5 minutes after starting the multime‐
dia system.
Multimedia system:
,

.
 
#
Select , , , 
or .
The selected program will run for 10 minutes.
Starting training
#
Select .
#
Select  ,  
 or .
The selected training video starts and is dis‐
played in the media display.
#
Select   .
The training video is displayed in full screen.
%
For information about pausing or skipping
videos, see Media playback(
page 341).
If, during an active program, a function require‐
ment is no longer met, a corresponding message
appears. The active program is canceled.
290
Multimedia system
Navigation
Switching navigation on
Multimedia system:
,

#
Alternatively: press the ß button.
The map appears and shows current vehicle
position 1.
%
If a climate control setting is changed, a cli‐
mate bar appears briefly.
Showing/hiding the navigation menu
Requirements:
R
The map shows the vehicle's current posi‐
tion.
,

#
To show: swipe left on the touchpad or
Touch Control.
or
#
Slide the controller to the left.
#
To hide: swipe right on the touchpad or
Touch Control.
or
Multimedia system
291
#
Slide the controller to the right.
%
To show or hide lower menu levels, swipe or
slide to the left or right as many times as
necessary.
Destination entry
Entering a POI or address
Multimedia system:
,

#
Show the navigation menu.
#
Select ª  .
The state or province in which the vehicle is
located is set 1.
There are two available methods of destina‐
tion entry:
R
free search 2
R
step-by-step search 3
Method 1: free search
#
Enter the POI or address in 2. The entries
can be made in any order.
During destination entry, suggestions are
made by the multimedia system. A selection
of destinations appears in a list.
Enter these address elements, for example:
R
city, street, house number
R
street, city
R
ZIP code
R
POI name
R
POI category, e.g.  
R
city, POI name
#
To switch to handwriting recognition:
select 5 v.
#
Write the character on the touchpad.
#
To switch to character selection: press the
% button.
or
#
Press the touchpad.
#
To delete an entry: select 4 % (if avail‐
able).
R
Press briefly: deletes the last character
entered or the last suggestion adopted.
R
Press and hold: deletes the entire entry.
#
To set the language: select 8.
#
Select the language.
%
This function is useful for countries in which
several character sets are supported. An
example is Russia, which uses Cyrillic and
Latin characters.
#
To call up the online search function:
select 6  .
Once an Internet connection is established, a
list appears. It shows online destinations
related to the previous entry.
Online destinations are provided by the Inter‐
net service provider.
292
Multimedia system
#
Select the online destination.
or
#
Enter an online destination in the input line.
%
Online search is not available in all coun‐
tries.
%
Requirement (USA): Mercedes-Benz
mbrace
®
is activated.
#
To call up the list: press the % button.
or
#
If the top line of the character bar is highligh‐
ted, navigate upwards.
#
Select the destination in the list.
#
To adopt a destination: select  
 7.
If there are several listings for a destination,
a list appears.
#
Select the destination.
The destination address is shown.
Method 2: search step-by-step
#
Press the % button.
or
#
If the top line of the character bar is highligh‐
ted, navigate upwards.
The character bar is hidden.    is
highlighted. Additional entry fields, e.g. for
, are available.
#
Select   .
The character bar appears.
#
Enter the city or the ZIP code.
During destination entry, suggestions are
made by the multimedia system. A selection
of destinations appears in a list.
The address entries can be made in any
order, for example:
R
  , ,  
Enter an intersecting street, if available.
R
,   
R
, e.g.  ,   
%
During destination entry, use the following
functions:
R
switching to handwriting recognition
R
switching to character selection
R
deleting an entry
An entry, e.g. a , can be deleted with
£ in a step-by-step search. Navigate
to the left to do so.
R
calling up online search function (if avail‐
able)
R
calling up a list
The functions are described in the free
search.
#
To change the state/province: select the
state or the province.
#
Enter the state or the province. You only
need to enter the first character.
#
Select the state or the province in the list.
#
To change the country: select the country.
#
Enter the country. You only need to enter the
first character.
#
Select the country on the list.
#
To adopt a destination: select  
.
If there are several listings for a destination,
a distance-orientated list appears.
Multimedia system
293
#
Select the destination.
The destination address is shown.
Selecting a POI
Multimedia system:
,

.
   

.

Method 1
#
Select the category.
If route guidance is not active: the search
begins in the vicinity of the current vehicle
position. The list is sorted by distance in
ascending order.
If route guidance is active: the search begins
after selecting a search position.
The POIs show the following information:
R
name of POI
R
linear distance to the POI
R
the direction of the linear distance to the
POI (arrow) is displayed when searching
for the vehicle's current position
#
Select the POI.
#
Route guidance is active: select the search
position prior to choosing a POI.
#
If intermediate destinations are set, these
can also be selected as the search position
after selecting  .
Method 2
#
Select  .
#
Select the category.
#
Select the POI.
#
Route guidance is active: select the search
position prior to choosing a POI.
#
If intermediate destinations are set, these
can also be selected as the search position
after selecting  .
Alternatively filtering the display by POI
#
Enter a search term in the ª 
line.
The results list shows relevant POIs.
#
Select ¡.
The first POI in the list is highlighted.
#
Select the POI.
Example: setting the search position for the
parking category during active route guid‐
ance
#
Select   ,   or
  .
The list shows the located POIs or opens an
overview of the route destination after
selecting  .
#
Select the POI.
#
Select  : select the inter‐
mediate destination or the destination.
Selecting previous destinations
Multimedia system:
,

.
   

#
Select  .
#
Select the destination suggestion or the des‐
tination.
The destination address is shown.
%
If   is switched on O, destina‐
tion suggestions are displayed
(
page 306).
294
Multimedia system
#
Alternatively: if a favorite has been saved
(
page 305), select   .
#
Select the favorite.
The destination address is shown.
Selecting a contact
Requirements:
R
a mobile phone is connected to the multime‐
dia system (
page 316).
Multimedia system:
,

.
   

.

#
Select the contact.
The contact details are displayed.
#
Select the address.
Alternatively filtering the display by contacts
#
Enter a name or telephone number into the
search field.
#
Select ¡.
The first contact in the list is highlighted.
#
Select the contact.
#
Select the address.
Entering geo-coordinates
Multimedia system:
,

.
   

.

#
Enter geo-coordinates as latitude and longi‐
tude coordinates in degrees, minutes and
seconds.
The map shows the position.
#
Confirm the entry.
#
To calculate a route: select  
.
#
If a route has already been created, select
    or   
 .
Selecting from the map
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
.


#
Alternatively: if the map is displayed in full
screen mode, press Touch Control, the con‐
troller or the touchpad.
The map menu appears.
#
Select "Move map" in map menu 2
(
page 309).
#
Swipe in any direction on Touch Control or
touchpad.
or
#
Slide the controller in any direction.
The map moves in the corresponding direc‐
tion under the crosshair. The more you move
your finger away from the starting position
on the touchpad, the faster the map moves.
#
Press Touch Control, the controller or the
touchpad.
If several destinations are located around the
crosshair, a list shows the available POIs and
roads.
If a destination is located exactly on the
crosshair, the destination address is dis‐
played.
#
Select the destination in the list.
The destination address is shown.
Setting the map orientation to 2D or 3D
#
Highlight   .
Multimedia system
295
#
Press Touch Control, the touchpad or the
controller.
The map will be displayed in the selected
map orientation.
Showing traffic messages in the vicinity of
the map
#
Select     .
The map appears.
#
Swipe left or right on the touchpad.
or
#
Slide the controller to the left or right.
The previous or next traffic incident is high‐
lighted on the map. Information on the traffic
incident is displayed.
Showing POIs in the vicinity of the map
#
Select    .
#
Swipe left or right on the touchpad.
or
#
Slide the controller to the left or right.
The previous or next POI is highlighted on the
map. The name or the address is shown.
#
Alternatively, to filter the display by POI
category: swipe down on Touch Control or
the touchpad.
or
#
Slide the controller down.
#
Select the POI category.
%
  allows personal POI symbols to
be selected (
page 311).
Entering an intermediate destination
Requirements:
R
A destination is entered.
Multimedia system:
,

.
 
 
#
Select     
.
#
Enter the intermediate destination as a POI
or address (
page 292).
#
Select the intermediate destination.
#
Select   .
or
#
Select an intermediate destination using
ª   during route guid‐
ance.
#
Select     
after entering the destination.
Calculating a route with intermediate desti‐
nations
Requirements:
R
Enter the destination and at least one inter‐
mediate destination.
Multimedia system:
,

.
 
 
#
Select    .
The route is calculated with the set inter‐
mediate destinations.
Editing intermediate destinations
Requirements:
R
A destination is entered.
296
Multimedia system
Multimedia system:
,

.
 
 
#
To change the order of destinations: high‐
light the destination or the intermediate des‐
tination.
#
Select ¥ .
#
Move the intermediate destination to the
desired position.
#
Press Touch Control, the controller or the
touchpad.
#
To call up the map: highlight the destination
or the intermediate destination.
#
Select ¥ .
#
Move the map ( page 310).
#
Select destination on the map ( page 295).
#
To delete a destination: highlight the desti‐
nation or the intermediate destination.
#
Select ¥ .
Starting an automatic gas station search
Requirements:
R
The automatic gas station search is activated
O (
page 300).
Driving situation
Route guidance is active. The fuel level in the
fuel tank reaches the reserve fuel level.
The       
     message is
shown.
#
Select .
The automatic gas station search begins. The
available gas stations along the route and in
the vicinity of the vehicle's current position
are displayed.
#
Select the gas station.
The address of the gas station is displayed.
#
Method 1: if route guidance is not activated,
select   .
The selected gas station is set as the desti‐
nation. Route guidance begins.
#
Method 2: if route guidance is activated,
select     or  
  .
   : the selected gas
station is set as a new destination. The previ‐
ous destinations and intermediate destina‐
tions are deleted. Route guidance to the gas
station begins.
    : the
selected gas station is set as the next inter‐
mediate destination. Route guidance begins.
#
If there are already four intermediate des‐
tinations: select  in the prompt.
The selected gas station is entered into posi‐
tion 1 of the intermediate destinations menu.
Intermediate destination 4 is deleted. Route
guidance begins.
Route
Calculating a route
Requirements:
R
The destination has been entered.
R
The destination address is shown.
Multimedia system
297
#
Method 1: if route guidance is not activated,
select   .
The route to the destination is calculated.
The map shows the route. Route guidance
then begins.
#
Method 2: if route guidance is activated,
select     or  
  .
   : the selected des‐
tination address is set as a new destination.
The previous destinations and intermediate
destinations are deleted. Route guidance to
the new destination begins.
    : the
selected destination address is set as the
next intermediate destination. Route guid‐
ance begins.
Taking alternative routes into consideration
#
Select an alternative route ( page 300).
Other menu functions
#
To save the destination: select ¥ 
  .
#
To display on the map: select ¥ .
#
To call a telephone number: select ¥
.
#
To call up an Internet address: select
¥  (if available).
Selecting a route type
Multimedia system:
,

.
À   
#
Select  .
#
Select the route type.
A route has already been created: the route
is calculated on the basis of the new route
type.
A route has not been created: the next route
is calculated on the basis of the new route
type.
R
 
An economical route is calculated. The
journey time may be somewhat longer
than for quicker routes.
The symbol for the current vehicle posi‐
tion is displayed in green.
R
 
A route with a quick journey time is cal‐
culated.
R
 
A route with a short driving distance is
calculated.
    can be
switched on O or off ª for these route
types. If     is
switched on,       
 can be selected.
The route types    
 and       
 are not available in every country.
R
   
The route is calculated with the currently
set route type.
Traffic reports via Live Traffic Information
are taken into account.
Live Traffic Information is not available in
all countries.
R
       
298
Multimedia system
A prompt appears when a new route is
detected with a shorter journey time
based on traffic reports. You can con‐
tinue to use the current route or use the
dynamic route instead.
Selecting route options
Multimedia system:
,

.
À
.
  

.
 
Avoiding areas
#
Select  ( page 312).
Avoiding highways, ferries, motorail trains,
tunnels, unpaved roads
#
Select O or deselect ª avoid option.
Using toll roads
#
Select   .
#
Select  or   or .
The route takes into account roads that
require the payment of a usage fee (toll).
If  is selected, toll roads are not taken into
account.
The selected route options cannot always be
implemented. Therefore, a route may include a
ferry, for instance, even though the avoid 
option is enabled. A message appears and you
will hear a corresponding message.
Using carpool lanes
#
Select      .
#
Select number.
When using carpool lanes, observe the appli‐
cable legal requirements as well as any con‐
ditions pertaining to when and where such
lanes may be used. Carpool lanes may only
be used if certain conditions are met.
These route options are not available in every
country.
Selecting notifications
Multimedia system:
,


.
Z 
.

#
Switch announcements on O or off ª.
R
  
This function is not available in all coun‐
tries.
R
  
The multimedia system announces the
names of the roads that will follow the
upcoming change of direction.
This function is not available in all coun‐
tries and languages.
Displaying destination information
Requirement:
R
A destination is entered.
Multimedia system:
,

#
Select    .
The following information is displayed:
R
intermediate destinations and destination
The route can also include up to four
intermediate destinations.
R
Name, address
R
Remaining driving distance
R
Time of arrival
Multimedia system
299
Selecting an alternative route
Multimedia system:
,

.
À   
#
Select  .
The routes are displayed in accordance with
the setting made in the route settings.
The currently selected route is shown with a
dark blue line.
#
Select the alternative route.
Switching the automatic gas station search
on/off
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
#
Switch   on O or off ª.
Switched on O: when the fuel reserve level
is reached, a prompt appears asking whether
you want to start searching for gas stations.
Starting the automatic service station
search
Requirements:
R
ATTENTION ASSIST and the  
 function are activated (
page 233).
Driving situation
The        
  message is shown.
#
Select .
The service station search starts. The availa‐
ble service stations along the route or in the
vicinity of the vehicle's current position are
displayed.
#
Select the service station.
The service station address is displayed.
#
Method 1: if route guidance is not activated,
select   .
The selected service station is set as a desti‐
nation. Route guidance begins.
#
Method 2: if route guidance is activated,
select     or  
  .
   : the selected
service station is set as a new destination.
The previous destination and all intermediate
destinations are deleted. Route guidance to
the service station begins.
    : the
selected service station is set as the next
destination. Route guidance begins.
Route guidance
Notes on route guidance
&
WARNING Risk of distraction from oper‐
ating integrated communication equip‐
ment while the vehicle is in motion
If you operate communication equipment
integrated in the vehicle when driving, you
will be distracted from the traffic situation.
This could also cause you to lose control of
the vehicle.
#
Only operate this equipment when the
traffic situation permits.
#
If you cannot be sure of this, stop the
vehicle whilst paying attention to road
and traffic conditions and operate the
equipment with the vehicle stationary.
Route guidance begins once a route has been
calculated.
300
Multimedia system
The road and traffic rules and regulations always
have priority over multimedia system driving rec‐
ommendations.
Driving recommendations are:
R
Navigation announcements
R
Route guidance displays
R
Lane recommendations
If you do not follow the navigation announce‐
ments or if you leave the calculated route, a new
route is calculated automatically.
Driving recommendations may differ from the
actual road and traffic conditions if:
R
the route is diverted.
R
the direction of a one-way street has been
changed.
For this reason, you must always observe road
and traffic rules and regulations during your
journey.
The route may differ from the ideal route due to
the following:
R
roadworks
R
incomplete digital map data
Changing direction overview
There are three phases when changing direction:
R
Preparation phase
If there is enough time between the changes
of direction, the multimedia system prepares
you for the upcoming change of direction. A
navigation announcement, e.g. "Prepare to
turn right", is issued.
The map appears in full-screen mode.
R
Announcement phase
The multimedia system announces the
upcoming change of direction, e.g. by
announcing "Turn right in 300 feet (100 m)".
The display is split into two parts. The map is
displayed on the left; on the right, there is a
detailed image of the intersection or a 3D
image of the upcoming change of direction.
R
Change-of-direction phase
The multimedia system announces the immi‐
nent change of direction, e.g. by announcing
"Now turn right".
The display is split into two parts.
The vehicle has successfully changed direc‐
tion when the light-colored bar on the right
drops down to 0 feet (0 meters) and the cur‐
rent vehicle position symbol has reached the
highlighted change-of-direction point.
When the change of direction is complete,
the map appears in full-screen mode.
Multimedia system
301
%
Changes of direction are also shown in the
Instrument Display.
Lane recommendations overview
This display appears for multi-lane roads.
If the digital map contains the relevant data, the
multimedia system can display lane recommen‐
dations for the next two changes of direction.
1
Recommended lane
2
Possible lane
3
Lanes not recommended
R
Recommended lane 1
In this lane, you will be able to complete both
the next change of direction and the one
after that.
R
Possible lane 2
In this lane, you will only be able to complete
the next change of direction.
R
Lane not recommended 3
In this lane, you will not be able to complete
the next change of direction without chang‐
ing lane.
During the change of direction, new lanes may
be added.
%
Lane recommendations can also be dis‐
played in the Instrument Display and in the
head-up display.
Destination reached
Once the destination is reached, you will see the
checkered flag Í. Route guidance is finished.
When an intermediate destination has been
reached, you will see the intermediate destina‐
tion flag with the number of your intermediate
destination Î. After this, route guidance is
continued.
Switching navigation announcements on/off
Requirements:
R
a route has already been created.
302
Multimedia system
R
route guidance is active.
#
To switch off: press the volume control on
the multifunction steering wheel during a
navigation announcement (
page 274).
or
#
Press on the volume control to the right of
the controller during a navigation announce‐
ment (
page 274).
The    
  message appears.
or
#
Show the navigation menu ( page 291).
#
Select !  .
The symbol changes to #.
#
To switch on: select #  
.
The current navigation announcement is
played.
%
In the following situations, navigation
announcements are switched on automati‐
cally:
R
A new route guidance is started.
R
The route is recalculated.
%
You can access and add this function as a
favorite under   
 .
Switching navigation announcements on/off
during a phone call
#
Select .
#
Select õ .
#
Select    
.
#
Switch   
  on O or off ª.
Adjusting the volume of navigation
announcements
Requirements:
R
a route has already been created.
R
route guidance is active.
On the multifunction steering wheel or next
to the controller
#
Turn the volume control on the multifunction
steering wheel during a navigation announce‐
ment.
or
#
Turn the volume control to the right of the
controller during a navigation announcement
(
page 275).
%
In the following situations, the volume is
raised to the minimum volume or lowered to
the maximum volume:
R
A new route guidance is started.
R
The route is recalculated.
%
The minimum volume can be individually set
at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Via system settings
#
Select .
#
Select õ  .
#
Select    
.
#
Select   .
Multimedia system
303
#
Set the volume.
Switching audio fadeout on/off during navi‐
gation announcements
#
Select .
#
Select õ .
#
Select    
.
#
Switch     
 on O or off ª.
Repeating navigation announcements
Requirements:
R
a route has already been created.
R
route guidance is active.
Multimedia system:
,

#
Select !  .
#
Select #  .
The current navigation announcement is
repeated.
%
You can access and add this function as a
favorite under    
.
Cancels route guidance
Requirements
R
A route has already been created.
R
Route guidance is active.
Multimedia system:
,

#
Select   .
Route guidance to an off-road destination
Off-road destination: the destination is within
the digital map. However, the map contains no
roads that lead to the destination.
You can enter off-road destinations on the map.
Route guidance guides you for as long as possi‐
ble with navigation announcements and displays
on roads that are known to the multimedia sys‐
tem.
Shortly before you reach the last known position
on the map, you will hear the "Please follow the
direction arrow" announcement. The display
shows a direction arrow and the linear distance
to the destination.
Route guidance from an off-road location to
a destination
Off-road position: the current vehicle position is
located within the digital map on roads that are
not available.
The following displays appear when route guid‐
ance begins:
R
the    message
R
a direction arrow showing the linear direction
to the POI
When the vehicle is back on a road known to the
multimedia system, route guidance continues as
normal.
Notes on the off-road status during route
guidance
Due to roadworks, for example, there may be dif‐
ferences between the data on the digital map
and the actual course of the road. In such cases,
the multimedia system will te
mporarily be
un
able to locate the vehicle's current position on
the digital map. The vehicle is off-road.
304
Multimedia system
The following displays appear when the vehicle
is off-road:
R
the    message
R
a direction arrow showing the linear direction
to the POI
When the vehicle is back on a road known to the
multimedia system, route guidance continues as
normal.
Destination
Saving the current vehicle position
Multimedia system:
,

#
Alternatively: if the map is displayed in full
screen mode, press Touch Control, the con‐
troller or the touchpad.
The map menu appears.
#
Select 1 on the map menu ( page 309).
The current vehicle position is saved to the
"Previous destinations" memory.
Storing a map position
Multimedia system:
,

The map is in full-screen mode.
#
Press Touch Control, the controller or the
touchpad.
#
Select "Move map" in map menu 2
(
page 309).
#
Select a position on the map.
If multiple entries are available for a map
position, a list appears.
#
Highlight an entry.
#
Select ¥    
.
The map position is saved to the "Previous
destinations" memory.
Editing the previous destinations
Multimedia system:
,

.
¬   

.
 
#
Highlight one of the previous destinations.
#
To save as a favorite: select ¥  
 .
The favorites are displayed.
#
Move the favorite to the desired position.
If a favorite has already been added at this
position, it will be overwritten.
#
To save as "Home" address: select ¥
  .
#
To save as "Work" address: select ¥
  .
#
To delete a single or all destinations:
select ¥  or  .
A prompt appears.
#
Select .
#
To display destination information: select
¥ .
Multimedia system
305
Using intelligent destination suggestions
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
.

  
The navigation system learns the user habits of
the driver. The most probable destinations are
suggested.
#
Activate O  .
The destination suggestions are displayed in
previous destinations and can be selected for
route guidance.
#
To not use the function: switch 
 off ª.
#
To delete destination suggestions: select
.
Using external destinations and routes
External destinations and routes can be received
from the following sources:
R
Mercedes-Benz Apps
R
door-to-door navigation with Companion App
(USA)
R
via an MB Info call to the Mercedes-Benz
Customer Assistance Center
R
Rear Seat Entertainment System
A prompt appears on the media display.
Received destinations and routes are saved in
the previous destinations.
#
If a destination is received: select  and
continue with method 1 or 2.
or
#
If a destination was received with photo
information, select   .
Route guidance starts.
#
Method 1: if route guidance is not activated,
select   .
The route to the destination is calculated.
The map shows the route. Route guidance
then begins.
#
Method 2: if route guidance is activated,
select     or  
  .
   : the received des‐
tination address is set as a new destination.
The previous destinations and intermediate
destinations are deleted. Route guidance to
the new destination begins.
    : the
received destination address is set as the
next new destination. Route guidance begins.
#
If a route is received: select  
     or 
    .
Route guidance starts from the selected
position.
Route guidance with current traffic reports
Traffic information overview
Traffic reports are received using Live Traffic
Information and are used for route guidance.
This service is unavailable in some countries.
There may be differences between the traffic
reports received and the actual road and traffic
conditions.
Important information on Live Traffic Informa‐
tion:
R
Current traffic reports are received via the
Internet connection.
306
Multimedia system
R
The traffic situation is updated at short, regu‐
lar intervals.
R
The subscription information shows the sta‐
tus (
page 307).
Information on the vehicle's position is regularly
sent to Daimler AG. The data is immediately ren‐
dered anonymous by Daimler AG and forwarded
to the traffic data provider. Using this data, traf‐
fic reports relevant to the vehicle's position are
sent to the vehicle. The vehicle acts as a sensor
for the flow of traffic and helps to improve the
quality of the traffic reports.
If you do not wish to transmit your vehicle posi‐
tion, you can have this service deactivated at an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Displaying subscription information
Requirements:
R
The vehicle is equipped with Live Traffic
Information.
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
The subscription expiration date is automatically
displayed:
R
one month before the expiration date
R
one week before the expiration date
R
on the expiration date
#
To display manually: select   
 .
Depending on the status, one of the following
messages appears:
R
the period of validity for the subscription
is displayed.
R
the subscription has expired.
%
The subscription can be extended:
R
at any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
R
via an MB Info call to the Mercedes-Benz
Customer Assistance Center
Displaying the traffic map
Requirements:
R
For Live Traffic Information: the vehicle is
equipped with a communication module fea‐
turing an activated, integrated SIM card.
R
When the vehicle is started, the communica‐
tion module automatically establishes an
Internet connection. Traffic information is
made available shortly afterwards.
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
.


#
Alternatively: if the map is displayed in full
screen mode, press Touch Control, the con‐
troller or the touchpad.
The map menu appears.
#
Activate O º.
The traffic map shows the following information,
for example:
R
traffic incidents, for example:
-
roadworks
-
road blocks
Multimedia system
307
-
warning messages
The symbols for traffic incidents are dis‐
played in color (on the route) or gray (off the
route).
R
traffic flow information:
-
traffic jam (red line)
-
slow-moving traffic (yellow line)
-
free-flowing traffic (green line)
R
display for traffic delays on the route lasting
at least one minute
R
warning message symbols:
-
symbol Ô
-
additional road safety notes when
approaching a traffic incident, e.g. the
end of a traffic jam
If the vehicle approaches a danger area
on the route, a warning message is dis‐
played on the map. A warning message
may also be issued (
page 309).
Displaying traffic incidents
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
.


#
Activate O  .
Roadworks, road blocks, local area reports
(e.g. fog) and warning messages are dis‐
played.
Activating free flow and traffic display
#
Activate O    and 
.
%
The traffic delay is displayed for the current
route. Traffic delays lasting one minute or
longer are taken into consideration.
Displaying details
#
Displaying the traffic map ( page 307).
#
Moving the map ( page 310).
#
When a traffic report symbol is under the
crosshair, press Touch Control, the controller
or the touchpad.
The traffic report details are displayed.
or
#
Press Touch Control, the controller or the
touchpad.
#
Select    .
The map shows the traffic report symbols in
the vicinity.
Traffic report information is displayed in the
status line:
R
traffic report symbol
R
reason for the traffic report, e.g. traffic
jam
R
warning message (highlighted in red)
#
To select a traffic report symbol: select
 or .
#
Press Touch Control, the controller or the
touchpad.
The traffic report details are displayed.
308
Multimedia system
Issuing hazard alerts
Multimedia system:
,


.
Z 
.

#
Activate O   .
Warning messages are issued and tailbacks
which pose a risk are announced.
Map and compass
Map and compass overview
1
To save the current vehicle position
2
To move the map
3
To select the map orientation and map view
4
To select the function depending on the
equipment:
To transmit a hazard alert (Car-to-X)
To filter the display of POIs in the vicinity
according to POI category
5
To switch the display of personal POI sym‐
bols on the map on or off
6
To switch one of the following displays on or
off depending on the equipment:
Weather information
Satellite map
Traffic incidents
7
To switch the traffic map display on or off
The map and satellite images are shown in globe
projection. This allows for a realistic map display
in all map scales. The map uses elevation model‐
ing.
Depending on the map data, important buildings
in many cities are depicted realistically on the
map in small map scales (1/32 mi (20 m),
1/16 mi (50 m)). Other buildings are shown as
models.
%
You can set the unit of measurement of the
map scale (
page 284).
Multimedia system
309
If online information is available, fuel prices and
the availability of parking spaces in parking
garages are displayed, for example.
%
Online information is not available in all
countries.
%
Requirement (USA): Mercedes-Benz
mbrace
®
is activated.
If    is activated in Traffic Sign
Assist (
page 235), speed limits and overtak‐
ing restrictions are displayed on the map.
%
Company logos displayed on the map are
trademarks of the respective companies and
used solely for the purpose of indicating the
locations of these companies. The use of
such logos on the map does not indicate
approval of, support of or advertising by
these companies for the navigation system
itself.
Setting the map scale
Requirements:
R
The map is shown.
Multimedia system:
,

#
To zoom in: swipe down on Touch Control.
or
#
Turn the controller counter-clockwise.
or
#
Move two fingers apart on the touchpad.
#
To zoom out: swipe up on Touch Control.
or
#
Turn the controller clockwise.
or
#
Move two fingers together on the touchpad.
%
You can set the unit of measurement of the
map scale (
page 284).
Moving the map
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
.


#
Alternatively: if the map is displayed in full
screen mode, press Touch Control, the con‐
troller or the touchpad.
The map menu appears.
#
Select "Move map" in map menu 2
(
page 309).
#
Swipe in any direction on Touch Control or
touchpad.
or
#
Slide the controller in any direction.
The map moves in the corresponding direc‐
tion under the crosshair. The further you
move your finger away from the starting posi‐
tion on the touchpad, the faster the map
moves.
310
Multimedia system
Selecting the map orientation
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
.


#
Alternatively: if the map is displayed in full
screen mode, press Touch Control or the
touchpad.
The map menu appears.
#
In map menu 3 , select ,  or
(
page 309).
R
: the 2D map view is displayed so that
north is always at the top.
R
: the 2D map view is aligned to the
direction of travel.
R
: the 3D map view is aligned to the
direction of travel.
Selecting POI symbols
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
.


POIs include gas stations and hotels which can
be displayed as symbols on the map, for exam‐
ple. Not all POIs are available everywhere.
#
Select  .
The # dot indicates the current setting.
 displays symbols of predefined cat‐
egories on the map.
  allows you to personally select
the symbols for the available categories.
 switches the display off.
#
Select a setting.
#
 : select categories.
The POI symbols of the selected categories
are displayed O or not displayed ª.
Selecting text information
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
.


#
Select text information.
  shows the street you are cur‐
rently driving on at the bottom of the display.
When the map is moved, the following infor‐
mation appears under the crosshair:
R
street name
R
POI name
R
area name
 displays the following infor‐
mation:
R
longitude and latitude
R
elevation
The elevation shown may deviate from
the actual elevation.
R
number of satellites from which a signal
can be received
When the map is moved, this information
does not appear.
  displays the current climate
control settings.
 switches the display off.
Displaying the next intersecting street
Requirements:
R
Route guidance is not active.
Multimedia system
311
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
#
Activate O   .
The name of the next intersecting street will
be displayed at the upper edge of the display.
Displaying the map version
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
#
Select  .
#
Select .
%
Information about new versions of the digital
map can be obtained from an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
Avoiding an area
You can define areas along a route that you
would like to avoid.
Avoiding a new area
Multimedia system:
,

.
À   

.
 
.

#
Select   .
#
To search for an area via the map: select
 .
#
Move the map
or
#
To search for an area using an address:
select  .
#
Enter the address.
#
Select  .
The map appears.
#
To display an area: press Touch Control, the
touchpad or the controller.
A red rectangle appears. This designates the
area that should be avoided.
#
To change the size of the area: swipe up or
down on Touch Control or the touchpad.
or
#
Slide the controller up or down.
The map scale is enlarged or reduced and
changes the size of the area.
#
To set the area: press Touch Control, the
touchpad or the controller.
The area is entered into the list.
Changing an area
Multimedia system:
,

.
À   

.
 
.

#
Highlight an area in the list.
#
Select ¥ .
Moving the area on the map
#
Swipe in any direction on Touch Control or
touchpad.
or
#
Slide the controller in any direction.
Changing the size of the area
#
To start: press Touch Control, the touchpad
or the controller.
#
To change: swipe up or down on Touch Con‐
trol or the touchpad.
or
#
Slide the controller up or down.
#
To stop: press Touch Control, the touchpad
or the controller.
312
Multimedia system
Taking the area for the route into account
#
Avoid O an area in the list.
If route guidance is active, a new route is cal‐
culated.
If there is no route yet, the setting is carried
over to the next route guidance.
The route can include an area that is to be
avoided in the following cases:
R
the destination is located in an area that
is to be avoided
R
there is no sensible alternative route
Deleting one or all areas
Multimedia system:
,

.
À   

.
 
.

#
Highlight an area in the list.
#
Select ¥  or ¥  .
#
Confirm the prompt with .
One or all areas are deleted.
Map data update overview
Updating at an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center
The digital maps generated by the map software
become outdated in the same way as conven‐
tional road maps. Optimal route guidance can
only be provided by the navigation system in
conjunction with the most up-to-date map data.
Information about new versions of the digital
map can be obtained from an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
You can receive updates to the digital map there.
Map data
Your vehicle is supplied with map data at the fac‐
tory. Depending on the country, map data for
your region is either pre-installed or the map
data is supplied on a data storage medium. You
do not require an activation code for the map
data which is provided with your vehicle.
If the map data on your vehicle has been instal‐
led at the factory and you wish to reinstall it, you
do not need to enter the activation code.
An activation code is required for purchased
map data.
Observe the following notes:
R
the activation code can be used for one vehi‐
cle
R
the activation code is not transferable
R
the activation code has six digits
In the event of the following problems, please
contact a
n authorized Mercedes-Benz Center:
R
the multimedia system does not accept the
activation code
R
you have lost the activation code
Displaying the compass
Multimedia system:
,

.
À   
#
Select .
The compass display shows the following
information:
R
the current direction of travel with bear‐
ing (360 degree format) and compass
direction
R
longitude and latitude coordinates in
degrees, minutes and seconds
Multimedia system
313
R
height (rounded)
R
number of GPS satellites from which a
signal can be received
Setting the map scale automatically
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
The map scale is set automatically depending on
your driving speed.
For journeys in cities with detailed city models, a
map view from the driver's perspective is used.
#
Switch   on O or off ª.
%
The automatically selected map scale can be
changed manually for a short time. The set‐
ting is reset automatically after a few sec‐
onds.
Displaying the satellite map
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
.


#
Switch   on O or off ª.
or
#
If satellite map display 6 is available in the
map menu, switch it on O or off ª
(
page 309).
Switched on O: satellite maps are displayed
in map scales of 2 mi (2 km).
Switched off ª: satellite maps are not dis‐
played in map scales from 2 mi (2 km) to
10 mi (10 km).
%
Satellite maps for these map scales are not
available in all countries.
Displaying weather information
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
.


#
Activate O  .
or
#
If weather information display 6 is available
in the map menu, activate O(
page 309)
it.
Current weather information is displayed on
the navigation map, e.g. temperature or
cloud cover.
%
Weather information is not available in all
countries.
%
Requirement (USA): Mercedes-Benz
mbrace
®
is activated.
%
This function is not available in all countries.
Calling up the Digital Operator's Manual
(navigation)
Information on navigation
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
.

 
#
Select the topic.
314
Multimedia system
Telephone
Telephony
Telephone menu overview
1
Bluetooth
®
device name of the currently
connected mobile phone
2
Signal strength of the mobile phone network
3
Battery status of the connected mobile
phone
4
¢ (telephone ready) or w (call active)
5
 ( page 320)
6
  ( page 322)
7
  ( page 316)
8
 
9
Active call
A

Symbols 1 to 4 are not shown until after a
mobile phone has been connected to the multi‐
media system. The symbols depend on your
mobile phone and your mobile phone network
provider.
Bluetooth
®
profile overview
Bluetooth
®
profile
of the mobile phone
Function
PBAP (Phone Book
Access Profile)
Contacts are auto‐
matically displayed in
the multimedia sys‐
tem
MAP (Message
Access Profile)
Message functions
can be used
Telephony operating modes overview
Depending on your equipment, the following tel‐
ephony operating modes are available:
R
A mobile phone is connected to the multime‐
dia system via Bluetooth
®
( page 316).
Multimedia system
315
Notes on telephony
&
WARNING Risk of distraction from oper‐
ating integrated communication equip‐
ment while the vehicle is in motion
If you operate communication equipment
integrated in the vehicle when driving, you
will be distracted from the traffic situation.
This could also cause you to lose control of
the vehicle.
#
Only operate this equipment when the
traffic situation permits.
#
If you cannot be sure of this, stop the
vehicle whilst paying attention to road
and traffic conditions and operate the
equipment with the vehicle stationary.
&
WARNING Risk of distraction from oper‐
ating mobile communication equipment
while the vehicle is in motion
If you operate communication equipment
integrated in the vehicle when driving, you
will be distracted from the traffic situation.
This could also cause you to lose control of
the vehicle.
Only operate this equipment when the vehi‐
cle is stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for the
country in which you are currently driving when
operating mobile communication equipment in
the vehicle.
Further information can be obtained from an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or at: http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect.
To improve voice quality, the multimedia system
supports telephone calls in HD Voice
®
.
In order to use this function, the mobile phones
and the mobile phone network provider of the
person you are calling must support HD Voice
®
.
Depending on the quality of the connection, the
voice quality may fluctuate.
The following situations can lead to the call
being disconnected while the vehicle is in
motion:
R
There is insufficient network coverage in the
area.
R
You move from one GSM or UMTS transmit‐
ter/receiver area (cell) into another and no
communication channels are free.
R
The SIM card used is not compatible with the
network available.
R
A mobile phone with "Twincard" is logged
into the network with the second SIM card at
the same time.
Connecting a mobile phone (Bluetooth
®
tel‐
ephony)
Requirements:
R
Bluetooth
®
is activated on the mobile phone
(see the manufacturer's operating instruc‐
tions).
R
Bluetooth
®
is activated on the multimedia
system (
page 279).
316
Multimedia system
Multimedia system:
,

.
á  
Searching for a mobile phone
#
Select   .
#
Select    .
The available mobile phones are displayed. If
a new mobile phone is found, it is indicated
by the á symbol.
Connecting a mobile phone (authorization
using Secure Simple Pairing)
#
Select the mobile phone.
A code is displayed in the multimedia system
and on the mobile phone.
#
If the codes match: confirm the code on
the mobile phone.
Connecting a mobile phone (authorization by
entering a passkey)
#
Select the mobile phone.
#
Choose a one to sixteen-digit number combi‐
nation as a passkey.
#
On the multimedia system: enter the pass‐
key and select a.
#
On the mobile phone: enter the passkey
again and confirm.
%
Up to 15 mobile phones can be authorized
on the multimedia system.
Authorized mobile phones are reconnected
automatically.
Disconnecting a mobile phone (deauthoriz‐
ing)
Multimedia system:
,

.
á  
#
Select the mobile phone from the device list.
#
Select ¥.
#
Select .
#
Select .
Switching mobile phones
Requirements:
R
The mobile phones are authorized
(
page 316).
Multimedia system:
,

.
á  
#
In the device list, select a mobile phone
which has already been authorized.
%
Only one mobile phone can be connected at
any one time. The connected mobile phone
is displayed at the top of the list.
Using the mobile phone with Near Field Com‐
munication (NFC)
Requirements:
R
NFC is activated on the mobile phone (see
the manufacturer's operating instructions)
R
the mobile phone's screen is switched on
and unlocked (see the manufacturer's oper‐
ating instructions)
NFC enables short-range wireless data transfer.
Multimedia system
317
#
To connect a mobile phone: open the cover
of the armrest on the center console.
#
Place the NFC area of the mobile phone (see
manufacturer's operating instructions) on
NFC logo 1.
The mobile phone is connected to the multi‐
media system.
#
To change mobile phones: place the NFC
area of the mobile phone on NFC logo 1.
If the mobile phone has already been author‐
ized on the multimedia system, it is now con‐
nected.
If the mobile phone is authorized on the mul‐
timedia system for the first time, it is connec‐
ted after confirming the mobile phone
instructions (see the manufacturer's operat‐
ing instructions).
Further information can be found at: http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
Further functions without having a mobile phone
authorized on the multimedia system (see manu‐
facturer's operating instructions):
R
transferring a contact or a business card,
e.g. for direct navigation to an entered
address
R
transferring a URL to be viewed in the multi‐
media system
R
setting up the vehicle's Wi-Fi access data via
the system settings (
page 281)
Setting the reception and transmission vol‐
ume
Requirements:
R
A mobile phone is authorized ( page 316).
Multimedia system:
,

.
á  
This function ensures optimal language quality.
#
Highlight the mobile phone in the device list.
#
Select ¥.
#
Select   or 
.
#
Set the volume.
Further information on the recommended recep‐
tion and transmission volume: http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
Adjusting the call and ringtone volume
Multimedia system:
,

.
õ 
.

#
Select   or  .
#
Set the volume.
318
Multimedia system
Starting/stopping mobile phone voice recog‐
nition
Requirements:
R
the mobile phone is connected to the multi‐
media system (
page 316).
Starting mobile phone voice recognition
#
Press and hold the ó button on the multi‐
function steering wheel for more than one
second.
You can use mobile phone voice recognition.
Stopping mobile phone voice recognition
#
Press the 8 or ~ button on the multi‐
function steering wheel.
Calls
Using the telephone
Multimedia system:
,

.
ª 
Making a call
#
Select  .
#
Enter the number.
#
Select w.
The call is made.
Accepting a call
#
Select .
Rejecting a call
#
Select .
Ending a call
#
Select =.
Activating functions during a call
#
To show all functions, navigate down.
The following functions are available during a
call:
R
 
R
  
R
 (show to send DTMF tones)
R
Switch   on O or off ª.
R
  (an active call in hands-free
mode is transferred over to the telephone)
Conducting calls with several participants
Requirements:
R
There is an active call ( page 319).
R
Another call is being made.
Switching between calls
#
Select call #.
The selected call is active. The other call is
on hold.
Activating or ending a call on hold
#
Select   or  .
Conducting a conference call
#
Select    in the tele‐
phone menu.
The new participant is included in the confer‐
ence call.
Ending an active call
#
Select =.
%
On some mobile phones, the call on hold is
activated as soon as the active call is ended.
Multimedia system
319
Accepting/rejecting a waiting call
Requirements:
R
There is an active call ( page 319).
If you receive a call while already in a call, a
message is displayed. An acoustic signal also
sounds.
#
Select .
The incoming call is active. The previous call
is on hold.
#
Select .
%
This function and behavior depends on your
mobile phone network provider and the
mobile phone (see the manufacturer's oper‐
ating instructions).
Contacts
Information about the contacts menu
The contacts menu contains all contacts from
existing data sources, e.g. mobile phone or
memory card.
It is possible to store up to 6,000 contacts:
R
3,000 entries are for permanently saved con‐
tacts.
R
3,000 for contacts loaded from the mobile
phone.
From the contacts menu, you can perform the
following actions:
R
Telephone operation
-
Calling a contact ( page 322)
-
Calling a new number ( page 319)
R
Navigation ( page 295)
R
Compose messages ( page 323)
If a mobile phone is connected to the multimedia
system (
page 316) and automatic calling up
(
page 320) is activated, the mobile phone's
contacts are displayed in the address book.
Downloading mobile phone contacts
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
Automatically
#
Activate O   
.
Manually
#
Deactivate ª   
.
#
Select  .
Calling up contacts
Multimedia system:
,

.
ª 
Depending on the character set, the following
options can be used to search for contacts:
R
searching by initials
R
searching by name
R
searching by phone number
#
Enter characters into the search field.
A selection of possible contacts appears.
Entering more characters into the search
field narrows down the number of possible
selections.
#
Select the contact.
A contact can contain the following details:
R
phone numbers
R
navigation addresses
320
Multimedia system
R
geo-coordinates
R
Internet address
Editing the format of a contact's name
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
.
 

The following options are available:
R
   
R
   
R
   
#
Select an option.
Overview of importing contacts
Importing contacts as electronic business
cards
Source Requirements:
ò Memory cardThe SD memory card
is inserted.
ò USB device The USB device is
inserted in the USB
port.
Source Requirements:
ñ Bluetooth
®
con‐
nection
If the sending of
vCards via Bluetooth
®
is supported, vCards
can be received on
mobile phones or net‐
books, for example.
Bluetooth
®
is activa‐
ted in the multimedia
system and on the
respective device
(see the manufactur‐
er's operating instruc‐
tions).
ó Mobile phone The mobile phone is
connected to the mul‐
timedia system.
Importing contacts into the contacts menu
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
#
Select .
#
Select an option.
Multimedia system
321
Saving a mobile phone contact
Multimedia system:
,

.
ª 
#
Select the ó mobile phone contact.
#
Select ¥.
#
Select   .
The contact saved in the multimedia system
is identified by the f symbol.
Calling a contact
Multimedia system:
,

.
ª 
#
Enter characters into the search field.
#
Select the contact.
#
Select the telephone number.
The number is dialed.
Selecting further options in the contacts
menu
Multimedia system:
,

.
ª 
#
Select a contact.
#
Select ¥.
Depending on the stored data, the following
options are available:
R

R
  
R
  (if a web address has been
stored)
R
 (if an address has been stored)
R
   
R
   (for a number with DTMF
tones)
#
Select an option.
Deleting a contact
Multimedia system:
,

.
ª 
You can delete contacts stored in the vehicle.
#
Search for the contact.
#
Select the contact.
#
Select ¥.
#
Select  .
#
Select .
Call list
Call list overview
If your mobile phone supports the PBAP Blue‐
tooth
®
profile:
R
The call lists from the mobile phone are dis‐
played in the multimedia system.
R
When connecting the mobile phone, you may
have to confirm the connection for the PBAP
Bluetooth
®
profile.
If your mobile phone does not support the PBAP
Bluetooth
®
profile:
R
The multimedia system generates its own call
lists.
R
The call list is not synchronized with the call
lists in the mobile phone.
Making a call from the call list
Multimedia system:
,

.
ø    
#
Select an entry.
The call is made.
322
Multimedia system
Options in the call list
Multimedia system:
,

.
ø    
#
Highlight an entry.
#
Select ¥.
The following options are available:
R
  
R
 
Text messages
Notes on the text message functions
If the connected mobile phone supports the
MAP Bluetooth
®
profile, the text message func‐
tions can be used on the multimedia system.
You can obtain further information about set‐
tings and supported functions of Bluetooth
®
-
capable mobile phones from an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or at: http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
Some mobile phones require further settings
after being connected to the multimedia system
(see manufacturer's operating instructions).
New messages are identified by the 1 symbol
in the multimedia system's display and an audi‐
ble signal.
Depending on the mobile phone, the multimedia
system only displays new incoming text mes‐
sages or the 100 newest text messages.
Configuring the displayed text messages
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
.
 

#
Select ¥.
A menu with the following options is shown:
R
 
R
   
R
 
R
 (The text messages are not displayed
automatically.)
#
Select an option.
Reading text messages
Multimedia system:
,

.
i  
Reading a text message
#
Select a text message.
The message text is displayed.
Using the read-aloud function
#
Select a text message.
#
Select  .
The text message is read aloud.
Composing and sending a text message
Multimedia system:
,

.
i  
#
Navigate to the left twice.
#
Select    .
Adding a recipient
#
Select    .
#
Select the contact.
Multimedia system
323
Dictating text
#
Select   .
The App for the dictation function is loaded.
If there was no prior Internet connection, a
connection is now established.
#
To start the dictation function: press the
controller or touchpad.
#
Say the message.
The dictation ends automatically after you
have finished speaking.
After the voice message has been processed,
it is shown as text.
Editing text
#
Select the word.
#
To call up the correction menu: press the
controller or touchpad.
The following options are available:
R
adjusting the capitalization of words (if
supported by the character set)
R
expanding the choice of words
R
deleting the selection
R
recording a new dictation
#
To leave the menu: select .
Sending text messages
#
Select   .
Replying to a text message
Multimedia system:
,

.
i  
#
Select the text message.
#
Select ¥.
#
Select .
Calling a text message sender
Multimedia system:
,

.
i  
#
Select the text message.
#
Select ¥.
#
Select  .
Further options in the text message menu
Multimedia system:
,

.
i  
#
Select ¥.
#
To delete a text message: select .
#
To change folders: select  .
#

or
#
Select .
Apple CarPlay™
Overview of Apple CarPlay™
iPhone
®
functions can be used via the multime‐
dia system using Apple CarPlay™. They are oper‐
ated using the controller or the Siri
®
voice-oper‐
ated control system. You can activate the voice-
operated control system by pressing and holding
the ó button on the multifunction steering
wheel.
When using Apple CarPlay™ via the voice-oper‐
ated control system, the multimedia system can
324
Multimedia system
still be operated via the Voice Control System
(
page 256).
Only one mobile phone at a time can be connec‐
ted via Apple CarPlay™ to the multimedia sys‐
tem.
The availability of Apple CarPlay™ may vary
according to the country.
The service provider is responsible for this appli‐
cation and the services and content connected
to it.
Notes on Apple CarPlay™
While using Apple CarPlay™ various functions of
the multimedia system, e.g. telephony or the
media sources Bluetooth
®
audio and iPod
®
, are
unavailable.
Only one route guidance can be active at a time.
If route guidance is active on the multimedia sys‐
tem, it is closed when route guidance is started
on the mobile phone.
Connecting an iPhone
®
via Apple CarPlay™
Requirements:
R
Apple
®
operating system version iOS 8.3 or
above is installed on the iPhone
®
.
R
There is an Internet connection for the full
range of functions for Apple CarPlay™.
R
The iPhone
®
is connected to the multimedia
system via the USB port ç using a suita‐
ble cable (
page 341).
Multimedia system:
,

.
 
Setting automatic or manual start
A message appears when connected for the first
time.
#
Automatic start: select .
  is activated O.
Apple CarPlay™ will now start immediately
after the iPhone
®
is connected to the multi‐
media system using a USB cable.
#
Manual start: select .
#
Select the iPhone
®
in the device list.
Accepting/rejecting the data protection reg‐
ulations
A message with the data protection regulations
appears.
#
Select  .
or
#
Select  .
If you selected automatic start, you will have
to start Apple CarPlay™ manually the next
time you want to use it.
Exiting Apple CarPlay™
#
Press the ò button on the multifunction
steering wheel, for example.
%
If Apple CarPlay™ was not displayed in the
foreground before disconnecting, the appli‐
cation starts in the background when recon‐
nected. You can call up Apple CarPlay
®
in
the main menu.
Calling up Apple CarPlay™ sound settings
Multimedia system:
,

.
 
.

#
Select the tone menu ( page 358).
Multimedia system
325
Ending Apple CarPlay™
Multimedia system:
,

.
 
#
Select .
The connection is ended.
The mobile phone continues to be supplied
with electricity.
or
#
Disconnect the connecting cable between
the mobile phone and multimedia system.
Mercedes-Benz recommends disconnecting
the connecting cable only when the vehicle is
stationary.
Android Auto
Android Auto overview
Mobile phone functions can be used with
Android Auto using the Android operating sys‐
tem on the multimedia system. It is operated
using the controller or the voice-operated con‐
trol system. You can activate the voice-operated
control system by pressing and holding the ó
button on the multifunction steering wheel.
When using Android Auto via the voice-operated
control system, the multimedia system can still
be operated via the Voice Control System
(
page 256).
Only one mobile phone at a time can be connec‐
ted via Android Auto to the multimedia system.
The availability of Android Auto and Android Auto
Apps may vary according to the country.
The service provider is responsible for this appli‐
cation and the services and content connected
to it.
Notes on Android Auto
While using Android Auto, various functions of
the multimedia system, for example, the media
source Bluetooth
®
audio, are not available.
Only one route guidance can be active at a time.
If route guidance is active on the multimedia sys‐
tem, it is closed when route guidance is started
on the mobile phone.
Connecting a mobile phone via Android Auto
Requirements:
R
The first activation of Android Auto on the
multimedia system must be carried out when
the vehicle is
stat
ionary for safety reasons.
R
The mobile phone supports Android Auto
from Android 5.0.
R
The Android Auto App is installed on the
mobile phone.
R
In order to use the telephone functions, the
mobile phone must be connected to the mul‐
timedia system via Bluetooth
®
( page 316).
If there was no prior Internet connection, this
is established with the use of the mobile
phone with Android Auto.
R
The mobile phone is connected to the multi‐
media system via the USB port ç using a
suitable cable (
page 341).
R
There is an Internet connection for the full
range of functions for Android Auto.
326
Multimedia system
Multimedia system:
,

.
 
#
Select the mobile phone from the device list.
Accepting/rejecting the data protection reg‐
ulations
A message with the data protection regulations
appears.
#
Select  .
or
#
Select  .
Activating automatic start
#
Select   O.
Starting manually
#
Select the mobile phone from the device list.
Exiting Android Auto
#
Press the ò button on the multifunction
steering wheel, for example.
%
If Android Auto was not displayed in the fore
ground before disconnecting, the application
starts in the background when reconnected.
You can call up Android Auto in the main
menu.
Calling up the Android Auto sound settings
Multimedia system:
,

.
 
.

#
Select the tone menu ( page 358).
Ending Android Auto
Multimedia system:
,

.
 
#
Select .
The connection is ended.
The mobile phone continues to be supplied
with electricity.
or
#
Disconnect the connecting cable between
the mobile phone and multimedia system.
Mercedes-Benz recommends disconnecting
the connecting cable only when the vehicle is
stationary.
Transferred vehicle data when using Apple
CarPlay™ and Android Auto
Notes on transferred vehicle data
When using Android Auto or Apple CarPlay™,
certain vehicle data is transferred to the mobile
phone. This enables you to get the best out of
selected mobile phone services. Vehicle data is
not directly accessible.
System information:
R
software release of the multimedia system
R
system ID (anonymized)
The transfer of this data is used to optimize com‐
munication between the vehicle and the mobile
phone.
To do this, and to assign several vehicles to the
mobile phone, a vehicle ID is randomly gener‐
ated.
This has no connection to the vehicle identifica‐
tion number (VIN) and is deleted when the multi‐
media system is reset (
page 288).
Driving status data:
R
transmission position engaged
Multimedia system
327
R
distinction between parked, standstill, rolling
and driving
R
day/night mode of the instrument cluster
The transfer of this data is used to alter how
content is displayed to correspond to the driving
situation.
Position data:
R
coordinates
R
speed
R
compass direction
R
acceleration direction
This data is only transferred while the navigation
system is active in order to improve it (e.g. so it
can continue functioning when in a tunnel).
Mercedes-Benz mbrace
®
(USA)
Making a call via the overhead control panel
Mercedes-Benz mbrace
®
is available in the USA.
1
Breakdown assistance call
2
SOS button cover
3
MB Info call
4
SOS button
#
To make a breakdown assistance call:
press button 1.
This initiates a call to the Mercedes-Benz
Customer Assistance Center.
#
To make an emergency call: press SOS
button cover 2 briefly to open.
#
Press and hold SOS button 4 for at least
one second.
This initiates a call to the Mercedes-Benz
Customer Assistance Center.
#
To make an MB Info call: press button 3.
This initiates a call to the Mercedes-Benz
Customer Assistance Center.
An emergency call can be initiated even if a
breakdown assistance or MB Info call is active.
This has priority over all other active calls.
Calls via the overhead control panel are only
possible with an available mobile phone net‐
work.
Further information on Mercedes-Benz mbrace
®
and other services can be found at: http://
www.mbusa.com
328
Multimedia system
Information on the emergency call system
&
WARNING Risk of accident and injury
despite pressing the SOS button
Even if you press the SOS button in an emer‐
gency, remaining in the vehicle may be dan‐
gerous for the following reasons:
R
you see smoke inside or outside of the
vehicle, e.g. if there is a fire after an acci‐
dent
R
the vehicle is on a dangerous section of
road
R
the vehicle is not visible or cannot easily
be seen by other road users, particularly
when dark or in poor visibility conditions
#
Leave the vehicle immediately in this or
similar situations as soon as it is safe to
do so.
#
Move to a safe location along with other
vehicle occupants.
#
In such situations, secure the vehicle in
accordance with national regulations,
e.g. with a warning triangle.
Automatic emergency call
The emergency call is initiated:
R
when an air bag is deployed
R
when an Emergency Tensioning Device is
triggered
You can end an automatically initiated emer‐
gency call yourself after 60 seconds.
Manual emergency call
An emergency call can be initiated manually via
the SOS button in the overhead control panel
(
page 328).
If you leave the vehicle immediately after press‐
ing the SOS button, you do not know if
Mercedes-Benz mbrace
®
has successfully made
the emergency call.
Initiated emergency call
A voice connection between the Customer Assis‐
tance Center and the vehicle occupants is estab‐
lished:
R
if the vehicle occupants are responsive, the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center
asks for more detailed information on the
emergency.
R
if no vehicle occupant answers, an ambu‐
lance is sent to the vehicle immediately.
Transferred data
During the voice connection to the Customer
Assistance Center, the following data is transfer‐
red:
R
current vehicle location
R
vehicle identification number
Emergency call not possible
R
if the mobile phone network is unavailable,
Mercedes-Benz mbrace
®
is not able to make
an emergency call.
A corresponding message appears in the
multimedia system display.
The indicator lamp flashes continuously.
In this case, seek assista
nce by other means.
Information on the MB Info ca
ll
An Info call to the Mercedes-Benz Customer
Assistance Center has been initiated via the
overhead control panel (
page 328).
Multimedia system
329
You can find information on the following topics:
R
Mercedes-Benz mbrace
®
activation
R
operating the vehicle
R
nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
R
other products and services from Mercedes-
Benz
Data is transmitted during the connection to the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center
(
page 330).
Information on the Roadside Assistance call
A Roadside Assistance call to the Mercedes-
Benz Customer Assistance Center has been initi‐
ated via the overhead control panel:
R
The problem with the vehicle is analyzed
using remote diagnosis.
Further information about this can be
obtained at: http://www.mbusa.com
R
A qualified Mercedes-Benz technician carries
out repairs on site and/or the vehicle will be
towed to the nearest
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
You may be charged for these services.
Data is transmitted during the connection to the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center
(
page 330).
Transferred data during a service call
In certain countries you must confirm the data
transfer.
If you make service calls using Mercedes-Benz
mbrace
®
(USA), transferred data includes the
following:
Overview of transferred data
Service callTransferred data
MB Info call
Roadside Assistance
call
R
Current vehicle
location
R
Vehicle identifica‐
tion number
R
Service code
R
Selected data
about the status
of the vehicle
Online and Internet functions
Internet connection
Information on connecting to the Internet
&
WARNING Risk of distraction from infor‐
mation systems and communications
equipment
If you operate information and communica‐
tion equipment integrated in the vehicle
when driving, you will be distracted from the
traffic situation. This could also cause you to
lose control of the vehicle.
#
Only operate this equipment when the
traffic situation permits.
#
If you cannot be sure of this, stop the
vehicle whilst paying attention to road
and traffic conditions and operate the
equipment with the vehicle stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for the
country in which you are currently driving when
operating the multimedia system.
330
Multimedia system
USA: to use Mercedes-Benz Apps and access
the Internet, Mercedes-Benz mbrace
®
must be
activated and operational. Furthermore,
mbrace
®
must be activated for Mercedes-Benz
Apps and Internet access.
Canada: the multimedia system must be con‐
nected to a mobile phone via Bluetooth
®
or to an
external device acting as a Wi-Fi hotspot. Fur‐
thermore, you need a valid mobile service con‐
tract with a data option, which is used to calcu‐
late the associated connection costs.
The Internet functions can only be used to a limi‐
ted degree whilst driving.
Setting up an Internet connection via Wi-Fi
Requirements:
R
the Wi-Fi function is activated on the multi‐
media system (
page 280).
R
the Wi-Fi function is activated on the external
device (see the manufacturer's operating
instructions).
R
Internet access via Wi-Fi is activated (see the
manufacturer's operating instructions).
The Internet connection via Wi-Fi is restricted or
does not function if:
R
the mobile phone is switched off
R
mobile data use is deactivated on the mobile
phone
R
the Wi-Fi function is deactivated on the multi‐
media system
R
the Wi-Fi function is deactivated on the exter‐
nal device
R
Internet access via Wi-Fi is deactivated on
the external device
Multimedia system:
,

.
ö 
.

 
.
   
#
Select the network.
#
Logging in to Wi-Fi network ( page 280).
Setting up an Internet connection via Blue‐
tooth
®
Requirements:
R
A mobile phone is connected to the multime‐
dia system via Bluetooth
®
( page 316).
To connect via Bluetooth
®
, the mobile phone
supports one of the following Bluetooth
®
pro‐
files:
R
DUN (Dial-Up Networking)
R
PAN (Personal Area Network)
The Internet connection via Bluetooth
®
is restric‐
ted or does not function if:
R
the mobile phone is switched off
R
the mobile phone network coverage is insuf‐
ficient
R
mobile data use is deactivated on the mobile
phone
R
the Bluetooth
®
function on the multimedia
system is switched off and the mobile phone
is to be connected via Bluetooth
®
R
the Bluetooth
®
function is switched off on
the mobile phone and the mobile phone is to
be connected via Bluetooth
®
R
neither the mobile phone network nor the
mobile phone allow simultaneous use of a
phone and an Internet connection
Multimedia system
331
R
the mobile phone has not been enabled for
Internet access via Bluetooth
®
If a mobile phone is connected to the multimedia
system for the first time via Bluetooth
®
, you will
be assisted through the process of setting up an
Internet connection.
The Internet connection can also be configured
manually.
Further information can be obtained at http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect or from an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Multimedia system:
,

.
ö 
.

 
Bluetooth
®
connection via PAN
#
Select the mobile phone.
The Internet connection is established.
Bluetooth
®
connection via DUN
#
Select the mobile phone.
#
To select the predefined access data of
the mobile phone network provider: select
 .
A list of countries appears.
#
Select the country of your mobile phone net‐
work provider.
The list of available providers appears.
#
Select your mobile phone network provider.
When an overview of the provider settings
appears, make the necessary settings.
#
Select  .
#
To manually set the access data of the
mobile phone network provider: select
 .
An overview of the provider settings appears.
#
Set the access data.
#
Select  .
%
Set the access data in accordance with your
data package. Otherwise, additional costs
may be incurred. You can contact your
mobile phone network provider to obtain the
precise access data.
Switching the Bluetooth
®
profile
Requirements:
R
The mobile phone supports the DUN and
PAN Bluetooth
®
profiles.
Multimedia system:
,

.
ö 
.

 
#
To switch from DUN to PAN: select the
mobile phone.
#
Select ¥.
#
Select  .
#
Activate O  .
The Internet connection is automatically con‐
figured using the PAN Bluetooth
®
profile.
#
To switch from PAN to DUN: select the
mobile phone.
#
Select ¥.
#
Select  .
#
Deactivate ª  .
#
Select    .
332
Multimedia system
#
Configuring the Internet connection using
preset or manual access data (
page 331).
Editing access data
Requirements:
R
The mobile phone supports the Bluetooth
®
DUN profile.
Multimedia system:
,

.
ö 
.

 
#
Highlight the mobile phone.
#
Select ¥.
#
Select  .
#
For mobile phones with PAN and DUN:
select    .
#
Configure the Internet connection using pre‐
set or manual access data (
page 331).
Canceling Internet access permission for a
mobile phone
Multimedia system:
,

.
ö 
.

 
#
Highlight the mobile phone.
#
Select ¥.
#
Select  .
#
Select .
Displaying mobile phone details
Multimedia system:
,

.
ö 
.

 
#
Highlight the mobile phone.
#
Select ¥.
#
Select .
Establishing an Internet connection
Multimedia system:
,

#
For example, select z .
%
The multimedia system usually establishes
the Internet connection automatically. If the
multimedia system is not connected to the
Internet, the Internet connection is estab‐
lished when an Internet application is used.
Connection status
Connection status overview
1
Display of existing connection and reception
field strength of the connected device
Multimedia system
333
Displaying the connection status
Multimedia system:
,

.
ö 
#
Select  .
%
Depending on the means of connection, the
approximate data volume transmitted is dis‐
played.
Mercedes-Benz Apps
Calling up Mercedes-Benz Apps
Requirements:
R
The registration for the use of Mercedes-
Benz Apps has been completed.
R
The general terms and conditions have been
confirmed.
Multimedia system:
,

.
Ú  
#
Select an App.
Further Mercedes-Benz Apps and information
can be obtained at: http://apps.mercedes-
benz.com/apps/
%
The available features are country-depend‐
ent.
License fees may be applicable.
Using Mercedes-Benz Apps voice control
Requirements:
R
The registration for the use of Mercedes-
Benz Apps has been completed.
R
The general terms and conditions have been
confirmed.
The o symbol indicates that a Mercedes-
Benz App can be used via voice control.
#
Select a Mercedes-Benz App ( page 334).
The App menu is displayed.
#
To use voice control: select o 
.
#
Say the question or command.
%
Voice control is not available in all countries
and languages.
Web browser
Calling up a web page
Multimedia system:
,


.
z 
.
z  
#
Enter a web address.
#
To finish the entry and call up the web‐
site: select ¬.
Showing/hiding the web browser menu
If you call up a website by selecting a link, for
example, the web browser menu is hidden.
#
To show/hide: press the % button.
%
The web browser supports video playback.
%
No websites or videos are displayed while
the vehicle is in motion.
334
Multimedia system
Web browser overview
1
URL entry
2
Bookmarks
3
Web page, back
4
Web page, forwards
5
Options
6
To close the browser
Calling up web browser options
Multimedia system:
,


.
z 
.
Z 
The following functions are available:
R
 /
R

R
 
R
  
#
Select an option.
#
Make the desired changes to the settings.
Calling up the web browser settings
Multimedia system:
,


.
z 
.
Z 
.

 
The following functions are available:
R
 
R
 
R
 
#
Switch the function on O or off ª.
Deleting browser data
Multimedia system:
,


.
z 
.
Z 
.

  
The following options are available:
R

R

R

R
 
R
 
#
Select an option.
#
Select .
Managing bookmarks
Multimedia system:
,


.
z 
.
ß 
Selecting a bookmark
#
Select an entry.
Multimedia system
335
Creating a bookmark
#
Select   .
#
Enter a URL and a name.
#
Select ¡.
Editing a bookmark
#
Highlight a bookmark.
#
Select ¥.
#
Select .
#
Enter a URL and a name.
#
Select ¡.
Deleting a bookmark
#
Highlight a bookmark.
#
Select ¥.
#
Select .
#
Select .
Closing the browser
Multimedia system:
,

.
z 
#
Select å  .
Internet radio
Calling up the Internet radio
Requirements:
R
The Internet radio service is activated.
R
The data volume is available.
Depending on the country, data volume may
need to be purchased.
R
A fast Internet connection for data transmis‐
sion free of interference.
The services are country-dependent.
For more information, consult an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
Multimedia system:
,

.
Þ  
#
Select  .
The Internet radio display appears. The last
station set starts playing.
%
The connection quality depends on the local
mobile phone reception.
Internet radio overview
1
Internet radio provider
2
Selected category
3
Display (if connected to private user
account)
4
Data transfer rate
5
Current station is stored as a favorite
6
Additional information on the current station
336
Multimedia system
Selecting and connecting to Internet radio
stations
Multimedia system:
,

.
Þ  
.


.
è 
#
Select a category.
#
Select a station.
The connection is established automatically.
or
#
Select  .
#
Enter a station name using the entry field.
%
A relatively large volume of data can be
transmitted when using Internet radio.
Saving/deleting Internet radio stations as
favorites
Multimedia system:
,

.
Þ  
.


#
Select a station.
#
Press and hold the touchpad or controller
until an audible signal sounds.
The ß symbol appears by the station
name.
#
Select ß .
The list of saved favorite stations appears.
or
#
Create an account for the online provider
(TuneIn radio) and then log in on the multi‐
media system.
Your favorites are imported to the multimedia
system.
Deleting favorites
#
Select ß .
#
Select a station.
#
Press and hold the touchpad or controller
until an audible signal sounds.
The ß symbol by the station name disap‐
pears.
Setting the Internet radio options
Multimedia system:
,

.
Þ  
.


.
Z 
The following options are available:
R
 : select the stream quality.
R
   : log in to your
TuneIn user account.
R
   : log out of your TuneIn
user account.
#
Select an option.
Media
Audio mode
Information on the audio mode
&
WARNING Risk of distraction when han‐
dling data storage media
If you handle a data storage medium while
driving, your attention is diverted from the
Multimedia system
337
traffic conditions. This could also cause you
to lose control of the vehicle.
#
Only handle a data storage medium
when the vehicle is stationary.
Permissible file systems:
R
FAT32
R
exFAT
R
NTFS
Permissible data storage medium:
R
SD card
R
USB storage device
R
iPod
®
/iPhone
®
R
MTP devices
R
Bluetooth
®
audio equipment
%
R
The multimedia system supports a total
of up to 50,000 files.
R
Data storage media up to 2 TB are sup‐
ported (32-bit address space).
Supported formats:
R
MP3
R
WMA
R
AAC
R
WAV
R
FLAC
R
ALAC
%
Observe the following notes:
R
Due to the large variety of available
music files regarding encoders, sampling
rates and bit rates, playback cannot
always be guaranteed.
R
Due to the wide range of USB devices
available on the market, playback cannot
be guaranteed for all USB devices.
R
Copy-protected music files or DRM
encrypted files cannot be played back.
R
MP3 players must support Media Trans‐
fer Protocol (MTP).
Manufactured under license from Dolby Labora‐
tories. Dolby, Dolby Audio and the double-D sym‐
bol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
338
Multimedia system
Gracenote, the Gracenote logo and logotype,
"Powered by Gracenote", MusicID and Playlist
Plus are either registered trademarks or trade‐
marks of Gracenote, Inc. in the United States
and/or other countries.
Notes on copyright
Audio files that you create or reproduce yourself
for playback are generally subject to copyright
protection. In many countries, reproductions,
even for private use, are not permitted without
the prior consent of the copyright holder. Make
sure that you know about the applicable copy‐
right regulations and that you comply with these.
Activating media mode
Multimedia system:
,

.
à  
#
Select a media source.
Playable music files are played back.
Inserting/removing an SD card
&
DANGER Risk of fatal injury from swal‐
lowing SD cards
SD cards are small parts.
They could be swallowed and lead to chok‐
ing.
#
Keep SD cards out of the reach of chil‐
dren.
#
Seek medical attention immediately if
an SD card has been swallowed.
*
NOTE Damage caused by high tempera‐
tures
High temperatures can damage the SD mem‐
ory card.
#
Remove the SD memory card after use
and take it out of the vehicle.
Multimedia system:
,

.
à  
.


Inserting
The multimedia connection unit is located in the
stowage compartment under the armrest.
#
Insert the SD memory card into the SD card
slot until it engages. The side with the con‐
tacts must face downwards.
Playable music files are played back.
Removing
#
Press the SD card.
#
Remove the SD card.
Multimedia system
339
Overview of the audio mode
1
Active data storage medium
2
Album cover
3
Track, artist, album
4
Track number and number of tracks in the
track list
5

6
 
7
 
8

9
  (for video playback)
A

340
Multimedia system
Connecting USB devices
*
NOTE Damage caused by high tempera‐
tures
High temperatures can damage USB devices.
#
Remove the USB device after use and
take it out of the vehicle.
The multimedia connection unit is found in the
stowage compartment under the armrest and
has two USB ports. Depending on the vehicle's
equipment, additional USB ports can be found in
the stowage compartment of the front center
console or rear folding compartment.
#
Connect the USB device to the USB port.
Playable music files are played back only if
the corresponding media display is activated.
%
Use the USB port identified by ç to use
Apple CarPlay™ and Android Auto.
Selecting a track
Multimedia system:
,

Selecting a track by skipping to a track
#
To skip backwards or forwards to a track:
navigate up or down.
Selecting a track using the current track list
#
Select è.
#
Select   .
#
Select a track.
Selecting playback options
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
Playing back similar tracks
#
Select   .
A track list with similar tracks is created and
played back.
Playback mode
#
Select    .
The current track list is played in random
order.
#
Select    .
All tracks on the active data storage medium
are played in random order.
#
Select   .
The current track list is played in the order it
appears on the data storage medium.
Controlling media playback
Multimedia system:
,

.
 
A bar with playback controls is shown.
#
To pause playback: press the controller.
The Ë symbol is displayed.
#
To continue playback: press the controller
again.
The Ì symbol is displayed.
Fast forward/rewinding
#
Move Ë on the timeline: turn the control‐
ler.
Multimedia system
341
Hiding the playback controls
#
Press the % button.
Video mode
Switching to video mode
Multimedia system:
,

.
à  
#
Select a data storage medium.
Playable video files are played back.
The multimedia system supports the following
formats:
R
MPEG
R
AVI, DivX, MKV
R
MP4, M4V
R
WMV
%
Due to the large variety of available video
files regarding encoders, sampling rates and
data transfer rates, playback cannot always
be guaranteed.
Videos up to FullHD (1920x1080) are sup‐
ported.
Copy-protected video files or DRM (Digital
Rights Management) encrypted files cannot
be played back.
342
Multimedia system
Overview of video mode
1
Active data storage medium
2
Preview window
3
Track, artist and album or film and scene
4
Track number and number of tracks in the
track list
5

6
 
7
 
8

9
 
A

Multimedia system
343
Activating/deactivating full-screen mode
Multimedia system:
,

.
à  
#
Select a data storage medium.
Playable video files are played back.
#
To activate full-screen mode: select #
 .
#
To deactivate full-screen mode: press the
touchpad.
Changing video settings
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
.
 

The following picture formats are available:
R

R

R

R

#
Select a picture format.
Adjusting the brightness manually
#
Select .
#
Adjust the brightness.
Media search
Starting the media search
Multimedia system:
,

.
ª 
Depending on the connected media sources and
files, the following categories are listed:
R
  
R
 
R

R

R

R

R

R
 
R

R

R

R
 (Apple
®
devices)
R
 (Apple
®
devices)
#
Select a category.
%
The categories are available as soon as the
entire media content has been read in and
analyzed.
Media Interface
Information about the Media Interface
Media Interface is a universal interface for the
connection of mobile audio equipment. The mul‐
timedia system has two USB ports. The USB
ports are located in the stowage compartment
under the armrest.
Supported devices
The Media Interface allows you to connect the
following data storage media:
R
iPod
®
R
iPhone
®
R
MP3 player
344
Multimedia system
R
USB devices
For details and a list of supported devices, visit
our website at http://www.mercedes-
benz.com/connect. Follow the instructions in
the "Media Interface" section.
Switching to Media Interface
Multimedia system:
,

.
à  
#
Connect a data storage medium to the USB
port (
page 341).
#
Select a media device.
Playable music files are played back.
Multimedia system
345
Overview of Media Interface
1
Active data storage medium
2
Cover
3
Artist, track and album
4
Track number and number of tracks in the
track list
5

6
 
7
 
8

9
  (video playback only)
A

Bluetooth
®
audio Information about Bluetooth
®
audio
346
Multimedia system
Before using your Bluetooth
®
audio equipment
with the multimedia system for the first time,
you will need to authorize it (
page 348).
Bluetooth
®
Audio overview
1
Active data storage medium
2
Cover art
3
Track, artist, album
4
Track number and number of tracks in the
track list
Multimedia system
347
5

6
 
7
 
8

9
  (video playback only)
A

Searching for and authorizing a Blue tooth
®
audio device
Requirements:
R
Blue tooth
®
is activated on the multimedia
system and on the audio equipment
(
page 279).
R
The audio equipment supports the Blue
tooth
®
audio profiles A2DP and AVRCP.
R
The audio equipment is "visible" for other
devices.
Multimedia system:
,

.
à  

.
á  
Authorizing new Blue tooth
®
audio equip‐
ment
#
Select ¥.
#
Select     .
#
Select    .
Detected audio equipment is displayed in the
device list.
#
Select a Blue tooth
®
audio device.
Authorization starts. A code is displayed on
the multimedia system and on the mobile
phone.
#
If the codes are identical, confirm on the
audio equipment.
The audio equipment is connected and play‐
back starts.
Selecting Blue tooth
®
audio equipment that
has already been authorized
#
Select ¥.
#
Select a Blue tooth
®
audio device.
Establishing a connection from the Blue
tooth
®
audio equipment
The Blue tooth
®
device name of the multimedia
system is   .
#
Select   .
#
Start the authorization on the audio device
(see manufacturer's operating instructions).
A code is displayed on the multimedia sys‐
tem and on the mobile phone.
#
Confirm on both devices if the codes are
identical.
The audio equipment is connected and play‐
back starts.
With some audio equipment, playback must be
initially started on the device itself so that the
multimedia system can play the audio files.
%
Device-specific information on authorizing
and connecting Bluetooth
®
-capable mobile
phones can be obtained at http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect or from
an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
348
Multimedia system
Activating Bluetooth
®
audio
Multimedia system:
,

.
à  
#
Select á  .
The multimedia system activates the connec‐
ted Bluetooth
®
audio equipment.
Selecting a music player
Multimedia system:
,

.
à  

.
á  
#
Select a Bluetooth
®
audio device.
If multiple music players are present on the
Bluetooth
®
audio equipment a list appears.
#
Select a music player.
Playback starts.
Searching for a track
Multimedia system:
,

.
à  

.
á  
#
Select ª.
#
Select a category.
A track list appears.
#
Select a track.
%
The function is only available when the
mobile phone and the music player selected
on the mobile phone support this function.
Switching Bluetooth
®
audio equipment via
NFC
Requirements:
R
Observe the notes on using NFC
(
page 317).
R
The Bluetooth
®
audio overview is displayed
(
page 349).
#
Lightly press the NFC area on the mobile
phone (see the manufacturer's operating
instructions).
If the mobile phone has already been author‐
ized on the multimedia system as Bluetooth
®
audio equipment, it is now connected.
If the mobile phone is authorized on the mul‐
timedia system as Bluetooth
®
audio equip‐
ment for the first time, it is connected after
confirming the instructions for the mobile
phone (see the manufacturer's operating
instructions).
Disconnecting Bluetooth
®
audio equipment
Multimedia system:
,

.
á  
#
Select a Bluetooth
®
audio device.
#
Select ¥ .
#
Select .
Starting cinema mode
Multimedia system:
,

.
à  
.

  
In cinema mode, a media source connected to
the Rear Seat Entertainment System is simulta‐
neously played in the multimedia system.
#
Select the Rear Seat Entertainment System
device.
The media source is also played on the multi‐
media system.
Multimedia system
349
Radio
Switching on the radio
Multimedia system:
,

#
Alternatively: press the $ button.
The radio display appears. You will hear the
last station played on the last frequency
band selected.
350
Multimedia system
Radio overview
1
Active frequency band
2
Station name or set frequency
3
Artist, title, album and radio text
4
Station list
5

6
 
7

8
  
9

Multimedia system
351
Switching HD Radio on/off
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
.
 
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
%
HD Radio Technology manufactured under
license from iBiquity Digital Corporation.
U.S. and Foreign Patents. HD Radio™ and
the HD, HD Radio and "Arc" logos are propri‐
etary trademarks of iBiquity Digital Corp.
Setting the waveband
Multimedia system:
,

.
Þ  
      and  
can be selected.
#
Select a frequency band.
Selecting a radio station
Multimedia system:
,

#
Navigate up or down.
Calling up the radio station list
Multimedia system:
,

.
è
#
Select a station.
Searching for radio stations using station
names or direct frequency entry
Multimedia system:
,

.
è
.
è
#
Enter a station name or frequency.
#
Select a.
The search results are displayed.
#
Select a station.
Storing radio stations
Multimedia system:
,

.
ß 
#
Select      .
Editing radio station presets
Multimedia system:
,

.
ß 
Moving stations:
#
Highlight a preset entry and navigate to the
left.
352
Multimedia system
#
Select   .
#
Select a preset.
Deleting stations:
#
Highlight a preset entry and navigate to the
left.
#
Select   .
#
Select .
Tagging music tracks
Multimedia system:
,

If radio stations provide the relevant information,
this function allows you to transfer information
on the music track currently playing to an
Apple
®
device. You can then purchase the audio
file from the iTunes Store
®
.
#
Select    .
The track information is saved.
Activating/deactivating radio text
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
.
 
 
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Satellite radio
Information on the satellite radio
SIRIUS XM
®
Satellite Radio offers more than 175
digital-quality radio channels providing 100%
commercial-free music, sports, news and enter‐
tainment, for example. SIRIUS XM satellite radio
employs a fleet of high-performance satellites to
broadcast around the clock throughout the USA
and Canada. The satellite radio program is avail‐
able for a monthly fee. Information about this
can be obtained from a Sirius XM
®
Service Cen‐
ter and at http://www.siriusxm.com (USA) or
http://www.siriusxm.ca (Canada). Your new
Mercedes-Benz vehicle comes with SIRIUS XM
®
Satellite Radio pre-installed at the factory. This
service is free for a six-month trial period. About
a month before the trial period ends, information
will be provided on how to extend this subscrip‐
tion. A message is shown, describing how the
subscription can be extended.
%
Sirius, XM and all related marks and logos
are trademarks of Sirius XM Radio Inc. and
its subsidiaries. All other marks, channel
names and logos are the property of their
respective owners. All rights reserved.
Satellite radio restrictions
Satellite radio mode may be temporarily unavail‐
able or interrupted for a variety of reasons.
These include environmental or topog
raphical
condit
ions beyond the control of Mercedes-Benz
USA, LLC. Thus, operation at certain locations
may not be possible.
Registering satellite radio
Requirements:
R
satellite radio equipment
R
registration with a satellite radio provider
R
if registration is not included when purchas‐
ing the system, your credit card details will
be required to activate your account
Multimedia system
353
Multimedia system:
,

.
Þ  
.

 
.
Z 
#
Select  .
The service information screen appears
showing the radio ID and the current sub‐
scription status.
#
Establish a telephone connection.
#
Follow the service staff's instructions.
The activation process may take up to ten
minutes.
%
You can also have the satellite service acti‐
vated online. To do so, please visit http://
www.siriusxm.com (USA) or http://
www.siriusxm.ca (Canada).
Switching on satellite radio
Multimedia system:
,

.
Þ  
#
Select  .
354
Multimedia system
Overview of the satellite radio
1
Active frequency band
2
Logo or album art (if available)
3
Category
4
Channel name
5
Channel information
6
  
7

8
 
9

A
 
B

Multimedia system
355
Selecting a satellite radio category
Multimedia system:
,

.
Þ  
.

 
.
è   

.

#
Select a category.
Selecting a satellite radio channel
Multimedia system:
,

.
Þ  
.

 
#
Navigate up or down.
Saving or deleting a satellite radio channel
Multimedia system:
,

.
Þ  
.

 
.
ß 
#
Select      .
Moving a channel
#
Select .
#
Select   .
#
Select a preset.
Deleting a channel
#
Select   .
#
Select a preset.
Displaying EPG information for the current
channel
Multimedia system:
,

.
Þ  
.

 
.
Z 
#
Select     
.
Setting the parental control
Multimedia system:
,

.
Þ  
.

 
.
Z 
.
 

#
Activate the function O.
#
Determine a four-digit character sequence
and select ¡.
All channels with adult content are locked.
Unlocking a channel
#
Enter the four-digit character sequence and
select ¡.
All channels with adult content are unlocked.
Music and sport alerts function
This function enables you to program an alert for
your favorite artists, tracks or sporting events.
Music alerts can be saved whilst a track is being
played and sport alerts can be saved during a
live game. You can also specify sport alerts via
the menu option. The system then continuously
searches through all the channels. If a match is
found with a stored alert, you will be informed.
Setting music and sport alerts
Multimedia system:
,

.
Þ  
.

 
.
Z 
.
 
   
Setting a music alert
#
Select   .
or
#
Select    .
356
Multimedia system
#
Select ¥ .
The following options are available:
R
    
R
  
R
  
R
  
R
  
#
Select an option.
#
    O.
The alert is set for the current artist or track.
If a match is found, a prompt appears asking
whether you wish to change to the station.
Setting a sport alert
#
Select   .
or
#
Select   .
#
Select   .
or
#
Select  .
#
Select a team from a league.
#
   O.
Information on smart favorites and Tune
Start
Stations in the station presets can be added as
smart favorites. Smart favorites stations are
automatically saved to temporary storage in the
background. If you change to a smart favorite
station, you can replay, pause or actively skip
forward or back to broadcasts which you have
missed. If Tune Start is activated and you change
to another smart favorite station, the music
track currently playing on the station is automat‐
ically restarted from the beginning of the track.
Activating/deactivating Tune Start
Multimedia system:
,

.
Z 
.

#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Playback controls
Multimedia system:
,

.
 
You can pause the playback of the current sta‐
tion or skip forward or backward in the timeline.
This leaves live mode to access the internal tem‐
porary storage.
#
To fast forward/rewind: select C or D.
#
To pause playback: select Ë.
#
To return to live mode: navigate to the end of
the timeline.
Displaying satellite radio service information
Multimedia system:
,

.
Þ  
.

 
.
Z 
#
Select  .
Sound
Tone settings
Information about the sound system
The sound system has a total output of 100
watts and is equipped with 10 speakers. It is
available for all functions in the radio and media
modes.
Multimedia system
357
Calling up the sound menu
Multimedia system:
,

.
à 
The following functions are available:
R

R
  
R
  
R
  
#
Select a sound menu.
Adjusting treble, mid-range and bass set‐
tings
Multimedia system:
,

.
à 
.

#
Select ,   or .
#
Change the settings.
Activating/deactivating automatic volume
adjustment
Multimedia system:
,

.
à 
.
 
 
Automatic volume adjustment compensates for
differing volumes when changing between audio
sources.
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Adjusting the balance/fader
Multimedia system:
,

.
à 
.
 

#
Adjust the balance and fader.
#
To exit the menu: press the % button.
Burmester
®
surround sound system
Information about the Burmester
®
surround
sound system
The Burmester
®
surround sound system has a
total output of 590 watts and is equipped with
13 speakers. It is available for all functions in the
radio and media modes.
Calling up the sound menu in the
Burmester
®
surround sound system
Multimedia system:
,

.
à 
The following functions are available:
R

R
  
R
  
R
 
R
 
R
  
#
Select a function.
Adjusting the treble, mid and bass settings
on the Burmester
®
surround sound system
Multimedia system:
,

.
à 
.

#
Select ,   or .
#
Set the desired values.
358
Multimedia system
Activating/deactivating volume adjustment
in the Burmester
®
surround sound system
Multimedia system:
,

.
à 
.
 
 
Automatic volume adjustment compensates for
differing volumes when changing between audio
sources.
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Adjusting the balance/fader in the
Burmester
®
surround sound system
Multimedia system:
,

.
à 
.
 

#
Adjust the balance and fader.
#
To exit the menu: press the % button.
Switching surround sound on/off in the
Burmester
®
surround sound system
Multimedia system:
,

.
à 
.


#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Adjusting the sound focus in the Burmester
®
surround sound system
Multimedia system:
,

.
à 
.
 
#
Adjust the sound focus.
Burmester
®
high-end 3D surround sound
system
Information on the Burmester
®
high-end 3D
surround sound system
The Burmester
®
high-end 3D surround sound
system has a total output of 1590 watts and is
equipped with 27 speakers. It is available for all
functions in the radio and media modes.
Calling up the sound menu in the
Burmester
®
high-end 3D surround sound
system
Multimedia system:
,

.
à 
The following functions are available:
R

R
  
R
  
R
  (seat-based sound optimization)
R
 
R
  
#
Select a sound menu.
Adjusting the treble, mid-range and bass set‐
tings on the Burmester
®
high-end 3D sur‐
round sound system
Multimedia system:
,

.
à 
.

#
Select ,   or .
#
Set the desired values.
Multimedia system
359
Activating/deactivating volume adjustment
in the Burmester
®
high-end 3D surround
sound system
Multimedia system:
,

.
à 
.
 
 
Automatic volume adjustment compensates for
differing volumes when changing between audio
sources.
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Adjusting the balance/fader in the
Burmester
®
high-end 3D surround sound
system
Multimedia system:
,

.
à 
.
 

#
Adjust the balance and fader.
#
To exit the menu: press the % button.
Adjusting the seat-based sound optimization
in the Burmester
®
high-end 3D surround
sound system
Multimedia system:
,

.
à 
.
 
This setting optimizes the sound playback for the
selected seat position.
#
Activate the function O.
#
Select a seat position.
Selecting the sound profile in the
Burmester
®
high-end 3D surround sound
system
Multimedia system:
,

.
à 
.
 
The following profiles are available:
R

R
 
R

R

R

#
Select a sound profile.
Rear Seat Entertainment System
Operating safety
&
WARNING Risk of injury from laser radi‐
ation from the Blu-ray drive
The Blu-ray drive is a class 1 laser product. If
you open the housing of the Blu-ray drive,
there is a risk of exposure to invisible laser
radiation.
Laser radiation can damage your retina.
#
Do not open the housing.
#
Always have maintenance work and
repairs carried out by a qualified spe‐
cialist workshop.
&
WARNING Risk of injury from unsecured
items in the vehicle
If objects such as headphones/headsets or
external audio/video sources are not
secured in the vehicle interior, they can be
flung around and hit vehicle occupants.
360
Multimedia system
#
Always stow these items or similar
objects carefully so that they cannot be
flung around, for example in a lockable
vehicle stowage compartment.
Replacing batteries (Rear Seat Entertain‐
ment System)
Batteries are required for the remote control and
the cordless headphones.
&
DANGER Serious damage to health
caused by swallowing batteries
Batteries contain toxic and corrosive sub‐
stances. Swallowing batteries may cause
serious damage to health.
There is a risk of fatal injury.
#
Keep batteries out of the reach of chil‐
dren.
#
If batteries are swallowed, seek medical
attention immediately.
+
ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
damage caused by improper disposal of
batteries
Batteries contain pollutants. It is
illegal to dispose of them with the household
rubbish.
#
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible manner.
Take discharged batteries to a qualified
specialist workshop or to a collection
point for used batteries.
Rear Seat Entertainment System overview
The Rear Seat Entertainment System includes:
R
two rear seat displays
R
two remote controls
R
up to two cordless headphones
R
the Blu-ray drive
R
ports for USB (two) and HDMI
%
The function of the remote control and the
cordless headphones can be impaired by
other radio-based electronic devices, e.g.
mobile phones.
Multimedia system
361
Rear passenger compartment displays
Rear passenger compartment displays over‐
view
1
Display
2
Socket for corded headphones with a
3.5 mm stereo jack
The rear passenger compartment displays are
located behind the head restraints of the front
seats.
Setting the display angle
#
Selecting a rear display on the remote con‐
trol (
page 363).
#
Press the / button.
#
To show the menu: press the = button.
#
Select  .
#
Select  .
#
Select  or .
Remote control
Remote control overview
1
To switch the display on and off
2
Main functions button group:
ß To switch navigation on
z To call up online and Internet functions
$ To switch on the radio
362
Multimedia system
Õ To switch to media mode
/ To set vehicle functions
3
To select a display ( page 363)
4
To select a menu function with
9:=;
5
To select menu functions using the selector
wheel
6
To display main functions
7
To lower/raise the volume (corded head‐
phones), to switch the sound off/on
8
Media playback button group:
C To skip to the beginning of a scene
D To skip to the end of a scene
Ì Play
Ë Pause
9
Back button
A
9 To confirm a menu function
B
Indicator lamp
Displays of indicator lamp B
LED colorMeaning
Green
The LED flashes once.
Entry being transmit‐
ted.
The batteries are fully
charged. The batter‐
ies have been inser‐
ted correctly.
Red
The LED flashes once.
Entry being transmit‐
ted.
The batteries are
almost discharged.
Orange
The LED flashes three
times.
Entry not correctly
transmitted.
No display The batteries are dis‐
charged.
Switching the display on/off
#
Press the Start/Stop button once.
#
Press the u button on the remote control.
or
#
Press u on the touchkey on the rear
passenger compartment display.
The display is switched on/off.
The displays are switched off after 30 minutes at
the latest in the following situations:
R
The ignition is switched off.
R
The SmartKey is not in place.
%
Please note that the battery continues to
discharge by switching the system on again.
Selecting a display
Multimedia system
363
#
Turn dial 1.
COMAND: multimedia system
L REAR: left rear passenger compartment
display
R REAR: right rear passenger compartment
display
Replacing batteries (remote control)
Requirements:
R
The remote control requires two type AAA,
1.5 V batteries.
Observe the safety and environmental note
(
page 360).
The battery compartment is located on the
reverse side.
#
Push the catch tab downwards and take off
the battery compartment cover.
#
Remove discharged batteries from the bat‐
tery compartment.
#
Insert new batteries. Observe the polarity
markings on the batteries and battery com‐
partment.
#
First place the battery compartment cover
on the retaining lugs in the battery compart‐
ment.
#
Allow the catch tab to engage in the battery
compartment.
Headphones
Headphones overview
1
Indicator lamp
2
On/off switch
3
Volume control
Adjust the fit of the headphones:
R
Pull both sides of the headphones outwards.
364
Multimedia system
R
Pull the headphone band in the direction of
the arrow.
Indicator lamp 1
LED color Meaning
Green The batteries are fully
charged. The batteries have
been inserted correctly.
RedThe batteries are almost dis‐
charged.
The LED lights
up.
The cordless headphones
are switched on and connec‐
ted to a rear display.
The LED
flashes.
The cordless headphones
are searching for a connec‐
tion to a rear display.
The LED is
dark.
The cordless headphones
are switched off.
The batteries are discharged.
The headphones automatically switch off if they
have not received an audio signal for approx‐
imately three minutes. This preserves the batter‐
ies.
Switching headphones on/off
#
Press 2 ( page 364).
Selecting a rear passenger compartment dis‐
play
#
Move switch 1 to L (left rear passenger
compartment display) or R (right rear
passenger compartment display).
Adjusting the volume
#
Turn volume control 3 ( page 364).
Replacing batteries (headphones)
Requirements:
R
The cordless headphones require two type
AAA, 1.5 V batteries.
Observe the safety and environmental note
(
page 360).
%
The operating duration of the headphones
with a set of batteries is up to 40 hours.
Multimedia system
365
The battery compartment is located on the left
headphone.
#
Switch the headphones off.
#
Turn battery compartment cover 1 counter-
clockwise and remove.
#
Remove discharged batteries from the bat‐
tery compartment.
#
Insert new batteries. Observe the polarity
markings on the batteries and battery com‐
partment.
#
Replace battery compartment cover 1 and
turn it clockwise until it engages.
#
Switch the headphones on.
If the batteries have been inserted correctly,
the indicator lamp will light up green.
Blu-ray drive overview
1
Disc slot
2
To insert/eject data storage medium
Depending on the vehicle equipment, the Blu-ray
drive is located:
R
At the rear of the center console under the
automatic climate control panel.
366
Multimedia system
R
Between the rear shelf and through-load ski
bag.
Ports
1
HDMI port
2
USB ports
Depending on the vehicle equipment, the ports
are located:
R
In the stowage box between the rear seats.
R
In the rear armrest.
Rear seats
Adjusting the rear seats
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

.
a 
#
Select   or .
#
Select the setting.
Memory function
#
Save the seat adjustments with the memory
function (
page 114).
Selecting the massage program for the rear
seats
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

.
a 
#
Select .
#
Select a massage program.
The massage program runs for approximately
8 to 18 minutes, depending on the setting.
#
To set the massage intensity: switch 
 on O or off ª.
Overview of massage and workout programs
Overview of massage and workout programs
(
page 106).
Resetting the rear seat
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

.
a 
.

#
Select  or .
Setting the rear climate control
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

.
b  
Activating the SYNC function
#
Select .
#
Switch the function on O or off ª.
Multimedia system
367
Activating the A/C function
#
Select .
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Controlling the rear climate control automat‐
ically
#
Select .
#
Activate O or deactivate ª the function.
Setting the airflow
#
Select .
#
Set the airflow.
Setting the temperature
#
Select .
#
Set the temperature.
Setting the air distribution
#
Select  .
#
Set the air distribution.
Setting ENERGIZING comfort in the rear
passenger compartment
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

.
 
Starting the program
#
For information on starting ENERGIZING
comfort program (
page 290).
ENERGIZING comfort program overview
#
For an overview of the available ENERGIZING
comfort programs (
page 289).
Adjusting the ambient lighting in the rear
passenger compartment
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

.
 
#
For information about adjusting the ambient
lighting (
page 148).
Activating/deactivating the panel heating
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

.
b  
#
Activate or deactivate the function.
Adjusting the entertainment system settings
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

.
  

Setting the display brightness
#
Select  .
#
Select .
#
Adjust the brightness.
Tilting the display
#
Select  .
#
Select  .
#
Tilt the display  or .
Setting the display design
#
Select  .
368
Multimedia system
#
Select  ,   or 
.
Adjusting the equalizer
#
Select  .
#
Select .
#
Set the equalizer.
%
For further information about the equalizer
(
page 358).
Activating audio on cabin
#
Select  .
#
Select       .
If the function is switched on, the current
media source is output via the vehicle's
speakers.
Setting the language
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

#
Select .
#
Set the desired language.
Switching off the display
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

#
Select  .
The display is switched off.
Navigation
Switching navigation on
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

#
Alternatively: press the ß button on the
remote control.
The map appears and shows the current
vehicle position.
If a route is active, the following is displayed
to the left of the map:
R
for the destination Í: remaining dis‐
tance and arrival time
R
for intermediate destinations Î:
remaining distance and arrival time
The route can include up to four inter‐
mediate destinations.
R
if there is a traffic delay on the current
route, it will be displayed with the dura‐
tion
R
the compass needle L
The following information is displayed is dis‐
played to the right of the map:
R
elevation
The elevation shown may deviate from
the actual elevation.
R
number of satellites from which a signal
can be received
R
longitude and latitude
Displaying destination information
Requirements:
R
A destination is entered. The route can also
include up to four intermediate destinations.
Multimedia system
369
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

#
Select the symbol in the bottom right-hand
corner of the display.
Names and addresses are displayed for the
destination Í and intermediate destina‐
tions Î.
#
To return to the map: select the % sym‐
bol.
Online and Internet functions
Overview of the Internet functions in the
rear passenger compartment
The following functions and displays are availa‐
ble in the rear passenger compartment depend‐
ing on the country and vehicle equipment:
R
Connectivity status display ( page 370)
R
Calling up the web browser ( page 334)
R
Calling up Mercedes-Benz Apps
(
page 334)
R
Re-establishing an Internet connection
(
page 370)
Displaying the Internet connectivity status
Requirements:
An Internet connection is set up in multimedia
system at the front, depending on the vehicle
equipment:
R
using the communication module (USA)
(
page 333)
R
via Wi-Fi ( page 331)
R
via Bluetooth
®
( page 331)
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

#
Select  .
Re-establishing an Internet connection
Observe the requirements for using the Internet
functions in the rear passenger compartment
(
page 370).
If an Internet connection is temporarily discon‐
nected, it can be re-established in the rear
passenger compartment.
#
Calling up the web browser ( page 334).
#
Enter a URL and call it up.
Media
Information about media mode in the rear
passenger compartment
The Rear Seat Entertainment System includes a
Blu-ray drive (
page 366), two USB ports and
an HDMI port (
page 367).
Depending on the vehicle model and equipment
level, the Blu-ray drive is found:
R
at the rear of the center console under the
automatic climate control panel
R
between the rear shelf and through-load ski
bag
Data storage media and devices supported by
the Rear Seat Entertainment System:
R
SD cards
R
USB storage device
R
Audio CD
R
Data CD
R
Data DVD
R
Video DVD
R
BD (Blu-ray disc) video
370
Multimedia system
R
iPod
®
R
iPhone
®
R
MTP devices
R
Bluetooth
®
audio
Bluetooth
®
audio equipment can only be
authorized using the multimedia system.
The Rear Seat Entertainment System supports a
total of up to 50,000 files. The Rear Seat Enter‐
tainment System can also access files on the
multimedia system.
Further information about audio mode
(
page 337).
Further information about Bluetooth
®
audio
(
page 346).
is a trademark of DVD Format/Logo
Licensing Corporation.
Blu-ray Disc™, Blu-ray™ and the logos are trade‐
marks of the Blu-ray Disc Association.
Java is a registered trademark of Oracle and/or
its affiliates.
Multimedia system
371
The terms HDMI and HDMI High-Definition Multi‐
media Interface, and the HDMI Logo are trade‐
marks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licens‐
ing LLC in the United States and other countries.
Gracenote, the Gracenote logo and logotype,
"Powered by Gracenote", MusicID and Playlist
Plus are either registered trademarks or trade‐
marks of Gracenote, Inc. in the United States
and/or other countries.
Manufactured under license from Dolby Labora‐
tories. Dolby, Dolby Audio and the double-D sym‐
bol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
For DTS Patents, see http://patents.dts.com.
Manufactured under license from DTS Licensing
Limited. DTS, DTS-HD, the Symbol, & DTS and
the Symbol together are registered trademarks
of DTS, Inc.
©
DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved.
372
Multimedia system
"Made for iPod", and "Made for iPhone," mean
that an electronic accessory has been designed
to connect specifically to iPod, or iPhone,
respectively, and has been certified by the devel‐
oper to meet Apple performance standards.
Apple is not responsible for the operation of this
device or its compliance with safety and regula‐
tory standards. Please note that the use of this
accessory with iPod, or iPhone may affect wire
less performance.
For the USA: iPhone
®
, iPod
®
, iPod classic
®
,
iPod nano
®
, and iPod touch
®
are trademarks of
Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other coun‐
tries. Lightning™ is a trademark of Apple Inc.
For Canada: iPhone, iPod, iPod classic, iPod
nano, and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple
Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
Lightning is a trademark of Apple Inc.
Cinavia notice: this product uses Cinavia tech
nology to limit the use of unauthorized copies of
some commercially-produced film and videos
and their soundtracks. When a prohibited use of
an unauthorized copy is detected, a message will
be displayed and playback or copying will be
interrupted. More information about Cinavia
technology is provided at Cinavia Online Con‐
sumer Information Center at http://
www.cinavia.com. To request additional informa‐
tion about
Cinavia by ma
il, send a postcard with
your mailing address to: Cinavia Consumer Infor‐
mation Center, P.O. Box 86851, San Diego, CA,
92138, USA.
This product incorporates proprietary technology
under license from Verance Corporation and is
protected by U.S. Patent 7, 369,677 and other
U.S. and worldwide patents issued and pending
as well as copyright and trade secret protection
for certain aspects of such technology. Cinavia is
a trademark of Verance Corporation. Copyright
2004-2012 Verance Corporation. All rights
reserved by Verance. Reverse Engineering or dis‐
assembly is prohibited.
Inserting a disc
&
WARNING Risk of injury from laser radi‐
ation from the Blu-ray drive
The Blu-ray drive is a class 1 laser product. If
you open the housing of the Blu-ray drive,
there is a risk of exposure to invisible laser
radiation.
Laser radiation can damage your retina.
#
Do not open the housing.
#
Always have maintenance work and
repairs carried out by a qualified spe‐
cialist workshop.
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

.
à  
.

Inserting
#
Insert the disc into the drive ( page 366).
The side to be played must face downwards.
Removing
#
Press the button to eject the disc
(
page 366).
#
Remove the disc.
Multimedia system
373
Switching on media mode - rear passenger
compartment
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

.
à  
Media sources connected to the multimedia sys‐
tem are named with the addition "COMAND".
#
Select the media source.
Blu-ray/DVD mode
DVD/Blu-ray functions overview
1
Activates the DVD/Blu-ray control menu
2
Calls up the Blu-ray pop-up menu (only avail‐
able for Blu-ray Discs)
3
Exits DVD/Blu-ray functions or go up a level
in the DVD/Blu-ray menu
4
Opens the video display of the Rear Seat
Entertainment System
5
Confirms entry in control menu
6
Navigates through the Blu-ray/DVD menu
7
Changes camera perspectives
8
Changes the audio language
9
Shows or hides subtitles
A
Selects a scene
B
Color selection menu
C
Stops playback
D
Pauses playback
Blu-ray/DVD menu
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

.
à  
.

Calling up the Blu-ray or DVD menu
The Blu-ray or DVD menu is the menu saved on
the disc itself.
#
To show disc functions: press the 9 button
on the remote control.
#
Select .
The Blu-ray or DVD menu appears.
374
Multimedia system
Selecting menu items in the Blu-ray or DVD
menu
#
Select a menu item.
#
Press the 9 button on the remote control.
#
Select .
#
Press the 9 button on the remote control.
The action is carried out or a submenu
appears.
Exiting the Blu-ray or DVD menu
#
Press the ~ button on the remote control
until you see the film.
Playback options in Blu-ray/DVD mode
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

.
à  
.

Pausing or continuing playback
#
To show disc functions: press the 9 button
on the remote control.
#
To pause playback: select Ë.
#
To stop playback: select É.
#
To continue playback: select Ì.
Fast forwarding or rewinding
#
Press and hold the << or >> button in the
DVD/Blu-ray control menu until the desired
position has been reached.
Selecting a Blu-ray/DVD chapter
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

.
à  
.

#
Call up the Blu-ray or DVD menu
(
page 374).
The Blu-ray or DVD menu appears.
#
Select a scene or chapter.
#
Press the 9 button on the remote control.
#
Select the chapter number.
#
Press the 9 button on the remote control.
After a short time, playback starts from the
selected position.
Selecting a film/title
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

.
à  
.

#
Call up the Blu-ray or DVD menu
(
page 374).
The Blu-ray or DVD menu appears.
#
Select the film or track.
#
Press the 9 button on the remote control.
#
Call up the selection list.
#
Select a film or track.
Switching to HDMI mode
Requirements:
R
a media source is connected to the Rear
Seat Entertainment System via the HDMI
port (
page 367).
R
there is an HDMI signal to the Rear Seat
Entertainment System.
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

.
à  
#
To show the menu: press the = button.
Multimedia system
375
#
Select .
The   display appears.
#
To show the menu: press the = button.
#
Select  .
Radio
Switching on the radio
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

#
Alternatively: press the $ button on the
remote control. Further information about
radio mode (
page 351).
Sound
Overview of the Rear Seat Entertainment
System sound settings
The equalizer functions, automatic volume
adjustment and dynamic range control are avail‐
able in the sound menu of the Rear Seat Enter‐
tainment System.
Further information about the sound system
(
page 357).
Information about dynamic range limitation
The dynamic range of the audio signal can be
adjusted for the playback device. The 
  function compensates for differ‐
ences in the quietest and loudest sounds. This
raises the volume of quiet dialog compared to
loud sound effects, for example.
The following settings are available:
R

The dynamic range is set automatically.
This setting is only available for Blu-ray discs.
R

The dynamic range is restricted to improve
the listening experience and comprehension.
R

The dynamic range is not restricted. The
playback volume is the same as the original
soundtrack.
Setting dynamic range limitation
Prerequisite
R
There is no media playback.
Rear Seat Entertainment System:
,

.
à 
.

 
#
Select the setting.
376
Multimedia system
ASSYST PLUS service interval display
Function of the ASSYST PLUS service interval
display
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display in the
Instrument Display provides information on the
remaining time or distance before the next
service due date.
You can hide this service message using the
back button on the left-hand side of the steering
wheel.
You can obtain further information concerning
the servicing of your vehicle from a qualified
specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
Displaying the service due date
On-board computer:
,

.
 
The next service due date is displayed.
#
To exit the display: press the back button
on the left-hand side of the steering wheel.
Make sure to observe the following further rela‐
ted subject:
R
Operating the on-board computer
(
page 245).
Carrying out service work at regular inter‐
vals
*
NOTE Premature wear through failure to
observe service due dates
Service work which is not carried out at the
right time or incompletely can lead to
increased wear and damage to the vehicle.
#
Always observe the prescribed service
intervals.
#
Always have the prescribed service
work carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Special service requirements
The prescribed service interval is based on nor‐
mal operation of the vehicle. Service work will
need to be performed more often if the vehicle
is operated under arduous conditions or
increased loads, for example:
R
regular city driving with frequent intermedi‐
ate stops.
R
if the vehicle is primarily used to travel short
distances.
R
for frequent operation in mountainous terrain
or on poor road surfaces.
R
if the engine is often left idling for long peri‐
ods.
R
in particularly dusty conditions and/or if air-
recirculation mode is frequently used.
In these or similar operating conditions, have the
interior air filter, engine air filter, engine oil, oil
filter etc. changed more frequently. The tires
must be checked more frequently if the vehicle
is operated under increased loads. Further infor‐
mation can be obtained at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Maintenance and care
377
Battery disconnection periods
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
can only calculate the service due date when
the battery is connected.
#
Note down the service due date displayed in
the Instrument Display before disconnecting
the battery (
page 377).
Engine compartment
Active hood (pedestrian protection)
Operation of the active hood (pedestrian pro‐
tection)
In certain accident situations, the risk of injury
to pedestrians can be reduced by the actuation
of the active hood. The rear area of the hood is
raised by approximately 80 mm.
For the drive to the workshop, reset the trig‐
gered active hood yourself. If the active hood
has been triggered, pedestrian protection may
be limited.
A qualified specialist workshop must re-instate
the full functionality of the active hood.
The active hood is not available in all countries.
Resetting the active hood
&
WARNING Risk of burns from hot com‐
ponent parts in the engine compartment
Certain component parts in the engine com‐
partment can be very hot, e.g. the engine,
the cooler and parts of the exhaust system.
#
Let the engine cool down and only
touch the component parts described
as follows.
#
With your hand flat, push down active hood
1 in the area around the hinges on both
sides (arrows).
The hood must engage in position.
#
If the active hood can be raised slightly at
the rear in the area of the hinges, repeat the
step until it engages correctly.
Opening/closing the hood
&
WARNING Risk of accident if the engine
hood is unlatched while driving
An unlocked engine hood may open up when
the vehicle is in motion and block your view.
#
Never unlatch the engine hood while
driving.
#
Before every trip, ensure that the
engine hood is latched.
378
Maintenance and care
&
WARNING Risk of accident and injury
when opening and closing the engine
hood
When opening or closing the engine hood, it
may suddenly drop into the end position.
There is a risk of injury for anyone in the
engine hood's range of movement.
#
Only open or close the engine hood
when there are no persons in the
engine hood's range of movement.
&
WARNING Danger of burns when open‐
ing the hood
If you open the hood when the engine has
overheated or during a fire in the engine
compartment, you could come into contact
with hot gases or other escaping operating
fluids.
#
Before opening the hood, allow the
engine to cool down.
#
In the event of a fire in the engine com‐
partment, keep the hood closed and
call the fire service.
&
WARNING Risk of injury due to moving
parts
Certain components in the engine compart‐
ment may continue to move or suddenly
move again even after the ignition has been
switched off, e.g. the cooler fan.
Make sure of the following before performing
tasks in the engine compartment:
#
Switch the ignition off.
#
Never touch the danger zone surround‐
ing moving component parts, e.g. the
rotation area of the fan.
#
Remove jewelry and watches.
#
Keep items of clothing and hair away
from moving parts.
&
WARNING Risk of injury from touching
component parts under voltage
The ignition system and the fuel injection
system work under high voltage. If you touch
component parts which are under voltage,
you could receive an electric shock.
#
Never touch component parts of the
ignition system or the fuel injection sys‐
tem when the ignition is switched on.
&
WARNING Risk of burns from hot com‐
ponent parts in the engine compartment
Certain component parts in the engine com‐
partment can be very hot, e.g. the engine,
the cooler and parts of the exhaust system.
#
Let the engine cool down and only
touch the component parts described
as follows.
Maintenance and care
379
&
WARNING Risk of injury from using the
windshield wipers while the engine hood
is open
When the engine hood is open and the wind‐
shield wipers are set in motion, you can be
trapped by the wiper linkage.
#
Always switch off the windshield wipers
and ignition before opening the engine
hood.
Plug-in hybrid: observe the notes in the Supple‐
ment. Otherwise, you may not recognize dan‐
gers.
#
To open: pull lever 1 to release the engine
hood.
#
Push hood catch 1 upwards and lift the
hood by approximately 15 in (40 cm).
#
To close: lower the hood and let it fall from a
height of approximately 8 in (20 cm).
#
If the hood can still be lifted slightly, open
the hood again and close it with a little more
force until it engages correctly.
380
Maintenance and care
Engine oil
Checking the engine oil level using the oil
dipstick (S 450, S 450 4MATIC)
&
WARNING Risk of burns from hot com‐
ponent parts in the engine compartment
Certain component parts in the engine com‐
partment can be very hot, e.g. the engine,
the cooler and parts of the exhaust system.
#
Let the engine cool down and only
touch the component parts described
as follows.
Plug-in hybrid: observe the notes in the Supple‐
ment. Otherwise, you may not recognize dan‐
gers.
Depending on the engine, the oil dipstick may be
installed in the engine compartment in different
locations.
Waiting time before checking the oil level:
R
Engine at normal operating temperature: five
minutes.
#
Park the vehicle on a flat surface.
#
Remove oil dipstick 1 and wipe off.
#
Slowly slide oil dipstick 1 into the guide
tube to the stop, and take it out again after
approximately three seconds.
R
Oil level is correct: oil level is between 2
and 3.
R
Oil level too low: oil level is at 3 or
below.
R
Oil level too high: oil level is above 2.
#
If the oil level is too low, add 1.1 US qt (1 l) of
engine oil.
#
If the engine oil level is too high, have the
excess engine oil removed as soon as possi‐
ble at a qualified specialist workshop.
Checking the engine oil level using the on-
board computer (except S 450, S 450
4MATIC)
The engine oil level is determined during driving.
The oil level display is only available after a driv‐
ing time of up to 30 minutes and if the ignition is
switched on, depending on the driving profile.
It is not possible to correctly measure the oil
level if:
R
The vehicle is not level during the measuring
process.
R
The engine hood was previously opened.
The engine must be restarted and the engine oil
level will be determined again during driving.
Maintenance and care
381
On-board computer:
,

.
  
You will see one of the following display
messages in the multifunction display:
#
   : measurement
of the oil level is not yet possible. Repeat the
request after a maximum of 30 minutes' driv‐
ing.
#
    and the bar display for
indicating the oil level in the multifunction
display is green and is between "min" and
"max": the oil level is correct.
#
     and the bar display
for indicating the oil level in the multifunction
display is orange and is below "min": add
1.1 US qt (1 l) of engine oil.
#
    and the bar display
for indicating the oil level in the multifunction
display is orange and is above "max": drain
off the excess engine oil. Consult a qualified
specialist workshop.
#
      :
switch on the ignition to check the engine oil
level.
#
    : sensor
defective or not connected. Consult a quali‐
fied specialist workshop.
#
     :
close the engine hood.
Adding engine oil
&
WARNING Risk of burns from hot com‐
ponent parts in the engine compartment
Certain component parts in the engine com‐
partment can be very hot, e.g. the engine,
the cooler and parts of the exhaust system.
#
Let the engine cool down and only
touch the component parts described
as follows.
&
WARNING Risk of fire and injury from
engine oil
If engine oil comes into contact with hot
component parts in the engine compart‐
ment, it may ignite.
#
Make sure that no engine oil is spilled
next to the filler opening.
#
Allow the engine to cool off and thor‐
oughly clean the engine oil from compo‐
nent parts before starting the vehicle.
*
NOTE Engine damage caused by an
incorrect oil filter, incorrect oil or addi‐
tives
#
Do not use engine oils or oil filters
which do not correspond to the specifi‐
cations explicitly prescribed for the
service intervals.
#
Do not alter the engine oil or oil filter in
order to achieve longer change intervals
than prescribed.
#
Do not use additives.
382
Maintenance and care
#
Follow the instructions in the service
interval display regarding the oil
change.
*
NOTE Damage caused by topping up too
much engine oil
Adding too much engine oil can cause dam‐
age to the engine or the catalytic converter.
#
Have excess engine oil removed at a
qualified specialist workshop.
#
Turn cap 1 counter-clockwise and remove
it.
#
Add engine oil.
#
Replace cap 1 and turn it clockwise as far
as it will go.
#
Check the oil level again ( page 381).
Checking coolant level
&
WARNING Risk of burns from hot com‐
ponent parts in the engine compartment
Certain component parts in the engine com‐
partment can be very hot, e.g. the engine,
the cooler and parts of the exhaust system.
#
Let the engine cool down and only
touch the component parts described
as follows.
&
WARNING Danger of burns from hot
coolant
The engine cooling system is pressurized,
particularly when the engine is warm. If you
open the cap, you could be scalded by hot
coolant spraying out.
#
Let the motor cool down before opening
the cap.
#
When opening the cap, wear gloves and
protective eyewear.
#
Slowly turn the cap half a turn to allow
pressure to escape.
Maintenance and care
383
#
Park the vehicle on a flat surface.
#
Check the coolant temperature display in the
instrument cluster.
The coolant temperature must be below
158 °F (70 °C).
#
Slowly turn cap 1 counter-clockwise to
relieve overpressure.
#
Continue turning cap 1 counter-clockwise
and remove it.
The coolant level is correct:
R
If the engine is cold, up to marker bar 2
R
If the engine is warm, up to 0.6 in (1.5 cm)
over marker bar 2
#
If necessary, add coolant that has been
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
R
Further information on coolant ( page 451)
Adding washer fluid to the windshield
washer system
&
WARNING Risk of burns from hot com‐
ponent parts in the engine compartment
Certain component parts in the engine com‐
partment can be very hot, e.g. the engine,
the cooler and parts of the exhaust system.
#
Let the engine cool down and only
touch the component parts described
as follows.
&
WARNING Danger of burns when open‐
ing the hood
If you open the hood when the engine has
overheated or during a fire in the engine
compartment, you could come into contact
with hot gases or other escaping operating
fluids.
#
Before opening the hood, allow the
engine to cool down.
#
In the event of a fire in the engine com‐
partment, keep the hood closed and
call the fire service.
&
WARNING Risk of fire and injury from
windshield washer concentrate
Windshield washer concentrate is highly
flammable. It could ignite if it comes into
contact with hot engine component parts or
the exhaust system.
#
Make sure that no windshield washer
concentrate spills out next to the filler
opening.
384
Maintenance and care
#
Remove cap 1 by the tab, place on the edge
of the filler opening and engage in place.
#
Add washer fluid.
Cleaning and care
Information on washing the vehicle in a car
wash
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to
reduced braking effect after washing the
vehicle
The braking effect is reduced after washing
the vehicle.
#
After the vehicle has been washed,
brake carefully while paying attention to
the traffic conditions until the braking
effect has been fully restored.
To avoid damage to your vehicle when using a
car wash, ensure the following beforehand:
R
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC and the
HOLD function are deactivated.
R
The 360° Camera or the rear view camera is
switched off.
R
The side windows and sliding sunroof are
completely closed.
R
The blower for the ventilation/heating is
switched off.
R
The windshield wiper switch is in position
g.
R
In car washes with a towing mechanism: neu‐
tral i is engaged.
R
The SmartKey is at a distance of at least
10 ft (3 m) away from the vehicle, otherwise
the trunk lid could open unintentionally.
%
If, after the car wash, you remove the wax
from the windshield and wiper rubber, this
will prevent smearing and reduce wiper
noise.
Information on using a power washer
&
WARNING Risk of accident when using
high-pressure cleaning equipment with
round-spray nozzles
The water jet from a round-spray nozzle (dirt
grinder) may cause damage to tires and sus‐
pension components that is not visible.
Maintenance and care
385
Components damaged in this way may fail
unexpectedly.
#
Do not use high-pressure cleaning
equipment with round-spray nozzles to
clean your vehicle.
#
Damaged tires or suspension compo‐
nents must be replaced immediately.
To avoid damage to your vehicle, observe the fol‐
lowing when using a power washer:
R
Keep the SmartKey at least 10 ft (3 m) away
from the vehicle. Otherwise the trunk lid
could open unintentionally.
R
Maintain a distance of at least 11.8 in
(30 cm) to the vehicle.
R
Vehicles with decorative foil: parts of your
vehicle are covered with a decorative foil.
Maintain a distance of at least 27.6 in
(70 cm) between the foil-covered parts of the
vehicle and the nozzle of the high pressure
cleaner. Move the power washer nozzle
around whilst cleaning.
R
Observe the information on the correct dis‐
tance in the equipment manufacturer's oper‐
ating instructions.
R
Do not point the nozzle of the power washer
directly at sensitive parts such as tires, slits,
electrical component parts, batteries, light
sources and ventilation slots.
Washing the vehicle by hand
Observe the legal requirements, e.g. in a number
of countries, washing by hand is only permitted
in specially designated washing areas.
#
Use a mild cleaning agent, e.g. car shampoo.
#
Wash the vehicle with lukewarm water using
a soft car sponge. When doing so, do not
expose the vehicle to direct sunlight.
#
Carefully hose the vehicle off with water and
dry using a chamois. Take care not to point
the water jet directly towards the air inlet
grille.
386
Maintenance and care
Notes on paintwork/matt finish paintwork care
Observe the following information:
Information on cleaning and careAvoiding damage to the paintwork
Paint
R
Insect remains: soak with insect remover and rinse off the
treated areas afterwards.
R
Bird droppings: soak with water and rinse off afterwards.
R
Coolant, brake fluid, tree resins, oils, fuel and greases:
gently rub with a cloth soaked in petroleum ether or
lighter fluid.
R
Tar stains: use tar remover.
R
Wax: use silicone remover.
R
Do not apply stickers, films etc.
R
Remove dirt immediately, where possible.
Matt finish
R
The vehicle should preferably be washed by hand using a
soft sponge, car shampoo and plenty of water.
R
Only use care products recommended by Mercedes-Benz.
R
Do not polish the vehicle and alloy wheels.
R
Do not have your vehicle cleaned at an automatic car
wash too frequently and do not use wash programs which
finish with a hot wax vehicle treatment.
R
Do not use paint cleaner, buffing or polishing products
such as a gloss preserver, e.g. wax.
R
Always have paintwork repairs carried out at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Maintenance and care
387
Cleaning Night View Assist
Camera behind the windshield
*
NOTE Damage to the camera lens when
cleaning
If you clean the camera lens yourself or spray
glass cleaner on the camera lens, you could
damage the camera lens.
#
When cleaning the field of vision of the
driving systems, do not spray glass
cleaner on the camera lens.
#
If the camera lens is dirty, please con‐
tact a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Fold down the camera cover by handle
recess 1.
#
Use a cloth to clean the windshield in front of
the camera.
Camera in the radiator grill
Camera lens 2 is cleaned at regular intervals
by operating the windshield washer system.
#
Use clear water and a soft cloth to clean
camera lens 2 when it is very dirty.
388
Maintenance and care
Notes on care of vehicle parts
&
WARNING Risk of entrapment if the
windshield wipers are switched on while
the windshield is being cleaned
If the windshield wipers are set in motion
while you are cleaning the windshield or
wiper blades, you can be trapped by the
wiper arm.
#
Always switch off the windshield wipers
and the ignition before cleaning the
windshield or wiper blades.
&
WARNING Risk of burns from tailpipes
and tailpipe trim
The tailpipe and tailpipe trim can become
very hot. If you come into contact with these
parts of the vehicle, you could burn yourself.
#
Always be particularly careful around
the tailpipe and the tailpipe trim.
#
Allow the vehicle parts to cool down
before you touch them.
Observe the following information:
Information on cleaning and careAvoiding vehicle damage
Wheels/rims
Use water and acid-free wheel cleaners.
R
Do not use acidic wheel cleaners to remove brake dust.
This could damage wheel bolts and brake components.
R
To avoid corrosion of the brake discs and brake linings,
drive the vehicle for a few minutes after cleaning before
parking it. The brake discs and brake linings warm up and
dry out.
Windows
Clean the windows on the inside and outside using a damp
cloth and cleaning products recommended by Mercedes-
Benz.
Do not use dry cloths, abrasive products or cleaning agents
containing solvents to clean the inside of the windows.
Maintenance and care
389
Information on cleaning and careAvoiding vehicle damage
Wiper blades
Fold out the wiper blades and clean them using a damp cloth.Do not clean the wiper blades too often.
Exterior lighting
Clean the lenses with a wet sponge and mild detergent, e.g.
car shampoo.
Only use cleaning agents or cleaning cloths that are suitable
for plastic lenses.
Sensors
Clean the sensors in the front and rear bumpers and in the
radiator grill with a soft cloth and car shampoo.
When using a high-pressure water jet, maintain a minimum
distance of 11.8 in (30 cm).
Rear view camera
and 360° Camera
R
Open the camera cover with the multimedia sys‐
tem(
page 226) .
R
Use clear water and a soft cloth to clean the camera lens.
Do not use a high-pressure water jet.
Tailpipes
Clean with cleaning agents recommended by Mercedes-Benz,
particularly in the winter and after washing the vehicle.
Use acid-free cleaning agents.
Notes on care of the interior
&
WARNING Risk of injury from plastic
parts breaking off after the use of sol‐
vent-based care products
Care and cleaning products containing sol‐
vents can cause surfaces in the cockpit to
become porous.
When the airbags are deployed, plastic parts
may break away.
#
Do not use any care or cleaning prod‐
ucts containing solvents to clean the
cockpit.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or death from
bleached seat belts
Bleaching or dyeing seat belts can severely
weaken them.
This can, for example, cause seat belts to
tear or fail in an accident.
#
Never bleach or dye seat belts.
390
Maintenance and care
Observe the following information:
Information on cleaning and careAvoiding vehicle damage
Seat belts
Clean with warm water and soap solution.
R
Do not use chemical cleaning agents.
R
Do not dry seat belts by heating them to over 176 °F
(80 °C) or exposing them to direct sunlight.
Display
Clean the surface carefully with a microfiber cloth and
TFT/LCD display cleaner.
R
Switch off the display and allow to cool.
R
Do not use any other cleaning products.
Plastic trim
R
Clean with a damp microfiber cloth.
R
If the trim is very dirty: use a cleaning agent recommen‐
ded by Mercedes-Benz.
R
Do not apply stickers, films etc.
R
Do not allow cosmetics, insect repellent or sun cream to
come in contact with the plastic trim.
Genuine wood/trim
elements
R
Clean with a microfiber cloth.
R
Black piano-lacquer look: clean with a damp cloth and
soap solution.
R
If the trim is very dirty: use a cleaning agent recommen‐
ded by Mercedes-Benz.
Do not use solvent-based cleaning agents, polishes or waxes.
Headliner
Clean with a brush or dry shampoo.
Carpet
Use carpet and textile cleaning agents recommended by
Mercedes-Benz.
Maintenance and care
391
Information on cleaning and careAvoiding vehicle damage
Genuine leather
seat covers
R
Clean with a damp cloth and then wipe with a dry cloth.
R
Leather care: use leather care agents that have been rec‐
ommended by Mercedes-Benz.
Do not allow the leather to become too damp.
Do not use a microfiber cloth.
DINAMICA seat cov‐
ers
Clean with a damp cloth.Do not use a microfiber cloth.
Artificial leather
seat covers
Clean with a damp cloth and 1% soap solution.Do not use a microfiber cloth.
Cloth seat covers
Clean with a damp cloth and 1% soap solution and allow to
dry.
EASY-PACK trunk
box
Clean with a damp cloth.Do not use any alcohol-based thinners, gasoline or abrasive
cleaning agents.
392
Maintenance and care
Emergency
Removing the safety vest
The safety vests are located in door stowage
compartments 1 in the front door.
#
To remove: pull out the safety vest bag con‐
taining the safety vest.
#
Open the safety vest bag and pull out the
safety vest.
%
Safety vests can also be stored in the rear
door stowage compartments.
1
Maximum number of washes
2
Maximum wash temperature
3
Do not bleach
4
Do not iron
5
Do not use a laundry dryer
6
Do not dry-clean
7
This is a class 2 vest
The requirements defined by the legal standard
are only fulfilled if the safety vest is the correct
size and is fully closed.
Replace the safety vest if:
R
It is damaged or dirt on the reflective strips
can no longer be removed
R
The maximum number of washes is exceeded
R
The fluorescence of the safety vest has faded
Flat tire
Notes on flat tires
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to a flat
tire
A flat tire severely affects the driving charac‐
teristics as well as the steering and braking
of the vehicle.
Tires without run-flat characteristics:
#
Do not drive on with a flat tire.
#
Change the flat tire immediately with
the emergency spare wheel or spare
wheel. Alternatively, consult a qualified
specialist workshop.
Tires with run-flat characteristics:
#
Observe the information and warning
notes on MOExtended tires (run-flat
tires).
Breakdown assistance
393
In the event of a flat tire, the following options
are available depending on your vehicle's equip‐
ment:
R
Vehicles with MOExtended tires: it is pos‐
sible to continue the journey for a short
period of time. Make sure you observe the
notes on MOExtended tires (run-flat tires)
(
page 394).
R
Vehicles with a TIREFIT kit: you can repair
the tire so that it is possible to continue the
journey for a short period of time. To do this,
use the TIREFIT kit (
page 395).
R
Vehicles with Mercedes-Benz
mbrace
®
(USA only): you can make a call for
Roadside Assistance via the overhead control
panel in the case of a breakdown
(
page 328).
R
All vehicles: change the wheel
(
page 437).
MOExtended tires (tires with run-flat proper‐
ties)
&
WARNING Risk of accident when driving
in limp-home mode
When driving in emergency mode the han‐
dling characteristics are impaired, e.g. when
cornering, when accelerating strongly and
when braking.
#
Do not exceed the specified maximum
speed.
#
Avoid any abrupt steering and driving
maneuvers as well as driving over
obstacles (curbs, pot holes, off-road).
This applies, in particular, to a loaded
vehicle.
#
Stop driving in the emergency mode if
you notice:
R
banging noise
R
vehicle vibration
R
smoke which smells like rubber
R
continuous ESP
®
intervention
R
cracks in tire side walls
#
After driving in emergency mode have
the rims checked by a qualified special‐
ist workshop with regard to their further
use.
#
The defective tire must be replaced in
every case.
With MOExtended tires (run-flat tires), you can
continue to drive your vehicle even if there is a
total loss of pressure in one or more tires. How‐
ever, the tire affected must not show any clearly
visible damage.
You can recognize MOExtended tires by the
MOExtended marking which appears on the side
wall of the tire.
Vehicles with tire pressure monitoring sys‐
tem: MOExtended tires may only be used in con‐
junction with an activated tire pressure monitor‐
ing system.
If a pressure loss warning message appears in
the multifunction display:
R
Check the tire for damage.
394
Breakdown assistance
R
If driving on, observe the following notes.
Driving distance possible in limp-home mode
after the pressure loss warning:
Load condition Driving distance pos‐
sible in limp-home
mode
Partially laden 50 miles (80 km)
Fully laden 19 miles (30 km)
R
The driving distance possible in limp-home
mode may vary depending on the driving
style.
R
Maximum permissible speed 50 mph
(80 km/h).
If a tire has gone flat and cannot be replaced
with an MOExtended tire, you can use a stand‐
ard tire as a temporary measure.
TIREFIT kit storage location
The TIREFIT kit is located under the trunk floor.
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. Otherwise, you may not recog‐
nize dangers.
Plug-in hybrid: observe the notes in the Supple‐
ment. Otherwise, you may not recognize dan‐
gers.
1
Tire sealant filler bottle
2
Tire inflation compressor
Using the TIREFIT kit
Have the following readily available:
R
Tire sealant filler bottle
R
Enclosed TIREFIT sticker
R
Tire inflation compressor
R
Disposable gloves
You can use TIREFIT tire sealant to seal punctu‐
res of up to 0.16 in (4 mm), particularly those in
the tire contact surface. You can use TIREFIT in
outside temperatures down to -4 °F (-20 °C).
&
WARNING Risk of accident when using
tire sealant.
In the following situations, the tire sealant is
unable to provide sufficient breakdown assis‐
tance, as it is unable to seal the tire properly:
R
There are cuts or punctures in the tire
larger than those previously mentioned.
R
The wheel rim is damaged.
R
You have driven at a very low tire pres‐
sure or on a flat tire.
#
Do not continue driving.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Breakdown assistance
395
&
WARNING Risk of injury and poisoning
from tire sealant
The tire sealant is harmful and causes irrita
tion. Do not allow it to come into contact
with the skin, eyes or clothing, and do not
swallow it. Do not inhale tire sealant fumes.
Keep the tire sealant away from children.
If you come into contact with the tire sealant,
observe the following:
#
Rinse off the tire sealant from your skin
immediately using water.
#
If tire sealant gets into your eyes, thor‐
oughly rinse out the eyes using clean
water.
#
If tire sealant has been swallowed,
immediately rinse out the mouth thor‐
oughly and drink plenty of water. Do not
induce vomiting and seek medical
attention immediately.
#
Change out of any clothes contamina‐
ted with tire sealant immediately.
#
If allergic reactions occur, seek medical
attention immediately.
*
NOTE Overheating due to the tire infla‐
tion compressor running too long
#
Do not run the tire inflation compressor
for longer than eight minutes without
interruption.
Comply with the manufacturer's safety notes on
the sticker on the tire inflation compressor.
Have the tire sealant bottle replaced every four
years at a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Do not remove any foreign objects which
have penetrated the tire.
#
Affix part 1 of the TIREFIT sticker to the
instrument cluster within the driver's field of
vision.
#
Affix part 2 of the TIREFIT sticker near the
valve on the wheel with the defective tire.
#
Pull plug 4 with the cable and hose 5 out
of the tire inflation compressor housing.
396
Breakdown assistance
#
Push the plug of hose 5 into flange 6 of
tire sealant bottle 1 until the plug engages.
#
Place tire sealant bottle 1 head downwards
into recess 2 of the tire inflation compres‐
sor.
#
Remove the cap from valve 7 on the defec‐
tive tire.
#
Screw filling hose 8 onto valve 7.
#
Insert plug 4 into a 12‑V‑socket in your
vehicle.
#
Switch on the ignition.
#
Press on and off switch 3 on the tire infla‐
tion compressor.
The tire inflation compressor is switched on.
The tire is inflated. First, tire sealant is pum‐
ped into the tire. The pressure may briefly
rise to approximately 500 kPa (5 bar/73 psi).
Do not switch off the tire inflation compres‐
sor during this phase.
#
Let the tire inflation compressor run for a
maximum of eight minutes.
The tire should then have attained a tire
pressure of at least 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi).
If tire sealant leaks out, make sure you clean the
affected area as quickly as possible. It is prefera‐
ble to use clean water.
If you get tire sealant on your clothing, have it
cleaned as soon as possible with perchloroethy‐
lene.
If a tire pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi)
has not been attained after eight minutes:
#
Switch off the tire inflation compressor.
#
Unscrew the filling hose from the valve of the
defective tire.
Please note that tire sealant may leak out when
unscrewing the filling hose.
#
Very slowly drive forwards or reverse approx
imately 33 ft (10 m).
#
Pump up the tire again.
After a maximum of eight minutes the tire
pressure must be at least 180 kPa (1.8 bar/
26 psi).
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to the
specified tire pressure not being reached
If the specified tire pressure is not reached
after the specified time, the tire is too badly
damaged. The tire sealant cannot repair the
tire in this instance.
Damaged tires and a tire pressure that is too
low can significantly impair braking and han‐
dling characteristics.
#
Do not continue driving.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Breakdown assistance
397
If a tire pressure of 180 kPa (1.8 bar/26 psi)
has been attained after eight minutes:
&
WARNING Risk of accident from driving
with sealed tires
A tire temporarily sealed with tire sealant
impairs the handling characteristics and is
not suitable for higher speeds.
#
Adapt your driving style accordingly and
drive carefully.
#
Do not exceed the specified maximum
speed with a tire that has been repaired
using tire sealant.
Observe the maximum permissible speed for a
tire sealed with tire sealant 50 mph (80 km/h).
#
Affix the upper section of the TIREFIT sticker
to the instrument cluster where it will be eas‐
ily seen by the driver.
*
NOTE Staining caused by leaking tire
sealant
After use, excess tire sealant may leak out
from the filling hose.
#
Therefore, place the filling hose in the
plastic bag that contained the TIREFIT
kit.
+
ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
pollution caused by environmentally irre
sponsible disposal
Tire sealant contains pollutants.
#
Have the tire sealant bottle disposed of
professionally, e.g. at an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
#
Switch off the tire inflation compressor.
#
Unscrew the filling hose from the valve of the
defective tire.
#
Stow the tire sealant bottle, the tire inflation
compressor and the warning triangle.
#
Pull away immediately.
#
Stop after driving for approximately ten
minutes and check the tire pressure using
the tire inflation compressor.
The tire pressure must now be at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi).
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to the
specified tire pressure not being reached
If the specified tire pressure is not reached
after a brief drive, the tire is too badly dam‐
aged. The tire sealant cannot repair the tire
in this instance.
Damaged tires and tire pressure that is too
low can significantly impair the braking prop‐
erties and the handling characteristics.
#
Do not continue driving.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
In cases such as the one mentioned above, con‐
tact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. Or
call 1-800-FOR-MERCedes (in the USA) or
1-800-387-0100 (in Canada).
#
Correct the tire pressure if it is still at least
130 kPa (1.3 bar/19 psi). See the Tire and
Loading Information placard on the driver's
side B‑pillar or the tire pressure table in the
fuel filler flap for values.
#
To increase the tire pressure: switch on
the tire inflation compressor.
398
Breakdown assistance
#
To reduce the tire pressure: press pressure
release button 1 next to manometer 2.
#
When the tire pressure is correct, unscrew
the filling hose from the valve of the sealed
tire.
#
Screw the valve cap onto the tire valve of the
sealed tire.
#
Pull the tire sealant bottle out of the tire
inflation compressor.
The filling hose stays on the tire sealant bot‐
tle.
#
Drive to the nearest qualified specialist work
shop and have the tire, tire sealant bottle and
filling hose replaced there.
Battery (vehicle)
Notes on the 12 V battery
Plug-in hybrid: be sure to observe the notes in
the Supplement. Otherwise, you may not recog‐
nize dangers.
&
WARNING Risk of an accident due to
work carried out incorrectly on the bat‐
tery
Work carried out incorrectly on the battery
can, for example, lead to a short circuit. This
can lead to function restrictions in safety-rel‐
evant systems, for example the lighting sys‐
tem, ABS (anti-lock braking system) or ESP
®
(Electronic Stability Program). The operating
safety of your vehicle may be restricted.
You could lose control of the vehicle in the
following situations:
R
when braking
R
in the event of abrupt steering maneuvers
and/or when the vehicle's speed is not
adapted to the road conditions
#
In the event of a short circuit or a simi‐
lar incident, contact a qualified special‐
ist workshop immediately.
#
Do not continue driving.
#
Always have work on the battery carried
out at a qualified specialist workshop.
R
Further information on ABS ( page 189)
R
Further information on ESP
®
( page 189)
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends
that you only use batteries which have been tes‐
ted and approved for your vehicle by Mercedes-
Benz. These batteries provide increased impact
protection to prevent vehicle occupants from
suffering acid burns should the battery be dam‐
aged in the event of an accident.
Breakdown assistance
399
All vehicles except vehicles with a lithium-
ion battery
&
WARNING Risk of explosion due to elec‐
trostatic charge
Electrostatic charge can cause sparks which
may ignite the highly flammable gas mixture
in the battery.
#
To discharge any electrostatic charge
that may have built up, touch the metal
vehicle body before handling the bat‐
tery.
The highly flammable gas mixture is created
while the battery is charging and during starting
assistance.
&
WARNING Danger of chemical burns
from the battery acid
Battery acid is caustic.
#
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or
clothing.
#
Do not lean over the battery.
#
Do not inhale battery gases.
#
Keep children away from the battery.
#
Immediately rinse battery acid off thor‐
oughly with plenty of clean water and
seek medical attention immediately.
All vehicles
+
ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
damage caused by improper disposal of
batteries
Batteries contain pollutants. It is
illegal to dispose of them with the household
rubbish.
#
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally responsible manner.
Take discharged batteries to a qualified
specialist workshop or to a collection
point for used batteries.
If you have to connect the 12 volt battery, con‐
tact a qualified specialist workshop.
Comply with safety notes and take protective
measures when handling batteries.
Risk of explosion
Fire, open flames and smoking are
prohibited when handling the battery.
Avoid creating sparks.
Electrolyte or battery acid is corro
sive. Avoid contact with the skin, eyes
or clothing. Wear suitable protective
clothing, in particular gloves, an
apron and a face mask. Immediately
rinse electrolyte or acid splashes off
with clean water. Consult a doctor if
necessary.
400
Breakdown assistance
Wear safety glasses.
Keep children away.
Observe this Operator's Manual.
If you do not intend to use the vehicle over an
extended period of time:
R
Activate standby mode, or
R
Connect the battery to a battery charger
approved by Mercedes-Benz, or
R
Consult a qualified specialist workshop to
disconnect the battery
Starting assistance and charging the 12 V
battery
Vehicles with a lithium-ion battery
#
When charging the battery and during start‐
ing assistance, always use the jump-start
connection point in the engine compartment.
*
NOTE Damage to the battery from over‐
voltage
When charging using a battery charger with‐
out a maximum charging voltage, the battery
or the on-board electronics may be damaged.
#
Only use battery chargers with a maxi‐
mum charging voltage of 14.4 V.
*
NOTE Shortening the service life of the
battery by charging the battery at low
temperatures
Charging the battery at very low tempera‐
tures may shorten the service life of the bat‐
tery and have a negative effect on starting.
#
Do not charge the battery at very low
temperatures.
All other vehicles
#
When charging the battery and during start‐
ing assistance, always use the jump-start
connection point in the engine compartment.
*
NOTE Damaging the battery through
overvoltage
When charging using a battery charger with‐
out a maximum charging voltage, the battery
or the vehicle electronics may be damaged.
#
Only use battery chargers with a maxi‐
mum charging voltage of 14.8 V.
&
WARNING Risk of explosion from hydro‐
gen gas igniting
A battery generates hydrogen gas during the
charging process. If there is a short circuit or
sparks start to form, there is a danger of the
hydrogen gas igniting.
Breakdown assistance
401
#
Make sure that the positive terminal of
the connected battery does not come
into contact with vehicle parts.
#
Never place metal objects or tools on a
battery.
#
When connecting and disconnecting the
battery, you must observe the descri‐
bed order for the battery clamps.
#
When giving starting assistance, always
make sure that you only connect bat‐
tery terminals with identical polarity.
#
During starting assistance, you must
observe the described order for con‐
necting and disconnecting the jumper
cables.
#
Do not connect or disconnect the bat‐
tery clamps while the engine is running.
&
WARNING Risk of explosion during
charging process and starting assistance
During the charging process and starting
assistance, the battery may release an explo‐
sive gas mixture.
#
Avoid fire, open flames, creating sparks
and smoking.
#
Make sure that there is sufficient venti‐
lation during the charging process and
during starting assistance.
#
Do not lean over a battery.
If the indicator/warning lamps in the instrument
cluster do not light up at low temperatures, it is
very likely that the discharged battery has fro‐
zen.
&
WARNING Risk of explosion from a fro‐
zen battery
A discharged battery may freeze at tempera‐
tures slightly above or below freezing point.
During starting assistance or battery charg‐
ing, battery gas may be released.
#
Always thaw a frozen battery out first
before charging it or performing start‐
ing assistance.
The service life of a battery that has been
thawed may be dramatically shortened.
It is recommended that you have a thawed bat‐
tery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
All vehicles
Plug-in hybrid: observe the notes in the Supple‐
ment. Otherwise, you may not recognize dan‐
gers.
*
NOTE Damage caused by numerous or
extended attempts to start the engine
Numerous or extended attempts to start the
engine may damage the catalytic converter
due to non-combusted fuel.
#
Avoid numerous and extended attempts
to start the engine.
Observe the following points during starting
assistance and when charging the battery:
R
Only use undamaged jumper cables/charg‐
ing cables with a sufficient cross-section and
insulated terminal clamps.
R
Non-insulated parts of the terminal clamps
must not come into contact with other metal
parts while the jumper cable/charging cable
402
Breakdown assistance
is connected to the battery/jump-start con‐
nection point.
R
The jumper cable/charging cable must not
come into contact with any parts which may
move when the engine is running.
R
Always make sure that neither you nor the
battery is electrostatically charged.
R
Keep away from fire and open flames.
R
Do not lean over the battery.
R
When charging: only use battery chargers
tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz, and
please read the battery charger's operating
instructions before charging the battery.
Observe the additional following points during
starting assistance:
R
Starting assistance may only be provided
using batteries with a nominal voltage of 12
V.
R
The vehicles must not touch.
R
Gasoline engine: Only accept starting assis‐
tance if the engine and exhaust system are
cold.
#
Secure the vehicle by applying the electric
parking brake.
#
Automatic transmission: Shift the trans‐
mission to position B.
#
Make sure that the ignition and all electrical
consumers are switched off.
#
Open the hood.
#
Vehicles with ground point cover: turn
screws 2 from ground point cover 1 coun‐
ter-clockwise and remove ground point cover
1.
#
Slide cover 3 of positive clamp 4 on the
jump-starting connection point in the direc‐
tion of the arrow.
#
Connect positive clamp 4 on your vehicle to
positive pole of the donor battery using the
jumper cable/charging cable. Always begin
with positive clamp 4 on your own vehicle
first.
Breakdown assistance
403
#
During the starting assistance proce‐
dure: start the engine of the donor vehicle
and run at idle speed.
#
Connect the negative pole of the donor bat‐
tery and ground point 5 of your own vehicle
by using the jumper cable/charging cable.
Begin with the donor battery first.
#
During starting assistance: start the
engine of your own vehicle.
#
During the charging process: start the
charging process.
#
During starting assistance: let the engines
run for several minutes.
#
During starting assistance: before discon‐
necting the jumper cable, switch on an elec‐
trical consumer on your own vehicle, e.g. the
rear window heater or lighting.
When the starting assistance/charging process
is complete:
#
First, remove the jumper cable/charging
cable from ground point 5 and negative
pole of the donor battery, then from positive
clamp 4 and positive pole of the donor bat‐
tery. Begin each time with the contacts on
your own vehicle first.
#
After removing the jumper cable/charging
cable, close cover 3 of positive clamp 4.
#
Vehicles with ground point cover: replace
ground point cover 1 and turn screws 2
clockwise.
You can obtain further information on starting
assistance at any qualified specialist workshop.
Tow starting or towing away
Permitted towing methods
Plug-in hybrid: observe the notes in the Supple‐
ment. Otherwise, you may not recognize dan‐
gers.
Mercedes-Benz recommends transporting your
vehicle in the case of a breakdown, rather than
towing it away.
*
NOTE Damage to the vehicle due to tow‐
ing away incorrectly
#
Observe the instructions and notes on
towing away.
404
Breakdown assistance
Permitted towing methods
Vehicle equipment/towing
method
Both axles on the ground Front axle raised Rear axle raised
Vehicles with automatic transmis‐
sion
Yes, maximum 31 miles (50 km) at
31 mph (50 km/h)
No Yes, if the steering wheel is fixed in
the center position with a steering
wheel lock.
4MATIC vehicles Yes, maximum 31 miles (50 km) at
31 mph (50 km/h)
No No
Towing with a raised axle: towing should be
performed by a towing company.
Towing the vehicle with both axles on the
ground
#
Observe the notes on the permitted towing
methods (
page 404).
#
Make sure that the battery is connected and
charged.
When the battery is discharged:
R
the engine cannot be started.
R
the electric parking brake cannot be released
or applied.
R
the automatic transmission cannot be shifted
to position i or j.
%
If the automatic transmission cannot be shif‐
ted to position i, transport the vehicle
(
page 407). A towing vehicle with lifting
equipment is required for vehicle transporta
tion.
*
NOTE Damage due to towing away at
excessively high speeds or over long dis‐
tances
The drivetrain could be damaged when tow‐
ing at excessively high speeds or over long
distances.
Breakdown assistance
405
#
A towing speed of 30 mph (50 km/h)
must not be exceeded.
#
A towing distance of 30 miles (50 km)
must not be exceeded.
&
WARNING Risk of accident when towing
a vehicle which is too heavy
If the vehicle being tow-started or towed
away is heavier than the permissible gross
mass of your vehicle, the following situations
can occur:
R
The towing eye may become detached.
R
The vehicle/trailer combination may
swerve or even overturn.
#
If another vehicle is tow-started or
towed away, its weight must not exceed
the permissible gross mass of your own
vehicle.
If a vehicle must be tow-started or towed away,
its weight must not exceed the permissible gross
mass of the towing vehicle.
#
Information on the permissible gross mass of
the vehicle can be found on the vehicle iden‐
tification plate (
page 445).
#
Do not open the driver's door or front
passenger door, otherwise the automatic
transmission automatically shifts to position
j.
#
Install the towing eye ( page 409).
#
Attach the tow bar.
*
NOTE Damage due to incorrect connec‐
tion
#
Only connect the tow rope or tow bar to
the towing eyes.
#
Deactivate the automatic locking mechanism
(
page 64).
#
Do not activate the HOLD function.
#
Deactivate Active Brake Assist ( page 196).
#
Shift the automatic transmission to position
i.
#
Release the electric parking brake.
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to limi‐
ted safety-related functions during the
towing process
Safety-related functions are limited or no lon‐
ger available in the following situations:
R
the ignition is switched off.
R
the brake system or power steering sys‐
tem is malfunctioning.
R
the energy supply or the on-board electri‐
cal system is malfunctioning.
When your vehicle is then towed away, signif‐
icantly more effort may be required to steer
and brake than is normally required.
#
Use a tow bar.
#
Make sure that the steering wheel can
move freely, before towing the vehicle
away.
406
Breakdown assistance
*
NOTE Damage due to excessive tractive
power
If you pull away sharply, the tractive power
may be too high and the vehicles could be
damaged.
#
Pull away slowly and smoothly.
Loading the vehicle for transport
#
Observe the notes on towing away
(
page 405).
#
Connect the tow bar to the towing eye to
load the vehicle.
#
Shift the automatic transmission to position
i.
%
The automatic transmission may be locked
in position j in the event of damage to the
electrics. To shift to i, provide the on-
board electrical system with power
(
page 401).
#
Load the vehicle onto the transporter.
#
Shift the automatic transmission to position
j.
#
Only secure the vehicle by the wheels.
Vehicles with ADS PLUS (Adaptive Damping
System PLUS)
&
WARNING Risk of an accident when
transporting vehicles with Adaptive
Damping System PLUS
The reduced damping forces on the vehicle
being transported can cause the vehicle/
trailer combination to start to swing.
As a result, when transporting vehicles with
the Adaptive Damping System PLUS, the
vehicle/trailer combination may start to skid.
Consequently, you could lose control of your
vehicle.
#
When transporting, ensure that:
R
The vehicle has been loaded onto
the transporter correctly
R
The vehicle is secured at all four
wheels with suitable tensioning
straps
R
The maximum permissible speed of
35 mph (60 km/h) is not exceeded
when transporting
*
NOTE Damage to the vehicle from secur‐
ing it incorrectly
#
After loading, the vehicle must be
secured on all four wheels. Otherwise,
the vehicle could be damaged.
#
A minimum distance of 4 in (10 cm)
upwards and 8 in (20 cm) downwards
must be kept to the transport platform.
%
Transport level is not available for the follow‐
ing vehicles:
R
Mercedes‑AMG vehicles
R
Vehicles with MAGIC BODY CONTROL
Breakdown assistance
407
#
To activate transport level: press button
1.
Indicator lamp 2 lights up.
The vehicle is raised by 1.2 in (30 mm) com‐
pared to the normal level.
#
Press button 1 again and hold it for at least
five seconds.
The vehicle is raised from the raised level to
the transport level.
The transport level is reached when indicator
lamp 2 flashes and the  
  display message appears in the
multifunction display.
Load the vehicle and lash it down at all four
wheels. Otherwise, the vehicle could be dam‐
aged.
%
A minimum distance of 4 in (10 cm) upwards
and 8 in (20 cm) downwards must be kept to
the transport platform.
The vehicle is lowered again in the following sit‐
uations:
R
When driving faster than 21 mph (35 km/h).
R
After selecting a drive program using the
DYNAMIC SELECT switch.
The vehicle is adjusted to the height of the last
active drive program.
#
To deactivate transport level: start the
engine when the vehicle is at a standstill.
If transport level is activated, indicator lamp
2 flashes.
#
Press and hold button 1 for at least five
seconds.
The vehicle is adjusted to the height of the
last active drive program. Indicator lamp 2
goes out.
#
Drive the vehicle off the transporter.
4MATIC vehicles
#
Make sure that the front and rear axles come
to rest on the same transport vehicle.
408
Breakdown assistance
*
NOTE Damage to the drivetrain due to
incorrect positioning
#
Do not position the vehicle above the
connection point of the transport vehi‐
cle.
Towing eye
Towing eye 1 is located with the vehicle tool kit
under the trunk floor.
Installing the towing eye
#
Press the mark on cover 1 inwards and
remove.
#
Screw in the towing eye clockwise to the
stop.
%
Make sure that cover 1 engages in the
bumper when you remove the towing eye.
*
NOTE Damage due to incorrect use of
the towing eye
When a towing eye is used to recover a vehi‐
cle, the vehicle may be damaged in the proc‐
ess.
#
Only use the towing eye to tow away or
tow start the vehicle.
Tow-starting the vehicle (emergency engine
start)
*
NOTE Damage to the automatic trans‐
mission due to tow starting
The automatic transmission may be damaged
in the process of tow starting vehicles with
automatic transmission.
#
Vehicles with automatic transmission
must not be tow started.
#
Vehicles with automatic transmission must
not be tow-started.
Breakdown assistance
409
Electrical fuses
Notes on electrical fuses
&
WARNING Risk of accident and injury
due to overloaded lines
If you manipulate or bridge a faulty fuse or if
you replace it with a fuse with a higher
amperage, the electric line could be overloa‐
ded.
This could result in a fire.
#
Always replace faulty fuses with speci‐
fied new fuses containing the correct
amperage.
*
NOTE Damage caused by incorrect fuses
Incorrect fuses may cause damage to electri‐
cal components or systems.
#
Only use Mercedes-Benz approved
fuses with the correct fuse rating.
Blown fuses must be replaced with fuses of the
same rating, which you can recognize by the
color and fuse rating. The fuse ratings are listed
in the fuse assignment diagram. The fuse assign‐
ment diagram is in the vehicle document wallet.
*
NOTE Damage or malfunctions caused
by moisture
Moisture may cause damage to the electrical
system or cause it to malfunction.
#
When the fuse box is open, make sure
that no moisture can enter the fuse
box.
#
When closing the fuse box, make sure
that the seal of the lid is positioned cor‐
rectly on the fuse box.
If the newly inserted fuse also blows, have the
cause traced and rectified at a qualified special‐
ist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center.
Ensure the following before replacing a fuse:
R
The vehicle is secured against rolling away.
R
All electrical consumers are switched off.
R
The ignition is switched off.
The electrical fuses are located in various fuse
boxes:
R
Fuse box in the engine compartment on the
driver's side (
page 410)
R
Fuse box on the driver's side of the dash‐
board (
page 412)
R
Fuse box in the front-passenger footwell
(
page 412)
R
Fuse box in the trunk on the right-hand side
of the vehicle, when viewed in the direction
of travel (
page 412)
Fuse box in the engine compartment
Requirements:
R
Observe the notes on electrical fuses
(
page 410).
Have the following readily available:
R
A dry cloth
R
A screwdriver
410
Breakdown assistance
Opening
&
WARNING Risk of injury from using the
windshield wipers while the engine hood
is open
When the engine hood is open and the wind‐
shield wipers are set in motion, you can be
trapped by the wiper linkage.
#
Always switch off the windshield wipers
and ignition before opening the engine
hood.
#
Release retaining clips 1.
Pull cover 2 up.
#
Remove any existing moisture from the fuse
box using a dry cloth.
#
Loosen screws 4, remove fuse box lid 3
from the top.
Closing
#
Check whether the seal is positioned cor‐
rectly in the lid.
Breakdown assistance
411
#
Insert the lid into the bracket at the rear of
the fuse box.
#
Fold down lid of the fuse box and tighten
screws 4.
#
Insert cover 2 on both sides and engage
retaining clips 1.
#
Close the hood.
Dashboard fuse box
The fuse box is on the side of the dashboard
under a cover.
#
Open cover 1 in the direction of the arrow
and remove it.
Fuse box in the front-passenger footwell
Requirement:
R
Observe the notes on electrical fuses
(
page 410).
#
Open cover 1 in the direction of the arrow
and remove it.
Fuse box in the trunk
Requirement:
R
Observe the notes on electrical fuses
(
page 410).
#
Fold cover 1 down in the direction of the
arrow.
412
Breakdown assistance
Noise or unusual handling characteristics
While driving, pay attention to vibrations, noises
and unusual handling characteristics, e.g. pulling
to one side. This may indicate that the wheels or
tires are damaged. If you suspect that a tire is
defective, reduce your speed immediately. Stop
the vehicle as soon as possible to check the
wheels and tires for damage. Hidden tire dam‐
age could also be causing the unusual handling
characteristics. If you find no signs of damage,
have the tires and wheels checked at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Checking wheels and tires regularly
&
WARNING Risk of accident from dam‐
aged tires
Damaged tires can cause tire pressure loss.
As a result, you could lose control of your
vehicle.
#
Check the tires regularly for signs of
damage and replace any damaged tires
immediately.
&
WARNING Risk of aquaplaning due to
insufficient tire tread
Insufficient tire tread will result in reduced
tire grip. The tire tread is no longer able to
dissipate water.
This means that in heavy rain or slush the
risk of hydroplaning is increased, in particu‐
lar if vehicle speed is not adapted to suit the
conditions.
If the tire pressure is too high or too low,
tires may exhibit different levels of wear at
different locations on the tire contact sur‐
face.
#
Thus, you should regularly check the
tread depth and the condition of the tire
contact surface across the entire width
of all tires.
Minimum tread depth for:
R
Summer tires: â in (3 mm)
R
M+S tires: ã in (4 mm)
#
For safety reasons, replace the tires
before the legally prescribed limit for
the minimum tread depth is reached.
Carry out the following checks on all wheels reg‐
ularly, at least once a month or as required, e.g.
prior to a long journey or driving off-road:
R
Check the tire pressure ( page 414).
R
Visual inspection of wheels and tires for
damage.
R
Check the valve caps.
The valves must be protected against mois‐
ture and dirt by the valve caps approved
especially for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz.
R
Visual check of the tread depth and the tire
contact surface across the entire width.
The minimum tread depth for summer tires is
â in (3 mm) and for winter tires ã in
(4 mm).
Wheels and tires
413
Six marks 1 show where the bar indicators
(arrow) are integrated into the tire tread. They
are visible once a tread depth of approximately
á in (1.6 mm) has been reached.
Notes on snow chains
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to incor‐
rect mounting of snow chains
If you have mounted snow chains to the front
wheels, the snow chains may drag against
the vehicle body or chassis components.
This could cause damage to the vehicle or
the tires.
#
Never mount snow chains on the front
wheels.
#
Only mount snow chains on the rear
wheels in pairs.
*
NOTE Damage to the wheel trim from
mounted snow chains
If snow chains are mounted to steel wheels,
the wheel trims can be damaged.
#
Remove the wheel trims of steel wheels
before mounting snow chains.
R
Snow chains are only permissible for certain
wheel/tire combinations. You can obtain
information about this from an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
R
For safety reasons, only use snow chains that
have been specifically approved for your
vehicle by Mercedes-Benz, or snow chains
with the same quality standard.
R
If snow chains are installed, the maximum
permissible speed is 30 mph (50 km/h).
R
Vehicles with Active Parking Assist: Do
not use Parking Assist PARKTRONIC when
snow chains have been installed.
R
Vehicles with AIR BODY CONTROL or
MAGIC BODY CONTROL: If snow chains are
installed, only drive at raised vehicle level.
%
You can deactivate ESP
®
to pull away
(
page 191). This allows the wheels to spin,
achieving an increased driving force.
Tire pressure
Notes on tire pressure
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to insuf‐
ficient or excessive tire pressure
Underinflated or overinflated tires pose the
following risks:
R
The tires may burst, especially as the
load and vehicle speed increase.
414
Wheels and tires
R
The tires may wear excessively and/or
unevenly, which may greatly impair tire
traction.
R
The driving characteristics, as well as
steering and braking, may be greatly
impaired.
#
Comply with the recommended tire
pressure and check the tire pressure of
all tires including the spare wheel regu‐
larly:
R
at least once a month
R
when the load changes
R
before embarking on a longer journey
R
if operating conditions change, e.g. off-
road driving
#
Adjust the tire pressure as necessary.
Driving with tire pressure that is too high or too
low can:
R
Shorten the service life of the tires.
R
Cause increased tire damage.
R
Adversely affect handling characteristics and
thus driving safety, e.g. due to hydroplaning.
&
WARNING Risk of an accident due to
insufficient tire pressure
Tires with pressure that is too low can over‐
heat and burst as a result.
In addition, they also suffer from excessive
and/or irregular wear, which can significantly
impair the braking properties and the han‐
dling characteristics.
#
Avoid excessively low tire pressures in
all the tires, including the spare wheel.
Tire pressure which is too low can cause:
R
Tire defects as a result of overheating
R
Impaired handling characteristics
R
Irregular wear
R
Increased fuel consumption
&
WARNING Risk of accident from exces‐
sive tire pressure
Tires with excessively high pressure can
burst because they are damaged more easily
by highway fill, pot holes etc.
In addition, they also suffer from irregular
wear, which can significantly impair the brak‐
ing properties and the handling characteris‐
tics.
#
Avoid excessively high tire pressures in
all the tires, including the spare wheel.
Excessively high tire pressure can result in:
R
Increased braking distance
R
Impaired handling characteristics
R
Irregular wear
R
Impaired driving comfort
R
Susceptibility to damage
Wheels and tires
415
&
WARNING Risk of accident caused by
repeated drop in tire pressure
If the tire pressure drops repeatedly, the
wheel, valve or tire may be damaged.
Insufficient tire pressure can cause the tires
to burst.
#
Inspect the tire for signs of foreign
objects.
#
Check whether the wheel or valve has a
leak.
#
If you are unable to rectify the damage,
contact a qualified specialist workshop.
You can find information on tire pressure for the
vehicle's factory-mounted tires on the following
labels:
R
Tire and Loading Information placard on the
B‑pillar of your vehicle (
page 420).
R
Tire pressure table on the inside of the fuel
filler flap (
page 416).
Observe the maximum tire pressure
(
page 428).
Use a suitable pressure gauge to check the tire
pressure. The outer appearance of a tire does
not permit any reliable conclusion about the tire
pressure.
Vehicles with a tire pressure monitoring sys‐
tem: You can also check the tire pressure using
the on-board computer.
Only correct tire pressure when the tires are
cold. Conditions for cold tires:
R
The vehicle has been parked with the tires
out of direct sunlight for at least three hours.
R
The vehicle has traveled less than 1 mile
(1.6 km).
A rise in the tire temperature of 18 °F (10 °C)
increases the tire pressure by approx. 10 kPa
(0.1 bar/1.5 psi). Take this into account when
checking the tire pressure of warm tires.
The tire pressure recommended for increased
load/speed in the tire pressure table can affect
the ride comfort.
&
WARNING Risk of accident from unsuita‐
ble accessories on the tire valves
If you mount unsuitable accessories onto tire
valves, the tire valves may be overloaded and
malfunction, which can cause tire pressure
loss. Tire pressure monitoring systems for
retrofitting will cause the tire valve to remain
open. This can also result in tire pressure
loss.
#
Only screw standard valve caps or valve
caps specifically approved by
Mercedes-Benz for your vehicle onto
the tire valve.
Tire pressure table
The tire pressure table is on the inside of the
fuel filler flap.
%
The data shown in the images is example
data.
416
Wheels and tires
The tire pressure table shows the recommended
tire pressure for all tires approved for this vehi‐
cle. The recommended tire pressures apply for
cold tires under various operating conditions, i.e.
loading and/or speed of the vehicle.
If one or more tire sizes precede a tire pressure,
the tire pressure information following is only
valid for those tire sizes.
The load conditions "partially laden" and "fully
laden" are defined in the table for different num‐
bers of passengers and amounts of luggage. The
actual number of seats may differ from this.
Some tire pressure tables only show the rim
diameter instead of the complete tire size, e.g.
R18. The rim diameter is part of the tire size and
can be found on the tire side wall (
page 428).
Be sure to also observe the following further
related subjects:
R
Notes on tire pressure ( page 414)
R
Tire and Loading Information placard
(
page 420)
R
Maximum tire pressure ( page 428)
Checking tire pressures manually
#
Read the tire pressure for the current operat‐
ing conditions from the Tire and Loading
Information placard or the tire pressure
table. Observe the notes on tire pressure.
#
Remove the valve cap of the tire to be
checked.
#
Press the tire pressure gauge securely onto
the valve.
#
Read the tire pressure.
#
If the tire pressure is lower than the recom‐
mended value, increase the tire pressure to
the recommended value.
#
If the tire pressure is higher than the recom‐
mended value, release air. To do so, press
down the metal pin in the valve, e.g. using
the tip of a pen for example. Then check the
tire pressure again using the tire pressure
gauge.
#
Screw the valve cap onto the valve.
Wheels and tires
417
Further related subjects:
R
Notes on tire pressure ( page 414)
R
Tire pressure table ( page 416)
R
Tire and Loading Information placard
(
page 420)
Tire pressure monitoring system
Function of the tire pressure monitoring sys‐
tem
&
DANGER Risk of accident due to incor‐
rect tire pressure
Every tire, including the spare (if provided),
should be checked when cold at least once a
month and inflated to the pressure recom‐
mended by the vehicle manufacturer (see
Tire and Loading Information placard on the
B-pillar on the driver’s side or the tire pres‐
sure label on the inside of the fuel filler flap
of your vehicle). If your vehicle has tires of a
different size than the size indicated on the
Tire and Loading Information placard or the
tire pressure table, you need to determine
the proper tire pressure for those tires.
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has
been equipped with a tire pressure monitor‐
ing system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire
pressure indicator lamp when one or more of
your tires are significantly underinflated.
Accordingly, if the low tire pressure indicator
lamp lights up, you should stop and check
your tires as soon as possible, and inflate
them to the proper pressure. Driving on a
significantly underinflated tire causes the tire
to overheat and can lead to tire failure.
Underinflation also increases fuel consump‐
tion and reduces tire tread life, and may
affect the vehicle's handling and braking abil‐
ity. Please note that the TPMS is not a substi‐
tute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the
driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire
pressure, even if underinflation has not
reached the level to trigger illumination of
the TPMS low tire pressure indicator lamp.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a
TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when
the system is not operating properly. The
TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with
the low tire pressure indicator lamp. When
the system detects a malfunction, the indica‐
tor lamp will flash for approximately a minute
and then remain continuously illuminated.
This sequence will continue upon subsequent
vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction
exists.
When the malfunction indicator is illumina‐
ted, the system may not be able to detect or
signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS
malfunctions may occur for a variety of rea‐
sons, including the installation of incompati‐
ble replacement or alternate tires or wheels
on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from
functioning properly.
Always check the TPMS malfunction warning
lamp after replacing one or more tires or
wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the
replacement or alternate tires and wheels
allow the TPMS to continue to function prop‐
erly.
418
Wheels and tires
The system checks the tire pressure and the tire
temperature of the tires mounted on the vehicle
by means of a tire pressure sensor.
New tire pressure sensor, e.g. in winter tires, are
automatically taught-in the first time they are
driven.
The tire pressure appears in the multifunction
display (
page 247).
If there is a substantial pressure loss or if the
tire temperature is excessive, a warning will be
given:
R
Via display messages ( page 487).
R
Via the h warning lamp in the instrument
cluster (
page 517).
It is the driver's responsibility to set the tire
pressure to the recommended cold tire pressure
suitable for the operating situation. Set the tire
pressure for cold tires using a tire pressure
gauge. Note that the correct tire pressure for the
current operating situation must first be taught-
in to the tire pressure monitoring system.
In most cases, the tire pressure monitoring sys‐
tem will automatically update the new reference
values after you have changed the tire pressure.
You can, however, also update the reference val‐
ues by restarting the tire pressure monitoring
system
manually (
page 420).
System limitations
The system may be impaired or may not function
in the following situations:
R
If the tire pressure is set incorrectly.
R
If there is a sudden pressure loss caused, for
example by a foreign object penetrating the
tire.
R
If there is a malfunction caused by another
radio signal source.
Make sure to observe the following further rela‐
ted subject:
R
Notes on tire pressure ( page 414)
Checking the tire pressure with the tire pres‐
sure monitoring system
Requirement:
R
The ignition is switched on.
On-board computer:
,

.

One of the following displays appears:
R
Current tire pressure of each wheel:
R
      
 
R
   : the teach-in
process of the system is not yet complete.
The tire pressures are already being moni‐
tored.
#
Compare the tire pressure with the recom‐
mended tire pressure for the current operat‐
Wheels and tires
419
ing condition ( page 416). Observe the
notes on tire temperature (
page 414).
%
The values displayed in the multifunction dis‐
play may deviate from those of the tire pres‐
sure gauge as they refer to sea level. At high
altitudes, the tire pressure values indicated
by pressure gauges are higher than those
shown by the on-board computer. In this
case, do not reduce the tire pressure.
Make sure to observe the following further rela‐
ted subject:
R
Notes on tire pressure ( page 414)
Restarting the tire pressure monitoring sys‐
tem
Requirements:
R
The recommended tire pressure is correctly
set for the respective operating condition on
each of the four wheels (
page 414).
Restart the tire pressure monitoring system in
the following situations:
R
The tire pressure has changed.
R
The wheels or tires have been changed or
newly installed.
On-board computer:
,

.

#
Swipe downwards on the Touch Control on
the left-hand side of the steering wheel.
The      
  message is shown in the multi‐
function display.
#
Press a to confirm the restart.
The     message is
shown in the multifunction display.
Current warning messages are deleted and
the h yellow warning lamp goes out.
After you have driven for a few minutes, the
system checks whether the current tire pres‐
sures are within the specified range. The cur‐
rent tire pressures are then accepted as ref‐
erence values and monitored.
Make sure to observe the following further rela‐
ted subject:
R
Notes on tire pressure ( page 414)
Radio-equipment approval of the tire pres‐
sure monitoring system
Radio equipment approval numbers
CountryRadio equipment approval
number
Canada
USA
FCC ID: MRXAG5SP4
FCC ID: MRXMFR
IC: 2546A-AG5SP4
Further information on the declaration of con‐
formity for wireless vehicle components
(
page 23).
Loading the vehicle
Tire and Loading Information placard
&
WARNING Risk of accident from overloa‐
ded tires
Overloaded tires may overheat and burst as a
consequence. Overloaded tires can also
impair the steering and handling characteris‐
tics and lead to brake failure.
420
Wheels and tires
#
Observe the load rating of the tires.
#
The load rating must be at least half the
permissible axle load of the vehicle.
#
Never overload the tires by exceeding
the maximum load.
The Tire and Loading Information placard is on
the B-pillar on the driver's side of the vehicle.
1
Tire and Loading Information placard
%
The data shown in the image is example
data.
The Tire and Loading Information placard shows:
R
Maximum number of seats 2 according to
the maximum number of people permitted to
travel in the vehicle.
R
Maximum permissible load 3 comprises the
gross weight of all vehicle occupants, load
and luggage.
R
Recommended tire pressures 1 for cold
tires. The recommended tire pressures are
valid for the maximum permissible load and
up to the maximum permissible vehicle
speed.
Please also note:
R
Information on permissible weights and loads
on the vehicle identification plate
(
page 445).
R
Information on tire pressure on the tire pres‐
sure table (
page 416).
Further related subjects:
R
Determining the maximum permissible load
(
page 421)
R
Notes on tire pressure ( page 414)
Determining the maximum permissible load
The following steps have been developed as
required of all manufacturers under Title 49,
Code of U.S. Federal Regulations, Part 575, pur‐
suant to the "National Traffic and Motor Vehicle
Safety Act of 1966".
Wheels and tires
421
#
Step 1: locate the statement "The combined
weight of occupants and cargo should never
exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs." ("The combined
weight of occupants and cargo should never
exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs.") on your vehicle's
Tire and Loading Information placard.
#
Step 2: determine the combined weight of
the driver and passengers that will be travel‐
ing in your vehicle.
#
Step 3: subtract the combined weight of the
driver and passengers from XXX kg or
XXX lbs.
#
Step 4: the resulting figure equals the per‐
missible cargo and luggage load capacity. For
example: If "XXX" equals 1400 lbs and there
are five occupants in your vehicle with a
weight of 150 lbs each, the maximum cargo
and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs (1400 -
750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs).
#
Step 5: determine the combined weight of
luggage and cargo that the vehicle will be
carrying. For safety reasons, this weight may
not safely exceed the available cargo and lug‐
gage load capacity calculated in step 4.
Even if you have calculated the total load care‐
fully, you should still make sure that the maxi‐
mum permissible gross mass and the maximum
permissible axle load of your vehicle are not
exceeded. Details can be found on the vehicle
identification plate.
#
Have your loaded vehicle including driver,
occupants and load weighed on a vehicle
weighbridge.
The measured values may not exceed the
maximum permissible values stated on the
vehicle identification plate.
Further related subjects:
R
Calculation example for determining the max‐
imum load (
page 422)
R
Tire and Loading Information placard
(
page 420)
R
Tire pressure table ( page 416)
R
Vehicle identification plate
Calculation example for determining the
maximum load
The following table shows examples of how to
calculate total and load capacities with varying
seating configurations and different numbers
and sizes of occupants. The following examples
use a maximum load of 1500 lbs (680 kg). This
is for illustration purposes only. Make sure
you are using the actual load limit for your vehi‐
cle stated on your vehicle's Tire and Loading
Information placard (
page 420).
The higher the weight of all the occupants, the
smaller the maximum load for luggage.
422
Wheels and tires
Step 1
Example 1Example 2
Combined maximum weight of occupants and
load (data from the Tire and Loading Information
placard)
1500 lbs (680 kg)1500 lbs (680 kg)
Step 2
Example 1Example 2
Number of people in the vehicle (driver and
occupants)
51
Distribution of the occupantsFront: 2
Rear: 3
Front: 1
Weight of occupantsOccupant 1: 150 lbs (68 kg)
Occupant 2: 180 lbs (82 kg)
Occupant 3: 160 lbs (73 kg)
Occupant 4: 140 lbs (63 kg)
Occupant 5: 120 lbs (54 kg)
Occupant 1: 200 lbs (91 kg)
Total weight of all occupants750 lbs (340 kg)200 lbs (91 kg)
Wheels and tires
423
Step 3
Example 1Example 2
Permissible load (maximum gross vehicle weight
rating from the Tire and Loading Information
placard minus the gross weight of all occupants)
1500 lbs (680 kg) Ò 750 lbs (340 kg) = 750 lbs
(340 kg)
1500 lbs (680 kg) Ò 200 lbs (91 kg) = 1300 lbs
(589 kg)
424
Wheels and tires
Tire labeling
Overview of tire labeling
1
Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standard
(
page 425)
2
DOT, Tire Identification Number
(
page 426)
3
Maximum tire load ( page 427)
4
Maximum tire pressure ( page 428)
5
Manufacturer
6
Characteristics of the tire ( page 428)
7
Tire size designation, load-bearing capacity,
speed rating and load index (
page 428)
8
Tire name
%
The data shown in the image is example
data.
Tire Quality Grading
In accordance with the US Department of Trans‐
portation's "Uniform Tire Quality Grading Stand‐
ards", tire manufacturers are required to grade
their tires on the basis of the following three per‐
formance factors:
1
Tread wear grade
2
Traction grade
3
Temperature grade
%
The data shown in the image is example
data.
%
The classification is not legally stipulated for
Canada, but it is generally stated.
Tread wear grade
The tread wear grade is a comparative rating
based on the wear rate of the tire when tested
under controlled conditions on a specified test
track of the US Department of Transportation.
For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one
Wheels and tires
425
and one-half times as well on the government
test track as a tire graded 100.
The relative performance of tires depends upon
the actual conditions of their use, however, and
may depart significantly from the norm due to
variations in driving habits, service practices and
differences in road characteristics and climate
conditions.
Traction grade
&
DANGER Risk of accident due to inade‐
quate traction
The traction grade assigned to this tire is
based on straight-ahead braking traction
tests, and does not include either accelera‐
tion, cornering, hydroplaning or peak traction
characteristics.
#
Always adapt your driving style and
drive at a speed to suit the prevailing
traffic and weather conditions.
*
NOTE Damage to the drivetrain from
wheelspin
#
Avoid wheelspin.
The traction grades from highest to lowest
are AA, A, B and C. Those grades represent the
tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as meas‐
ured under controlled conditions on specified
government test surfaces made of asphalt and
concrete.
Temperature grade
&
WARNING Risk of accident from tire
overheating and tire failure
The temperature grade for this tire is estab‐
lished for a tire that is properly inflated and
not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinfla‐
tion, or excessive loading, either separately
or in combination, can cause excessive heat
build-up and possible tire failure.
#
Observe the recommended tire pres‐
sures and regularly check the tire pres‐
sure of all tires including the spare
wheel.
#
Adjust the tire pressure as necessary.
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B
and C. They represent the tire's resistance to the
generation of heat and its ability to dissipate
heat when tested under controlled conditions on
a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sus‐
tained high temperature can cause the material
of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and
excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire
failure. Grade C corresponds to a level of per‐
formance which all passenger car tires must
meet under the requirements of the US Depart‐
ment of Transportation.
DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN)
US tire regulations stipulate that every tire man‐
ufacturer or retreader must imprint a TIN in or
on the side wall of each tire produced.
426
Wheels and tires
%
The data shown in the image is example
data.
The TIN is a unique identification number to
identify tires and comprises the following:
R
DOT (Department of Transportation): tire
symbol marks 1 indicating that the tire
complies with the requirements of the US
Department of Transportation.
R
Manufacturer identification code: manu‐
facturer identification code 2 contains
details of the tire manufacturer. New tires
have a code with two symbols. Retreaded
tires have a code with four symbols. Further
information on retreaded tires (
page 433).
R
Tire size: identifier 3 describes the tire
size.
R
Tire type code: tire type code 4 can be
used by the manufacturer as a code to
describe specific characteristics of the tire.
R
Manufacturing date: manufacturing date
5 provides information about the age of a
tire. The 1st and 2nd positions represent the
calendar week and the 3rd and 4th positions
state the year of manufacture (e.g. "3208"
represents the 32nd week of 2008).
Information on the maximum tire load
%
The data shown in the image is example
data.
Maximum tire load 1 is the maximum permissi‐
ble weight for which the tire is approved.
Do not overload the tires by exceeding the speci‐
fied load limit. The maximum permissible load
can be found on the vehicle's Tire and Loading
Information placard on the B-pillar on the driv‐
er's side (
page 420).
Specifications for maximum tire pressure
%
The data shown in the image is example
data.
Wheels and tires
427
Never exceed maximum tire pressure 1 speci‐
fied for the tire.
Information on tire characteristics
%
The data shown in the image is example
data.
This information describes the type of tire cord
and the number of layers in side wall 1 and
under tire tread 2.
Tire size designation, load-bearing capacity,
speed rating and load index
&
WARNING Risk of injury through exceed‐
ing the specified tire load rating or the
permissible speed rating
Exceeding the specified tire load rating or
the permissible speed rating may lead to tire
damage and to the tires bursting.
#
Therefore, only use tire types and sizes
approved for your vehicle model.
#
Observe the tire load rating and speed
rating required for your vehicle.
1
Preceding letter
2
Nominal tire width in millimeters
3
Aspect ratio in %
4
Tire code
5
Rim diameter
6
Load-bearing index
7
Speed rating
8
Load index
%
The data shown in the image is example
data.
Information about reading tire data can be
obtained from any qualified specialist workshop.
428
Wheels and tires
Preceding letter 1:
R
Without: passenger vehicle tires according to
European manufacturing standards.
R
"P": passenger vehicle tires according to US
manufacturing standards.
R
"LT": light truck tires according to US manu‐
facturing standards.
R
"T": compact emergency spare wheels with
high tire pressure that are only designed for
temporary use in an emergency.
Aspect ratio 3
:
Ratio between tire height and tire width in per‐
cent (tire height divided by tire width).
Tire code 4
(tire type):
R
"R" radial tire
R
"D": bias ply tire
R
"B": bias belted tires
R
"ZR": radial tire with a maximum speed above
149 mph (240 km/h) (optional)
Rim diameter 5
:
The diameter of the bead seat (not the diameter
of the rim flange). The rim diameter is specified
in inches (in).
Load-bearing index 6
:
Numerical code that specifies the maximum
load-bearing capacity of a tire (e.g. "91" corre
sponds to 1356 lbs (615 kg)).
The load-bearing capacity of the tire must be at
least half the permissible axle load of your vehi‐
cle. Do not overload the tires by exceeding the
specified load limit.
See also:
R
Maximum permissible load on the Tire and
Loading Information placard (
page 420)
R
Maximum tire load ( page 427)
R
Load index
Speed rating 7
:
Specifies the approved maximum speed of the
tire.
%
An electronic speed limiter prevents your
vehicle from exceeding a speed of 130 mph
(210 km/h).
Make sure that your tires have the required
speed rating. You can obtain information on the
required speed rating from an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
Summer tires
IndexSpeed rating
Qup to 100 mph (160 km/h)
Rup to 106 mph (170 km/h)
Sup to 112 mph (180 km/h)
Tup to 118 mph (190 km/h)
Hup to 130 mph (210 km/h)
Vup to 149 mph (240 km/h)
Wup to 168 mph (270 km/h)
Yup to 186 mph (300 km/h)
Wheels and tires
429
IndexSpeed rating
ZR...Y
1
up to 186 mph (300 km/h)
ZR...(..Y)
1
over 186 mph (300 km/h)
ZR
1
over 149 mph (240 km/h)
R
Specifying the speed rating as the "ZR" index
in tire code 4 is optional for tires up to
186 mph (300 km/h).
R
If your tire code 4 includes "ZR" and there
is no speed rating 7, find out what the max‐
imum speed is from the tire manufacturer.
R
If load-bearing index 6 and speed rating 7
are in brackets, the maximum speed rating of
your tire is above 186 mph (300 km/h). To
find out the maximum speed, ask the tire
manufacturer.
All-weather tires and winter tires
IndexSpeed rating
Q M+S
2
up to 100 mph (160 km/h)
T M+S
2
up to 118 mph (190 km/h)
H M+S
2
up to 130 mph (210 km/h)
V M+S
2
up to 149 mph (240 km/h)
Winter tires bear the i snowflake symbol
and fulfill the requirements of the Rubber Manu‐
facturers Association (RMA) and the Rubber
Association of Canada (RAC) regarding the tire
traction on snow.
Load index 8
:
R
No specification given: standard load (SL)
tire
R
"XL" or "Extra Load": extra load tire or rein‐
forced tire
R
"Light Load": light load tire
R
"C", "D", "E": a load range that depends on
the maximum load that the tire can carry at a
certain pressure
Definition of terms for tires and loading
Tire structure and characteristics: describes
the number of layers or the number of rubber-
coated belts in the tire contact surface and the
tire wall. These are made of steel, nylon, poly‐
ester and other materials.
Bar: metric unit for tire pressure.
14.5038 pounds per square inch (psi) and
100 kilopascal (kPa) is the equivalent of one bar.
DOT (Department of Transportation): DOT-
marked tires fulfill the requirements of the
US Department of Transportation.
Average weight of the vehicle occupants: the
number of vehicle occupants for which the vehi‐
cle is designed, multiplied by 150 lb (68 kg).
1
"ZR" stated in the tire code.
2
Or "M+S i" for winter tires
430
Wheels and tires
Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards: a
uniform standard to grade the quality of tires
with regard to tread quality, tire traction and
temperature characteristics. The quality grading
assessment is made by the manufacturer follow‐
ing specifications from the U.S. government. The
quality grade of a tire is imprinted on the side
wall of the tire.
Recommended tire pressure: the recommen‐
ded tire pressure is the tire pressure specified
for the tires mounted to the vehicle at the fac‐
tory.
The tire and information table contains the rec‐
ommended tire pressures for cold tires, the max‐
imum permissible load and the maximum per‐
missible vehicle speed.
The tire pressure table contains the recommen‐
ded tire pressures for cold tires under various
operating conditions, i.e. loading and/or speed
of the vehicle.
Increased vehicle weight due to optional
equipment: the combined weight of all standard
and optional equipment available for the vehicle,
regardless of whether it is actually installed on
the vehicle or not.
Rim: the part of the wheel on which the tire is
installed.
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating): the GAWR
is the maximum permissible axle load. The
actual load on an axle must never exceed the
gross axle weight rating. The gross
axle weight
rati
ng can be found on the vehicle identification
plate on the B‑pillar on the driver's side.
Speed rating: the speed rating is part of the tire
identification. It specifies the speed range for
which a tire is approved.
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight): the gross vehicle
weight comprises the weight of the vehicle
including fuel, tools, the spare wheel, accesso‐
ries installed, occupants, luggage and the trailer
drawbar noseweight, if applicable. The gross
vehicle weight must not exceed the gross vehicle
weight rating GVWR as specified on the vehicle
identification plate on the B‑pillar on the driver's
side.
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating): the
GVWR is the maximum permitted gross weight
of the fully laden vehicle (weight of the vehicle
including all accessories, occupants, fuel, lug‐
gage and the trailer drawbar noseweight if appli‐
cable). The gross vehicle weight rating is speci‐
fied on the vehicle identification plate on the
B‑pillar on the driver's side.
Maximum weight of the laden vehicle: the
maximum weight is the sum of the curb weight
of the vehicle, the weight of the accessories, the
maximum load and the weight of optional equip‐
ment installed at the factory.
Kilopascal (kPa): metric unit for tire pressure.
6.9 kPa corresponds to 1 psi. Another unit for
tire pressure is bar
. 100 ki
lopascal (kPa) equals
1 bar.
Load index: in addition to the load-bearing
index, the load index may also be imprinted on
the side wall of the tire. This specifies the load-
bearing capacity of the tire more precisely.
Curb weight: the weight of a vehicle with stand‐
ard equipment including the maximum capacity
of fuel, oil and coolant. It also includes the air
conditioning system and optional equipment if
Wheels and tires
431
these are installed on the vehicle, but does not
include passengers or luggage.
Maximum tire load: the maximum tire load is
the maximum permissible weight in kilograms or
lbs for which a tire is approved.
Maximum permissible tire pressure: maxi‐
mum permissible tire pressure for one tire.
Maximum load on one tire: maximum load on
one tire. This is calculated by dividing the maxi‐
mum axle load of one axle by two.
PSI (pounds per square inch): standard unit of
measurement for tire pressure.
Aspect ratio: ratio between tire height and tire
width in percent.
Tire pressure: pressure inside the tire applying
an outward force to every square inch of the tire.
The tire pressure is specified in pounds per
square inch (psi), in kilopascals (kPa) or in bar.
The tire pressure should only be corrected when
the tires are cold.
Cold tire pressure: the tires are cold when the
vehicle has been parked for at least 3 hours
without direct sunlight on the tires or the vehicle
has been driven for less than 1 mile (1.6 km).
Tire contact surface: the part of the tire that
comes into contact with the road.
Tire bead: the purpose of the tire bead is to
ensure that the tire sits securely on the wheel
rim. There are several wire cores in the tire bead
to
prevent the t
ire from changing length on the
wheel rim.
Side wall: the part of the tire between the tread
and the tire bead.
Weight of optional equipment: the combined
weight of the optional equipment weighing more
than the replaced standard parts and more than
5 lbs (2.3 kg). This optional equipment, such as
high-performance brakes, level control system, a
roof luggage rack or high-performance batteries,
is not included in the curb weight and the weight
of the accessories.
TIN (Tire Identification Number): a unique
identification number which can be used by a
tire manufacturer to identify tires, for example,
in a product recall, and thus identify the pur‐
chasers. The TIN is made up of the manufactur‐
er's identity code, tire size, tire type code and
the manufacturing date.
Load-bearing index: the load-bearing index is a
code that contains the maximum load-bearing
capacity of a tire.
Traction: traction is the grip resulting from fric‐
tion between the tires and the road surface.
Wear indicator: narrow bars (tread wear bars)
that are distributed over the tire contact surface.
If the tire tread is level with the bars, the wear
limit of 1/16 in (1.6 mm) has been reached.
Distribution of vehicle occupants: distribution
of vehicle occupants
over design
ated seat posi‐
tions in a vehicle.
Maximum permissible payload weight: nomi‐
nal load and luggage load plus 150 lb (68 kg)
multiplied by the number of seats in the vehicle.
432
Wheels and tires
Changing a wheel
Notes on selecting, mounting and replacing
tires
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: be sure to observe
the notes in the Supplement. Otherwise, you
may not recognize dangers.
You can ask for information regarding permitted
wheel/tire combinations at an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to incor‐
rect dimensions of wheels and tires
If wheels and tires of the wrong size are
installed, the wheel brakes or wheel suspen‐
sion components may be damaged.
#
Always replace wheels and tires with
those that fulfill the specifications of
the original part.
When replacing wheels, make sure to fit the
correct:
R
Designation
R
Model
When replacing tires, make sure to install the
correct:
R
Designation
R
Manufacturer
R
Model
&
WARNING Risk of injury through exceed‐
ing the specified tire load rating or the
permissible speed rating
Exceeding the specified tire load rating or
the permissible speed rating may lead to tire
damage and to the tires bursting.
#
Therefore, only use tire types and sizes
approved for your vehicle model.
#
Observe the tire load rating and speed
rating required for your vehicle.
*
NOTE Damage to vehicle and tires due to
non-approved tire types and sizes
For safety reasons, only use wheels, tires
and accessories which have been approved
for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz.
These tires have been specially adapted for
use with the control systems, e.g. ABS or
ESP
®
, and are marked as follows:
R
MO = Mercedes-Benz Original
R
MOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended
(run-flat tires only for certain wheels)
R
MO1 = Mercedes-Benz Original (only cer‐
tain AMG tires)
Certain characteristics, e.g. handling, vehicle
noise emissions or fuel consumption, may
otherwise be adversely affected. In addition,
when driving with a load, tire dimension var‐
iations could cause the tires to come into
contact with the body and axle components.
This could result in damage to the tires or the
vehicle.
Wheels and tires
433
Only use tires, wheels or accessories tested
and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
*
NOTE Risk to driving safety from retrea‐
ded tires
Retreaded tires are neither tested nor recom‐
mended by Mercedes-Benz, since previous
damage cannot always be detected on
retreaded tires.
For this reason driving safety cannot be guar
anteed.
#
Do not use used tires if you have no
information about their previous usage.
*
NOTE Possible damage to wheels or tires
when driving over obstacles
Large wheels have a lower tire section width.
The lower the tire section width, the greater
is the risk of damage to wheels or tires when
driving over obstacles.
#
Avoid obstacles or drive particularly
carefully.
*
NOTE Damage to electronic component
parts from the use of tire-mounting tools
Vehicles with a tire pressure monitoring
system: Electronic component parts are
located in the wheel. Tire-mounting tools
should not be used in the area of the valve.
This could otherwise damage the electronic
component parts.
#
Have the tires changed at a qualified
specialist workshop only.
*
NOTE Damage to summer tires at low
ambient temperatures
Using summer tires at very low ambient tem‐
peratures can cause cracks to form, thereby
damaging the tires permanently.
#
At temperatures below 45 °F (7 °C) use
M+S tires.
Accessory parts that are not approved for your
vehicle by Mercedes-Benz or are not being used
correctly can impair the operating safety.
Before purchasing and using non-approved
accessories, visit a qualified specialist workshop
and inquire about:
R
Suitability
R
Legal stipulations
R
Factory recommendations
&
WARNING Risk of accident with high
performance tires
The special tire tread in combination with the
optimized tire compound means that the risk
of skidding or hydroplaning on wet roads is
increased.
In addition, the tire grip is greatly reduced at
a low outside temperature and tire running
temperature.
#
Switch on the ESP
®
and adapt your
driving style accordingly.
#
Use M+S tire at outside temperatures
of less than 10 °C (50 °F).
434
Wheels and tires
Observe the following when selecting, mounting
and replacing tires:
R
Only use tires and wheels of the same type
(summer tires, winter tires, MOExtended
tires) and the same make.
R
Only mount wheels of the same size on one
axle (left and right).
It is only permissible to install a different
wheel size in the event of a flat tire in order
to drive to the specialist workshop.
R
Only mount tires of the correct size onto the
wheels.
R
Vehicles with a tire pressure monitoring
system: All mounted wheels must be equip‐
ped with functioning sensors for the tire
pressure monitoring system.
R
At temperatures below 45 °F (7 °C), use win‐
ter tires or all-season tire marked M+S for all
wheels.
Winter tires bearing the i snowflake sym‐
bol in addition to the M+S marking provide
the best possible grip in wintry road condi‐
tions.
R
For M+S tires, only use tires with the same
tread.
R
Observe the maximum permissible speed for
the M+S tire mounted.
If this is below the vehicle's maximum speed,
this must be indicated in an appropriate label
in the driver's field of vision.
R
Break in new tires at moderate speeds for
the first 60 miles (100 km).
R
Replace the tires after six years at the latest,
regardless of wear.
R
When replacing with tires that do not fea‐
ture run-flat characteristics: vehicles with
MOExtended tires are not equipped with a
TIREFIT kit at the factory. Equip the vehicle
with a TIREFIT kit after replacing with tires
that do not feature run-flat characteristics,
e.g. winter tires.
For more information on wheels and tires, con‐
tact a qualified specialist workshop.
Be sure to also observe the following further
related subjects:
R
Notes on tire pressure ( page 414)
R
Tire and Loading Information placard
(
page 420)
R
Tire size designation, load-bearing capacity,
speed rating and load index (
page 428)
R
Tire pressure table ( page 416)
Notes on interchanging wheels
&
WARNING Risk of injury through differ‐
ent wheel sizes
Interchanging the front and rear wheels if the
wheels or tires have different dimensions
may severely impair the driving characteris‐
tics.
The wheel brakes or wheel suspension com‐
ponents may also be damaged.
#
Rotate front and rear wheels only if the
wheels and tires are of the same dimen‐
sions.
Wheels and tires
435
The wear patterns on the front and rear wheels
differ:
R
Front wheels wear more on the shoulder of
the tire.
R
Rear wheels wear more in the center of the
tire.
On vehicles that have the same size front and
rear wheels, interchange the wheels according
to the intervals in the tire manufacturer's war‐
ranty book in your vehicle documents. If this is
not available, interchange the tires every
3000 to 6000 miles (5000 to 10000 km),
depending on the wear. Ensure that the direction
of rotation is maintained.
It is imperative to observe the instructions and
safety notes on "Wheel change" when doing so.
Notes on storing wheels
R
After removing wheels, store them in a cool,
dry and preferably dark place.
R
Protect the tires from contact with oil, grease
or fuel.
Overview of the tire-change tool kit
Apart from some country-specific variants, vehi‐
cles are not equipped with a tire-change tool kit.
For more information on which tire-changing
tools are required and approved for performing a
wheel change on your vehicle, consult a qualified
specialist workshop.
Required tire-change tools may include, for
example:
R
Jack
R
chock
R
Lug wrench
R
Centering pin
The tire-change tool kit is located under the
trunk floor.
1
Ratchet
2
Centering pin
3
Jacking support
4
Jack
5
Lug wrench
6
Folding chock
436
Wheels and tires
Setting up the folding wheel chock
Preparing the vehicle for a wheel change
Requirements:
R
The required tire-change tool kit is available.
If your vehicle is not equipped with the tire-
change tool kit, consult a qualified specialist
workshop to find out about suitable tools.
R
The vehicle is not on a slope.
R
The vehicle is on solid, non-slippery and level
ground.
#
Apply the electric parking brake manually.
#
Move the front wheels to the straight-ahead
position.
#
Shift the transmission to position j.
#
Vehicles with AIR BODY CONTROL or
MAGIC BODY CONTROL: Set the normal
vehicle level.
#
Switch off the engine.
#
Make sure that the engine cannot be started.
#
Place chocks or other suitable items under
the front and rear of the wheel that is diago‐
nally opposite the wheel you wish to change.
#
Remove the hub caps if necessary
(
page 437).
#
Raise the vehicle ( page 438).
Removing and mounting hub caps
Requirement:
R
The vehicle is prepared for a wheel change
(
page 437).
Plastic hub cap
#
To remove: turn the center cover of the hub
cap counter-clockwise and remove the hub
cap.
#
To mount: make sure that the center cover
of the hub cap is turned counter-clockwise.
#
Position the hub cap and turn the center
cover clockwise until the hub cap engages
physically and audibly.
Wheels and tires
437
Aluminum hub cap
#
To remove: position socket 2 on hub cap
1.
%
The socket can be found in the tire-change
tool kit.
#
Position wheel wrench 3 on socket 2.
#
Using wheel wrench 3, turn hub cap 1
counter-clockwise and remove it.
#
To mount: position hub cap 1 and turn
until it is completely flush with the wheel.
#
Position socket 2 on hub cap 1.
#
Attach wheel wrench 3 to socket 2 and
tighten the hub cap clockwise.
Specified tightening torque: 18 lb-ft
(25 Nm).
#
Raising the vehicle ( page 438).
Raising the vehicle when changing a wheel
Requirements:
R
There are no persons in the vehicle.
R
The vehicle is prepared for a wheel change
(
page 437).
R
The hub caps have been removed
(
page 437).
Important notes on using the jack:
R
Use only the vehicle-specific jack that has
been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz
to raise the vehicle.
R
The jack is only designed for raising and
holding the vehicle for a short time while a
wheel is being changed and not for mainte‐
nance work under the vehicle.
R
The jack must be placed on a firm, flat and
non-slip surface. If necessary, use a large,
load-bearing, non-slip underlay.
R
The base of the jack must be positioned ver‐
tically under the jack support point.
Rules of conduct when the vehicle is raised:
R
Never place your hands or feet under the
vehicle.
R
Do not lie under the vehicle.
R
Do not start the engine and do not release
the electric parking brake.
R
Do not open or close any doors or the trunk
lid.
438
Wheels and tires
#
Using the wheel wrench, loosen the wheel
bolts on the wheel you wish to change by
about one full turn. Do not unscrew the
screws completely.
Position of jack support points
&
WARNING Risk of injury from incorrect
positioning of the jack
If you do not position the jack correctly at
the appropriate jacking point of the vehicle,
the jack could tip with the vehicle raised.
#
Only position the jack at the appropri‐
ate jacking point of the vehicle. The
base of the jack must be positioned ver‐
tically under the jacking point of the
vehicle.
*
NOTE Vehicle damage from the jack
If you do not position the jack correctly at
the appropriate jack support point of the
vehicle, the jack could tip over with the vehi‐
cle raised.
#
The jack is designed exclusively for
jacking up the vehicle at the jack sup‐
port points.
#
Take the box wrench out of the tire-change
tool kit and place it on the hexagon nut of
the jack so that the letters AUF are visible.
Wheels and tires
439
#
Position jack 2 at jack support point 1.
#
Turn box wrench 3 clockwise until jack 2
sits completely on jack support point 1 and
the base of the jack lies evenly on the
ground.
#
Continue to turn box wrench 3 until the tire
is raised a maximum of 1.2 in (3 cm) off the
ground.
#
Loosen and remove the wheel ( page 440).
Removing a wheel
Requirement:
R
The vehicle is raised ( page 438).
When changing a wheel, avoid applying any force
to the brake discs, since this could impair the
level of comfort when braking.
*
NOTE Damage to threading from dirt on
wheel bolts
#
Do not place wheel bolts in sand or on
a dirty surface.
#
Unscrew the uppermost wheel bolt com‐
pletely.
#
Screw centering pin 1 instead of the wheel
bolt into the threading.
#
Unscrew the remaining wheel bolts fully.
#
Remove the wheel.
#
Mount the new wheel ( page 440).
Mounting a new wheel
Requirement:
R
The wheel is removed ( page 440).
440
Wheels and tires
&
WARNING Risk of accident from losing a
wheel
Oiled, greased or damaged wheel bolt/wheel
nut threads or wheel hub/wheel mounting
bolt threads can cause the wheel bolts/
wheel nuts to come loose.
As a result, you could lose a wheel while driv‐
ing.
#
Never oil or grease the threads.
#
In the event of damage to the threads,
contact a qualified specialist workshop
immediately.
#
Have the damaged wheel bolts or dam‐
aged hub threads replaced.
#
Do not continue driving.
#
Observe the information on the choice of
tires (
page 433).
For tires with a specified direction of rotation, an
arrow on the side wall of the tire indicates the
correct direction of rotation. Observe the direc‐
tion of rotation when installing.
#
Slide the wheel to be mounted onto the cen‐
tering pin and push it on.
&
WARNING Risk of injury from tightening
wheel bolts and nuts
If you tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is raised, the jack could tip.
#
Only tighten wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is on the ground.
#
For safety reasons, only use wheel bolts
which have been approved for Mercedes-
Benz and the wheel in question.
*
NOTE Damage to paintwork of the wheel
rim when screwing on the first wheel bolt
If the wheel has too much play when screw
ing in the first wheel bolt, the wheel rim paint
can be damaged.
#
Press the wheel firmly against the
wheel hub when screwing on the first
wheel bolt.
#
Tighten the wheel bolts until they are finger-
tight.
#
Unscrew the centering pin.
#
Tighten the last wheel bolt until it is finger-
tight.
#
Lower the vehicle ( page 441).
Lowering the vehicle after a wheel change
Requirements:
R
The new wheel has been mounted
(
page 440).
#
Place the ratchet wrench onto the hexagon
nut of the jack so that the letters "AB" are
visible.
#
To lower the vehicle: turn the ratchet
wrench of the jack counter-clockwise.
Wheels and tires
441
#
Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a crosswise
pattern in the sequence indicated (1 to 5).
Specified tightening torque: 111 lb-ft
(150 Nm).
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to incor‐
rect tightening torque
The wheels could come loose if the wheel
bolts or wheel nuts are not tightened to the
prescribed tightening torque.
#
Have the tightening torque checked
immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop after changing a wheel.
#
Check the tire pressure of the newly moun‐
ted wheel and adjust accordingly.
#
Vehicles with a tire pressure monitoring
system: Restart the tire pressure monitoring
system (
page 420).
Make sure to observe the following further rela‐
ted subject:
R
Notes on tire pressure ( page 414)
442
Wheels and tires
Notes on technical data
Plug-in hybrid: observe the notes in the Supple‐
ment. Otherwise, you may not recognize dan‐
gers.
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. Otherwise, you may not recog‐
nize dangers.
The data stated only applies to vehicles with
standard equipment. You can obtain further
information from an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center.
Vehicle electronics
Two-way radios
Notes on installing two-way radios
&
WARNING Risk of accident due to
improper work on two-way radios
The electromagnetic radiation from two-way
radios can interfere with the on-board elec‐
tronics if RF transmitters are manipulated or
retrofitted incorrectly.
This could jeopardize the operating safety of
the vehicle.
#
You should have all work on electrical
and electronic components carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
&
WARNING Risk of accident from incor‐
rect operation of two-way radios
If you operate two-way radios incorrectly in
the vehicle, the electromagnetic radiation
could interfere with the on-board electronics,
e.g.:
R
if the two-way radio is not connected to
an exterior antenna
R
if the exterior antenna is not correctly
mounted or is not of low reflection
This could jeopardies the operating safety of
the vehicle.
#
Have the low-reflection exterior
antenna installed at a qualified special‐
ist workshop.
#
When operating two-way radios in the
vehicle, always connect them to the
low-reflection exterior antenna.
*
NOTE Invalidation of the operating per‐
mit due to failure to comply with the
instructions for installation and use
The operating permit may be invalidated if
the instructions for installation and use of
two-way radios are not observed.
#
Only use approved frequency bands.
#
Observe the maximum permissible out‐
put power in these frequency bands.
#
Only use approved antenna positions.
Technical data
443
1
Front roof area
2
Rear roof area
3
Rear fender
4
Trunk lid
On vehicles with a panoramic sliding sunroof,
installing an antenna to the front or rear roof
area is not permitted.
On the rear fenders, it is recommended that you
position the antenna on the side of the vehicle
closest to the center of the road.
Use Technical Specification ISO/TS 21609 (Road
Vehicles "EMC guidelines for installation of
aftermarket radio frequency transmitting equip‐
ment") when retrofitting two-way radios. Comply
with the legal requirements for detachable parts.
If your vehicle has installations for two-way radio
equipment, use the power supply or antenna
connections intended for use with the basic wir‐
ing. Observe the manufacturer's supplements
when installing.
Two-way radio transmission output
The maximum transmission output (PEAK) at the
base of the antenna must not exceed the values
in the following table:
Frequency band and maximum transmission
output
Frequency band Maximum transmis‐
sion output
Short wave
3 - 54 MHz
100 W
4 m waveband
74 - 78 MHz
30 W
2 m waveband
144 - 174 MHz
50 W
Trunked radio sys‐
tem/Tetra
380 - 460 MHz
10 W
70 cm waveband
400 - 460 MHz
35 W
Mobile communica‐
tions (2G/3G/4G)
10 W
444
Technical data
The following can be used in the vehicle without
restrictions:
R
RF transmitters with a maximum transmis‐
sion output of up to 100 mW
R
RF transmitters with transmitter frequencies
in the 380 - 410 MHz frequency band and a
maximum transmission output of up to 2 W
(trunked radio system/Tetra)
R
Mobile phones (2G/3G/4G)
There are no restrictions when positioning the
antenna on the outside of the vehicle for some
frequency bands.
This applies to the following frequency bands:
R
Trunked radio system/Tetra
R
70 cm waveband
R
2G/3G/4G
Vehicle identification plate, VIN and engine
number overview
Vehicle identification plate
Vehicle identification plate (USA only)
1
Permissible gross mass
2
Permissible front axle load
3
Permissible rear axle load
4
Paint code
5
VIN (vehicle identification number)
Technical data
445
Vehicle identification plate (Canada only)
1
Permissible gross mass
2
Permissible front axle load
3
Permissible rear axle load
4
Paint code
5
VIN (vehicle identification number)
The maximum permissible gross vehicle weight
is made up of the vehicle weight, all vehicle
occupants, the fuel and the load. The maximum
permissible axle load is the maximum weight
that can be carried by one axle (front or rear
axle).
Never exceed the maximum permissible gross
vehicle weight or the maximum permissible axle
load for the front or rear axle.
VIN in front of the front seat
1
VIN (vehicle identification number)
Additional plates
1
Plate with information about emissions test
ing, including confirmation of emissions
guidelines at the U.S. federal level as well as
for California
2
VIN (vehicle identification number)
3
Engine number stamped into the crankcase
446
Technical data
Operating fluids
Notes on operating fluids
Mercedes-AMG vehicles: observe the notes in
the Supplement. Otherwise, you may not recog‐
nize dangers.
&
WARNING Risk of injury from operating
fluids harmful to your health
Operating fluids may be poisonous and harm‐
ful to your health.
#
Observe the text on the original con‐
tainers when using, storing or disposing
of operating fluids.
#
Always store operating fluids sealed in
their original containers.
#
Always keep children away from operat‐
ing fluids.
&
WARNING Risk of fire and explosion
caused by fuel
Fuels are highly inflammable.
#
You must avoid fire, open flames, creat‐
ing sparks and smoking.
#
Before refueling, switch off the engine
and, if installed in your vehicle, the sta‐
tionary heater.
&
WARNING Risk of injury from fuel
Fuels are poisonous and harmful to your
health
#
Do not swallow fuel or let it come into
contact with skin, eyes or clothing.
#
Do not inhale fuel vapors.
#
Keep children away from fuel.
If you or other people come into contact with
fuel, observe the following:
#
Immediately rinse fuel off your skin with
soap and water.
#
If fuel comes into contact with your
eyes, immediately rinse them thor‐
oughly with clean water. Seek medical
attention immediately.
#
If you swallow fuel, seek medical atten‐
tion immediately. Do not induce vomit‐
ing.
#
Change immediately out of clothing that
has come into contact with fuel.
+
ENVIRONMENTAL NOTE Environmental
pollution caused by environmentally irre
sponsible disposal
#
Dispose of operating fluids in an envi‐
ronmentally responsible manner.
Operating fluids include the following:
R
Fuels
R
Lubricants
R
Coolant
R
Brake fluid
R
Windshield washer fluid
R
Climate control system refrigerant
Only use products recommended by Mercedes-
Benz.
Technical data
447
You can identify operating fluids approved by
Mercedes-Benz by the following inscriptions on
the container:
R
MB-Freigabe (e.g. MB-Freigabe 229.51)
R
MB-Approval (e.g. MB-Approval 229.51)
Further information on approved operating flu‐
ids:
R
In the Mercedes-Benz Specifications for
Operating Fluids at http://bevo.mercedes-
benz.com (by entering the designation)
R
At a qualified specialist workshop
Fuel
Information on fuel grades for vehicles with
a gasoline engine
Observe the notes on operating fluids
(
page 447).
*
NOTE Damage caused by the wrong fuel
Even small amounts of the wrong fuel could
result in damage to the fuel system, the
engine and the emission control system.
#
Only refuel with low-sulfur premium
grade fuel.
This fuel may contain up to 10 % ethanol.
Your vehicle is suitable for use with E10 fuel.
Do not refuel using:
R
Diesel
R
E15, E85, E100
R
Gasoline containing methanol (M15, M30,
M85, M100)
R
Gasoline with additives containing metal
If you accidentally refuel with the wrong fuel:
#
Do not switch the ignition on.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the available fuel is not sufficiently low in sul‐
fur, this can produce unpleasant odors.
Only refuel with fuel, that has at least the octane
number specified in the information table in the
fuel filler flap (
page 177).
If you want maximum engine output: only
refuel with unleaded premium grade gasoline
with an octane number of at least 91 AKI/
95 RON.
As a temporary measure, if the recommended
fuel is not available, you may also use unleaded
regular gasoline with an octane number of at
least 87 AKI/91 RON.
*
NOTE Premature wear through unleaded
regular gasoline
Unleaded regular gasoline can cause the
engine to wear more quickly and impair lon‐
gevity and performance.
If unleaded premium grade gasoline is
unavailable and you have to refuel using
unleaded regular gasoline with 87 AKI/
91 RON:
#
Only fill the fuel tank to half full with
unleaded regular gasoline and top up as
soon as possible with unleaded pre‐
mium grade gasoline.
#
Do not drive at the maximum speed.
#
Avoid sudden acceleration and engine
speeds over 3000 rpm.
448
Technical data
This may reduce engine performance and
increase fuel consumption. Never refuel using
gasoline with a lower octane number.
Further information on fuel can be found:
R
At a gas station
R
At a qualified specialist workshop
R
USA only: Under http://www.mbusa.com
Information on additives in gasoline
Observe the notes on operating fluids
(
page 447).
*
NOTE Damage caused by non-approved
additives
Even small amounts of the wrong additive
may lead to malfunctions occurring.
#
Only add cleaning additives recommen‐
ded by Mercedes-Benz to the fuel.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use fuel
brands that have additives.
The fuel grade available in some countries may
not be sufficient. Residue could build up in the
fuel injection system as a result. In this case, in
consultation with an authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center, the fuel may be mixed with the cleaning
additive recommended by Mercedes-Benz. Be
sure to observe the notes and mixing ratios
specified on the container.
Tank capacity and reserve fuel level
The total capacity of the fuel tank may vary,
depending on the vehicle equipment.
Model Total capacity
All models 21.1 gal (80.0 l)
Model Of which reserve
All models2.1 gal (8.0 l)
Engine oil
Notes on engine oil
Observe the notes on operating fluids
(
page 447).
*
NOTE Engine damage caused by an
incorrect oil filter, incorrect oil or addi‐
tives
#
Do not use engine oils or oil filters other
than those which meet the specifica‐
tions necessary for the prescribed
service intervals.
#
Do not alter the engine oil or oil filter in
order to achieve longer change intervals
than prescribed.
#
Do not use additives.
#
Have the engine oil changed after the
prescribed intervals.
Technical data
449
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have the
oil change carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Further information on engine oils and oil filters:
R
In the Mercedes-Benz Specifications for
operating fluids at http://bevo.mercedes-
benz.com (by entering the designation)
R
At a qualified specialist workshop
Quality and filling capacity of engine oil
MB-Freigabe or MB-Approval
Sedan MB-Freigabe or MB-
Approval
S 450 4MATIC 229.5, 229.6
S 560 4MATIC 229.52, 229.61
Long wheelbase
vehicles
MB-Freigabe or MB-
Approval
S 450 4MATIC
S 450
229.5, 229.6
S 600 229.5
All other models 229.52, 229.61
Mercedes‑MaybachMB-Freigabe or MB-
Approval
S 650 Mercedes-May‐
bach
229.5
S 560 4MATIC
Mercedes-Maybach
229.52, 229.61
The following values refer to an oil change,
including the oil filter.
Capacity
SedanCapacity
S 450 4MATIC 6.9 US qt (6.5 l)
S 560 4MATIC 9.5 US qt (9.0 l)
Long wheelbase
vehicles
Capacity
S 450 4MATIC
S 450
6.9 US qt (6.5 l)
S 600 11.1 US qt (10.5 l)
All other models 9.5 US qt (9.0 l)
Mercedes‑MaybachCapacity
S 650 Mercedes-May‐
bach
11.1 US qt (10.5 l)
S 560 4MATIC
Mercedes-Maybach
9.5 US qt (9.0 l)
450
Technical data
Notes on brake fluid
Observe the notes on operating fluids
(
page 447).
&
WARNING Risk of an accident due to
vapor pockets forming in the brake sys‐
tem
The brake fluid constantly absorbs moisture
from the air. This lowers the boiling point of
the brake fluid. If the boiling point is too low,
vapor pockets may form in the brake system
when the brakes are applied hard.
This causes the braking effect to be
impaired.
#
Have the brake fluid renewed at the
specified intervals.
Have the brake fluid regularly changed at a quali‐
fied specialist workshop.
Only use brake fluid approved by Mercedes-Benz
according to MB-Freigabe or MB-Approval 331.0.
Further information on brake fluid:
R
In the Mercedes-Benz Specifications for
Operating Fluids at http://bevo.mercedes-
benz.com
R
At a qualified specialist workshop
Coolant
Notes on coolant
Observe the notes on operating fluids
(
page 447).
&
WARNING Risk of fire and injury from
antifreeze
If antifreeze comes into contact with hot
component parts in the engine compart‐
ment, it may ignite.
#
Allow the engine to cool down before
adding antifreeze.
#
Make sure that no antifreeze spills out
next to the filler opening.
#
Thoroughly clean off any antifreeze
from component parts before starting
the vehicle.
*
NOTE Damage caused by incorrect cool‐
ant
#
Only add coolant that has been pre‐
mixed with the required antifreeze pro‐
tection.
Further information on coolant:
R
In the Mercedes-Benz Specifications for
Operating Fluids 310.1, e.g. online at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
R
At a qualified specialist workshop.
*
NOTE Overheating at high outside tem‐
peratures
If an inappropriate coolant is used, the
engine cooling system is not sufficiently pro‐
tected against overheating and corrosion at
high outside temperatures.
Technical data
451
#
Always use coolant approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
#
Observe the instructions in the
Mercedes-Benz Specifications for Oper‐
ating Fluids 310.1.
Have the coolant regularly changed at a qualified
specialist workshop.
The proportion of corrosion inhibitor/ antifreeze
concentrate in the engine cooling system should
be:
R
A minimum of 50% (antifreeze protection
down to approximately -35 °F (-37 °C)).
R
A maximum of 55% (antifreeze protection
down to -49 °F (-45 °C)).
Coolant filling capacity
SedanCapacity
S 450 4MATIC 13.9 US qt (13.2 l)
S 560 4MATIC 15.0 US qt (14.2 l)
Long wheelbase
vehicles
Capacity
S 450 4MATIC
S 450
13.9 US qt (13.2 l)
S 600 16.9 US qt (16.0 l)
All other models 15.0 US qt (14.2 l)
Mercedes‑MaybachCapacity
S 650 Mercedes-May‐
bach
16.9 US qt (16.0 l)
S 560 4MATIC
Mercedes-Maybach
15.0 US qt (14.2 l)
Notes on windshield washer fluid
Observe the notes on operating fluids
(
page 447).
&
WARNING Risk of fire and injury from
windshield washer concentrate
Windshield washer concentrate is highly
flammable. It could ignite if it comes into
contact with hot engine component parts or
the exhaust system.
#
Make sure that no windshield washer
concentrate spills out next to the filler
opening.
*
NOTE Blocked spray nozzles caused by
mixing windshield washer fluids
#
Do not mix MB SummerFit and MB Win‐
terFit with other windshield washer flu‐
ids.
Do not use distilled or de-ionized water as the fill
level sensor may be triggered erroneously.
Recommended windshield washer fluid:
R
Above freezing point: e.g. MB SummerFit
R
Below freezing point: e.g. MB WinterFit
452
Technical data
For the correct mixing ratio refer to the informa‐
tion on the antifreeze container.
Mix the washer fluid with the windshield washer
fluid all year round.
Refrigerant
Notes on refrigerants
Observe the notes on operating fluids
(
page 447).
*
NOTE Damage due to incorrect refriger‐
ant
If a non-approved refrigerant is used, the cli‐
mate control system may be damaged.
#
Only use the refrigerant R‑134a
*
NOTE Damage to the climate control
system due to incorrect refrigerant com‐
pressor oil
#
Only use refrigerant compressor oil that
has been approved by Mercedes-Benz.
#
Do not mix the approved refrigerant
compressor oil with a different refriger‐
ant compressor oil.
Work on the climate control system may only be
carried out by a qualified specialist workshop. All
applicable regulations, as well as SAE standard
J639, must be adhered to.
1
Warning symbols
2
Refrigerant filling capacity
3
Applicable standards
4
PAG oil part number
5
Refrigerant type
Warning symbols 1 advise you about:
R
possible dangers
R
having service work carried out at a qualified
specialist workshop
Refrigerant filling capacity and PAG oil
Sedan, vehicles
with a long wheel‐
base
Refrigerant
All models23.3 ± 0.4 oz
(660 ± 10 g)
Mercedes‑MaybachRefrigerant
All models27. 2 ± 0.4 oz
(770 ± 10 g)
Sedan PAG oil
All models3.9 ± 0.4 oz
(110 ± 10 g)
Technical data
453
Long wheelbase
vehicles
PAG oil
S 600 4.2 ± 0.4 oz
(120 ± 10 g)
All other models 3.9 ± 0.4 oz
(110 ± 10 g)
Mercedes‑MaybachPAG oil
All models 4.2 ± 0.4 oz
(120 ± 10 g)
Vehicle data
Vehicle dimensions
The heights specified may vary as a result of the:
R
Tires
R
Load
R
Condition of the suspension
R
Optional equipment
Opening height
Sedan
1
Opening
height
S 450 4MATIC 71.0 in
(1803 mm)
S 560 4MATIC 71.1 in
(1806 mm)
Long wheelbase vehicles
1
Opening
height
S 450 4MATIC
S 450
70.9 in
(1803 mm)
All other models 71.1 in
(1806 mm)
Mercedes‑Maybach
1
Opening
height
All models 71.1 in
(1806 mm)
Vehicle dimensions
Sedan
Vehicle length201.8 in
(5125 mm)
Vehicle width including exte
rior mirrors
83.9 in
(2130 mm)
454
Technical data
Sedan
Vehicle width without exterior
mirrors
74.8 in
(1899 mm)
Wheelbase 119.5 in
(3035 mm)
Long wheelbase vehicles
Vehicle length206.9 in
(5255 mm)
Vehicle width including exte
rior mirrors
83.9 in
(2130 mm)
Vehicle width without exterior
mirrors
74.8 in
(1899 mm)
Wheelbase 124.6 in
(3165 mm)
Mercedes‑Maybach
Vehicle length215 in
(5462 mm)
Vehicle width including exte
rior mirrors
83.9 in
(2130 mm)
Vehicle width without exterior
mirrors
74.8 in
(1899 mm)
Wheelbase 132.5 in
(3365 mm)
Vehicle height
Sedan
S 450 4MATIC 58.9 in (1496 mm)
S 560 4MATIC 59.0 in (1499 mm)
Long wheelbase
vehicles
S 450 4MATIC
S 450
58.8 in (1494 mm)
All other models 58.9 in (1497 mm)
Mercedes‑Maybach
All models 59 in (1498 mm)
Weights and loads
Please note that for the specified vehicle data:
R
Items of optional equipment increase the
curb weight and reduce the maximum pay‐
load.
Technical data
455
Roof load
All models (sedan)
Maximum roof load 220 lb (100 kg)
All other models
(vehicles with a
long wheelbase)
Maximum roof load 220 lb (100 kg)
456
Technical data
Display messages
Introduction
Notes on display messages
Display messages appear in the multifunction
display.
Display messages with graphic symbols are sim‐
plified in the Operator's Manual and may differ
from the symbols in the multifunction display.
The multifunction display shows high-priority dis‐
play messages in red. Certain display messages
are accompanied by a warning tone.
Please respond in accordance with the display
messages and follow the additional notes in this
Operator's Manual.
For some display messages, a symbol is also
shown:
R
¤ Further information
R
O Hide display message
You can select the desired symbol by swiping
left or right on the left-hand side of Touch Con‐
trol. Press the ¤ symbol to show further
information. Press the O symbol to hide the
display message.
You can hide low-priority display messages by
pressing the % button or the left-hand side of
Touch Control. The display messages are then
stored in the message memory.
Rectify the cause of a display message as
quickly as possible.
High-priority display messages cannot be hid‐
den. The multifunction display shows these dis‐
play messages continuously until the cause for
the message has been rectified.
Calling up stored display messages
On-board computer:
,

.

If there are no display messages,  
appears in the multifunction display.
#
Scroll through the display messages by swip‐
ing upwards or downwards on Touch Control
on the left-hand side of the steering wheel.
#
To exit the message memory: press the
% button.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
457
Safety systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
!
÷
  

*
ABS and ESP
®
are malfunctioning.
Other driving systems and driving safety systems may also malfunction.
&
WARNING Risk of skidding if ABS and ESP
®
are malfunctioning
If ABS and ESP
®
are malfunctioning, the wheels could lock when braking and ESP
®
cannot carry out vehicle
stabilization.
The steering capability and braking characteristics are thus severely impaired. The braking distance in an emer‐
gency braking situation can increase. In addition, other driving safety systems are switched off.
#
Drive on carefully.
#
Have ABS and ESP
®
checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Drive on carefully.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
458
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
!
÷
  
 
*
ABS and ESP
®
are temporarily unavailable.
Other driving systems and driving safety systems may also malfunction.
&
WARNING Risk of skidding if ABS and ESP
®
are malfunctioning
If ABS and ESP
®
are malfunctioning, the wheels could lock when braking and ESP
®
cannot carry out vehicle
stabilization.
The steering capability and braking characteristics are thus severely impaired. The braking distance in an emer‐
gency braking situation can increase. In addition, other driving safety systems are switched off.
#
Drive on carefully.
#
Have ABS and ESP
®
checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 19 mph
(30 km/h).
#
If the display message does not disappear, consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately. Drive carefully.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
459
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
÷
  

*
ESP
®
is malfunctioning.
Other driving systems and driving safety systems may also malfunction.
The brake system continues to operate normally. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
&
WARNING Risk of skidding if ESP
®
is malfunctioning
If ESP
®
is malfunctioning, ESP
®
cannot carry out vehicle stabilization. In addition, other driving safety systems
are switched off.
#
Drive on carefully.
#
Have ESP
®
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Drive on carefully.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
460
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
÷
  
 
*
ESP
®
is temporarily unavailable.
Other driving systems and driving safety systems may also malfunction.
&
WARNING Risk of skidding if ESP
®
is malfunctioning
If ESP
®
is malfunctioning, ESP
®
cannot carry out vehicle stabilization. In addition, other driving safety systems
are switched off.
#
Drive on carefully.
#
Have ESP
®
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Carefully drive on a suitable stretch of road, making slight steering movements at a speed above 19 mph
(30 km/h).
#
If the display message does not disappear, consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately. Drive carefully.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
461
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
T
!
÷
  

*
EBD, ABS and ESP
®
are malfunctioning.
Other driving systems and driving safety systems may also malfunction.
&
WARNING Risk of skidding if EBD, ABS and ESP
®
are malfunctioning
If EBD, ABS and ESP
®
are malfunctioning, the wheels can lock when braking and ESP
®
cannot carry out vehicle
stabilization.
The steering capability and braking characteristics are thus severely impaired. The braking distance in an emer‐
gency braking situation can increase. In addition, other driving safety systems are switched off.
#
Drive on carefully.
#
Have the brake system checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Drive on carefully.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
462
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
F
(USA only)
!
(Canada only)
    
   
*
The red F (USA only) or ! (Canada only) indicator lamp is lit.
You have attempted to release the electric parking brake with the ignition switched off.
#
Switch on the ignition.
F
(USA only)
!
(Canada only)
  

*
The red F (USA only) or ! (Canada only) indicator lamp flashes.
The electric parking brake is applied while driving:
R
A condition for automatic release of the electric parking brake is not fulfilled .
R
You are performing emergency braking using the electric parking brake .
#
Check that the conditions for automatic release of the electric parking brake are fulfilled.
#
Release the electric parking brake manually.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
463
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
F
(USA only)
!
(Canada only)
   
 
*
The yellow ! indicator lamp is lit. The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To apply:
#
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
#
Apply the electric parking brake manually .
If it is not possible to apply the electric parking brake:
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Where necessary, also safeguard the parked vehicle against rolling away.
The yellow ! and the red F (USA only) or ! (Canada only) indicator lamps are lit. The electric parking
brake is malfunctioning.
To release:
#
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
#
Release the electric parking brake manually .
or
#
Release the electric parking brake automatically .
If it is still not possible to release the electric parking brake:
#
Do not drive on. Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The yellow ! indicator lamp is lit and the red F (USA only) or ! (Canada only) indicator lamp is flashing.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
The electric parking brake could not be applied or released.
464
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
#
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
To apply:
#
Release and then apply the electric parking brake manually .
To release:
#
Apply and then release the electric parking brake manually.
If the electric parking brake cannot be applied or the red F (USA only) or ! (Canada only) indicator lamp
continues to flash:
#
Do not drive on. Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Where necessary, also safeguard the parked vehicle against rolling away.
The yellow indicator lamp ! is on and the red F indicator lamp (USA only) or ! (Canada only) indicator
lamp flashes for approximately ten seconds after the electric parking brake has been applied or released. It then
remains lit or goes out. The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
If the battery charge level is too low:
#
Charge the battery.
To apply:
#
Switch the ignition off.
The electric parking brake is applied automatically.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
465
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
If you do not wish the electric parking brake to be applied, leave the ignition switched on, e.g. when washing the
vehicle in an automatic car wash or when having the vehicle towed away. Do not do this when having the vehicle
towed with the rear axle raised.
If the electric parking brake is not applied automatically:
#
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
#
Release and then apply the electric parking brake manually .
If it is still not possible to apply the electric parking brake:
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Where necessary, also safeguard the parked vehicle against rolling away.
To release:
#
If the conditions for automatic release are fulfilled and the electric parking brake is not released automatically,
release the electric parking brake manually .
If it is still not possible to release the electric parking brake:
#
Do not drive on. Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
466
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
$
(USA only)
J
(Canada only)
   
*There is not enough brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
&
WARNING Risk of an accident due to low brake fluid level
If the brake fluid level is too low, the braking effect and the braking characteristics may be impaired.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
Do not continue driving under any circumstances.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Do not add brake fluid.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not
continue driving under any circumstances.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Do not add brake fluid.
#
   
*The brake linings have reached the wear limit.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
G

*One or more of the mbrace system's main features are malfunctioning.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
467
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
   
   
 
* Vehicles with the Driving Assistance Package: Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function, Evasive Steering
Assist or PRE‑SAFE
®
PLUS are temporarily unavailable or only partially available.
Vehicles without the Driving Assistance Package: Active Brake Assist is temporarily unavailable.
The ambient conditions are outside the system limitations .
#
Drive on.
As soon as the ambient conditions are within the system limitations, the system will become available again.
#
If the display message does not disappear, stop the vehicle while paying attention to road and traffic conditions
and restart the engine.
   
   
 
* Vehicles with Driving Assistance Package: Active Brake Assist with cross-traffic function, Evasive Steering
Assist or PRE‑SAFE
®
PLUS is malfunctioning.
Vehicles without the Driving Assistance Package: Active Brake Assist is malfunctioning.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
  
 
*
PRE‑SAFE
®
functions are malfunctioning.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
468
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
   
 
*The radar sensor system is malfunctioning. Possible causes are:
R
Soiling of the sensors
R
Heavy rain
R
Extended country driving without moving traffic, e.g. in the desert
Driving systems and driving safety systems may be malfunctioning or temporarily unavailable.
Once the cause of the problem is no longer present, driving systems and driving safety systems are available again.
If the display message does not disappear:
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
#
Clean all sensors .
#
Restart the engine.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
469
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
   
 
*The radar sensor system is malfunctioning. Possible causes are:
R
Soiling of the sensors
R
Heavy rain
R
Extended driving on inter-urban roads without moving traffic, e.g. in the desert
Driving systems and driving safety systems may be malfunctioning or temporarily unavailable.
Once the cause of the problem is no longer present, driving systems and driving safety systems are available again.
If the display message does not disappear:
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
#
Clean all sensors .
#
Restart the engine.
470
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
6
  

*The restraint system is faulty .
&
WARNING Risk of injury or fatal injury due to a malfunction in the restraint system
If the restraint system is malfunctioning, restraint system components may be triggered unintentionally or
might not be triggered at all in the event of an accident. This may affect the Emergency Tensioning Device or
airbag, for example.
#
Have the restraint system checked and repaired immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
Detection of a restraint system malfunction:
R
The 6 restraint system warning lamp does not light up when the ignition is switched on.
R
The 6 restraint system warning lamp lights up continuously or repeatedly during a journey.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
471
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
  
  

*The front passenger air bag and knee air bags are enabled during the journey:
R
even when a child, a small adult or an object weighing less than the system weight threshold is located on the
front passenger seat
R
even when the front passenger seat is not occupied
The system may detect objects or forces that are adding to the weight applied to the seat.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or fatal injury when using a child restraint system while the front passenger air bag
is enabled
If you secure a child in a child restraint system on the front passenger seat and the front passenger air bag is
enabled, the front passenger air bag can deploy in the event of an accident.
The child could be struck by the air bag.
#
Ensure, both before and during the journey, that the status of the front passenger air bag is correct.
NEVER use a rearward facing child restraint on a seat protected by an ACTIVE FRONT AIR BAG; DEATH or SERI‐
OUS INJURY to the CHILD can occur.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
#
Check the status of the automatic front passenger air bag shutoff .
#
If necessary, consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
472
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
   
   

*The front passenger air bag and the knee air bag are deactivated, even though an adult or a person of a corre
sponding stature is seated on the front passenger seat. If additional forces are applied to the seat, the weight the
system detects may be too low.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or fatal injury due to a disabled front passenger airbag
If the front passenger airbag is disabled, the front passenger airbag will not be deployed in the event of an acci‐
dent and cannot perform its intended protective function.
A person in the front passenger seat could then, for example, come into contact with the vehicle's interior,
especially if the person is sitting too close to the cockpit.
#
Make sure, both before and during the journey, that the status of the front passenger airbag is correct.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
#
Check the status of the automatic front passenger air bag shutoff .
#
If necessary, consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
473
Driving systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
À
  

*ATTENTION ASSIST has detected fatigue or an increasing lack of concentration on the part of the driver
(
page 232).
#
If necessary, take a break.
À
  

*ATTENTION ASSIST is malfunctioning.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
É
 
*Your vehicle is adjusting to the level you have selected.
É
   
*The vehicle level is too low and the vehicle rises to the selected vehicle level.
#
Wait until the display message disappears before pulling away.
474
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
É
   

*You have pulled away despite the vehicle level being too low.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
The vehicle rises to the selected vehicle level.
#
Wait until the display message disappears before pulling away.
If the display message does not disappear and a warning tone also sounds, AIR BODY CONTROL is malfunctioning:
#
Do not drive faster than 50 mph (80 km/h) and consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
*
NOTE The tires of the front axle or the front fenders could be damaged by large steering movements
#
Avoid large steering movements while driving and listen for scraping sounds.
#
If you hear scraping sounds, pull over and stop the vehicle safely, paying attention to road and traffic con‐
ditions, and set a higher vehicle level if possible.
#
Set a higher vehicle level .
Depending on the malfunction, the vehicle is raised.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
475
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
   
 
*The AIR BODY CONTROL function is restricted. The vehicle's handling characteristics may be affected.
*
NOTE The tires of the front axle or the front fenders could be damaged by large steering movements
#
Avoid large steering movements while driving and listen for scraping sounds.
#
If you hear scraping sounds, pull over and stop the vehicle safely, paying attention to road and traffic con‐
ditions, and set a higher vehicle level if possible.
#
Do not drive faster than 50 mph (80 km/h).
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
   
  
 
*Active Lane Keeping Assist is temporarily unavailable.
The ambient conditions are outside the system limitations (
page 240).
Vehicles with Active Steering Assist: The camera view may be restricted by the windshield.
#
Drive on.
As soon as the ambient conditions are within the system limitations, the system will become available again.
If the display message does not disappear on vehicles with Active Steering Assist:
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
#
Clean the windshield.
   

*Active Lane Keeping Assist is malfunctioning.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
476
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
   
  
 
*Active Blind Spot Assist is temporarily unavailable.
The system limitations have been reached (
page 238).
#
Drive on.
Once the cause of the problem is no longer present, the system will be available again.
#
If the display message does not disappear, stop the vehicle while paying attention to road and traffic conditions
and restart the engine.
   

*Active Blind Spot Assist is malfunctioning.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
    
  
   

*When you establish the electrical connection to the trailer, Active Blind Spot Assist is unavailable.
#
Press the left-hand side of Touch Control and confirm the display message.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
477
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
   
  

*Blind Spot Assist is temporarily unavailable.
The system limitations have been reached (
page 238).
#
Drive on.
Once the cause of the problem is no longer present, the system will be available again.
or
#
If the display message does not disappear, stop the vehicle while paying attention to road and traffic conditions
and restart the engine.
#
If necessary, clean the rear bumper. If the bumper is extremely dirty, the sensors in the bumper may be mal‐
functioning.
   

*Blind Spot Assist is malfunctioning.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Example: 
  
*Active Parking Assist was interrupted. You have opened the driver's door or touched the steering wheel, for exam‐
ple.
#
Steer and brake manually.
   
 
  
*Active Parking Assist and Parking Assist PARKTRONIC are malfunctioning.
#
Stop the vehicle, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and restart the engine.
#
If the display message continues to be displayed, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
478
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
  
 
  

*Active Parking Assist and Parking Assist PARKTRONIC are temporarily unavailable. The ambient conditions are out‐
side the system limitations (
page 226). Beware of the entire vehicle surroundings.
#
As soon as the ambient conditions are within the system limitations, the system will become available again.
   

*Traffic Sign Assist is malfunctioning.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
   
  
 
*Traffic Sign Assist is temporarily unavailable.
#
Drive on.
Once the cause of the problem is no longer present, the system will be available again.
   
   
 
*The camera view is restricted. Possible causes are:
R
Dirt on the windshield in the camera's field of vision
R
Heavy rain, snow or fog
Driving systems and driving safety systems may be malfunctioning or temporarily unavailable.
Once the cause of the problem is no longer present, driving systems and driving safety systems are available again.
If the display message does not disappear:
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
#
Clean the windshield.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
479
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
ë

*The HOLD function is deactivated because the vehicle is skidding or a condition for activation is not met.
#
Reactivate the HOLD function later or check the activation conditions for the HOLD function .
   

*Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC is operational again and can be activated (
page 200).
   
  
 
*Active Distance Assist is temporarily unavailable.
The ambient conditions are outside the system limitations(
page 199).
#
Drive on.
As soon as the ambient conditions are within the system limitations, the system will become available again.
   

*Active Distance Assist is malfunctioning.
Other driving systems and driving safety systems may also malfunction.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
   
  
 
*Active Steering Assist is temporarily unavailable.
The ambient conditions are outside the system limitations (
page 204).
#
Drive on.
As soon as the ambient conditions are within the system limitations, the system will become available again.
#
If necessary, clean the windshield in the camera's field of vision.
480
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
   

*Active Steering Assist is malfunctioning. Active Distance Assist remains available.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
¯ 
*Cruise control cannot be activated as not all activation conditions are fulfilled.
#
Observe the activation conditions for cruise control .
  
*Cruise control has been deactivated.
If there is an additional warning tone, cruise control has been switched off automatically (
page 196).
  
*Cruise control is malfunctioning.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.

*The vehicle level may be lowered for the following reasons:
R
you have selected a different drive program.
R
you have exceeded a critical speed.
R
you have changed the vehicle level by pressing a button.
   
*The vehicle has been set to transport level. Transport level is not a permissible driving level. Only suitable for trans‐
porting the vehicle.
#
Do not drive faster than 22 mph (35 km/h).
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
481
Engine
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
   
 
*The coolant level is too low.
*
NOTE Engine damage due to insufficient coolant
#
Avoid long journeys with insufficient coolant.
#
Add coolant .
?
    
   
*The coolant is too hot.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
&
WARNING Danger of burns when opening the hood
If you open the hood when the engine has overheated or during a fire in the engine compartment, you could
come into contact with hot gases or other escaping operating fluids.
#
Before opening the hood, allow the engine to cool down.
#
In the event of a fire in the engine compartment, keep the hood closed and call the fire service.
#
Wait until the engine has cooled down.
#
Make sure that the air supply to the radiator is not obstructed.
#
Avoiding high loads on the engine, drive on to the nearest qualified specialist workshop. In doing so, ensure that
the coolant temperature display remains below 248 °F (120 °C).
482
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
?
*The fan motor is defective.
#
Avoiding high loads on the engine, drive on to the nearest qualified specialist workshop. In doing so, ensure that
the coolant temperature display remains below 248 °F (120 °C).
#
  
*The battery is not being charged.
*
NOTE Possible engine damage if you continue driving
#
Do not continue driving under any circumstances.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely and switch off the engine, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
483
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
#
   
 
*The battery is no longer being charged and the battery charge level is too low.
*
NOTE Possible engine damage if you continue driving
#
Do not continue driving under any circumstances.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not
continue driving under any circumstances.
#
Switch off the engine.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
#
   
 
*The engine is off and the battery charge level is too low.
#
Switch off electrical consumers that are not required.
#
Leave the engine running for a few minutes, or drive for a longer distance.
The battery charges.
#
   

*The battery charge level is too low and must be charged.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not
continue driving under any circumstances.
#
Start the engine.
#
Wait until the display message disappears before pulling away.
484
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
4
    

*The engine oil level has dropped to the minimum level.
*
NOTE Engine damage caused by driving with insufficient engine oil
#
Avoid long journeys with insufficient engine oil.
#
Check the engine oil level when next refueling.
Add engine oil (
page 382).
Notes on engine oil (
page 449).
¯
   
  
*The DEF system is malfunctioning. You can no longer start the engine.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
¯
   
 
*The DEF system is malfunctioning.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
485
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
¯
   
    
 
*The DEF system is malfunctioning. Performance is limited above the speed displayed.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Ø
    
   

*The low DEF level leads to limited performance after driving the distance displayed.
#
Refill DEF immediately .
%
The message disappears after driving at a speed above 10 mph (15 km/h) for approximately one minute.
8
  
*There has been pressure loss in the fuel system. The fuel filler cap is not closed correctly or the fuel system is
leaking.
#
Close the fuel filler cap.
#
If the fuel filler cap was already properly closed: Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
8
  
*The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
#
Refuel.
486
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Tires
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
h
   

*The tire pressure is too low in at least one of the tires, or the tire pressure difference between the wheels is too
great.
#
Check the tire pressure and add air, if necessary.
#
When the tire pressure is correct, restart the tire pressure monitoring system .
h
 
*The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped significantly. The wheel position is displayed.
&
WARNING Risk of an accident due to insufficient tire pressure
Tire pressures that are too low pose the following hazards:
R
The tires may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed increase.
R
The tires may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may greatly impair tire traction.
R
The driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be greatly impaired.
You could then lose control of the vehicle.
#
Observe the recommended tire pressure.
#
Adjust the tire pressure if necessary.
#
Stop the vehicle, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
#
Check the tire pressure and the tires.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
487
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
h
  
*The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped suddenly. The wheel position is displayed.
&
WARNING Risk of an accident from driving with a flat tire
Flat tires are dangerous in the following ways:
R
The tires can overheat and cause a fire.
R
The driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be greatly impaired.
You could then lose control of the vehicle.
#
Do not drive with a flat tire.
#
Observe the notes on flat tires.
Notes on flat tires ( page 393).
#
Stop the vehicle, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
#
Check the tires.
   
 
*No signals can be received from the tire pressure sensor due to strong radio signal source interference. The tire
pressure monitoring system is temporarily unavailable.
#
Drive on.
The tire pressure monitoring system restarts automatically as soon as the cause has been rectified.
488
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
h
  
*There is no signal from the tire pressure sensor of one or more wheels. The pressure of the affected tire is not
displayed.
#
Have the defective tire pressure sensor replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
   
   
*The wheels installed do not have suitable tire pressure sensors. The tire pressure monitoring system is deactivated.
#
Install wheels with suitable tire pressure sensors.
   

*The tire pressure monitoring system is malfunctioning.
&
WARNING There is a risk of an accident if the tire pressure monitoring system is malfunctioning
If the tire pressure monitoring system is malfunctioning, it is not able to issue a warning if there is pressure loss
in one or more of the tires.
Underinflated tires may, for example, impair the driving, steering and braking characteristics.
#
Have the tire pressure monitoring system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
489
SmartKey
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
Â
  
*The SmartKey needs to be replaced.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Â
  
*The SmartKey battery is discharged.
#
Replace the battery .
Â
   (white
display message)
*The SmartKey is currently undetected.
#
Change the location of the SmartKey in the vehicle.
#
If the SmartKey is still not recognized, start the engine with the SmartKey in the stowage compartment .
490
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
Â
   (red dis‐
play message)
*The SmartKey cannot be detected and may no longer be in the vehicle.
The SmartKey is no longer in the vehicle and you switch off the engine:
R
You can no longer start the engine.
R
you cannot centrally lock the vehicle
#
Ensure that the SmartKey is in the vehicle.
If the SmartKey detection function has a malfunction due to a strong radio signal source:
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
#
Place the SmartKey in the stowage compartment for starting the engine with the SmartKey .
Â
   
*Awarning tone also sounds. This message reminds you to take your SmartKey with you when you leave the vehicle.
Â
    
   
 
*The SmartKey detection function is malfunctioning.
#
Change the location of the SmartKey in the vehicle.
#
Start the vehicle with the SmartKey in the stowage compartment .
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
491
Vehicle
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
    

*
You have attempted to shift the transmission out of position j and into another transmission position.
#
Depress the brake pedal.
   
   

*
You have attempted to shift the transmission out of position j or i into another transmission position.
#
Depress the brake pedal.
#
Start the engine.
  
   
   
*
The driver's door is not fully closed and the transmission is in position k, i or h.
#
Shift the transmission to position j when you park the vehicle.
  
  
*
While the vehicle is rolling or while you are driving, the transmission has been shifted to position i.
#
Depress the brake pedal to stop and, when the vehicle is stationary, shift the transmission to position j.
#
To continue your journey, shift the transmission to position h or k.
     
  
*
The transmission can only be shifted to position j when the vehicle is stationary.
492
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
   
   
*The transmission is malfunctioning. The transmission position can no longer be shifted.
#
When the transmission is in position h, consult a qualified specialist workshop and do not shift the transmis‐
sion position.
#
For all other transmission positions, park the vehicle safely.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop or breakdown service.
d
  
    

*You are leaving the vehicle when it is in a ready-to-drive state.
#
When you leave the vehicle, switch off the ignition and take the SmartKey with you.
#
If you do not leave the vehicle, switch off the electrical consumers, e.g. the seat heater. Otherwise, the 12 V
battery might discharge and it will then only be possible to start the vehicle using a second battery (starting
assistance).
 

*
The transmission is malfunctioning. The transmission shifts to position i automatically.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
#
Before leaving the vehicle, apply the electric parking brake.
#
Switch the transmission to position j.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
  
 
*The transmission is malfunctioning. Reverse gear can no longer be engaged.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
493
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
   
  

*The transmission has overheated. Pulling away can be temporarily impaired or not possible.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not
continue driving under any circumstances.
#
Start the engine.
#
Wait until the display message disappears before pulling away.
  

*The auxiliary battery for the transmission is no longer being charged.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Until then, manually set the transmission to position j before you switch off the engine.
#
Before leaving the vehicle, apply the electric parking brake.
  
   
*Operation of the climate control system is temporarily restricted. Airflow and fresh air supply are set to automatic
mode.
#
Have the climate control system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
494
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
     
   
   
*The climate control system is malfunctioning.
&
WARNING Risk of injury and accident due to an insufficient supply of fresh air
If the climate control system is malfunctioning, carbon dioxide levels may increase in the vehicle interior.
Breathing in carbon dioxide may cause dizziness.
#
Open the window to ensure that there is a sufficient supply of fresh air.
#
Open the window to ensure that there is a sufficient supply of fresh air.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Ð
  
  
*The power assistance of the steering is malfunctioning. You may need to use more force to steer.
#
Drive on carefully.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
495
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
Ð
  
  
 
*The steering is malfunctioning. Steering capability is considerably impaired.
&
WARNING Risk of accident if steering capability is impaired
If the steering does not function as intended, the vehicle's operating safety is jeopardized.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
Do not continue driving under any circumstances.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not
continue driving under any circumstances.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Ð
 
  
  
*The power assistance of the steering is malfunctioning.
&
WARNING Risk of an accident due to altered steering characteristics
If the power assistance of the steering fails partially or completely, you will need to use more force to steer.
#
If safe steering is possible, drive on carefully.
#
Visit or consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
#
If safe steering is possible, drive on carefully.
#
Visit or consult a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
496
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
  
  
*The active hood (pedestrian protection) is malfunctioning or inoperative after having already been triggered.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
M
*The engine hood is open.
&
WARNING Risk of accident if the engine hood is unlatched while driving
An unlocked engine hood may open up when the vehicle is in motion and block your view.
#
Never unlatch the engine hood while driving.
#
Before every trip, ensure that the engine hood is latched.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible.
#
Close the engine hood.
C
*At least one door is open.
#
Close all doors.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
497
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
N
*The trunk lid is open.
&
WARNING Risk of exhaust gas poisoning
Combustion engines emit poisonous exhaust gases such as carbon monoxide. Exhaust gases can enter the
vehicle interior if the trunk lid is open when the engine is running, especially if the vehicle is in motion.
#
Always switch off the engine before opening the trunk lid.
#
Never drive with the trunk lid open.
#
Close the trunk lid.
_
   
 (example)
*The corresponding seat backrest of the rear bench seat is not engaged.
#
Fold the corresponding seat backrest back until it engages.
¥
  
*The washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped below the minimum.
#
Add washer fluid .
498
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Lights
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
b
  
 (example)
*The corresponding light source is defective.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
%
LED light bulbs: the display message for the corresponding lamp only appears when all the light-emitting diodes
in the lamp have failed.
b
  

*The active light function is malfunctioning.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
  
 
*The exterior lighting is malfunctioning.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
499
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
b
   

*The light sensor is malfunctioning.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
  
*You are leaving the vehicle and the lights are still switched on.
#
Turn the light switch to the à position.
b
  
*You are driving without low-beam headlamps.
#
Turn the light switch to the L or à position.
  

*Adaptive Highbeam Assist is malfunctioning.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
  
  
 
*Adaptive Highbeam Assist is temporarily unavailable.
The system limitations have been reached (
page 146).
#
Drive on.
Once the cause of the problem is no longer present, the system will be available again. The  
   display message appears.
500
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
  
  
  
*The camera view is restricted. Possible causes are:
R
Dirt on the windshield in the camera's field of vision
R
Heavy rain, snow or fog
Driving systems and driving safety systems may be malfunctioning or temporarily unavailable.
Once the cause of the problem is no longer present, driving systems and driving safety systems are available again.
If the display message does not disappear:
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
#
Clean the windshield.
Warning and indicator lamps
Overview of warning and indicator lamps
Some systems perform a self-test when the igni‐
tion is switched on. Some warning and indicator
lamps may briefly light up or flash. This behavior
is non-critical. These warning and indicator
lamps only indicate a malfunction if they light up
or flash after the engine is started or during a
journey.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
501
Instrument Display in the Widescreen Cock
pit
Progressive setting (Widescreen Cockpit)
If you select the progressive display setting in
vehicles with a Widescreen Cockpit, the position
of the indicator lamps in the Instrument Display
changes.
Warning and indicator lamps:
L
Low beam (
page 143)
T
Parking lights (
page 143)
K
High beam (
page 144)
#!
Turn signal light (
page 144)
R
Rear fog light (
page 143)
ü
Seat belt is not fastened
(
page 510)
$
USA: brakes (red) (
page 503)
J
Canada: brakes (red) (
page 503)
!
ABS malfunction (
page 503)
÷
ESP
®
( page 503)
å
ESP
®
OFF ( page 503)
F
USA: electric parking brake applied
(red) (
page 503)
!
Canada: electric parking brake
applied (red) (
page 503)
!
Electric parking brake (yellow)
(
page 503)
Ð
Steering assistance malfunction
(
page 512)
#
Electrical malfunction (
page 513)
6
Restraint system (
page 503)
;
Check Engine (
page 513)
8
Fuel reserve with fuel filler cap loca‐
tion indicator (
page 513)
?
Coolant too hot/cold (
page 513)
·
Distance warning (
page 511)
h
Tire pressure monitoring system
(
page 517)
502
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Safety systems
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
$
Brake warning lamp (USA)
J
Brakes warning lamp (Can‐
ada)
The red brake system warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
Possible causes are:
R
The brake force boosting is malfunctioning and the braking characteristics may be affected.
R
There is not enough brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
&
WARNING There is a risk of an accident if brake force boosting is malfunctioning
If brake force boosting is malfunctioning, the wheels may lock when braking. Braking characteristics may be
impaired. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can increase.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do
not continue driving under any circumstances.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
&
WARNING Risk of an accident due to low brake fluid level
If the brake fluid level is too low, the braking effect and the braking characteristics may be impaired.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do
not continue driving under any circumstances.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Do not add brake fluid.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
503
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not
continue driving under any circumstances.
#
Observe the messages in the multifunction display.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
USA only: if an additional display message appears with the # symbol in the multifunction display, the brake linings
have reached their wear limit.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
504
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
!
ABS warning lamp
The yellow ABS warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
ABS is malfunctioning.
If there is an additional warning tone, EBD is malfunctioning.
Other driving and driving safety systems may also be faulty.
&
WARNING There is risk of skidding if EBD or ABS is malfunctioning
If EBD or ABS is malfunctioning, the wheels could lock when braking
The steering capability and braking characteristics are thus severely impaired. The braking distance in an emer‐
gency braking situation can increase. In addition, other driving safety systems are switched off.
#
Drive on carefully.
#
Have the brake system checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Drive on carefully.
#
Observe the messages in the multifunction display.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
÷
ESP
®
warning lamp flashes
The yellow ESP
®
warning lamp flashes while the vehicle is in motion.
ESP
®
is intervening .
#
Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
505
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
÷
ESP
®
warning lamp lights
up
The yellow ESP
®
warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
ESP
®
is malfunctioning.
Other driving and driving safety systems may also be malfunctioning.
&
WARNING Risk of skidding if ESP
®
is malfunctioning
If ESP
®
is malfunctioning, ESP
®
cannot carry out vehicle stabilization. In addition, other driving safety systems are
switched off.
#
Drive on carefully.
#
Have ESP
®
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Drive on carefully.
#
Observe the messages in the multifunction display.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
506
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
å
ESP
®
OFF warning lamp
The yellow ESP
®
OFF warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
ESP
®
is deactivated.
&
WARNING Risk of skidding when driving with ESP
®
deactivated
If ESP
®
is deactivated, ESP
®
cannot carry out vehicle stabilization. The availability of further driving safety systems
is also limited.
#
Drive on carefully.
#
Only deactivate ESP
®
for as long as the situation requires.
If ESP
®
cannot be activated, ESP
®
is malfunctioning.
#
Have ESP
®
checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Observe the notes on deactivating ESP
®
.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
507
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
F
Red indicator lamp, electric
parking brake applied (USA
only)
!
Red indicator lamp, electric
parking brake applied (Can‐
ada only)
!
Yellow electric parking
brake indicator lamp is mal‐
functioning
The red electric parking brake indicator lamp flashes or is lit. The yellow indicator lamp is also lit if the electric parking
brake malfunctions.
#
Observe the messages in the multifunction display.
508
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
6
Restraint system warning
lamp
The red restraint system warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
The restraint system is malfunctioning.
&
WARNING Risk of injury or fatal injury due to a malfunction in the restraint system
If the restraint system is malfunctioning, restraint system components may be triggered unintentionally or might not
be triggered at all in the event of an accident. This may affect the Emergency Tensioning Device or airbag, for exam‐
ple.
#
Have the restraint system checked and repaired immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Drive on carefully.
#
Observe the messages in the multifunction display.
#
Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
509
Seat belts
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
7
Seat belt warning lamp
lights up
After starting the engine, the red seat belt warning lamp lights up for 6 seconds.
In addition, an acoustic warning tone may sound.
The seat belt warning lamp reminds the driver and front passenger to fasten their seat belts.
#
Fasten your seat belt .
If you have placed objects on the front passenger seat, the warning lamp may remain lit.
7
Seat belt warning lamp
flashes
The red seat belt warning lamp flashes and an intermittent warning tone sounds.
The driver or front passenger has not fastened their seat belt while the vehicle is in motion.
#
Fasten your seat belt .
There are objects on the front passenger seat.
#
Remove the objects from the front passenger seat.
510
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Driving systems
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
à
Air suspension warning
lamp
The yellow AIR BODY CONTROL warning lamp is lit.
AIR BODY CONTROL is faulty.
#
Observe the messages in the multifunction display.
·
Distance warning lamp
The red distance warning lamp lights up while the vehicle is in motion.
The distance to the vehicle in front is too small for the speed selected.
If there is an additional warning tone, you are approaching an obstacle at too high a speed.
#
Be prepared to brake immediately.
#
Increase the distance.
Active Brake Assist .
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
511
Vehicle
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
Ð
Power steering system
warning lamp
The red power steering system warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
The power steering assistance or the steering itself is malfunctioning.
&
WARNING Risk of accident if steering capability is impaired
If the steering does not function as intended, the vehicle's operating safety is jeopardized.
#
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Do
not continue driving under any circumstances.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Observe the messages in the multifunction display.
512
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Engine
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
;
Engine diagnosis warning
lamp
The yellow engine diagnosis warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
A malfunction has occurred in the engine, the exhaust system or the fuel system.
The emissions limit values may be exceeded and the engine may be running in emergency operation mode.
In some states, legal requirements stipulate that you must immediately consult a qualified specialist workshop as soon
as the yellow engine diagnosis warning lamp lights up.
#
Have the vehicle checked as soon as possible at a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Electrical malfunction warn
ing lamp
The red electrical malfunction warning lamp is lit.
There is a malfunction in the electrics.
#
Observe the messages in the multifunction display.
8
Fuel reserve warning lamp
The yellow fuel reserve warning lamp lights up while driving.
There has been pressure loss in the fuel system. The fuel filler cap is not closed correctly or the fuel system is leaking.
#
Close the fuel filler cap.
#
If the fuel filler cap was already properly closed: consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
513
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
8
Fuel reserve warning lamp
The yellow fuel reserve warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
The fuel level has dropped into the reserve range.
#
Refuel.
514
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
?
Coolant warning lamp
The red coolant warning lamp is lit while the engine is running.
Possible causes are:
R
The temperature sensor is malfunctioning
R
Coolant level too low
R
The air supply to the radiator is obstructed
R
The radiator fan is defective
If there is an additional warning tone, the coolant temperature has exceeded the maximum permissible temperature.
&
WARNING Danger of burns when opening the hood
If you open the hood when the engine has overheated or during a fire in the engine compartment, you could come
into contact with hot gases or other escaping operating fluids.
#
Before opening the hood, allow the engine to cool down.
#
In the event of a fire in the engine compartment, keep the hood closed and call the fire service.
#
Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions, and switch off the engine. Do not con‐
tinue driving under any circumstances.
#
Observe the messages in the multifunction display.
If the coolant temperature display is at the lower end of the temperature scale:
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
515
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
Otherwise:
#
Leave the vehicle and keep a safe distance from the vehicle until the engine has cooled down.
#
Check the coolant level .
#
Make sure that the air supply to the radiator is not obstructed.
#
Avoiding high loads on the engine, drive on to the nearest qualified specialist workshop. In doing so, ensure that the
coolant temperature display remains below the red area.
516
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
Tires
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
h
Tire pressure monitoring
system warning lamp lights
up
The yellow tire pressure monitoring system warning lamp (pressure loss/malfunction) is lit.
The tire pressure monitoring system has detected tire pressure loss in at least one of the tires.
&
WARNING Risk of an accident due to insufficient tire pressure
Tire pressures that are too low pose the following hazards:
R
The tires may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed increase.
R
The tires may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may greatly impair tire traction.
R
The driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be greatly impaired.
You could then lose control of the vehicle.
#
Observe the recommended tire pressure.
#
Adjust the tire pressure if necessary.
#
Stop the vehicle, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
#
Check the tire pressure and the tires.
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
517
Warning/indicator lamp
Possible causes/consequences and M
Solutions
h
Tire pressure monitoring
system warning lamp
flashes
The yellow tire pressure monitoring system warning lamp (pressure loss/malfunction) flashes for approximately one
minute and then remains lit.
The tire pressure monitoring system is malfunctioning.
&
WARNING There is a risk of an accident if the tire pressure monitoring system is malfunctioning
If the tire pressure monitoring system is malfunctioning, it is not able to issue a warning if there is pressure loss in
one or more of the tires.
Underinflated tires may, for example, impair the driving, steering and braking characteristics.
#
Have the tire pressure monitoring system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
#
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
518
Display messages and warning/indicator lamps
1, 2, 3 ...
12 V socket
see Socket (12 V)
115 V socket
see Socket (115 V)
360° camera ............................................ 224
Assigning as a favorite ........................ 226
Care .................................................... 389
Function .............................................. 224
Selecting a view .................................. 226
A
A/C function
Activating/deactivating (multimedia
system) ................................................ 158
Switching on/off (control panel) ......... 158
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) .............189
Acceleration
see Kickdown
Access data
Editing .................................................333
Setting ................................................. 331
Acoustic locking verification signal
Activating/deactivating ......................... 59
Active Blind Spot Assist ......................... 238
Activating/deactivating .......................240
Brake application ................................. 239
Function .............................................. 238
System limitations ...............................238
Towing a trailer .................................... 239
Active Brake Assist
Function/notes ................................... 192
Setting ................................................. 196
Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC ........ 199
Active Emergency Stop Assist .............207
Active Lane Change Assist .................. 206
Calling up a speed ............................... 200
Displays in the Instrument Display ...... 208
Function .............................................. 199
Increasing/decreasing speed ..............200
Requirements ...................................... 200
Route-based speed adjustment ...........203
Steering wheel buttons ...............
.....
... 200
Storing a speed ................................... 200
Switching off/deactivating .................. 200
Switching on/activating ......................200
System limitations ...............................199
Active Emergency Stop Assist ...............207
Active hood (pedestrian protection) ...... 378
Method of operation ............................378
Resetting ............................................. 378
Active Lane Change Assist
Function .............................................. 206
Switching on/off ................................. 207
Active Lane Keeping Assist .................... 240
Function .............................................. 240
Sensitivity (function/notes) ................. 243
Setting the sensitivity .......................... 243
Switching on/off ................................. 242
System limitations ...............................240
Towing a trailer .................................... 240
Active Parking Assist .............................. 226
Cross Traffic Alert ................................ 231
Drive Away Assist ................................ 230
Exiting a parking space .......................229
Function .............................................. 226
Parking ................................................ 228
System limitations ...............................226
Active Speed Limit Assist
.............. 202, 235
Di
splay ................................................ 202
Function .............................................. 202
Index
519
Setting ................................................. 235
Active Steering Assist .............................204
Activating/deactivating .......................206
Active Emergency Stop Assist .............207
Active Lane Change Assist .................. 206
Displays in the Instrument Display ...... 208
Function .............................................. 204
System limitations ...............................204
Adaptive cruise control
see Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
Adaptive Highbeam Assist
Function .............................................. 146
Switching on/off ................................. 147
Additives .................................................. 449
Engine oil ............................................ 449
Fuel ..................................................... 449
Additives (engine oil)
see Additives
Additives (fuel)
see Fuel
Address book
see Contacts
Adjusting the balance/fader
Burmester
®
high-end 3D surround
sound system ...................................... 360
Burmester
®
surround sound system ... 359
Adjusting the bass, mid-range and
treble
Burmester
®
high-end 3D surround
sound system ...................................... 359
Adjusting the mid-range, treble and
bass
Burmester
®
high-end 3D surround
sound system ...................................... 359
Adjusting the sound focus
Burmester
®
surround sound system ... 359
Adjusting the s
ound optimization
Burmester
®
high-end 3D surround
sound system ...................................... 360
Adjusting treble, mid-range and bass
settings
Burmester
®
high-end 3D surround
sound system ...................................... 359
ADS PLUS damping system
see AIR BODY CONTROL
After-sales service center
see ASSYST PLUS
Air bag ........................................................ 38
Activation .............................................. 32
Belt air bag ............................................ 36
Cushionbag ........................................... 38
Front air bag (driver, front passenger) ... 38
Installation locations .............................38
Knee air bag .......................................... 38
Overview ............................................... 38
Protection ..............................................39
Reduced protection ...............................40
Side air bag ........................................... 38
Window air bag ...................................... 38
AIR BODY CONTROL .................................211
Setting ................................................. 213
Suspension .......................................... 211
Air distribution
Setting (multimedia system) ................159
Air freshener system
see Fragrance system
Air pressure
see Tire pressure
520
Index
Air suspension
see AIR BODY CONTROL
Air vents ................................................... 162
Adjusting (front) .................................. 162
Adjusting (rear) .................................... 163
Glove box .............................................164
Rear center air vent ............................. 163
Rear side air vent ................................. 163
Air vents
see Air vents
Air-recirculation mode ............................ 160
Alarm
see Panic alarm
Alarm system
see ATA (anti-theft alarm system)
Alternative route
see Route
Ambient lighting ...................................... 148
Android Auto ............................................ 326
Connecting a mobile phone ................. 326
Ending ................................................. 327
Notes .................................................. 326
Overview ............................................. 326
Sound settings .................................... 327
Transferred vehicle data ......................327
Animals
Pets in the vehicle ................................. 56
Anti-lock braking system
see ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Anti-theft alarm system
see ATA (anti-theft alarm system)
Anti-theft protection
Immobilizer ............................................ 86
Anti-theft protection
see AT
A (
anti-theft alarm system)
Anticipatory occupant protection
see PRE-SAFE
®
(anticipatory occu‐
pant protection)
see PRE-SAFE
®
PLUS (anticipatory
occupant protection plus)
Apple CarPlay™ ....................................... 324
Connecting an iPhone
®
....................... 325
Ending .................................................326
Notes .................................................. 325
Overview ............................................. 324
Sound settings .................................... 325
Transferred vehicle data ......................327
Ashtray
Front center console ........................... 132
Rear door .............................................132
Assistance graphic
Menu (on-board computer) .................. 248
Assistance systems
see Driving safety system
ASSYST PLUS ........................................... 377
Battery disconnection periods ............. 378
Displaying the service due date ........... 377
Function/notes ................................... 377
Regular service work ........................... 377
Special service requirements .............. 377
ATA (anti-theft alarm system) .................. 86
Deactivating the alarm .......................... 87
Function ................................................ 86
ATTENTION ASSIST ......................... 232, 233
Function ........................
...................... 232
Setti
ng ................................................. 233
System limitations ...............................232
Attention assistant
see ATTENTION ASSIST
Index
521
Audio mode
Activating media mode ........................ 339
Connecting USB devices ...................... 341
Copyright ............................................. 339
Information .......................................... 337
Inserting/removing an SD card ...........339
Media search ....................................... 344
Overview ............................................. 340
Pause and playback function ...............341
Selecting a track .................................. 341
Selecting playback options .................. 341
Track list .............................................. 341
Authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
see Qualified specialist workshop
Authorized workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
Automatic activation
Activating/deactivating .......................237
Automatic distance control
see Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
Automatic driving lights ......................... 144
Automatic engine start (ECO start/
stop function) ........................................... 171
Automatic engine stop (ECO start/
stop function) ........................................... 171
Automatic front-passenger front air
bag deactivation system .....................41, 43
Function of the automatic front
passenger air bag shutoff ......................41
PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lam
p .
....43
Automatic lateral support adjustment
Setting .................................................105
Automatic mirror folding function
Switching on/off .................................154
Automatic transmission
DIRECT SELECT lever ........................... 173
Drive program display .......................... 173
Drive programs .................................... 172
DYNAMIC SELECT switch ..................... 172
Engaging drive position ........................ 175
Engaging reverse gear .........................175
Kickdown ............................................. 177
Manual gear shifting ............................ 176
Selecting park position ........................ 175
Shifting to neutral ................................ 175
Steering wheel gearshift paddles .........176
Transmission position display .............. 173
Transmission positions ........................ 173
B
Bag hook ................................................... 124
BAS (Brake Assist System) .....................189
Battery
SmartKey ............................................... 60
Battery (vehicle)
Charging .............................................. 401
Jump-starting ....................................... 401
Notes .................................................. 399
Belt
see Seat belts
Belt air bag
Activation .............................................. 32
Function/notes .....................................36
Blind Spot Assist ..................................... 238
Activating/deactivating .......................240
Function .............................................. 238
System limitations ...............................238
Blu-ray drive (Rear Seat Entertain‐
ment System)
Overview .............................................366
522
Index
Bluetooth
®
Activating/deactivating .......................279
Setting up an Internet connection ....... 331
Settings ............................................... 279
Switching profile (DUN/PAN) .............. 332
Bluetooth
®
audio
Activating ............................................ 349
De-authorizing (de-registering) the
device .................................................. 349
Information .......................................... 346
Overview .............................................347
Searching for a track ........................... 349
Searching for and authorizing the
device .................................................. 348
Selecting a music player ..................... 349
Switching device via NFC .................... 349
Brake Assist System
see BAS (Brake Assist System)
Brake fluid
Notes ................................................... 451
Brake force distribution
EBD (electronic brake force distribu‐
tion) ..................................................... 192
Brakes
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ........... 189
Active Brake Assist .............................. 192
BAS (Brake Assist System) .................. 189
Driving tips .......................................... 168
EBD (electronic brak
e force dist
ribu‐
tion) ..................................................... 192
HOLD function .....................................210
Limited braking effect (salt-treated
roads) .................................................. 168
New/replaced brake linings/brake
discs .................................................... 168
Notes on breaking-in a new vehicle ..... 168
Braking assistance
see BAS (Brake Assist System)
Breakdown
Assistance overview .............................. 16
Changing a wheel ................................ 437
Roadside Assistance .............................. 21
Tow-starting ........................................ 409
Towing away ........................................ 405
Transporting the vehicle ......................407
Breakdown
see Flat tire
Burmester
®
high-end 3D surround
sound system
Adjusting the balance/fader ............... 360
Adjusting the sound optimization ........ 360
Adjusting treble, mid-range and bass
settings ............................................... 359
Automatic volume adjustment .............360
Calling up the sound menu .................. 359
Information .......................................... 359
Setting the sound profile ..................... 360
Burmester
®
surround sound system .....358
Adjusting the balance/fader ............... 359
Adjusting the sound focus ................... 359
Adjusting treble, mid-range and bass
settings ............................................... 358
Automatic volume adjustment .............359
Calling up the sound menu .................. 358
Information .......................................... 358
Switching the surround sound on/off
.............................................................359
Buttons
Steering wheel .....................................245
Index
523
C
California
Important information for private
customers and lessees ..........................22
Call list
Making a call .......................................322
Options in the call list .......................... 323
Overview ............................................. 322
Calling up the sound menu
Burmester
®
high-end 3D surround
sound system ...................................... 359
Burmester
®
surround sound system ... 358
Calls ..........................................................319
Accepting ............................................. 319
Activating functions during a call ......... 319
Calls with several participants .............319
Declining .............................................. 319
Ending a call ........................................ 319
Incoming call during an existing call .... 320
Making .................................................319
Camera
see 360° camera
see Rear view camera
Car wash
see Care
Car wash (care) ....................................... 385
Care ..........................................................390
Car wash ............................................. 385
Carpet .................................................390
Display ................................................ 390
EASY-PACK trunk box ................
.......... 3
90
Exterior lighting ................................... 389
Genuine wood/trim elements .............390
Headliner ............................................. 390
Matt finish ........................................... 387
Night View Assist ................................ 388
Paint .................................................... 387
Plastic trim .......................................... 390
Power washer ...................................... 385
Rear view camera/360° Camera ........ 389
Seat belts ............................................ 390
Seat cover ........................................... 390
Sensors ............................................... 389
Tailpipes .............................................. 389
Washing by hand ................................. 386
Wheels/rims ....................................... 389
Windows .............................................. 389
Wiper blades .......................................389
Carpet (Care) ...........................................390
Champagne glass ....................................129
Change of address ..................................... 21
Change of ownership ................................ 21
Changing a wheel
Lowering the vehicle ............................441
Mounting a new wheel ........................ 440
Preparation ........................
.................. 437
R
aising the vehicle .............................. 438
Removing a wheel ...............................440
Removing/mounting hub caps ............ 437
Changing hub caps .................................. 437
Channel list
Calling up ............................................ 352
Character entry
Function/notes ................................... 275
On the touchpad .................................. 276
Using the controller ............................. 276
Charging
Battery (vehicle) .................................. 401
Mobile phone (wireless) .......................139
USB port .............................................. 136
524
Index
Chassis level (AIR BODY CONTROL)
Setting .................................................213
Chassis level (MAGIC BODY CON‐
TROL)
Setting .................................................217
Chauffeur mode ......................................... 95
Fully reclined position .......................... 100
Information ............................................ 95
Installing/removing the head restraint .. 97
Moving the front passenger seat into
the chauffeur position ...........................96
Moving the front passenger seat into
the normal position ...............................98
Child safety lock
Rear door .............................................. 55
Rear side windows ................................. 56
Setting ................................................. 283
Child seat
Front passenger seat (notes) ................. 53
Front passenger seat (rearward-
facing/forward-facing) .......................... 54
LATCH-type (ISOFIX) (installing) .............51
LATCH-type (ISOFIX) (notes) .................. 50
Notes ..................................................... 47
Top Tether ..............................................52
Child seat safety feature .......................... 50
Children
Child seat safety feature ........................ 50
Restraint
systems ..
................................47
Cigarette lighter
Front center console ........................... 133
Rear passenger compartment .............133
Cleaning
see Care
Climate control
Activating/deactivating the A/C
function (control panel) .......................158
Activating/deactivating the A/C
function (multimedia system) .............. 158
Activating/deactivating the synchro‐
nization function (multimedia sys‐
tem) ..................................................... 160
Adjusting the climate mode settings ... 158
Air distribution settings .......................159
Air vent, rear center air vent ................ 163
Air vent, rear side air vent ................... 163
Air-recirculation mode .........................160
Automatic control (front) .....................158
Automatic control (rear passenger
compartment) ..................................... 158
Climate style function .......................... 158
Control panel for 3-zone automatic
climate control .................................... 157
Defrosting the windows ....................... 160
Filling capacity for PAG oil ...................453
Front air vents ..................................... 162
Front residual heat .............................. 160
Glove box air vent ................................ 164
Inserting/removing the flacon (fra‐
grance system) ............
.....
................... 161
Ionization ............................................. 161
Rear air vents ...................................... 163
Rear operating unit .............................. 157
Refrigerant .......................................... 453
Refrigerant filling capacity ...................453
Residual heat in the rear ...................... 160
Setting the fragrance system ............... 161
Switching on/off (front) ...................... 158
Switching on/off (rear) ........................ 158
Ventilating the vehicle (convenience
opening) ................................................ 75
Windshield heater ................................ 162
Index
525
Climate style
Function .............................................. 158
Setting ................................................. 158
Cockpit .........................................................6
Overview .................................................6
COMAND
see Multimedia system
COMAND Touch
Managing devices ................................ 282
Combination switch
see Turn signal light
Compass ................................................... 313
Computer
On-board computer ............................. 245
Connection status
Displays ............................................... 334
Overview ............................................. 333
Contacts ................................................... 320
Calling up ............................................ 320
Deleting ............................................... 322
Downloading (from mobile phone) ...... 320
Importing ............................................. 321
Information .......................................... 320
Making a call ....................................... 322
Name format .......................................321
Options ................................................ 322
Storing ................................................ 322
Controller
Operating ............................................ 27
0
Convenience closing feature .................... 75
Convenience opening .....
........................... 75
Coolant (engine)
Filling capacity .................................... 452
Level check ......................................... 383
Notes ................................................... 451
Copyright
Licenses ................................................ 30
Trademarks ............................................ 30
Cornering light function .......................... 146
Cover
see Side windows
Cross Traffic Alert ...................................231
Crosswind Assist
Function/notes .................................... 191
Crosswind Assist
see MAGIC BODY CONTROL
Cruise control .......................................... 196
Buttons ................................................ 197
Calling up a speed ...............................197
Function .............................................. 196
Requirements: .....................................197
Selecting .............................................. 197
Setting a speed .................................... 197
Storing a speed .................................... 197
Switching off ........................................ 197
Switching on ........................................ 197
System limitations ...............................196
Cup holder ................................................ 129
Installing/removing (center console) ... 129
Rear passenger compartment (vehi‐
cles with a rear
bench seat) ................. 130
R
ear passenger compartment (vehi‐
cles with electrically adjustable rear
seats) .................................................. 130
Removing/installing the insert (vehi‐
cles with electrically adjustable rear
seats) .................................................. 130
Switching the cooling/heating func‐
tion on/off ...........................................131
526
Index
Cushionbag ................................................ 38
Customer Assistance Center (CAC) .........25
Customer Relations Department .............25
D
Dashboard
see Cockpit
Dashboard lighting
see Instrument lighting
Data acquisition
Vehicle .................................................. 26
Data import/export
Function/notes ................................... 284
Importing/exporting ........................... 284
Date
Setting the time and date automati‐
cally ..................................................... 278
Daytime running lights ........................... 147
Activating/deactivating .......................147
Daytime running lights mode
see Daytime running lights
Deactivating the alarm (ATA) .................... 87
Declaration of conformity
Wireless vehicle components ................23
Definitions (tires and loading) ............... 430
Designs
Menu (on-board computer) .................. 254
Destination ..............................................305
Editing intermediate destinations ........296
Editing the previous destinations ........ 305
External ...............................................306
Saving (current vehicle position) ......... 305
Saving as global favorite ...................... 305
Storing a map position ........................ 305
Using intelligent destination sugges‐
tions ....................................................306
Destination entry ............................ 292, 29
4
E
nter geo-coordinates .........................295
Entering a POI or address .................... 292
Entering an intermediate destination .. 296
Selecting a contact ............................. 295
Selecting a POI .................................... 294
Selecting from the map ....................... 295
Selecting previous destinations ...........294
Detecting inattentiveness
see ATTENTION ASSIST
Diagnostics connection ............................24
Digital Operator's Manual .........................18
Digital speedometer ................................ 249
DIRECT SELECT lever ............................... 173
Engaging drive position ........................ 175
Engaging park position automatically .. 175
Engaging reverse gear .........................175
Function ............................................... 173
Selecting park position ........................ 175
Shifting to neutral ................................ 175
Display
Care .................................................... 390
Display (multimedia system)
Notes .................................................. 269
Settings ............................................... 277
Display (on-board computer)
Displays in the multifunction display ... 247
Display message ..........................
...........457
C
alling up (on-board computer) ...........457
Notes ................................................... 457
Display messages
C ................................................... 497
Index
527
M ................................................... 497
N ................................................... 498
¯ .................................................... 481
Active Blind Spot Assist Currently
Unavailable See Operator's Manual .....477
Active Blind Spot Assist Inoperative .... 477
Active Blind Spot Asst. Not Available
When Towing a Trailer See Opera‐
tor's Manual ........................................ 477
Active Brake Assist Functions Cur‐
rently Limited See Operator's Man‐
ual .......................................................468
Active Brake Assist Functions Limi‐
ted See Operator's Manual .................. 468
Active Distance Assist Currently
Unavailable See Operator's Manual .....480
Active Distance Assist Inoperative ......480
Active Distance Assist Now Available
.............................................................480
bActive Headlamps Inoperative ..... 499
Active Hood Malfunction See Opera‐
tor's Manual ........................................ 497
Active Lane Keeping Assist Currently
Unavailable See Operator's Manual .....476
Active Lane Keeping Assist Inopera‐
tive .......................................................476
Active Parking Assist and
PARKTRONIC Inoperative See Opera
tor's Manual ........................................ 478
Active Parking Assist Maneuvering
Assistance Restricted See Opera
to
r's Ma
nual ........................................ 479
Active Steering Assist Currently
Unavailable See Operator's Manual .....480
Active Steering Assist Inoperative .......481
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Camera
View Restricted See Operator's Man‐
ual ....................................................... 501
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Currently
Unavailable See Operator's Manual .....500
Adaptive Highbeam Assist Inopera‐
tive ...................................................... 500
Apply Brake to Shift from 'P' ............... 492
ÀATTENTION ASSIST Inoperative ... 474
ÀATTENTION ASSIST: Take a
Break! .................................................. 474
bAuto Lamp Function Inoperative
............................................................. 500
Auxiliary Battery Malfunction .............. 494
Blind Spot Assist Currently Unavaila‐
ble See Operator's Manual .................. 478
Blind Spot Assist Inoperative ............... 478
$ Check Brake Fluid Level .............467
Check Coolant Level See Operator's
Manual ................................................ 482
4Check Engine Oil At Next Refu‐
eling .................................................... 485
bCheck Left Low Beam (exam‐
ple) ...................................................... 499
hCheck Tires ................................. 487
528
Index
¥Check Washer Fluid .................... 498
?Coolant Too Hot Stop Vehicle
Turn Engine Off .................................... 482
Cruise Control Canceled ...................... 481
Cruise Control Inoperative ................... 481
!Currently Unavailable See Oper‐
ator's Manual ...................................... 459
÷Currently Unavailable See Oper‐
ator's Manual .......................................461
¯ DEF System Fault Engine Start
Not Possible ........................................485
¯ DEF System Fault Perf.
Reduced in XXX ml See Operator's
Manual ................................................ 486
¯ DEF System Fault See Opera‐
tor's Manual ........................................ 485
ÂDon't Forget Your Key .................. 491
Driver's Door Open & Transmission
Not in P Risk of Vehicle Rolling Away .. 492
Example: Active Parking Assist Park
ing Canceled .......................................478
Front Passenger Airbag Disabled See
Operator's Manual ...............................473
Front Passenger Airbag Enabled See
Operator's Manual ...............................472
8Fuel Level Low ............................ 486
8Gas Cap Loose ......................
...
... 486
!Inoperative See Operator's
Manual ................................................ 458
÷Inoperative See Operator's
Manual ................................................ 460
TInoperative See Operator's
Manual ................................................ 462
GInoperative ..................................467
ÂKey Not Detected (red display
message) .............................................491
ÂKey Not Detected (white dis‐
play message) .....................................490
Let fresh air into the vehicle interior.
Air Conditioning Malf. Visit Work
shop ....................................................495
Lowering .............................................. 481
Malfunction Drive at Max. 50 mph .......476
bMalfunction See Operator’s
Manual ................................................ 499
Max. Speed 22 mph ............................481
N Permanently Active Risk of Rolling
Away ................................................... 492
ÂObtain a New Key ........................ 490
ëOff ...............................................480
Only Shift to 'P' when Vehicle is Sta‐
tionary .................................................492
FParking Brake See Operator's
Manual ................................................464
Â
Place the Key in the Marked
Space See Operator's Manual ............. 491
hPlease Correct Tire Pressure .......487
F Please Release Parking Brake .... 463
Index
529
PRE-SAFE Inoperative See Opera‐
tor's Manual ........................................ 468
Radar Sensors Dirty See Operator's
Manual ........................................ 469, 470
_Rear Left Backrest Not
Latched (example) ...............................498
ÂReplace Key Battery .................... 490
Reversing Not Possible Service
Required .............................................. 493
#See Operator's Manual ............... 483
Service Required Do Not Shift Gears
Visit Dealer .......................................... 493
6SRS Malfunction Service
Required .............................................. 471
# Start Engine See Operator's
Manual ................................................ 484
ÐSteering Malfunction Drive
Carefully Service Required .................. 495
ÐSteering Malfunction Increased
Physical Effort See Operator's Man‐
ual ....................................................... 496
ÐSteering Malfunction Stop
Immediately See Operator's Manual ... 496
Stop Vehicle Leave Engine Running
Wait Transmission Cooling ...................494
#Stop Vehicle Leave Engine Run‐
ning ..................................................... 484
#Stop Vehicle See Operator's
Manual ..............................
.................. 484
É
Stop Vehicle Vehicle Too Low ...... 475
bSwitch Off Lights ......................... 500
bSwitch On Headlamps ................. 500
Tire Press. Monitor Currently
Unavailable .......................................... 488
Tire Press. Monitor Inoperative ........... 489
Tire Pressure Monitor Inoperative No
Wheel Sensors .................................... 489
To Deselect P or N, Depress Brake
and Start Engine .................................. 492
Traffic Sign Assist Camera View
Restricted See Operator's Manual ....... 479
Traffic Sign Assist Currently Unavail‐
able See Operator's Manual ................ 479
Traffic Sign Assist Inoperative .............479
Transmission Malfunction Stop ........... 493
F Turn On the Ignition to Release
the Parking Brake ................................ 463
dVehicle Operational Switch the
Ignition Off Before Exiting ................... 493
ÉVehicle Rising Please Wait ...........474
ÉVehicle Rising .............................. 474
hWarning Tire Malfunction ............ 488
hWheel Sensor(s) Missing .............489
Display on the windshield
see Head-up Display
Distance control
see Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
530
Index
Distance recorder
see Trip distance
DISTRONIC
see Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
Door
Locking (mechanical key) ...................... 65
Opening (from inside) ............................ 62
Power closing function .......................... 65
Unlocking (from inside) .........................62
Unlocking (mechanical key) ...................65
Door control panel .....................................12
Door control panel (rear passenger
compartment) ............................................ 14
DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN) ... 426
Drinking and driving ................................ 168
Drinks holder
see Cup holder
Drive Away Assist .................................... 230
Drive position
Selecting .............................................. 175
Drive program display ............................. 173
Drive programs
see DYNAMIC SELECT
Driving light
see Automatic driving lights
Driving safety system .............................188
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ........... 189
Active Brake Assist .............................. 192
BAS (Brake Assist System) .................. 189
EBD (electronic brake force distribu‐
tion) .................................
.....
............... 192
ESP
®
(Electronic Stability Program)
Crosswind Assist ................................. 191
Overview ............................................. 188
Radar sensors .....................................188
Responsibility ...................................... 188
STEER CONTROL ................................. 192
Driving system
see 360° camera
see Active Blind Spot Assist
see Active Distance Assist DISTRONIC
see Active Lane Keeping Assist
see Active Parking Assist
see Active Speed Limit Assist
see Active Steering Assist
see AIR BODY CONTROL
see ATTENTION ASSIST
see Blind Spot Assist
see Cruise control
see Driving safety system
see HOLD function
see MAGIC BODY CONTROL
see Night View Assist
see Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
see Rear view camera
see Traffic Sign Assist
Driving tips
Drinking and driving ............................ 168
General driving tips .............................168
Notes on breaking-in a new vehicle ..... 168
Drowsiness detection
see ATTENTION ASSIST
Dynamic handling control system
see ESP
®
(Electronic Stability Program)
DYNAMIC SELECT ....................................172
Configuring drive program I ................. 173
Displaying
engine data .
........................173
Displaying vehicle data ........................ 173
Drive program display ..........................173
Drive programs ....................................172
Index
531
Function ............................................... 172
Operating (DYNAMIC SELECT switch)
.............................................................173
Selecting the drive program ................. 173
E
E10 ...........................................................448
Easy entry feature
Function/notes .................................... 111
Setting ................................................. 112
Easy exit feature
Function/notes .................................... 111
Setting ................................................. 112
EASY-PACK trunk box .............................. 126
Adjusting the height to any position .... 124
Care .................................................... 390
Installing/removing .............................126
EBD (electronic brake force distribu‐
tion)
Function/notes ................................... 192
ECO display
Function ............................................... 172
Resetting ............................................. 250
ECO start/stop function ......................... 171
Automatic engine start ........................ 171
Automatic engine stop .........................171
Method of operation ............................171
Switching off/on ................................. 171
Electric parking brake .............185, 186, 187
Applying automatically ........................ 185
Applying or releasing manually ............ 186
Emergency braking .............................. 187
Releasing automatically .......................186
Electr
ical fuse
s
Before replacing a fuse ........................ 410
Electrical fuses
see Fuses
Electronic Stability Program
see ESP
®
(Electronic Stability Program)
Electronics ............................................... 443
Emergency
Assistance overview .............................. 16
Safety vest .......................................... 393
Emergency braking .................................187
Emergency call system
Mercedes-Benz mbrace
®
(USA) ...........329
Emergency engine start ......................... 409
Emergency operation mode
Starting the vehicle .............................. 167
Emergency release
Trunk lid (from inside) ............................ 71
Emergency Tensioning Devices
Activation .............................................. 32
ENERGIZING comfort
Overview of programs .........................289
Starting the program ........................... 290
Energy consumption
Key ........................................................ 59
Engine
ECO start/stop function ......................171
Engine number .................................... 445
Jump-starting .......................................401
Starting (emergency operation
mode) .................................................. 167
Star
ting (smart
phone) .........................167
Starting (start/stop button) .................166
Switching off (start/stop button) ........ 179
Engine data
Displaying ............................................ 173
532
Index
Engine number ........................................ 445
Engine oil .................................................382
Adding .................................................382
Additives .............................................449
Capacity .............................................. 450
Checking the oil level using the oil
dipstick ................................................ 381
Checking the oil level using the on-
board computer ................................... 381
MB-Freigabe or MB-Approval ...............450
Quality ................................................. 450
ESC (Electronic Stability Control)
see ESP
®
(Electronic Stability Program)
ESP
®
Crosswind Assist ................................. 191
ESP
®
(Electronic Stability Program) ...... 189
Function/notes ................................... 189
Switching on/off ................................. 191
Exterior lighting
Care .................................................... 389
Exterior lighting
see Lights
External device
Locking ...............................................283
F
Fatigue detection
see ATTENTION ASSIST
Favorites
Adding .................................................273
Calling up ............................................ 273
Deleting ...............................................274
Moving .................................................274
Overview ............................................. 273
Renaming ............................................ 273
Flacon
Inserting/removing .............................. 161
Flat tire .....................................................393
Changing a wheel ................................ 437
MOExtended tires ................................ 394
Notes .................................................. 393
TIREFIT kit ...........................................395
Floor mats ................................................ 141
Folding table ............................................ 121
Fragrance
see Fragrance system
Fragrance system .................................... 161
Inserting/removing the flacon .............161
Free software ............................................ 30
Frequencies
Two-way radio ......
.....
..........................444
Frequency band
Dialing (on-board computer) ................ 251
Front air bag (driver, front passenger) .... 38
Front passenger air bag shutoff
see Automatic front-passenger front
air bag deactivation system
Front passenger head restraint
Installing/removing (chauffeur mode) ... 97
Front passenger seat
Adjusting from the driver's seat .............91
Adjusting from the rear passenger
compartment .........................................91
Installing/removing the head
restraint (chauffeur mode) .....................97
Fuel ...........................................................449
Additives .............................................449
Index
533
E10 ...................................................... 448
Gasoline .............................................. 448
Quality (gasoline) ................................ 448
Refuel .................................................. 177
Reserve fuel level ................................ 449
Sulfur content ..................................... 448
Tank capacity ...................................... 449
Fuel consumption
On-board computer .............................249
Function seat
see Door control panel
Function seat (rear passenger com‐
partment)
see Seat (rear passenger compartment)
Fuse insert
see Fuses
Fuses ......................................................... 410
Assignment diagram ............................ 410
Dashboard fuse box ............................. 412
Fuse box in the engine compartment ... 410
Fuse box in the front-passenger foot
well ...................................................... 412
Fuse box in the trunk ........................... 412
Notes ................................................... 410
G
Garage door opener
Clearing the memory ........................... 183
Opening/closing the garage door ........ 183
Programming buttons .......................... 180
Radio equipment approval numbers .... 184
Resolving problems ............................. 182
Synchronizing the rolling code .............182
Gas station search
Starting an automatic gas station
search ................................................. 297
Switching the automatic gas station
search on/off ...................................... 300
Gasoline ................................................... 448
Gearshift paddles
see Steering wheel gearshift paddles
Gearshift recommendation .....................176
Genuine parts ............................................ 19
Genuine wood (Care) .............................. 390
Glass roof
see MAGIC SKY CONTROL
Glasses compartment .............................121
Glide mode ............................................... 177
Glove box
Air vent ................................................ 164
Locking/unlocking .............................. 120
H
Handbrake
see Electric parking brake
Handling characteristics (unusual) ........413
HANDS-FREE ACCESS ................................ 69
Hazard warning lamps ............................ 145
Head restraint .........................................100
Attaching/removing the supplemen‐
tary cushion ........................................ 104
EASY ADJUST luxury head restraint
(front) .................................................. 101
Front (adjusting manually) ...................100
Front (luxury head restraint) ................ 101
Rear (adjusting electrically) .................104
Rear (adjusting) ...................................103
Rear (extending from the front) ........... 102
Rear (folding into position mechani‐
cally) .................................................... 105
Rear (lowering from the front) .............102
534
Index
Rear (luxury head restraint) .................104
Rear (setting the last position) .............103
Head-up Display ...................................... 253
Adjusting brightness (on-board com‐
puter) .................................................. 253
Adjusting display elements (on-board
computer) ............................................ 253
Function .............................................. 254
Menu (on-board computer) .................. 253
Setting the position (on-board com‐
puter) .................................................. 253
Switching on/off ................................. 255
Using the memory function .................. 113
Headlamp flashing .................................. 144
Headliner (care) ....................................... 390
Headphones (Rear Seat Entertain‐
ment System)
Activating/deactivating .......................365
Adjusting the volume ...........................365
Overview ............................................. 364
Replacing batteries .............................365
Selecting a rear passenger compart‐
ment display ........................................ 365
High beam
Switching on/off .................................144
High-beam headlamps
Adaptive Highbeam Assist ...................146
Hill start assist ........................................ 210
HOLD function ......................................... 210
Function/notes ............
........................ 210
Sw
itching on/off ................................. 210
Hood
Function (active hood) ......................... 378
Opening/closing ..................................378
Resetting (active hood) ........................ 378
Hotspot
Setting up (Wi-Fi) ................................. 281
Hydropneumatic suspension
see MAGIC BODY CONTROL
I
Identification plate
Engine .................................................445
Refrigerant .......................................... 453
Vehicle ................................................ 445
Ignition
Switching on (start/stop button) .........165
Ignition key
see SmartKey
Immobilizer ................................................ 86
Indicator lamp
see Warning/indicator lamps
Individual drive program
Configuring .......................................... 173
Selecting .............................................. 173
Instrument cluster
see Instrument display
see Warning/indicator lamps
Instrument display .................................. 244
Adjusting the lighting ........................... 247
Function/notes ................................... 244
Overview ............................................. 244
Warning and indicator lamps (overview) .. 8
Warning/indicator lamps .....................501
Instrument lighting .................................247
Intelligent Light System
Cornering light function .......................146
Interchanging wheels .............................435
Index
535
Interior lighting .......................................148
Ambient lighting .................................. 148
Setting ................................................. 148
Switch-off delay time ........................... 149
Interior lighting
see Interior lighting
Intermediate destination
Calculating a route with intermediate
destinations ........................................ 296
Editing .................................................296
Entering ............................................... 296
Starting an automatic gas station
search ................................................. 297
Starting the automatic service sta‐
tion search .......................................... 300
Internet
Deleting a bookmark ...........................335
Deleting browser data .........................335
Managing bookmarks .......................... 335
Internet connection
Canceling permission .......................... 333
Connection status ...............................333
Displaying the connection status ........ 334
Editing access data .............................333
Establishing .........................................333
Information .......................................... 330
Mobile phone details ...........................333
Restrictions ......................................... 330
Setting access data ............................. 331
Setting
up (
Bluetooth
®
) ........................ 331
Switching Bluetooth
®
profile (DUN/
PAN) .................................................... 332
Via Bluetooth
®
..................................... 331
Via Wi-Fi .............................................. 331
Internet radio
Calling up ............................................ 336
Deleting stations .................................337
Logging in ............................................ 337
Logging out .........................................337
Overview ............................................. 336
Saving stations .................................... 337
Selecting and connecting to a station
.............................................................337
Selecting stream .................................337
Setting options .................................... 337
Terms of use ........................................337
Ionization .................................................. 161
iPhone
®
see Apple CarPlay™
J
Jack
Storage location ..................................436
Jump-start connection ............................ 401
Jump-starting
see Jump-start connection
K
Key
Energy consumption .............................. 59
KEYLESS-GO
Locking the vehicle ................................ 63
Problem .................................................64
Unlocking setting .................................. 59
Unlocking the vehicle ............................63
Kickdown .................................................177
Using ................................................... 177
Knee air bag ...............................................38
536
Index
L
Labeling (tires)
see Tire labeling
Laden
Bag hook .............................................124
Notes ................................................... 118
Roof rack ............................................. 128
Stowage space under the trunk floor ... 127
Lamp
see Interior lighting
Lamp (Instrument Display)
see Warning/indicator lamps
Lane Keeping Assist
see Active Lane Keeping Assist
Language
Notes .................................................. 283
Setting .................................................283
LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat
attachment
Installing ................................................ 51
Notes ..................................................... 50
Level control system
see AIR BODY CONTROL
see MAGIC BODY CONTROL
Light switch
Overview .............................................143
Lighting
see Lights
Lights ........................................................ 143
Adaptive Highbeam Assist ...................146
Adjusting the instrument lighting ......... 247
Automatic driving lights ....................... 144
Combination switch ............................. 144
Cornering light function ....................... 146
Hazard warning lights .......................... 145
Headlamp flashing ..............................
.144
Hi
gh beam ........................................... 144
Light switch .........................................143
Low beam ............................................ 143
Parking lights .......................................143
Rear fog light ....................................... 144
Responsibility for lighting systems ...... 143
Setting the surround lighting ...............147
Standing lights .....................................143
Turn signal light ................................... 144
Limited Warranty
Vehicle .................................................. 26
Live Traffic Information
Displaying subscription information .... 307
Displaying the traffic map ...................307
Displaying traffic incidents .................. 308
Extending a subscription ..................... 307
Issuing hazard alerts ........................... 309
Load index (tires) .................................... 428
Load-bearing capacity (tires) ................. 428
Loading
Definitions ...........................................430
Loading guidelines ................................... 118
Loading information table ...................... 420
Loads
Securing ...............................................118
Locking/unlocking
KEYLESS-GO ....................................
...
... 63
Unlocking and opening doors from
the inside ..............................................62
Low beam
Switching on/off .................................143
Lubricant additives
see Additives
Index
537
Luggage
Net hooks ............................................ 123
Securing ............................................... 118
M
MAGIC BODY CONTROL ...........................214
Setting ................................................. 217
Suspension .......................................... 214
MAGIC SKY CONTROL ...............................81
Function ................................................. 81
Operating ..............................................82
MAGIC VISION CONTROL
Windshield wipers ................................ 151
Maintenance
Vehicle ................................................... 21
Maintenance
see ASSYST PLUS
Making a call via the overhead con‐
trol panel
Mercedes-Benz mbrace
®
(USA) ...........328
Malfunction
Restraint system ................................... 32
Malfunction message
see Display message
Map ...........................................307, 309, 310
Avoiding an area ..................................312
Avoiding an area (overview) .................312
Changing an area .................................312
Deleting an area ...................................313
Displaying the compass ....................... 313
Displaying the map version .................. 312
Displaying the next intersecting
street ................................................... 311
Displaying the satellite map ................. 314
Displaying the traffic map ................... 307
Displaying weather information ...........314
Map data
............................................. 313
Moving .................................................310
Overview ...
.......................................... 309
Selecting POI symbols .........................311
Selecting text information .................... 311
Selecting the map orientation .............. 311
Setting the map scale .......................... 310
Setting the map scale automatically ....314
Updating .............................................. 313
Map and compass
Overview ............................................. 309
Massage programs
Overview .............................................106
Selecting the front seats ..................... 107
Massage settings
Resetting ............................................. 107
Matt finish (cleaning instructions) ........ 387
Maximum load rating .............................. 427
Maximum permissible load
Calculation example ............................ 422
Determining .........................................421
Maximum tire pressure ..........................427
Mechanical key
Inserting/removing ............................... 60
Locking a door ....................................... 65
Unlocking a door ................................... 65
Unlocking the trunk lid .......................... 71
Media
Menu (on-board computer) .................. 252
Searchin
g ............................................ 344
Starting cinema mode .........................349
Media display
Notes .................................................. 269
538
Index
Media Interface
Activating ............................................ 345
Information .......................................... 344
Overview .............................................346
Media mode
Activating ............................................ 339
Media playback
Operating (on-board computer) ........... 252
Media search
Starting ...............................................344
Media source
Dialing (on-board computer) ................ 252
Memory function
Head-up Display Calling up saved
settings ................................................ 113
Head-up Display Saving settings ....... 113
Operating ............................................. 113
Outside mirror Calling up saved
settings ................................................ 113
Outside mirror Saving settings .......... 113
Seat Calling up saved settings .......... 113
Seat Saving settings ......................... 113
Steering wheel Calling up saved
settings ................................................ 113
Steering wheel Saving settings ......... 113
Memory function in the rear
passenger compartment
Operating rear seats ............................ 114
Operating the front passenger seat
and rear seat ........................................ 116
Menu (on-board computer)
Assistance graphic .............................. 248
Designs ............................................... 254
Head
-up Display .................................. 253
Media .................................................. 252
Navigation ...........................................250
Overview ............................................. 245
Radio ...................................................251
Service ................................................ 248
Telephone ............................................ 252
Trip ...................................................... 249
Mercedes-AMG vehicles
Notes ................................................... 165
Mercedes-Benz Apps
Calling up ............................................ 334
Using voice control .............................. 334
Mercedes-Benz mbrace
®
(USA)
Emergency call system ........................ 329
Making a call via the overhead con‐
trol panel ............................................. 328
MB Info call ......................................... 329
Roadside Assistance call ..................... 330
Transferred data ..................................330
Message (multifunction display)
see Display message
Message memory ....................................457
Messages
see Text messages
Mirrors
see Outside mirrors
Mobile phone
Canceling permission for Internet
connection .......................................... 333
Wireless charging ................................ 140
Wireless chargin
g (rear passen
ger
compartment) ...................................... 140
Mobile phone
see Android Auto
see Apple CarPlay™
see Telephone
Index
539
Mobile phone voice recognition
Starting ................................................ 319
Stopping ..............................................319
Model type ............................................... 445
MOExtended tires .................................... 394
Multifunction camera
ROAD SURFACE SCAN .........................216
Multifunction display (on-board com‐
puter) ........................................................ 247
Multifunction steering wheel
Overview of buttons ............................ 245
Multifunction steering wheel
see Steering wheel
Multimedia system .........................269, 277
Activating/deactivating standby
mode ...................................................187
Adjusting the volume ...........................275
Central control elements .....................269
Configuring display settings ................277
ENERGIZING comfort program over‐
view ..................................................... 289
Main functions ..................................... 272
Overview ............................................. 269
Rear climate control ............................ 159
Restoring the factory settings ............. 288
Setting the footwell temperature .........
159
Start
ing the ENERGIZING comfort
program ..............................................290
Switching the sound on or off .............. 274
N
Navigation
Calling up the Digital Operator's
Manual .................................................314
Menu (on-board computer) .................. 250
Showing/hiding the menu ...................291
Switching on ........................................ 291
Updating the map data ........................ 313
Voice commands (Voice Control Sys‐
tem) ..................................................... 260
Navigation
see Destination
see Destination entry
see Map
see Route
see Route guidance
see Traffic information
Navigation announcements
Activating/deactivating .......................302
Adjusting the volume ...........................303
Repeating ............................................ 304
Switching audio fadeout on/off .......... 303
Switching on/off during a phone call .. 302
Navigation messages
On-board computer ............................. 250
Near Field Communication (NFC) ...........317
Connecting the mobile phone to the
multimedia system ...............................317
Switching Bluetooth
®
audio equip‐
ment .................................................... 349
Switching mobile phones .....................317
Neutral
Selecting .............................................. 175
NFC
see Near Field Communication (NFC)
Night view
see Night View Assist
Night View Assist ........
...
......................... 235
Activating/deactivating .......................236
Automatic activation ........................... 237
Care .................................................... 388
540
Index
Function .............................................. 235
Pedestrian detection ........................... 236
Spotlight function ................................ 237
Notes on breaking-in a new vehicle .......168
O
Occupant safety
Pets in the vehicle ................................. 56
Occupant safety
see Air bag
see Automatic front-passenger front
air bag deactivation system
see PRE-SAFE
®
(anticipatory occu‐
pant protection)
see PRE-SAFE
®
PLUS (anticipatory
occupant protection plus)
see Restraint system
see Seat belts
Odometer
see Total distance
Oil
see Engine oil
On-board computer
Assistance graphic menu .................... 248
Displaying the service due date ........... 377
Head-up Display menu ........................ 253
Media menu ........................................ 252
Menu designs ...................................... 254
Menu overview .................................... 245
Multifunction display ........................... 247
Navigation system menu ..................... 250
Operating ............................................ 245
Radio menu .........................................251
Service menu ...................................... 248
Telephone menu .................................. 252
Trip menu ............................................ 249
On-board diagnostics interface
see Diagnostics connection
Open-source software .............................. 30
Opening the trunk lid using your foot
HANDS-FREE ACCESS ...........................69
Operating fluids
Additives
(fuel) .
................................... 449
Brake fluid ...........................................451
Coolant (engine) .................................. 451
Engine oil ............................................ 449
Fuel (gasoline) .....................................448
Notes ................................................... 447
Refrigerant (air conditioning system) ... 453
Windshield washer fluid ...................... 452
Operating safety
Declaration of conformity (wireless
vehicle components) ............................. 23
Information ............................................ 22
Operating system
On-board computer .............................245
Operator's Manual
Vehicle equipment ................................. 20
Operator's Manual (digital) ....................... 18
Outside mirrors ....................... 152, 153, 154
Anti-glare mode (automatic) ................153
Automatic mirror folding function ........ 154
Folding in/out .....................................152
Parking position ...................................154
Setting ................................................. 152
Using the memory function .................. 11
3
Overhead cont
rol panel
Overview ............................................... 10
P
Paint (cleaning instructions) .................. 387
Index
541
Paint code ................................................ 445
Panel heating
Setting .................................................109
Panic alarm ................................................ 59
Activating/deactivating ......................... 59
Panoramic sliding sunroof
see Sliding sunroof
Parcel net hooks ...................................... 123
Park position
Selecting .............................................. 175
Selecting automatically ........................ 175
Parking .....................................................187
Parking
see Electric parking brake
Parking aid
see Parking Assist PARKTRONIC
Parking Assist
Maneuvering assistance ...................... 232
Parking Assist PARKTRONIC ................... 218
Activating ............................................ 220
Adjusting warning tones ...................... 221
Deactivating ........................................ 220
Function ............................................... 218
Side impact protection .........................219
System limitations ...............................218
Parking assistance systems
see Active Parking Assist
Parking brake
see Electric parking brake
Parking lights ...........................................143
Parking position
Outside mirrors ................................... 154
Storing the position of the passenger
outside mirror using reverse gear ......
.. 154
PASSENGER AIR BAG status display
see Automa
tic front-passenger front
air bag deactivation system
Payload
Calculation example ............................ 422
Determining the maximum .................. 421
Pedestrian protection
see Active hood (pedestrian protection)
Pennant holder ......................................... 141
Perfume
see Fragrance system
Perfume atomizer
Setting .................................................161
Perfume vial
see Fragrance system
Period out of use
Activating/deactivating standby
mode ...................................................187
Permitted towing methods .....................404
Personalization
see User profile
Pets in the vehicle .....................................56
Phone book
see Contacts
Picture formats
see Video mode
Picture settings
see Video mode
PIN protection
Activating/deactivating .......................285
Plastic trim (Care) ................................... 390
Playback options
Selecting .............................................. 341
542
Index
POI symbols
Custom ................................................ 311
Ports (Rear Seat Entertainment Sys‐
tem)
Overview .............................................367
Power closing function
Door ...................................................... 65
Trunk lid .................................................67
Power supply
Switching on (start/stop button) .........165
Power washer (care) ...............................385
PRE-SAFE
®
(anticipatory occupant
protection) .................................................45
Function ................................................ 45
PRE-SAFE
®
Sound ................................. 45
Reversing the measures ........................ 46
PRE-SAFE
®
PLUS (anticipatory occu‐
pant protection plus) ................................ 46
Function ................................................ 46
Reversing the measures ........................ 46
Preventative occupant protection sys‐
tem
see PRE-SAFE
®
(anticipatory occu‐
pant protection)
Previous destinations
Selecting .............................................294
Programs
see DYNAMIC SELECT
Protecting the environment
Notes ..................................................... 19
Q
QR code
Rescue card .......................................... 26
Qualified specialist workshop ................. 25
R
Radar sensors .......................................... 188
Radio
Activating ............................................ 350
Activating/deactivating radio text ....... 353
Calling up the channel list ...................352
Deleting stations .................................352
Direct frequency entry ........................ 352
Displaying information .........................353
Displaying radio text ............................ 353
Editing station presets .........................352
Menu (on-board computer) .................. 251
Moving stations ...................................352
Overview .............................................. 351
Searching for stations .........................352
Setting a station .................................. 352
Setting the waveband .......................... 352
Storing radio stations .......................... 352
Switching HD Radio on/off .................352
Tagging music tracks ........................... 353
Voice commands (Voice Control Sys‐
tem) ..................................................... 263
Radio stations
Dialing (on-board computer) ................251
Rain closing function
Sliding sunroof ...................................... 80
Range
Displaying ............................................
249
Reading l
amp
see Interior lighting
Index
543
Rear climate control
Setting ................................................. 159
Rear display
Activating/deactivating .......................283
Locking ............................................... 283
Overview ............................................. 362
Rear door (child safety lock) .................... 55
Rear fog light ...........................................144
Rear passenger compartment display
Setting the angle ................................. 362
Rear passenger compartment Inter‐
net functions
Overview ............................................. 370
Rear Seat Entertainment System
Activating media mode ........................ 374
Activating/deactivating the panel
heating ................................................ 368
Adjusting the ambient lighting .............368
Adjusting the rear seats ...................... 367
Blu-ray drive ........................................ 366
Blu-ray functions overview ...................374
Blu-ray/DVD menu .............................. 374
Climate control .................................... 367
Displaying destination information
(navigation) .........................................369
Dynamic range limitation ..................... 376
ENERGIZING comfort .......................... 368
Entertainment system settings
.....
....... 368
Headphones overview .........................364
Information about dynamic range
limitation ............................................. 376
Information about media mode ........... 370
Inserting a disc .................................... 373
Internet connectivity status .................370
Internet functions overview .................370
Operating safety .................................. 360
Overview .............................................. 361
Overview of massage and workout
programs ............................................. 367
Overview of the sound settings ............ 376
Playback option in Blu-ray/DVD
mode ................................................... 375
Ports overview .....................................367
Re-establishing an Internet connec‐
tion ...................................................... 370
Rear display overview .......................... 362
Remote control overview .....................362
Resetting the rear seat ........................ 367
Selecting a film/track in Blu-
ray/DVD mode .................................... 375
Selecting a massage pr
ogram ...
..........367
Selecting the scene/chapter in Blu-
ray/DVD mode .................................... 375
Setting the language ........................... 369
Switching navigation on ......................369
Switching off the display ..................... 369
Switching on the radio .........................376
Switching to HDMI mode ..................... 375
Rear view camera ....................................222
Assigning as a favorite (360° Cam‐
era) ...................................................... 226
Function .............................................. 222
Opening the camera cover (360°
Camera) ..............................................226
Rear view camera/ 360° Camera
Care .................................................... 389
Rear window
Roller sunblind .......................................72
Rear-view mirror
see Outside mirrors
Refrigerant (air conditioning system)
Notes .................................................. 453
544
Index
Refrigerator box
Installing/removing ............................. 138
Using ................................................... 137
Refueling
Refueling the vehicle ........................... 177
Remote control (Rear Seat Entertain‐
ment System)
Overview .............................................362
Replacing batteries .............................. 364
Selecting a display .............................. 363
Switching the display on/off ............... 363
Reporting malfunctions relevant to
safety .......................................................... 25
Rescue card ............................................... 26
Reserve
Fuel ..................................................... 449
Reset function (multimedia system) .....288
Residual heat
Front ....................................................160
Rear .....................................................160
Restoring (factory settings)
see Reset function (multimedia system)
Restraint system .......................................31
Children .................................................47
Function in an accident ......................... 32
Functionality ..........................
................ 32
M
alfunction ........................................... 32
Protection ..............................................31
Reduced protection ...............................31
System self-test .....................................32
Warning lamp ........................................ 32
Reverse gear
Selecting .............................................. 175
Rims (Care) .............................................. 389
ROAD SURFACE SCAN
Multifunction camera ...........................216
Roadside Assistance ................................. 21
Roadside Assistance call
Mercedes-Benz mbrace
®
(USA) ........... 330
Roll away protection
see HOLD function
Roller sunblind
Rear window .......................................... 72
Side windows (electric) .......................... 72
Roof load .................................................. 455
Roof rack .................................................. 128
Route ................................................ 297, 300
Calculating .......................................... 297
Displaying destination information ...... 299
Displaying destination information
(Rear Seat Entertainment System) ...... 369
External ...............................................306
Selecting a type .................................. 298
Selecting an alternative route .............300
Selecting notifications ......................... 299
Selecting options ................................ 299
Starting the automatic service st
a‐
t
ion search .......................................... 300
Switching the automatic gas station
search on/off ...................................... 300
With intermediate destinations ...........296
Route guidance ....................................... 300
Canceling ............................................ 304
Changing direction .............................. 301
Destination reached ............................ 302
From an off-road location .................... 304
Lane recommendations ....................... 302
Notes .................................................. 300
Off-road ............................................... 304
To an off-road destination ...................304
Index
545
Route-based speed adjustment .............203
Displays in the Instrument Display ...... 208
Setting .................................................204
Run-flat characteristics
MOExtended tires ................................ 394
S
Safety systems
see Driving safety system
Safety vest ............................................... 393
Satellite map ............................................ 314
Satellite radio
Activating/deactivating Tune Start ...... 357
Deleting a channel ...............................356
Displaying EPG information .................356
Displaying service information ............ 357
Information .......................................... 353
Information on smart favorites and
Tune Start ............................................ 357
Logging in ............................................ 353
Moving a channel ................................ 356
Music and sport alerts function .......... 356
Overview .............................................355
Pause and playback function ...............357
Restrictions ......................................... 353
Selecting a category ............................ 356
Selecting a channel .............................356
Setting music and sport alerts ............ 356
Setting the parental control ................. 356
Storing a channel ................................ 356
Switching on ....
...
................................. 354
SD card
Inserting/removing .............................339
Seat
Adjusting (electrically) ...........................89
Adjusting (Seat Comfort) ....................... 93
Adjusting a reclining rear seat ...............93
Adjusting the front passenger seat
from the rear passenger compartment .. 91
Adjusting the front-passenger seat
from the driver’s seat ............................91
Configuring settings ............................105
Correct driver's seat position ................ 88
Massage program overview .................106
Panel heating ....................................... 109
Rear passenger compartment
(adjusting electrically) ...........................93
Resetting the settings .......................... 107
Selecting a massage program .............. 107
Setting automatic lateral support
adjustment .......................................... 105
Setting options ...................................... 12
Setting the reclined position .................. 94
Using the memory function .................. 113
Seat
see Chauffeur mode
see Head restraint
Seat (rear passenger compartment) ....... 14
Setting options ...................................... 14
Seat belt ..................................................... 38
Activating/deactivating seat belt
ad
justme
nt ............................................ 38
Belt air bag ............................................ 36
Reduced protection ...............................34
Releasing ...............................................38
Seat belt adjustment (function) ............. 36
Seat belt buckle extender ...................... 37
Warning lamp ........................................ 38
Seat belt adjustment
Activating/deactivating ......................... 38
Function ................................................ 36
Seat belt buckle extender ........................ 37
546
Index
Seat belt warning
see Seat belt
Seat belts ...................................................33
Adjusting the height .............................. 36
Care ....................................................390
Fastening ............................................... 36
Protection ..............................................33
Seat cover (Care) .....................................390
Seat heater
Switching on/off ................................. 107
Seat ventilation
Switching on/off ................................. 109
Selecting a gear
see Shifting gears
Selecting a POI
see Destination entry
Selector lever
see DIRECT SELECT lever
Sensors (Care) ......................................... 389
Service
Menu (on-board computer) .................. 248
Service
see ASSYST PLUS
Service center
see Qualified specialist workshop
Service interval display
see ASSYST PLUS
Setting a speed
see Cruise control
Setting summer time .............................. 278
Setting the date format .......................... 278
Setting the distance unit ........................ 284
Setting the footwell temperature
Setting .................................................159
Setting the map scale
see Map
Setting the sound profile
Burmester
®
high-end 3D surround
sound system ...........
........................... 360
Shifting gears ...........................................176
Gearshift recommendation .................. 176
Manual .................................................176
Short text messages
see Text messages
Side air bag ................................................ 38
Side impact protection ............................ 219
Side windows ....................................... 72, 73
Child safety lock in the rear
passenger compartment .......................56
Closing .................................................. 73
Closing using the SmartKey ................... 75
Convenience closing feature .................75
Convenience opening ............................ 75
Opening .................................................73
Opening with the SmartKey ................... 75
Problem .................................................76
Roller sunblind (electric) ........................ 72
Size designation (tires) ........................... 428
Skid chains
see Snow chains
Sliding sunroof .......................................... 77
Automatic features ................................ 80
Closing .................................................. 77
Closing using the SmartKey ................... 75
MAGIC SKY CONTROL (function) ........... 81
MAGIC SKY CO
NTROL (opera
ting) .........82
Opening .................................................77
Opening with the SmartKey ................... 75
Problem .................................................83
Index
547
Rain closing function .............................80
SmartKey ................................................... 58
Battery .................................................. 60
Features ................................................ 58
Key ring attachment .............................. 60
Mechanical key ...................................... 60
Overview ...............................................58
Panic alarm ........................................... 59
Problem ................................................. 61
Unlocking setting .................................. 59
Smartphone
Cooling or heating the vehicle inte‐
rior .......................................................166
Starting the vehicle .............................. 167
Smartphone
see Android Auto
see Apple CarPlay™
see Telephone
Snow chains ............................................. 414
Socket (12 V) ............................................ 134
Front center console ........................... 134
Rear passenger compartment .............134
Trunk ...................................................136
Socket (115 V) .......................................... 135
Rear passenger compartment .............135
Software update
Important system updates .................. 288
Information .......................................... 287
Performing ............
.............................. 287
Sound
PRE-SAFE
®
Sound ................................. 45
Wheels and tires ..................................413
Sound
see Burmester
®
surround sound system
see Sound settings
Sound settings ........................................357
Adjusting the balance/fader ............... 358
Adjusting treble, mid-range and bass
settings ............................................... 358
Automatic volume adjustment .............358
Calls up the sound menu ..................... 358
Information .......................................... 357
Speech dialog system
see Voice Control System
Speed index (tires) ..................................428
Speed limit for winter tires
Setting ................................................. 198
Speedometer
Digital ..................................................249
Spotlight function
Activating/deactivating .......................238
Standby mode
Activating/deactivating .......................187
Function .............................................. 187
Standing lights ........................................ 143
Start/Stop button
Starting the vehicle ............................. 166
Switching off the vehicle ..................... 179
Switching on the power supply or
ignition ................................................ 165
Start/stop function
see ECO start/stop function
Starting the engine
see Vehicle
Starting-off aid
see Hill start assist
Station
Deleting
............................................... 352
548
Index
Direct frequency entry ........................ 352
Moving ................................................ 352
Searching ............................................ 352
Setting .................................................352
Storing ................................................ 352
Station presets
Editing ................................................. 352
STEER CONTROL
Function/notes ................................... 192
Steering wheel .........................................245
Adjusting (electrically) .........................110
Buttons ................................................ 245
Steering wheel heater .......................... 111
Using the memory function .................. 113
Steering wheel gearshift paddles .......... 176
Steering wheel heater
Switching on/off .................................. 111
Stowage areas
see Stowage compartment
Stowage compartment ........................... 120
Armrest ............................................... 120
Center console .................................... 120
Door .................................................... 120
Folding table ........................................ 121
Glasses compartment .......................... 121
Glove box .............................................120
Parcel net hooks ..................................123
Rear armrest ..........
...
........................... 121
Rear seat backrest .............................. 122
Rear-compartment center armrest ......122
Stowage compartments
see Stowage compartment
Stowage space under the trunk floor .... 127
Sulfur content ......................................... 448
Sun visor
Operating ............................................ 155
Surround lighting
Setting .................................................147
Surround View
see 360° camera
Suspension
Adjusting the chassis level (AIR
BODY CONTROL) .................................213
Adjusting the chassis level (MAGIC
BODY CONTROL) .................................217
Suspension
see AIR BODY CONTROL
see MAGIC BODY CONTROL
Switch-off delay time
Interior .................................................149
Switching the surround sound on/off
Burmester
®
surround sound system ... 359
Synchronization function
Activating/deactivating (multimedia
system) ................................................ 160
System self-test
Automatic front-passenger front air
bag deactivation system ........................ 43
System settings
Language .............................................283
Notes on language selection ............... 283
Reset function (multimedia syst
em) ..
..288
Setting the distance unit ..................... 284
Software update .................................. 287
System settings
see Multimedia system
Index
549
T
Table
see Folding table
Tailpipes (Care) ........................................ 389
Tank capacity
Fuel ..................................................... 449
Reserve (fuel) ...................................... 449
Technical data
Information .......................................... 443
Tire pressure monitoring system ......... 420
Vehicle identification plate .................. 445
Telephone .........................................252, 315
Activating functions during a call ......... 319
Call and ringtone volume .....................318
Calls with several participants .............319
Connecting a mobile phone (Near
Field Communication (NFC)) ................ 317
Connecting a mobile phone (Pass‐
key) ...................................................... 316
Connecting a mobile phone (Secure
Simple Pairing) .....................................316
Disconnecting a mobile phone .............317
Importing contacts .............................. 321
Incoming call during an existing call .... 320
Menu (on-board computer) .................. 252
Mobile phone voice recognition ........... 319
Notes ...............
.................................... 316
Operating modes ...
.............................. 315
Reception and transmission volume .... 318
Switching mobile phones ..................... 317
Switching mobile phones (Near Field
Communication (NFC)) ........................ 317
Telephone menu overview ...................315
Telephone operation ............................ 319
Using Near Field Communication
(NFC) ................................................... 317
Voice commands (Voice Control Sys‐
tem) ..................................................... 262
Wireless charging (mobile phone in
the rear passenger compartment) .......140
Wireless charging (mobile phone) ........ 140
Telephone number
Dialing (on-board computer) ................ 252
Telephony operating modes
Bluetooth
®
Telephony .......................... 315
Temperature grade .................................. 425
Text messages ......................................... 323
Calling a message sender .................... 324
Changing folders .................................324
Composing .......................................... 323
Configuring the displayed text mes‐
sages ................................................... 323
Deleting ..................
............................. 324
Drafts .................................................. 324
Notes .................................................. 323
Options ................................................ 324
Outbox .................................................324
R
ead-aloud function ............................ 323
Reading ...............................................323
Replying ...............................................324
Sending ............................................... 323
Voice commands (Voice Control Sys‐
tem) ..................................................... 266
Time
Manual time setting ............................. 278
Setting summer time ........................... 278
Setting the time and date automati‐
cally ..................................................... 278
Setting the time zone .......................... 278
Setting the time/date format .............. 278
TIN (Tire Identification Number) ............426
Tire and Loading Information placard ... 420
550
Index
Tire characteristics ................................. 428
Tire inflation compressor
see TIREFIT kit
Tire information table .............................420
Tire labeling .............................................425
Characteristics .................................... 428
DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN)
.............................................................426
Load index ...........................................428
Load-bearing capacity ......................... 428
Maximum tire load .............................. 427
Maximum tire pressure ....................... 427
Overview ............................................. 425
Speed rating ........................................ 428
Temperature grade .............................. 425
Tire Quality Grading ............................. 425
Tire size designation ............................428
Traction grade .....................................425
Tread wear grade .................................425
Tire load (maximum) ...............................427
Tire pressure ............................................ 417
Checking (manually) .............................417
Checking (tire pressure monitoring
system) ................................................ 419
Maximum ............................................ 427
Notes ................................................... 414
Restarting the tire pr
essure mon
itor‐
ing system ...........................................420
Tire pressure monitoring system
(function) ............................................. 418
Tire pressure table ...............................416
TIREFIT kit ...........................................395
Tire pressure monitor
Checking the tire pressures ................. 419
Function ............................................... 418
Restarting ............................................ 420
Tire pressure monitoring system
Technical data ..................................... 420
Tire pressure table .................................. 416
Tire Quality Grading ................................ 425
Tire tread .................................................. 413
Tire-change tool kit
Overview .............................................436
TIREFIT kit ................................................ 395
Storage location ..................................395
Using ................................................... 395
Tires
Changing hub caps .............................. 437
Characteristics .................................... 428
Checking .............................................. 413
Checking the tire pressure (man‐
ually) ................................................
....417
Check
ing the tire pressure (tire pres‐
sure monitoring system) ......................419
Definitions ........................................... 430
DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN)
.............................................................426
Flat tire ................................................ 393
Load index ...........................................428
Load-bearing capacity .........................428
Maximum tire load .............................. 427
Maximum tire pressure ....................... 427
MOExtended tires ................................ 394
Mounting ............................................. 440
Noise ...................................................413
Notes on mounting .............................. 433
Overview of tire labeling ......................425
Removing ............................................ 440
Replacing .................................... 433, 437
Restarting the tire pressure monitor‐
ing system ...........................................420
Selection ............................................. 433
Index
551
Snow chains .........................................414
Speed rating ........................................ 428
Storing ................................................ 436
Temperature grade .............................. 425
Tire and Loading Information placard
.............................................................420
Tire pressure (notes) ............................414
Tire pressure monitoring system
(function) ............................................. 418
Tire pressure table ...............................416
Tire Quality Grading ............................. 425
Tire size designation ............................428
TIREFIT kit ...........................................395
Traction grade .....................................425
Tread wear grade .................................425
Unusual handling characteristics .........413
Tool
see Vehicle tool kit
Top Tether .................................................. 52
Total distance .......................................... 249
Displaying ............................................ 249
Touch Control
On-board computer ............................. 245
Operating ........................
.................... 270
Setti
ng the sensitivity .......................... 270
Touchpad
Activating/deactivating .......................271
Operating ............................................. 271
Reading the handwriting recognition
aloud ................................................... 272
Selecting a station and track ...............272
Setting the sensitivity .......................... 272
Tow-starting ............................................. 409
Towing a trailer
Active Blind Spot Assist ....................... 239
Active Lane Keeping Assist .................. 240
Towing away ............................................ 405
Towing eye
Installing .............................................. 409
Storage location ..................................409
Towing methods ...................................... 404
Track
Selecting (audio mode) ........................ 341
Traction grade ......................................... 425
Traffic information .................................. 306
Displaying the traffic map ...................307
Displaying traffic incidents .................. 308
Issuing hazard alerts ........................... 309
Live Traffic Information ........................ 307
Overview ............................................. 306
Traffic map
see Map
Traffic Sign Assist ...................................233
Function/notes ..................
................. 233
Setting .................................................235
System limitat
ions ...............................233
Transferred vehicle data
Android Auto ....................................... 327
Apple CarPlay ................................... 327
Transmission position display ................ 173
Transporting
Loading guidelines ...............................118
Vehicle .................................................407
Tread wear grade ..................................... 425
Trim element (Care) ................................ 390
Trip
Menu (on-board computer) .................. 249
Trip computer
Displaying ............................................ 249
Resetting ............................................. 250
552
Index
Trip distance ............................................ 249
Displaying ............................................ 249
Resetting ............................................. 250
Trip odometer
see Trip distance
Trunk box
see EASY-PACK trunk box
Trunk lid
Activating/deactivating the trunk lid
opening height restriction ...................... 71
Closing .................................................. 67
Emergency release (from inside) ............ 71
HANDS-FREE ACCESS ...........................69
Locking separately ................................ 70
Opening ................................................. 66
Opening dimensions ............................ 454
Power closing function .......................... 67
Unlocking (mechanical key) ...................71
Turn signal indicator
see Turn signal light
Turn signal light ....................................... 144
Switching on/off ................................. 144
Two-way radios
Frequencies ......................................... 444
Notes on installation ...........................443
Transmission output (maximum) .........444
U
Units of measurement
Setting .................................................284
Unlocking setting ...................................... 59
USB devices
Connecting .......................................... 341
USB port ...................................................136
User profile .............................................. 285
Creating .............................................. 286
Importing/exporting ........................... 286
Options ................................................ 286
Selecting ............................................. 285
Using the telephone
see Calls
V
Vehicle .............................................. 166, 167
Activating/deactivating standby
mode ...................................................187
Correct use ........................................... 25
Data acquisition .................................... 26
Diagnostics connection ......................... 24
Equipment ............................................. 20
Limited Warranty ...................................26
Locking (automatically) ......................... 64
Locking (from inside) .............................63
Locking (KEYLESS-GO) .......................... 63
Locking (mechanical key) ...................... 64
Lowering .............................................. 441
Maintenance .......................................... 21
Parking ................................................ 187
Problem notification .............................. 25
QR code rescue card ............................. 26
Qualified specialist workshop ................25
Raising ................................................ 438
Starting (emergency operation
mode) .................................................. 167
Starting (smartphone) .........................167
Starting (start/stop button) .................166
Switching off (start/stop button) ........ 179
Unlocking (from inside) ..
...
....................63
Unlocking (KEYLESS-GO) .......................63
Ventilating (convenience opening) ......... 75
Voice commands (Voice Control Sys‐
tem) ..................................................... 267
Index
553
Vehicle data
Displaying (DYNAMIC SELECT) ............ 173
Roof load ............................................. 455
Turning radius ...................................... 454
Vehicle height ...................................... 454
Vehicle length ...................................... 454
Vehicle width ....................................... 454
Wheelbase ...........................................454
Vehicle data storage
COMAND/mbrace ................................. 28
Electronic control units .........................26
Event data recorders ............................. 29
Service providers .................................. 28
Vehicle dimensions ................................. 454
Vehicle electronics
Notes .................................................. 443
Two-way radios .................................... 443
Vehicle identification number
see VIN
Vehicle identification plate
Paint code ...........................................445
VIN ...................................................... 445
Vehicle identification plate
see Model type
Vehicle interior
Cooling or heating (smartphone) .........166
Vehicle key
see SmartKey
Vehicle maintenance
see ASSYST PLUS
Vehicle
operati
on
Outside the USA or Canada ...................21
Vehicle position
Transmitting ........................................ 279
Vehicle tool kit ........................................ 395
TIREFIT kit ...........................................395
Towing eye .......................................... 409
Ventilating
Convenience opening ............................ 75
Vents
see Air vents
Video mode .............................................. 344
Activating ............................................ 342
Activating/deactivating full-screen
mode ................................................... 344
Overview .............................................343
Settings ............................................... 344
VIN ............................................................ 445
Identification plate .............................. 445
Seat ..................................................... 445
Windshield ........................................... 445
Visibility
Defrosting the windows ....................... 160
Windshield heater ................................ 162
Voice command types (Voice Control
System) .................................................... 257
Voice Control System .............................256
Application-specific voice commands
.............................................................257
Audible help functions .........................258
Entering numbers ................................ 258
Global voice com
mands .
..................... 257
Improving speech quality .................... 258
Language setting .................................258
Media player voice commands ............ 264
Message voice commands .................. 266
Multifunction steering wheel (operat
ing) ...................................................... 256
Navigation voice commands ................ 260
Operable functions .............................. 257
Operating safety .................................. 256
Radio voice commands .......................263
554
Index
Switch voice commands ...................... 259
Telephone voice controls .....................262
Text message voice commands ...........266
Types of voice commands ...................257
Vehicle voice commands .....................267
Voice prompting .................................. 257
Voice control system
see Voice Control System
W
Warning lamp
see Warning/indicator lamps
Warning system
see ATA (anti-theft alarm system)
Warning/indicator lamp
!ABS warning lamp .......................505
àAir suspension warning lamp .......511
$Brake warning lamp (USA) ...........503
JBrakes warning lamp (Canada) .... 503
?Coolant warning lamp .................. 515
·Distance warning lamp .................511
#Electrical malfunction warning
lamp .....................................................513
;Engine diagnosis warning lamp .... 513
åESP
®
OFF warning lamp .............. 507
÷ESP
®
warning lamp flashes .........505
÷ESP
®
warning lamp lights up .......506
8Fuel reserve warning lamp ...513, 514
ÐPower steering system warning
lamp .....................................................512
!Red indicator lamp, electric
parking brake applied (Canada only) ...508
FRed indicator lamp, electric
parking brake applied (USA only) ........ 508
6Restraint system warning lamp ...509
7Seat belt warning lamp flashes .... 510
7Seat belt wa
rnin
g lamp lights
up ........................................................ 510
hTire pressure monitoring sys‐
tem warning lamp flashes .................... 518
hTire pressure monitoring sys‐
tem warning lamp lights up .................. 517
!Yellow electric parking brake
indicator lamp is malfunctioning .........508
Warning/indicator lamps ...................8, 501
Instrument Display (overview) .................8
Overview ..............................................501
PASSENGER AIR BAG ............................ 43
Warranty .................................................... 26
Washer fluid
see Windshield washer fluid
Washing by hand (care) .......................... 386
Weather information ............................... 314
Web browser
Calling up a web page .........................334
Calling up options ............................... 335
Calling up the settings .........................335
Deleting a bookmark ........................... 335
Deleting browser data .........................335
Ending ................................................. 336
Managing bookmarks .......................... 335
Overview ............................................. 335
Showing/hiding the menu ...................334
Index
555
Website
Calling up ............................................ 334
Showing/hiding the web browser
menu ................................................... 334
Wheel chock ............................................ 436
Storage location ..................................436
Wheel chock
see Wheel chock
Wheels
Care ....................................................389
Changing hub caps .............................. 437
Checking .............................................. 413
Checking the tire pressure (man‐
ually) ....................................................417
Checking the tire pressure (tire pres‐
sure monitoring system) ......................419
Definitions ........................................... 430
DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN)
.............................................................426
Flat tire ................................................ 393
Interchanging ...................................... 435
Load index ........................................... 428
Load-bearing capacity ......................... 428
Maximum tire load .............................. 427
Maximum tire pressure ....................... 427
MOExtended tires ................................ 394
Mounting ............................................. 440
Noise ...................................................413
Notes on mounting .............................. 433
Overview of tire
labeling ......................425
R
emoving ............................................ 440
Replacing .................................... 433, 437
Restarting the tire pressure monitor‐
ing system ...........................................420
Selection ............................................. 433
Snow chains .........................................414
Speed rating ........................................ 428
Storing ................................................ 436
Temperature grade .............................. 425
Tire and Loading Information placard
.............................................................420
Tire characteristics .............................. 428
Tire pressure (notes) ............................414
Tire pressure monitoring system
(function) ............................................. 418
Tire pressure table ...............................416
Tire Quality Grading ............................. 425
Tire size designation ............................428
TIREFIT kit ...........................................395
Traction grade .....................................425
Tread wear grade .................................425
Unusual handling ch
arac
teristics .........413
Wi-Fi
Overview ............................................. 280
Setting .................................................280
Setting up a hotspot ............................ 281
Setting up an Internet connection ....... 331
Window air bag .......................................... 38
Window lifter
see Side windows
Windows
see Side windows
Windows (Care) .......................................389
Windshield ................................................ 151
Infrared reflective ................................ 155
Replacing the wiper blades .................. 151
Replacing wiper blades (MAGIC
VISION CONTROL) ............................... 151
Windshield
see Windshield
Windshield heater ................................... 162
Windshield heating
see Windshield heater
556
Index
Windshield washer fluid .........................452
Notes .................................................. 452
Windshield washer system
Refilling ...............................................384
Windshield wipers
Replacing the wiper blades .................. 151
Replacing wiper blades (MAGIC
VISION CONTROL) ............................... 151
Service position ................................... 150
Switching on/off ................................. 149
Winter operation
Snow chains .........................................414
Winter tires
Setting the permanent speed limit ...... 198
Wiper blades
Activating/deactivating the service
position ............................................... 150
Care .................................................... 389
Replacing .............................................151
Replacing (MAGIC VISION CONTROL)
.............................................................151
Wireless charging
Function/notes ................................... 139
Mobile phone ....................................... 140
Mobile phone (rear passenger com‐
partment) ............................................ 140
Wireless vehicle components
Declaration of conformity ...................... 23
Workout program
Overview ...
.......................................... 106
Workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
Index
557
559

Hulp nodig? Stel uw vraag in het forum

Spelregels

Misbruik melden

Gebruikershandleiding.com neemt misbruik van zijn services uitermate serieus. U kunt hieronder aangeven waarom deze vraag ongepast is. Wij controleren de vraag en zonodig wordt deze verwijderd.

Product:

Bijvoorbeeld antisemitische inhoud, racistische inhoud, of materiaal dat gewelddadige fysieke handelingen tot gevolg kan hebben.

Bijvoorbeeld een creditcardnummer, een persoonlijk identificatienummer, of een geheim adres. E-mailadressen en volledige namen worden niet als privégegevens beschouwd.

Spelregels forum

Om tot zinvolle vragen te komen hanteren wij de volgende spelregels:

Belangrijk! Als er een antwoord wordt gegeven op uw vraag, dan is het voor de gever van het antwoord nuttig om te weten als u er wel (of niet) mee geholpen bent! Wij vragen u dus ook te reageren op een antwoord.

Belangrijk! Antwoorden worden ook per e-mail naar abonnees gestuurd. Laat uw emailadres achter op deze site, zodat u op de hoogte blijft. U krijgt dan ook andere vragen en antwoorden te zien.

Abonneren

Abonneer u voor het ontvangen van emails voor uw Mercedes S-Class 2018 bij:


U ontvangt een email met instructies om u voor één of beide opties in te schrijven.


Ontvang uw handleiding per email

Vul uw emailadres in en ontvang de handleiding van Mercedes S-Class 2018 in de taal/talen: Engels als bijlage per email.

De handleiding is 7,77 mb groot.

 

U ontvangt de handleiding per email binnen enkele minuten. Als u geen email heeft ontvangen, dan heeft u waarschijnlijk een verkeerd emailadres ingevuld of is uw mailbox te vol. Daarnaast kan het zijn dat uw internetprovider een maximum heeft aan de grootte per email. Omdat hier een handleiding wordt meegestuurd, kan het voorkomen dat de email groter is dan toegestaan bij uw provider.

Stel vragen via chat aan uw handleiding

Stel uw vraag over deze PDF

Uw handleiding is per email verstuurd. Controleer uw email

Als u niet binnen een kwartier uw email met handleiding ontvangen heeft, kan het zijn dat u een verkeerd emailadres heeft ingevuld of dat uw emailprovider een maximum grootte per email heeft ingesteld die kleiner is dan de grootte van de handleiding.

Er is een email naar u verstuurd om uw inschrijving definitief te maken.

Controleer uw email en volg de aanwijzingen op om uw inschrijving definitief te maken

U heeft geen emailadres opgegeven

Als u de handleiding per email wilt ontvangen, vul dan een geldig emailadres in.

Uw vraag is op deze pagina toegevoegd

Wilt u een email ontvangen bij een antwoord en/of nieuwe vragen? Vul dan hier uw emailadres in.



Info